Convert tid_range_parser and get_number_or_range to classes
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / breakpoint.c
1 /* Everything about breakpoints, for GDB.
2
3 Copyright (C) 1986-2016 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4
5 This file is part of GDB.
6
7 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the License, or
10 (at your option) any later version.
11
12 This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
16
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
19
20 #include "defs.h"
21 #include "arch-utils.h"
22 #include <ctype.h>
23 #include "hashtab.h"
24 #include "symtab.h"
25 #include "frame.h"
26 #include "breakpoint.h"
27 #include "tracepoint.h"
28 #include "gdbtypes.h"
29 #include "expression.h"
30 #include "gdbcore.h"
31 #include "gdbcmd.h"
32 #include "value.h"
33 #include "command.h"
34 #include "inferior.h"
35 #include "infrun.h"
36 #include "gdbthread.h"
37 #include "target.h"
38 #include "language.h"
39 #include "gdb-demangle.h"
40 #include "filenames.h"
41 #include "annotate.h"
42 #include "symfile.h"
43 #include "objfiles.h"
44 #include "source.h"
45 #include "linespec.h"
46 #include "completer.h"
47 #include "gdb.h"
48 #include "ui-out.h"
49 #include "cli/cli-script.h"
50 #include "block.h"
51 #include "solib.h"
52 #include "solist.h"
53 #include "observer.h"
54 #include "memattr.h"
55 #include "ada-lang.h"
56 #include "top.h"
57 #include "valprint.h"
58 #include "jit.h"
59 #include "parser-defs.h"
60 #include "gdb_regex.h"
61 #include "probe.h"
62 #include "cli/cli-utils.h"
63 #include "continuations.h"
64 #include "stack.h"
65 #include "skip.h"
66 #include "ax-gdb.h"
67 #include "dummy-frame.h"
68 #include "interps.h"
69 #include "format.h"
70 #include "location.h"
71 #include "thread-fsm.h"
72 #include "tid-parse.h"
73
74 /* readline include files */
75 #include "readline/readline.h"
76 #include "readline/history.h"
77
78 /* readline defines this. */
79 #undef savestring
80
81 #include "mi/mi-common.h"
82 #include "extension.h"
83 #include <algorithm>
84
85 /* Enums for exception-handling support. */
86 enum exception_event_kind
87 {
88 EX_EVENT_THROW,
89 EX_EVENT_RETHROW,
90 EX_EVENT_CATCH
91 };
92
93 /* Prototypes for local functions. */
94
95 static void enable_delete_command (char *, int);
96
97 static void enable_once_command (char *, int);
98
99 static void enable_count_command (char *, int);
100
101 static void disable_command (char *, int);
102
103 static void enable_command (char *, int);
104
105 static void map_breakpoint_numbers (char *, void (*) (struct breakpoint *,
106 void *),
107 void *);
108
109 static void ignore_command (char *, int);
110
111 static int breakpoint_re_set_one (void *);
112
113 static void breakpoint_re_set_default (struct breakpoint *);
114
115 static void
116 create_sals_from_location_default (const struct event_location *location,
117 struct linespec_result *canonical,
118 enum bptype type_wanted);
119
120 static void create_breakpoints_sal_default (struct gdbarch *,
121 struct linespec_result *,
122 char *, char *, enum bptype,
123 enum bpdisp, int, int,
124 int,
125 const struct breakpoint_ops *,
126 int, int, int, unsigned);
127
128 static void decode_location_default (struct breakpoint *b,
129 const struct event_location *location,
130 struct program_space *search_pspace,
131 struct symtabs_and_lines *sals);
132
133 static void clear_command (char *, int);
134
135 static void catch_command (char *, int);
136
137 static int can_use_hardware_watchpoint (struct value *);
138
139 static void break_command_1 (char *, int, int);
140
141 static void mention (struct breakpoint *);
142
143 static struct breakpoint *set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (struct gdbarch *,
144 enum bptype,
145 const struct breakpoint_ops *);
146 static struct bp_location *add_location_to_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *,
147 const struct symtab_and_line *);
148
149 /* This function is used in gdbtk sources and thus can not be made
150 static. */
151 struct breakpoint *set_raw_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
152 struct symtab_and_line,
153 enum bptype,
154 const struct breakpoint_ops *);
155
156 static struct breakpoint *
157 momentary_breakpoint_from_master (struct breakpoint *orig,
158 enum bptype type,
159 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
160 int loc_enabled);
161
162 static void breakpoint_adjustment_warning (CORE_ADDR, CORE_ADDR, int, int);
163
164 static CORE_ADDR adjust_breakpoint_address (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
165 CORE_ADDR bpaddr,
166 enum bptype bptype);
167
168 static void describe_other_breakpoints (struct gdbarch *,
169 struct program_space *, CORE_ADDR,
170 struct obj_section *, int);
171
172 static int watchpoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1,
173 struct bp_location *loc2);
174
175 static int breakpoint_location_address_match (struct bp_location *bl,
176 struct address_space *aspace,
177 CORE_ADDR addr);
178
179 static int breakpoint_location_address_range_overlap (struct bp_location *,
180 struct address_space *,
181 CORE_ADDR, int);
182
183 static void breakpoints_info (char *, int);
184
185 static void watchpoints_info (char *, int);
186
187 static int breakpoint_1 (char *, int,
188 int (*) (const struct breakpoint *));
189
190 static int breakpoint_cond_eval (void *);
191
192 static void cleanup_executing_breakpoints (void *);
193
194 static void commands_command (char *, int);
195
196 static void condition_command (char *, int);
197
198 static int remove_breakpoint (struct bp_location *);
199 static int remove_breakpoint_1 (struct bp_location *, enum remove_bp_reason);
200
201 static enum print_stop_action print_bp_stop_message (bpstat bs);
202
203 static int watchpoint_check (void *);
204
205 static void maintenance_info_breakpoints (char *, int);
206
207 static int hw_breakpoint_used_count (void);
208
209 static int hw_watchpoint_use_count (struct breakpoint *);
210
211 static int hw_watchpoint_used_count_others (struct breakpoint *except,
212 enum bptype type,
213 int *other_type_used);
214
215 static void hbreak_command (char *, int);
216
217 static void thbreak_command (char *, int);
218
219 static void enable_breakpoint_disp (struct breakpoint *, enum bpdisp,
220 int count);
221
222 static void stop_command (char *arg, int from_tty);
223
224 static void stopin_command (char *arg, int from_tty);
225
226 static void stopat_command (char *arg, int from_tty);
227
228 static void tcatch_command (char *arg, int from_tty);
229
230 static void free_bp_location (struct bp_location *loc);
231 static void incref_bp_location (struct bp_location *loc);
232 static void decref_bp_location (struct bp_location **loc);
233
234 static struct bp_location *allocate_bp_location (struct breakpoint *bpt);
235
236 /* update_global_location_list's modes of operation wrt to whether to
237 insert locations now. */
238 enum ugll_insert_mode
239 {
240 /* Don't insert any breakpoint locations into the inferior, only
241 remove already-inserted locations that no longer should be
242 inserted. Functions that delete a breakpoint or breakpoints
243 should specify this mode, so that deleting a breakpoint doesn't
244 have the side effect of inserting the locations of other
245 breakpoints that are marked not-inserted, but should_be_inserted
246 returns true on them.
247
248 This behavior is useful is situations close to tear-down -- e.g.,
249 after an exec, while the target still has execution, but
250 breakpoint shadows of the previous executable image should *NOT*
251 be restored to the new image; or before detaching, where the
252 target still has execution and wants to delete breakpoints from
253 GDB's lists, and all breakpoints had already been removed from
254 the inferior. */
255 UGLL_DONT_INSERT,
256
257 /* May insert breakpoints iff breakpoints_should_be_inserted_now
258 claims breakpoints should be inserted now. */
259 UGLL_MAY_INSERT,
260
261 /* Insert locations now, irrespective of
262 breakpoints_should_be_inserted_now. E.g., say all threads are
263 stopped right now, and the user did "continue". We need to
264 insert breakpoints _before_ resuming the target, but
265 UGLL_MAY_INSERT wouldn't insert them, because
266 breakpoints_should_be_inserted_now returns false at that point,
267 as no thread is running yet. */
268 UGLL_INSERT
269 };
270
271 static void update_global_location_list (enum ugll_insert_mode);
272
273 static void update_global_location_list_nothrow (enum ugll_insert_mode);
274
275 static int is_hardware_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *bpt);
276
277 static void insert_breakpoint_locations (void);
278
279 static void tracepoints_info (char *, int);
280
281 static void delete_trace_command (char *, int);
282
283 static void enable_trace_command (char *, int);
284
285 static void disable_trace_command (char *, int);
286
287 static void trace_pass_command (char *, int);
288
289 static void set_tracepoint_count (int num);
290
291 static int is_masked_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *b);
292
293 static struct bp_location **get_first_locp_gte_addr (CORE_ADDR address);
294
295 /* Return 1 if B refers to a static tracepoint set by marker ("-m"), zero
296 otherwise. */
297
298 static int strace_marker_p (struct breakpoint *b);
299
300 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be inherited by all breakpoint_ops
301 that are implemented on top of software or hardware breakpoints
302 (user breakpoints, internal and momentary breakpoints, etc.). */
303 static struct breakpoint_ops bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops;
304
305 /* Internal breakpoints class type. */
306 static struct breakpoint_ops internal_breakpoint_ops;
307
308 /* Momentary breakpoints class type. */
309 static struct breakpoint_ops momentary_breakpoint_ops;
310
311 /* Momentary breakpoints for bp_longjmp and bp_exception class type. */
312 static struct breakpoint_ops longjmp_breakpoint_ops;
313
314 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in regular user created
315 breakpoints. */
316 struct breakpoint_ops bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
317
318 /* Breakpoints set on probes. */
319 static struct breakpoint_ops bkpt_probe_breakpoint_ops;
320
321 /* Dynamic printf class type. */
322 struct breakpoint_ops dprintf_breakpoint_ops;
323
324 /* The style in which to perform a dynamic printf. This is a user
325 option because different output options have different tradeoffs;
326 if GDB does the printing, there is better error handling if there
327 is a problem with any of the arguments, but using an inferior
328 function lets you have special-purpose printers and sending of
329 output to the same place as compiled-in print functions. */
330
331 static const char dprintf_style_gdb[] = "gdb";
332 static const char dprintf_style_call[] = "call";
333 static const char dprintf_style_agent[] = "agent";
334 static const char *const dprintf_style_enums[] = {
335 dprintf_style_gdb,
336 dprintf_style_call,
337 dprintf_style_agent,
338 NULL
339 };
340 static const char *dprintf_style = dprintf_style_gdb;
341
342 /* The function to use for dynamic printf if the preferred style is to
343 call into the inferior. The value is simply a string that is
344 copied into the command, so it can be anything that GDB can
345 evaluate to a callable address, not necessarily a function name. */
346
347 static char *dprintf_function = "";
348
349 /* The channel to use for dynamic printf if the preferred style is to
350 call into the inferior; if a nonempty string, it will be passed to
351 the call as the first argument, with the format string as the
352 second. As with the dprintf function, this can be anything that
353 GDB knows how to evaluate, so in addition to common choices like
354 "stderr", this could be an app-specific expression like
355 "mystreams[curlogger]". */
356
357 static char *dprintf_channel = "";
358
359 /* True if dprintf commands should continue to operate even if GDB
360 has disconnected. */
361 static int disconnected_dprintf = 1;
362
363 /* A reference-counted struct command_line. This lets multiple
364 breakpoints share a single command list. */
365 struct counted_command_line
366 {
367 /* The reference count. */
368 int refc;
369
370 /* The command list. */
371 struct command_line *commands;
372 };
373
374 struct command_line *
375 breakpoint_commands (struct breakpoint *b)
376 {
377 return b->commands ? b->commands->commands : NULL;
378 }
379
380 /* Flag indicating that a command has proceeded the inferior past the
381 current breakpoint. */
382
383 static int breakpoint_proceeded;
384
385 const char *
386 bpdisp_text (enum bpdisp disp)
387 {
388 /* NOTE: the following values are a part of MI protocol and
389 represent values of 'disp' field returned when inferior stops at
390 a breakpoint. */
391 static const char * const bpdisps[] = {"del", "dstp", "dis", "keep"};
392
393 return bpdisps[(int) disp];
394 }
395
396 /* Prototypes for exported functions. */
397 /* If FALSE, gdb will not use hardware support for watchpoints, even
398 if such is available. */
399 static int can_use_hw_watchpoints;
400
401 static void
402 show_can_use_hw_watchpoints (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
403 struct cmd_list_element *c,
404 const char *value)
405 {
406 fprintf_filtered (file,
407 _("Debugger's willingness to use "
408 "watchpoint hardware is %s.\n"),
409 value);
410 }
411
412 /* If AUTO_BOOLEAN_FALSE, gdb will not attempt to create pending breakpoints.
413 If AUTO_BOOLEAN_TRUE, gdb will automatically create pending breakpoints
414 for unrecognized breakpoint locations.
415 If AUTO_BOOLEAN_AUTO, gdb will query when breakpoints are unrecognized. */
416 static enum auto_boolean pending_break_support;
417 static void
418 show_pending_break_support (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
419 struct cmd_list_element *c,
420 const char *value)
421 {
422 fprintf_filtered (file,
423 _("Debugger's behavior regarding "
424 "pending breakpoints is %s.\n"),
425 value);
426 }
427
428 /* If 1, gdb will automatically use hardware breakpoints for breakpoints
429 set with "break" but falling in read-only memory.
430 If 0, gdb will warn about such breakpoints, but won't automatically
431 use hardware breakpoints. */
432 static int automatic_hardware_breakpoints;
433 static void
434 show_automatic_hardware_breakpoints (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
435 struct cmd_list_element *c,
436 const char *value)
437 {
438 fprintf_filtered (file,
439 _("Automatic usage of hardware breakpoints is %s.\n"),
440 value);
441 }
442
443 /* If on, GDB keeps breakpoints inserted even if the inferior is
444 stopped, and immediately inserts any new breakpoints as soon as
445 they're created. If off (default), GDB keeps breakpoints off of
446 the target as long as possible. That is, it delays inserting
447 breakpoints until the next resume, and removes them again when the
448 target fully stops. This is a bit safer in case GDB crashes while
449 processing user input. */
450 static int always_inserted_mode = 0;
451
452 static void
453 show_always_inserted_mode (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
454 struct cmd_list_element *c, const char *value)
455 {
456 fprintf_filtered (file, _("Always inserted breakpoint mode is %s.\n"),
457 value);
458 }
459
460 /* See breakpoint.h. */
461
462 int
463 breakpoints_should_be_inserted_now (void)
464 {
465 if (gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ()))
466 {
467 /* If breakpoints are global, they should be inserted even if no
468 thread under gdb's control is running, or even if there are
469 no threads under GDB's control yet. */
470 return 1;
471 }
472 else if (target_has_execution)
473 {
474 struct thread_info *tp;
475
476 if (always_inserted_mode)
477 {
478 /* The user wants breakpoints inserted even if all threads
479 are stopped. */
480 return 1;
481 }
482
483 if (threads_are_executing ())
484 return 1;
485
486 /* Don't remove breakpoints yet if, even though all threads are
487 stopped, we still have events to process. */
488 ALL_NON_EXITED_THREADS (tp)
489 if (tp->resumed
490 && tp->suspend.waitstatus_pending_p)
491 return 1;
492 }
493 return 0;
494 }
495
496 static const char condition_evaluation_both[] = "host or target";
497
498 /* Modes for breakpoint condition evaluation. */
499 static const char condition_evaluation_auto[] = "auto";
500 static const char condition_evaluation_host[] = "host";
501 static const char condition_evaluation_target[] = "target";
502 static const char *const condition_evaluation_enums[] = {
503 condition_evaluation_auto,
504 condition_evaluation_host,
505 condition_evaluation_target,
506 NULL
507 };
508
509 /* Global that holds the current mode for breakpoint condition evaluation. */
510 static const char *condition_evaluation_mode_1 = condition_evaluation_auto;
511
512 /* Global that we use to display information to the user (gets its value from
513 condition_evaluation_mode_1. */
514 static const char *condition_evaluation_mode = condition_evaluation_auto;
515
516 /* Translate a condition evaluation mode MODE into either "host"
517 or "target". This is used mostly to translate from "auto" to the
518 real setting that is being used. It returns the translated
519 evaluation mode. */
520
521 static const char *
522 translate_condition_evaluation_mode (const char *mode)
523 {
524 if (mode == condition_evaluation_auto)
525 {
526 if (target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
527 return condition_evaluation_target;
528 else
529 return condition_evaluation_host;
530 }
531 else
532 return mode;
533 }
534
535 /* Discovers what condition_evaluation_auto translates to. */
536
537 static const char *
538 breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode (void)
539 {
540 return translate_condition_evaluation_mode (condition_evaluation_mode);
541 }
542
543 /* Return true if GDB should evaluate breakpoint conditions or false
544 otherwise. */
545
546 static int
547 gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p (void)
548 {
549 const char *mode = breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode ();
550
551 return (mode == condition_evaluation_host);
552 }
553
554 void _initialize_breakpoint (void);
555
556 /* Are we executing breakpoint commands? */
557 static int executing_breakpoint_commands;
558
559 /* Are overlay event breakpoints enabled? */
560 static int overlay_events_enabled;
561
562 /* See description in breakpoint.h. */
563 int target_exact_watchpoints = 0;
564
565 /* Walk the following statement or block through all breakpoints.
566 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE does so even if the statement deletes the
567 current breakpoint. */
568
569 #define ALL_BREAKPOINTS(B) for (B = breakpoint_chain; B; B = B->next)
570
571 #define ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE(B,TMP) \
572 for (B = breakpoint_chain; \
573 B ? (TMP=B->next, 1): 0; \
574 B = TMP)
575
576 /* Similar iterator for the low-level breakpoints. SAFE variant is
577 not provided so update_global_location_list must not be called
578 while executing the block of ALL_BP_LOCATIONS. */
579
580 #define ALL_BP_LOCATIONS(B,BP_TMP) \
581 for (BP_TMP = bp_location; \
582 BP_TMP < bp_location + bp_location_count && (B = *BP_TMP); \
583 BP_TMP++)
584
585 /* Iterates through locations with address ADDRESS for the currently selected
586 program space. BP_LOCP_TMP points to each object. BP_LOCP_START points
587 to where the loop should start from.
588 If BP_LOCP_START is a NULL pointer, the macro automatically seeks the
589 appropriate location to start with. */
590
591 #define ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR(BP_LOCP_TMP, BP_LOCP_START, ADDRESS) \
592 for (BP_LOCP_START = BP_LOCP_START == NULL ? get_first_locp_gte_addr (ADDRESS) : BP_LOCP_START, \
593 BP_LOCP_TMP = BP_LOCP_START; \
594 BP_LOCP_START \
595 && (BP_LOCP_TMP < bp_location + bp_location_count \
596 && (*BP_LOCP_TMP)->address == ADDRESS); \
597 BP_LOCP_TMP++)
598
599 /* Iterator for tracepoints only. */
600
601 #define ALL_TRACEPOINTS(B) \
602 for (B = breakpoint_chain; B; B = B->next) \
603 if (is_tracepoint (B))
604
605 /* Chains of all breakpoints defined. */
606
607 struct breakpoint *breakpoint_chain;
608
609 /* Array is sorted by bp_location_compare - primarily by the ADDRESS. */
610
611 static struct bp_location **bp_location;
612
613 /* Number of elements of BP_LOCATION. */
614
615 static unsigned bp_location_count;
616
617 /* Maximum alignment offset between bp_target_info.PLACED_ADDRESS and
618 ADDRESS for the current elements of BP_LOCATION which get a valid
619 result from bp_location_has_shadow. You can use it for roughly
620 limiting the subrange of BP_LOCATION to scan for shadow bytes for
621 an address you need to read. */
622
623 static CORE_ADDR bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max;
624
625 /* Maximum offset plus alignment between bp_target_info.PLACED_ADDRESS
626 + bp_target_info.SHADOW_LEN and ADDRESS for the current elements of
627 BP_LOCATION which get a valid result from bp_location_has_shadow.
628 You can use it for roughly limiting the subrange of BP_LOCATION to
629 scan for shadow bytes for an address you need to read. */
630
631 static CORE_ADDR bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max;
632
633 /* The locations that no longer correspond to any breakpoint, unlinked
634 from bp_location array, but for which a hit may still be reported
635 by a target. */
636 VEC(bp_location_p) *moribund_locations = NULL;
637
638 /* Number of last breakpoint made. */
639
640 static int breakpoint_count;
641
642 /* The value of `breakpoint_count' before the last command that
643 created breakpoints. If the last (break-like) command created more
644 than one breakpoint, then the difference between BREAKPOINT_COUNT
645 and PREV_BREAKPOINT_COUNT is more than one. */
646 static int prev_breakpoint_count;
647
648 /* Number of last tracepoint made. */
649
650 static int tracepoint_count;
651
652 static struct cmd_list_element *breakpoint_set_cmdlist;
653 static struct cmd_list_element *breakpoint_show_cmdlist;
654 struct cmd_list_element *save_cmdlist;
655
656 /* See declaration at breakpoint.h. */
657
658 struct breakpoint *
659 breakpoint_find_if (int (*func) (struct breakpoint *b, void *d),
660 void *user_data)
661 {
662 struct breakpoint *b = NULL;
663
664 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
665 {
666 if (func (b, user_data) != 0)
667 break;
668 }
669
670 return b;
671 }
672
673 /* Return whether a breakpoint is an active enabled breakpoint. */
674 static int
675 breakpoint_enabled (struct breakpoint *b)
676 {
677 return (b->enable_state == bp_enabled);
678 }
679
680 /* Set breakpoint count to NUM. */
681
682 static void
683 set_breakpoint_count (int num)
684 {
685 prev_breakpoint_count = breakpoint_count;
686 breakpoint_count = num;
687 set_internalvar_integer (lookup_internalvar ("bpnum"), num);
688 }
689
690 /* Used by `start_rbreak_breakpoints' below, to record the current
691 breakpoint count before "rbreak" creates any breakpoint. */
692 static int rbreak_start_breakpoint_count;
693
694 /* Called at the start an "rbreak" command to record the first
695 breakpoint made. */
696
697 void
698 start_rbreak_breakpoints (void)
699 {
700 rbreak_start_breakpoint_count = breakpoint_count;
701 }
702
703 /* Called at the end of an "rbreak" command to record the last
704 breakpoint made. */
705
706 void
707 end_rbreak_breakpoints (void)
708 {
709 prev_breakpoint_count = rbreak_start_breakpoint_count;
710 }
711
712 /* Used in run_command to zero the hit count when a new run starts. */
713
714 void
715 clear_breakpoint_hit_counts (void)
716 {
717 struct breakpoint *b;
718
719 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
720 b->hit_count = 0;
721 }
722
723 /* Allocate a new counted_command_line with reference count of 1.
724 The new structure owns COMMANDS. */
725
726 static struct counted_command_line *
727 alloc_counted_command_line (struct command_line *commands)
728 {
729 struct counted_command_line *result = XNEW (struct counted_command_line);
730
731 result->refc = 1;
732 result->commands = commands;
733
734 return result;
735 }
736
737 /* Increment reference count. This does nothing if CMD is NULL. */
738
739 static void
740 incref_counted_command_line (struct counted_command_line *cmd)
741 {
742 if (cmd)
743 ++cmd->refc;
744 }
745
746 /* Decrement reference count. If the reference count reaches 0,
747 destroy the counted_command_line. Sets *CMDP to NULL. This does
748 nothing if *CMDP is NULL. */
749
750 static void
751 decref_counted_command_line (struct counted_command_line **cmdp)
752 {
753 if (*cmdp)
754 {
755 if (--(*cmdp)->refc == 0)
756 {
757 free_command_lines (&(*cmdp)->commands);
758 xfree (*cmdp);
759 }
760 *cmdp = NULL;
761 }
762 }
763
764 /* A cleanup function that calls decref_counted_command_line. */
765
766 static void
767 do_cleanup_counted_command_line (void *arg)
768 {
769 decref_counted_command_line ((struct counted_command_line **) arg);
770 }
771
772 /* Create a cleanup that calls decref_counted_command_line on the
773 argument. */
774
775 static struct cleanup *
776 make_cleanup_decref_counted_command_line (struct counted_command_line **cmdp)
777 {
778 return make_cleanup (do_cleanup_counted_command_line, cmdp);
779 }
780
781 \f
782 /* Return the breakpoint with the specified number, or NULL
783 if the number does not refer to an existing breakpoint. */
784
785 struct breakpoint *
786 get_breakpoint (int num)
787 {
788 struct breakpoint *b;
789
790 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
791 if (b->number == num)
792 return b;
793
794 return NULL;
795 }
796
797 \f
798
799 /* Mark locations as "conditions have changed" in case the target supports
800 evaluating conditions on its side. */
801
802 static void
803 mark_breakpoint_modified (struct breakpoint *b)
804 {
805 struct bp_location *loc;
806
807 /* This is only meaningful if the target is
808 evaluating conditions and if the user has
809 opted for condition evaluation on the target's
810 side. */
811 if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
812 || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
813 return;
814
815 if (!is_breakpoint (b))
816 return;
817
818 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
819 loc->condition_changed = condition_modified;
820 }
821
822 /* Mark location as "conditions have changed" in case the target supports
823 evaluating conditions on its side. */
824
825 static void
826 mark_breakpoint_location_modified (struct bp_location *loc)
827 {
828 /* This is only meaningful if the target is
829 evaluating conditions and if the user has
830 opted for condition evaluation on the target's
831 side. */
832 if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
833 || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
834
835 return;
836
837 if (!is_breakpoint (loc->owner))
838 return;
839
840 loc->condition_changed = condition_modified;
841 }
842
843 /* Sets the condition-evaluation mode using the static global
844 condition_evaluation_mode. */
845
846 static void
847 set_condition_evaluation_mode (char *args, int from_tty,
848 struct cmd_list_element *c)
849 {
850 const char *old_mode, *new_mode;
851
852 if ((condition_evaluation_mode_1 == condition_evaluation_target)
853 && !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
854 {
855 condition_evaluation_mode_1 = condition_evaluation_mode;
856 warning (_("Target does not support breakpoint condition evaluation.\n"
857 "Using host evaluation mode instead."));
858 return;
859 }
860
861 new_mode = translate_condition_evaluation_mode (condition_evaluation_mode_1);
862 old_mode = translate_condition_evaluation_mode (condition_evaluation_mode);
863
864 /* Flip the switch. Flip it even if OLD_MODE == NEW_MODE as one of the
865 settings was "auto". */
866 condition_evaluation_mode = condition_evaluation_mode_1;
867
868 /* Only update the mode if the user picked a different one. */
869 if (new_mode != old_mode)
870 {
871 struct bp_location *loc, **loc_tmp;
872 /* If the user switched to a different evaluation mode, we
873 need to synch the changes with the target as follows:
874
875 "host" -> "target": Send all (valid) conditions to the target.
876 "target" -> "host": Remove all the conditions from the target.
877 */
878
879 if (new_mode == condition_evaluation_target)
880 {
881 /* Mark everything modified and synch conditions with the
882 target. */
883 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, loc_tmp)
884 mark_breakpoint_location_modified (loc);
885 }
886 else
887 {
888 /* Manually mark non-duplicate locations to synch conditions
889 with the target. We do this to remove all the conditions the
890 target knows about. */
891 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, loc_tmp)
892 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) && loc->inserted)
893 loc->needs_update = 1;
894 }
895
896 /* Do the update. */
897 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
898 }
899
900 return;
901 }
902
903 /* Shows the current mode of breakpoint condition evaluation. Explicitly shows
904 what "auto" is translating to. */
905
906 static void
907 show_condition_evaluation_mode (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
908 struct cmd_list_element *c, const char *value)
909 {
910 if (condition_evaluation_mode == condition_evaluation_auto)
911 fprintf_filtered (file,
912 _("Breakpoint condition evaluation "
913 "mode is %s (currently %s).\n"),
914 value,
915 breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode ());
916 else
917 fprintf_filtered (file, _("Breakpoint condition evaluation mode is %s.\n"),
918 value);
919 }
920
921 /* A comparison function for bp_location AP and BP that is used by
922 bsearch. This comparison function only cares about addresses, unlike
923 the more general bp_location_compare function. */
924
925 static int
926 bp_location_compare_addrs (const void *ap, const void *bp)
927 {
928 const struct bp_location *a = *(const struct bp_location **) ap;
929 const struct bp_location *b = *(const struct bp_location **) bp;
930
931 if (a->address == b->address)
932 return 0;
933 else
934 return ((a->address > b->address) - (a->address < b->address));
935 }
936
937 /* Helper function to skip all bp_locations with addresses
938 less than ADDRESS. It returns the first bp_location that
939 is greater than or equal to ADDRESS. If none is found, just
940 return NULL. */
941
942 static struct bp_location **
943 get_first_locp_gte_addr (CORE_ADDR address)
944 {
945 struct bp_location dummy_loc;
946 struct bp_location *dummy_locp = &dummy_loc;
947 struct bp_location **locp_found = NULL;
948
949 /* Initialize the dummy location's address field. */
950 memset (&dummy_loc, 0, sizeof (struct bp_location));
951 dummy_loc.address = address;
952
953 /* Find a close match to the first location at ADDRESS. */
954 locp_found = ((struct bp_location **)
955 bsearch (&dummy_locp, bp_location, bp_location_count,
956 sizeof (struct bp_location **),
957 bp_location_compare_addrs));
958
959 /* Nothing was found, nothing left to do. */
960 if (locp_found == NULL)
961 return NULL;
962
963 /* We may have found a location that is at ADDRESS but is not the first in the
964 location's list. Go backwards (if possible) and locate the first one. */
965 while ((locp_found - 1) >= bp_location
966 && (*(locp_found - 1))->address == address)
967 locp_found--;
968
969 return locp_found;
970 }
971
972 void
973 set_breakpoint_condition (struct breakpoint *b, const char *exp,
974 int from_tty)
975 {
976 xfree (b->cond_string);
977 b->cond_string = NULL;
978
979 if (is_watchpoint (b))
980 {
981 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
982
983 xfree (w->cond_exp);
984 w->cond_exp = NULL;
985 }
986 else
987 {
988 struct bp_location *loc;
989
990 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
991 {
992 xfree (loc->cond);
993 loc->cond = NULL;
994
995 /* No need to free the condition agent expression
996 bytecode (if we have one). We will handle this
997 when we go through update_global_location_list. */
998 }
999 }
1000
1001 if (*exp == 0)
1002 {
1003 if (from_tty)
1004 printf_filtered (_("Breakpoint %d now unconditional.\n"), b->number);
1005 }
1006 else
1007 {
1008 const char *arg = exp;
1009
1010 /* I don't know if it matters whether this is the string the user
1011 typed in or the decompiled expression. */
1012 b->cond_string = xstrdup (arg);
1013 b->condition_not_parsed = 0;
1014
1015 if (is_watchpoint (b))
1016 {
1017 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
1018
1019 innermost_block = NULL;
1020 arg = exp;
1021 w->cond_exp = parse_exp_1 (&arg, 0, 0, 0);
1022 if (*arg)
1023 error (_("Junk at end of expression"));
1024 w->cond_exp_valid_block = innermost_block;
1025 }
1026 else
1027 {
1028 struct bp_location *loc;
1029
1030 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
1031 {
1032 arg = exp;
1033 loc->cond =
1034 parse_exp_1 (&arg, loc->address,
1035 block_for_pc (loc->address), 0);
1036 if (*arg)
1037 error (_("Junk at end of expression"));
1038 }
1039 }
1040 }
1041 mark_breakpoint_modified (b);
1042
1043 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b);
1044 }
1045
1046 /* Completion for the "condition" command. */
1047
1048 static VEC (char_ptr) *
1049 condition_completer (struct cmd_list_element *cmd,
1050 const char *text, const char *word)
1051 {
1052 const char *space;
1053
1054 text = skip_spaces_const (text);
1055 space = skip_to_space_const (text);
1056 if (*space == '\0')
1057 {
1058 int len;
1059 struct breakpoint *b;
1060 VEC (char_ptr) *result = NULL;
1061
1062 if (text[0] == '$')
1063 {
1064 /* We don't support completion of history indices. */
1065 if (isdigit (text[1]))
1066 return NULL;
1067 return complete_internalvar (&text[1]);
1068 }
1069
1070 /* We're completing the breakpoint number. */
1071 len = strlen (text);
1072
1073 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
1074 {
1075 char number[50];
1076
1077 xsnprintf (number, sizeof (number), "%d", b->number);
1078
1079 if (strncmp (number, text, len) == 0)
1080 VEC_safe_push (char_ptr, result, xstrdup (number));
1081 }
1082
1083 return result;
1084 }
1085
1086 /* We're completing the expression part. */
1087 text = skip_spaces_const (space);
1088 return expression_completer (cmd, text, word);
1089 }
1090
1091 /* condition N EXP -- set break condition of breakpoint N to EXP. */
1092
1093 static void
1094 condition_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
1095 {
1096 struct breakpoint *b;
1097 char *p;
1098 int bnum;
1099
1100 if (arg == 0)
1101 error_no_arg (_("breakpoint number"));
1102
1103 p = arg;
1104 bnum = get_number (&p);
1105 if (bnum == 0)
1106 error (_("Bad breakpoint argument: '%s'"), arg);
1107
1108 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
1109 if (b->number == bnum)
1110 {
1111 /* Check if this breakpoint has a "stop" method implemented in an
1112 extension language. This method and conditions entered into GDB
1113 from the CLI are mutually exclusive. */
1114 const struct extension_language_defn *extlang
1115 = get_breakpoint_cond_ext_lang (b, EXT_LANG_NONE);
1116
1117 if (extlang != NULL)
1118 {
1119 error (_("Only one stop condition allowed. There is currently"
1120 " a %s stop condition defined for this breakpoint."),
1121 ext_lang_capitalized_name (extlang));
1122 }
1123 set_breakpoint_condition (b, p, from_tty);
1124
1125 if (is_breakpoint (b))
1126 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
1127
1128 return;
1129 }
1130
1131 error (_("No breakpoint number %d."), bnum);
1132 }
1133
1134 /* Check that COMMAND do not contain commands that are suitable
1135 only for tracepoints and not suitable for ordinary breakpoints.
1136 Throw if any such commands is found. */
1137
1138 static void
1139 check_no_tracepoint_commands (struct command_line *commands)
1140 {
1141 struct command_line *c;
1142
1143 for (c = commands; c; c = c->next)
1144 {
1145 int i;
1146
1147 if (c->control_type == while_stepping_control)
1148 error (_("The 'while-stepping' command can "
1149 "only be used for tracepoints"));
1150
1151 for (i = 0; i < c->body_count; ++i)
1152 check_no_tracepoint_commands ((c->body_list)[i]);
1153
1154 /* Not that command parsing removes leading whitespace and comment
1155 lines and also empty lines. So, we only need to check for
1156 command directly. */
1157 if (strstr (c->line, "collect ") == c->line)
1158 error (_("The 'collect' command can only be used for tracepoints"));
1159
1160 if (strstr (c->line, "teval ") == c->line)
1161 error (_("The 'teval' command can only be used for tracepoints"));
1162 }
1163 }
1164
1165 /* Encapsulate tests for different types of tracepoints. */
1166
1167 static int
1168 is_tracepoint_type (enum bptype type)
1169 {
1170 return (type == bp_tracepoint
1171 || type == bp_fast_tracepoint
1172 || type == bp_static_tracepoint);
1173 }
1174
1175 int
1176 is_tracepoint (const struct breakpoint *b)
1177 {
1178 return is_tracepoint_type (b->type);
1179 }
1180
1181 /* A helper function that validates that COMMANDS are valid for a
1182 breakpoint. This function will throw an exception if a problem is
1183 found. */
1184
1185 static void
1186 validate_commands_for_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
1187 struct command_line *commands)
1188 {
1189 if (is_tracepoint (b))
1190 {
1191 struct tracepoint *t = (struct tracepoint *) b;
1192 struct command_line *c;
1193 struct command_line *while_stepping = 0;
1194
1195 /* Reset the while-stepping step count. The previous commands
1196 might have included a while-stepping action, while the new
1197 ones might not. */
1198 t->step_count = 0;
1199
1200 /* We need to verify that each top-level element of commands is
1201 valid for tracepoints, that there's at most one
1202 while-stepping element, and that the while-stepping's body
1203 has valid tracing commands excluding nested while-stepping.
1204 We also need to validate the tracepoint action line in the
1205 context of the tracepoint --- validate_actionline actually
1206 has side effects, like setting the tracepoint's
1207 while-stepping STEP_COUNT, in addition to checking if the
1208 collect/teval actions parse and make sense in the
1209 tracepoint's context. */
1210 for (c = commands; c; c = c->next)
1211 {
1212 if (c->control_type == while_stepping_control)
1213 {
1214 if (b->type == bp_fast_tracepoint)
1215 error (_("The 'while-stepping' command "
1216 "cannot be used for fast tracepoint"));
1217 else if (b->type == bp_static_tracepoint)
1218 error (_("The 'while-stepping' command "
1219 "cannot be used for static tracepoint"));
1220
1221 if (while_stepping)
1222 error (_("The 'while-stepping' command "
1223 "can be used only once"));
1224 else
1225 while_stepping = c;
1226 }
1227
1228 validate_actionline (c->line, b);
1229 }
1230 if (while_stepping)
1231 {
1232 struct command_line *c2;
1233
1234 gdb_assert (while_stepping->body_count == 1);
1235 c2 = while_stepping->body_list[0];
1236 for (; c2; c2 = c2->next)
1237 {
1238 if (c2->control_type == while_stepping_control)
1239 error (_("The 'while-stepping' command cannot be nested"));
1240 }
1241 }
1242 }
1243 else
1244 {
1245 check_no_tracepoint_commands (commands);
1246 }
1247 }
1248
1249 /* Return a vector of all the static tracepoints set at ADDR. The
1250 caller is responsible for releasing the vector. */
1251
1252 VEC(breakpoint_p) *
1253 static_tracepoints_here (CORE_ADDR addr)
1254 {
1255 struct breakpoint *b;
1256 VEC(breakpoint_p) *found = 0;
1257 struct bp_location *loc;
1258
1259 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
1260 if (b->type == bp_static_tracepoint)
1261 {
1262 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
1263 if (loc->address == addr)
1264 VEC_safe_push(breakpoint_p, found, b);
1265 }
1266
1267 return found;
1268 }
1269
1270 /* Set the command list of B to COMMANDS. If breakpoint is tracepoint,
1271 validate that only allowed commands are included. */
1272
1273 void
1274 breakpoint_set_commands (struct breakpoint *b,
1275 struct command_line *commands)
1276 {
1277 validate_commands_for_breakpoint (b, commands);
1278
1279 decref_counted_command_line (&b->commands);
1280 b->commands = alloc_counted_command_line (commands);
1281 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b);
1282 }
1283
1284 /* Set the internal `silent' flag on the breakpoint. Note that this
1285 is not the same as the "silent" that may appear in the breakpoint's
1286 commands. */
1287
1288 void
1289 breakpoint_set_silent (struct breakpoint *b, int silent)
1290 {
1291 int old_silent = b->silent;
1292
1293 b->silent = silent;
1294 if (old_silent != silent)
1295 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b);
1296 }
1297
1298 /* Set the thread for this breakpoint. If THREAD is -1, make the
1299 breakpoint work for any thread. */
1300
1301 void
1302 breakpoint_set_thread (struct breakpoint *b, int thread)
1303 {
1304 int old_thread = b->thread;
1305
1306 b->thread = thread;
1307 if (old_thread != thread)
1308 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b);
1309 }
1310
1311 /* Set the task for this breakpoint. If TASK is 0, make the
1312 breakpoint work for any task. */
1313
1314 void
1315 breakpoint_set_task (struct breakpoint *b, int task)
1316 {
1317 int old_task = b->task;
1318
1319 b->task = task;
1320 if (old_task != task)
1321 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b);
1322 }
1323
1324 void
1325 check_tracepoint_command (char *line, void *closure)
1326 {
1327 struct breakpoint *b = (struct breakpoint *) closure;
1328
1329 validate_actionline (line, b);
1330 }
1331
1332 /* A structure used to pass information through
1333 map_breakpoint_numbers. */
1334
1335 struct commands_info
1336 {
1337 /* True if the command was typed at a tty. */
1338 int from_tty;
1339
1340 /* The breakpoint range spec. */
1341 char *arg;
1342
1343 /* Non-NULL if the body of the commands are being read from this
1344 already-parsed command. */
1345 struct command_line *control;
1346
1347 /* The command lines read from the user, or NULL if they have not
1348 yet been read. */
1349 struct counted_command_line *cmd;
1350 };
1351
1352 /* A callback for map_breakpoint_numbers that sets the commands for
1353 commands_command. */
1354
1355 static void
1356 do_map_commands_command (struct breakpoint *b, void *data)
1357 {
1358 struct commands_info *info = (struct commands_info *) data;
1359
1360 if (info->cmd == NULL)
1361 {
1362 struct command_line *l;
1363
1364 if (info->control != NULL)
1365 l = copy_command_lines (info->control->body_list[0]);
1366 else
1367 {
1368 struct cleanup *old_chain;
1369 char *str;
1370
1371 str = xstrprintf (_("Type commands for breakpoint(s) "
1372 "%s, one per line."),
1373 info->arg);
1374
1375 old_chain = make_cleanup (xfree, str);
1376
1377 l = read_command_lines (str,
1378 info->from_tty, 1,
1379 (is_tracepoint (b)
1380 ? check_tracepoint_command : 0),
1381 b);
1382
1383 do_cleanups (old_chain);
1384 }
1385
1386 info->cmd = alloc_counted_command_line (l);
1387 }
1388
1389 /* If a breakpoint was on the list more than once, we don't need to
1390 do anything. */
1391 if (b->commands != info->cmd)
1392 {
1393 validate_commands_for_breakpoint (b, info->cmd->commands);
1394 incref_counted_command_line (info->cmd);
1395 decref_counted_command_line (&b->commands);
1396 b->commands = info->cmd;
1397 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b);
1398 }
1399 }
1400
1401 static void
1402 commands_command_1 (char *arg, int from_tty,
1403 struct command_line *control)
1404 {
1405 struct cleanup *cleanups;
1406 struct commands_info info;
1407
1408 info.from_tty = from_tty;
1409 info.control = control;
1410 info.cmd = NULL;
1411 /* If we read command lines from the user, then `info' will hold an
1412 extra reference to the commands that we must clean up. */
1413 cleanups = make_cleanup_decref_counted_command_line (&info.cmd);
1414
1415 if (arg == NULL || !*arg)
1416 {
1417 if (breakpoint_count - prev_breakpoint_count > 1)
1418 arg = xstrprintf ("%d-%d", prev_breakpoint_count + 1,
1419 breakpoint_count);
1420 else if (breakpoint_count > 0)
1421 arg = xstrprintf ("%d", breakpoint_count);
1422 else
1423 {
1424 /* So that we don't try to free the incoming non-NULL
1425 argument in the cleanup below. Mapping breakpoint
1426 numbers will fail in this case. */
1427 arg = NULL;
1428 }
1429 }
1430 else
1431 /* The command loop has some static state, so we need to preserve
1432 our argument. */
1433 arg = xstrdup (arg);
1434
1435 if (arg != NULL)
1436 make_cleanup (xfree, arg);
1437
1438 info.arg = arg;
1439
1440 map_breakpoint_numbers (arg, do_map_commands_command, &info);
1441
1442 if (info.cmd == NULL)
1443 error (_("No breakpoints specified."));
1444
1445 do_cleanups (cleanups);
1446 }
1447
1448 static void
1449 commands_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
1450 {
1451 commands_command_1 (arg, from_tty, NULL);
1452 }
1453
1454 /* Like commands_command, but instead of reading the commands from
1455 input stream, takes them from an already parsed command structure.
1456
1457 This is used by cli-script.c to DTRT with breakpoint commands
1458 that are part of if and while bodies. */
1459 enum command_control_type
1460 commands_from_control_command (char *arg, struct command_line *cmd)
1461 {
1462 commands_command_1 (arg, 0, cmd);
1463 return simple_control;
1464 }
1465
1466 /* Return non-zero if BL->TARGET_INFO contains valid information. */
1467
1468 static int
1469 bp_location_has_shadow (struct bp_location *bl)
1470 {
1471 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint)
1472 return 0;
1473 if (!bl->inserted)
1474 return 0;
1475 if (bl->target_info.shadow_len == 0)
1476 /* BL isn't valid, or doesn't shadow memory. */
1477 return 0;
1478 return 1;
1479 }
1480
1481 /* Update BUF, which is LEN bytes read from the target address
1482 MEMADDR, by replacing a memory breakpoint with its shadowed
1483 contents.
1484
1485 If READBUF is not NULL, this buffer must not overlap with the of
1486 the breakpoint location's shadow_contents buffer. Otherwise, a
1487 failed assertion internal error will be raised. */
1488
1489 static void
1490 one_breakpoint_xfer_memory (gdb_byte *readbuf, gdb_byte *writebuf,
1491 const gdb_byte *writebuf_org,
1492 ULONGEST memaddr, LONGEST len,
1493 struct bp_target_info *target_info,
1494 struct gdbarch *gdbarch)
1495 {
1496 /* Now do full processing of the found relevant range of elements. */
1497 CORE_ADDR bp_addr = 0;
1498 int bp_size = 0;
1499 int bptoffset = 0;
1500
1501 if (!breakpoint_address_match (target_info->placed_address_space, 0,
1502 current_program_space->aspace, 0))
1503 {
1504 /* The breakpoint is inserted in a different address space. */
1505 return;
1506 }
1507
1508 /* Addresses and length of the part of the breakpoint that
1509 we need to copy. */
1510 bp_addr = target_info->placed_address;
1511 bp_size = target_info->shadow_len;
1512
1513 if (bp_addr + bp_size <= memaddr)
1514 {
1515 /* The breakpoint is entirely before the chunk of memory we are
1516 reading. */
1517 return;
1518 }
1519
1520 if (bp_addr >= memaddr + len)
1521 {
1522 /* The breakpoint is entirely after the chunk of memory we are
1523 reading. */
1524 return;
1525 }
1526
1527 /* Offset within shadow_contents. */
1528 if (bp_addr < memaddr)
1529 {
1530 /* Only copy the second part of the breakpoint. */
1531 bp_size -= memaddr - bp_addr;
1532 bptoffset = memaddr - bp_addr;
1533 bp_addr = memaddr;
1534 }
1535
1536 if (bp_addr + bp_size > memaddr + len)
1537 {
1538 /* Only copy the first part of the breakpoint. */
1539 bp_size -= (bp_addr + bp_size) - (memaddr + len);
1540 }
1541
1542 if (readbuf != NULL)
1543 {
1544 /* Verify that the readbuf buffer does not overlap with the
1545 shadow_contents buffer. */
1546 gdb_assert (target_info->shadow_contents >= readbuf + len
1547 || readbuf >= (target_info->shadow_contents
1548 + target_info->shadow_len));
1549
1550 /* Update the read buffer with this inserted breakpoint's
1551 shadow. */
1552 memcpy (readbuf + bp_addr - memaddr,
1553 target_info->shadow_contents + bptoffset, bp_size);
1554 }
1555 else
1556 {
1557 const unsigned char *bp;
1558 CORE_ADDR addr = target_info->reqstd_address;
1559 int placed_size;
1560
1561 /* Update the shadow with what we want to write to memory. */
1562 memcpy (target_info->shadow_contents + bptoffset,
1563 writebuf_org + bp_addr - memaddr, bp_size);
1564
1565 /* Determine appropriate breakpoint contents and size for this
1566 address. */
1567 bp = gdbarch_breakpoint_from_pc (gdbarch, &addr, &placed_size);
1568
1569 /* Update the final write buffer with this inserted
1570 breakpoint's INSN. */
1571 memcpy (writebuf + bp_addr - memaddr, bp + bptoffset, bp_size);
1572 }
1573 }
1574
1575 /* Update BUF, which is LEN bytes read from the target address MEMADDR,
1576 by replacing any memory breakpoints with their shadowed contents.
1577
1578 If READBUF is not NULL, this buffer must not overlap with any of
1579 the breakpoint location's shadow_contents buffers. Otherwise,
1580 a failed assertion internal error will be raised.
1581
1582 The range of shadowed area by each bp_location is:
1583 bl->address - bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max
1584 up to bl->address + bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max
1585 The range we were requested to resolve shadows for is:
1586 memaddr ... memaddr + len
1587 Thus the safe cutoff boundaries for performance optimization are
1588 memaddr + len <= (bl->address
1589 - bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max)
1590 and:
1591 bl->address + bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max <= memaddr */
1592
1593 void
1594 breakpoint_xfer_memory (gdb_byte *readbuf, gdb_byte *writebuf,
1595 const gdb_byte *writebuf_org,
1596 ULONGEST memaddr, LONGEST len)
1597 {
1598 /* Left boundary, right boundary and median element of our binary
1599 search. */
1600 unsigned bc_l, bc_r, bc;
1601
1602 /* Find BC_L which is a leftmost element which may affect BUF
1603 content. It is safe to report lower value but a failure to
1604 report higher one. */
1605
1606 bc_l = 0;
1607 bc_r = bp_location_count;
1608 while (bc_l + 1 < bc_r)
1609 {
1610 struct bp_location *bl;
1611
1612 bc = (bc_l + bc_r) / 2;
1613 bl = bp_location[bc];
1614
1615 /* Check first BL->ADDRESS will not overflow due to the added
1616 constant. Then advance the left boundary only if we are sure
1617 the BC element can in no way affect the BUF content (MEMADDR
1618 to MEMADDR + LEN range).
1619
1620 Use the BP_LOCATION_SHADOW_LEN_AFTER_ADDRESS_MAX safety
1621 offset so that we cannot miss a breakpoint with its shadow
1622 range tail still reaching MEMADDR. */
1623
1624 if ((bl->address + bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max
1625 >= bl->address)
1626 && (bl->address + bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max
1627 <= memaddr))
1628 bc_l = bc;
1629 else
1630 bc_r = bc;
1631 }
1632
1633 /* Due to the binary search above, we need to make sure we pick the
1634 first location that's at BC_L's address. E.g., if there are
1635 multiple locations at the same address, BC_L may end up pointing
1636 at a duplicate location, and miss the "master"/"inserted"
1637 location. Say, given locations L1, L2 and L3 at addresses A and
1638 B:
1639
1640 L1@A, L2@A, L3@B, ...
1641
1642 BC_L could end up pointing at location L2, while the "master"
1643 location could be L1. Since the `loc->inserted' flag is only set
1644 on "master" locations, we'd forget to restore the shadow of L1
1645 and L2. */
1646 while (bc_l > 0
1647 && bp_location[bc_l]->address == bp_location[bc_l - 1]->address)
1648 bc_l--;
1649
1650 /* Now do full processing of the found relevant range of elements. */
1651
1652 for (bc = bc_l; bc < bp_location_count; bc++)
1653 {
1654 struct bp_location *bl = bp_location[bc];
1655
1656 /* bp_location array has BL->OWNER always non-NULL. */
1657 if (bl->owner->type == bp_none)
1658 warning (_("reading through apparently deleted breakpoint #%d?"),
1659 bl->owner->number);
1660
1661 /* Performance optimization: any further element can no longer affect BUF
1662 content. */
1663
1664 if (bl->address >= bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max
1665 && memaddr + len <= (bl->address
1666 - bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max))
1667 break;
1668
1669 if (!bp_location_has_shadow (bl))
1670 continue;
1671
1672 one_breakpoint_xfer_memory (readbuf, writebuf, writebuf_org,
1673 memaddr, len, &bl->target_info, bl->gdbarch);
1674 }
1675 }
1676
1677 \f
1678
1679 /* Return true if BPT is either a software breakpoint or a hardware
1680 breakpoint. */
1681
1682 int
1683 is_breakpoint (const struct breakpoint *bpt)
1684 {
1685 return (bpt->type == bp_breakpoint
1686 || bpt->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint
1687 || bpt->type == bp_dprintf);
1688 }
1689
1690 /* Return true if BPT is of any hardware watchpoint kind. */
1691
1692 static int
1693 is_hardware_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *bpt)
1694 {
1695 return (bpt->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
1696 || bpt->type == bp_read_watchpoint
1697 || bpt->type == bp_access_watchpoint);
1698 }
1699
1700 /* Return true if BPT is of any watchpoint kind, hardware or
1701 software. */
1702
1703 int
1704 is_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *bpt)
1705 {
1706 return (is_hardware_watchpoint (bpt)
1707 || bpt->type == bp_watchpoint);
1708 }
1709
1710 /* Returns true if the current thread and its running state are safe
1711 to evaluate or update watchpoint B. Watchpoints on local
1712 expressions need to be evaluated in the context of the thread that
1713 was current when the watchpoint was created, and, that thread needs
1714 to be stopped to be able to select the correct frame context.
1715 Watchpoints on global expressions can be evaluated on any thread,
1716 and in any state. It is presently left to the target allowing
1717 memory accesses when threads are running. */
1718
1719 static int
1720 watchpoint_in_thread_scope (struct watchpoint *b)
1721 {
1722 return (b->base.pspace == current_program_space
1723 && (ptid_equal (b->watchpoint_thread, null_ptid)
1724 || (ptid_equal (inferior_ptid, b->watchpoint_thread)
1725 && !is_executing (inferior_ptid))));
1726 }
1727
1728 /* Set watchpoint B to disp_del_at_next_stop, even including its possible
1729 associated bp_watchpoint_scope breakpoint. */
1730
1731 static void
1732 watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (struct watchpoint *w)
1733 {
1734 struct breakpoint *b = &w->base;
1735
1736 if (b->related_breakpoint != b)
1737 {
1738 gdb_assert (b->related_breakpoint->type == bp_watchpoint_scope);
1739 gdb_assert (b->related_breakpoint->related_breakpoint == b);
1740 b->related_breakpoint->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
1741 b->related_breakpoint->related_breakpoint = b->related_breakpoint;
1742 b->related_breakpoint = b;
1743 }
1744 b->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
1745 }
1746
1747 /* Extract a bitfield value from value VAL using the bit parameters contained in
1748 watchpoint W. */
1749
1750 static struct value *
1751 extract_bitfield_from_watchpoint_value (struct watchpoint *w, struct value *val)
1752 {
1753 struct value *bit_val;
1754
1755 if (val == NULL)
1756 return NULL;
1757
1758 bit_val = allocate_value (value_type (val));
1759
1760 unpack_value_bitfield (bit_val,
1761 w->val_bitpos,
1762 w->val_bitsize,
1763 value_contents_for_printing (val),
1764 value_offset (val),
1765 val);
1766
1767 return bit_val;
1768 }
1769
1770 /* Allocate a dummy location and add it to B, which must be a software
1771 watchpoint. This is required because even if a software watchpoint
1772 is not watching any memory, bpstat_stop_status requires a location
1773 to be able to report stops. */
1774
1775 static void
1776 software_watchpoint_add_no_memory_location (struct breakpoint *b,
1777 struct program_space *pspace)
1778 {
1779 gdb_assert (b->type == bp_watchpoint && b->loc == NULL);
1780
1781 b->loc = allocate_bp_location (b);
1782 b->loc->pspace = pspace;
1783 b->loc->address = -1;
1784 b->loc->length = -1;
1785 }
1786
1787 /* Returns true if B is a software watchpoint that is not watching any
1788 memory (e.g., "watch $pc"). */
1789
1790 static int
1791 is_no_memory_software_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
1792 {
1793 return (b->type == bp_watchpoint
1794 && b->loc != NULL
1795 && b->loc->next == NULL
1796 && b->loc->address == -1
1797 && b->loc->length == -1);
1798 }
1799
1800 /* Assuming that B is a watchpoint:
1801 - Reparse watchpoint expression, if REPARSE is non-zero
1802 - Evaluate expression and store the result in B->val
1803 - Evaluate the condition if there is one, and store the result
1804 in b->loc->cond.
1805 - Update the list of values that must be watched in B->loc.
1806
1807 If the watchpoint disposition is disp_del_at_next_stop, then do
1808 nothing. If this is local watchpoint that is out of scope, delete
1809 it.
1810
1811 Even with `set breakpoint always-inserted on' the watchpoints are
1812 removed + inserted on each stop here. Normal breakpoints must
1813 never be removed because they might be missed by a running thread
1814 when debugging in non-stop mode. On the other hand, hardware
1815 watchpoints (is_hardware_watchpoint; processed here) are specific
1816 to each LWP since they are stored in each LWP's hardware debug
1817 registers. Therefore, such LWP must be stopped first in order to
1818 be able to modify its hardware watchpoints.
1819
1820 Hardware watchpoints must be reset exactly once after being
1821 presented to the user. It cannot be done sooner, because it would
1822 reset the data used to present the watchpoint hit to the user. And
1823 it must not be done later because it could display the same single
1824 watchpoint hit during multiple GDB stops. Note that the latter is
1825 relevant only to the hardware watchpoint types bp_read_watchpoint
1826 and bp_access_watchpoint. False hit by bp_hardware_watchpoint is
1827 not user-visible - its hit is suppressed if the memory content has
1828 not changed.
1829
1830 The following constraints influence the location where we can reset
1831 hardware watchpoints:
1832
1833 * target_stopped_by_watchpoint and target_stopped_data_address are
1834 called several times when GDB stops.
1835
1836 [linux]
1837 * Multiple hardware watchpoints can be hit at the same time,
1838 causing GDB to stop. GDB only presents one hardware watchpoint
1839 hit at a time as the reason for stopping, and all the other hits
1840 are presented later, one after the other, each time the user
1841 requests the execution to be resumed. Execution is not resumed
1842 for the threads still having pending hit event stored in
1843 LWP_INFO->STATUS. While the watchpoint is already removed from
1844 the inferior on the first stop the thread hit event is kept being
1845 reported from its cached value by linux_nat_stopped_data_address
1846 until the real thread resume happens after the watchpoint gets
1847 presented and thus its LWP_INFO->STATUS gets reset.
1848
1849 Therefore the hardware watchpoint hit can get safely reset on the
1850 watchpoint removal from inferior. */
1851
1852 static void
1853 update_watchpoint (struct watchpoint *b, int reparse)
1854 {
1855 int within_current_scope;
1856 struct frame_id saved_frame_id;
1857 int frame_saved;
1858
1859 /* If this is a local watchpoint, we only want to check if the
1860 watchpoint frame is in scope if the current thread is the thread
1861 that was used to create the watchpoint. */
1862 if (!watchpoint_in_thread_scope (b))
1863 return;
1864
1865 if (b->base.disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
1866 return;
1867
1868 frame_saved = 0;
1869
1870 /* Determine if the watchpoint is within scope. */
1871 if (b->exp_valid_block == NULL)
1872 within_current_scope = 1;
1873 else
1874 {
1875 struct frame_info *fi = get_current_frame ();
1876 struct gdbarch *frame_arch = get_frame_arch (fi);
1877 CORE_ADDR frame_pc = get_frame_pc (fi);
1878
1879 /* If we're at a point where the stack has been destroyed
1880 (e.g. in a function epilogue), unwinding may not work
1881 properly. Do not attempt to recreate locations at this
1882 point. See similar comments in watchpoint_check. */
1883 if (gdbarch_stack_frame_destroyed_p (frame_arch, frame_pc))
1884 return;
1885
1886 /* Save the current frame's ID so we can restore it after
1887 evaluating the watchpoint expression on its own frame. */
1888 /* FIXME drow/2003-09-09: It would be nice if evaluate_expression
1889 took a frame parameter, so that we didn't have to change the
1890 selected frame. */
1891 frame_saved = 1;
1892 saved_frame_id = get_frame_id (get_selected_frame (NULL));
1893
1894 fi = frame_find_by_id (b->watchpoint_frame);
1895 within_current_scope = (fi != NULL);
1896 if (within_current_scope)
1897 select_frame (fi);
1898 }
1899
1900 /* We don't free locations. They are stored in the bp_location array
1901 and update_global_location_list will eventually delete them and
1902 remove breakpoints if needed. */
1903 b->base.loc = NULL;
1904
1905 if (within_current_scope && reparse)
1906 {
1907 const char *s;
1908
1909 if (b->exp)
1910 {
1911 xfree (b->exp);
1912 b->exp = NULL;
1913 }
1914 s = b->exp_string_reparse ? b->exp_string_reparse : b->exp_string;
1915 b->exp = parse_exp_1 (&s, 0, b->exp_valid_block, 0);
1916 /* If the meaning of expression itself changed, the old value is
1917 no longer relevant. We don't want to report a watchpoint hit
1918 to the user when the old value and the new value may actually
1919 be completely different objects. */
1920 value_free (b->val);
1921 b->val = NULL;
1922 b->val_valid = 0;
1923
1924 /* Note that unlike with breakpoints, the watchpoint's condition
1925 expression is stored in the breakpoint object, not in the
1926 locations (re)created below. */
1927 if (b->base.cond_string != NULL)
1928 {
1929 if (b->cond_exp != NULL)
1930 {
1931 xfree (b->cond_exp);
1932 b->cond_exp = NULL;
1933 }
1934
1935 s = b->base.cond_string;
1936 b->cond_exp = parse_exp_1 (&s, 0, b->cond_exp_valid_block, 0);
1937 }
1938 }
1939
1940 /* If we failed to parse the expression, for example because
1941 it refers to a global variable in a not-yet-loaded shared library,
1942 don't try to insert watchpoint. We don't automatically delete
1943 such watchpoint, though, since failure to parse expression
1944 is different from out-of-scope watchpoint. */
1945 if (!target_has_execution)
1946 {
1947 /* Without execution, memory can't change. No use to try and
1948 set watchpoint locations. The watchpoint will be reset when
1949 the target gains execution, through breakpoint_re_set. */
1950 if (!can_use_hw_watchpoints)
1951 {
1952 if (b->base.ops->works_in_software_mode (&b->base))
1953 b->base.type = bp_watchpoint;
1954 else
1955 error (_("Can't set read/access watchpoint when "
1956 "hardware watchpoints are disabled."));
1957 }
1958 }
1959 else if (within_current_scope && b->exp)
1960 {
1961 int pc = 0;
1962 struct value *val_chain, *v, *result, *next;
1963 struct program_space *frame_pspace;
1964
1965 fetch_subexp_value (b->exp, &pc, &v, &result, &val_chain, 0);
1966
1967 /* Avoid setting b->val if it's already set. The meaning of
1968 b->val is 'the last value' user saw, and we should update
1969 it only if we reported that last value to user. As it
1970 happens, the code that reports it updates b->val directly.
1971 We don't keep track of the memory value for masked
1972 watchpoints. */
1973 if (!b->val_valid && !is_masked_watchpoint (&b->base))
1974 {
1975 if (b->val_bitsize != 0)
1976 {
1977 v = extract_bitfield_from_watchpoint_value (b, v);
1978 if (v != NULL)
1979 release_value (v);
1980 }
1981 b->val = v;
1982 b->val_valid = 1;
1983 }
1984
1985 frame_pspace = get_frame_program_space (get_selected_frame (NULL));
1986
1987 /* Look at each value on the value chain. */
1988 for (v = val_chain; v; v = value_next (v))
1989 {
1990 /* If it's a memory location, and GDB actually needed
1991 its contents to evaluate the expression, then we
1992 must watch it. If the first value returned is
1993 still lazy, that means an error occurred reading it;
1994 watch it anyway in case it becomes readable. */
1995 if (VALUE_LVAL (v) == lval_memory
1996 && (v == val_chain || ! value_lazy (v)))
1997 {
1998 struct type *vtype = check_typedef (value_type (v));
1999
2000 /* We only watch structs and arrays if user asked
2001 for it explicitly, never if they just happen to
2002 appear in the middle of some value chain. */
2003 if (v == result
2004 || (TYPE_CODE (vtype) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
2005 && TYPE_CODE (vtype) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY))
2006 {
2007 CORE_ADDR addr;
2008 enum target_hw_bp_type type;
2009 struct bp_location *loc, **tmp;
2010 int bitpos = 0, bitsize = 0;
2011
2012 if (value_bitsize (v) != 0)
2013 {
2014 /* Extract the bit parameters out from the bitfield
2015 sub-expression. */
2016 bitpos = value_bitpos (v);
2017 bitsize = value_bitsize (v);
2018 }
2019 else if (v == result && b->val_bitsize != 0)
2020 {
2021 /* If VAL_BITSIZE != 0 then RESULT is actually a bitfield
2022 lvalue whose bit parameters are saved in the fields
2023 VAL_BITPOS and VAL_BITSIZE. */
2024 bitpos = b->val_bitpos;
2025 bitsize = b->val_bitsize;
2026 }
2027
2028 addr = value_address (v);
2029 if (bitsize != 0)
2030 {
2031 /* Skip the bytes that don't contain the bitfield. */
2032 addr += bitpos / 8;
2033 }
2034
2035 type = hw_write;
2036 if (b->base.type == bp_read_watchpoint)
2037 type = hw_read;
2038 else if (b->base.type == bp_access_watchpoint)
2039 type = hw_access;
2040
2041 loc = allocate_bp_location (&b->base);
2042 for (tmp = &(b->base.loc); *tmp != NULL; tmp = &((*tmp)->next))
2043 ;
2044 *tmp = loc;
2045 loc->gdbarch = get_type_arch (value_type (v));
2046
2047 loc->pspace = frame_pspace;
2048 loc->address = addr;
2049
2050 if (bitsize != 0)
2051 {
2052 /* Just cover the bytes that make up the bitfield. */
2053 loc->length = ((bitpos % 8) + bitsize + 7) / 8;
2054 }
2055 else
2056 loc->length = TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (v));
2057
2058 loc->watchpoint_type = type;
2059 }
2060 }
2061 }
2062
2063 /* Change the type of breakpoint between hardware assisted or
2064 an ordinary watchpoint depending on the hardware support
2065 and free hardware slots. REPARSE is set when the inferior
2066 is started. */
2067 if (reparse)
2068 {
2069 int reg_cnt;
2070 enum bp_loc_type loc_type;
2071 struct bp_location *bl;
2072
2073 reg_cnt = can_use_hardware_watchpoint (val_chain);
2074
2075 if (reg_cnt)
2076 {
2077 int i, target_resources_ok, other_type_used;
2078 enum bptype type;
2079
2080 /* Use an exact watchpoint when there's only one memory region to be
2081 watched, and only one debug register is needed to watch it. */
2082 b->exact = target_exact_watchpoints && reg_cnt == 1;
2083
2084 /* We need to determine how many resources are already
2085 used for all other hardware watchpoints plus this one
2086 to see if we still have enough resources to also fit
2087 this watchpoint in as well. */
2088
2089 /* If this is a software watchpoint, we try to turn it
2090 to a hardware one -- count resources as if B was of
2091 hardware watchpoint type. */
2092 type = b->base.type;
2093 if (type == bp_watchpoint)
2094 type = bp_hardware_watchpoint;
2095
2096 /* This watchpoint may or may not have been placed on
2097 the list yet at this point (it won't be in the list
2098 if we're trying to create it for the first time,
2099 through watch_command), so always account for it
2100 manually. */
2101
2102 /* Count resources used by all watchpoints except B. */
2103 i = hw_watchpoint_used_count_others (&b->base, type, &other_type_used);
2104
2105 /* Add in the resources needed for B. */
2106 i += hw_watchpoint_use_count (&b->base);
2107
2108 target_resources_ok
2109 = target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (type, i, other_type_used);
2110 if (target_resources_ok <= 0)
2111 {
2112 int sw_mode = b->base.ops->works_in_software_mode (&b->base);
2113
2114 if (target_resources_ok == 0 && !sw_mode)
2115 error (_("Target does not support this type of "
2116 "hardware watchpoint."));
2117 else if (target_resources_ok < 0 && !sw_mode)
2118 error (_("There are not enough available hardware "
2119 "resources for this watchpoint."));
2120
2121 /* Downgrade to software watchpoint. */
2122 b->base.type = bp_watchpoint;
2123 }
2124 else
2125 {
2126 /* If this was a software watchpoint, we've just
2127 found we have enough resources to turn it to a
2128 hardware watchpoint. Otherwise, this is a
2129 nop. */
2130 b->base.type = type;
2131 }
2132 }
2133 else if (!b->base.ops->works_in_software_mode (&b->base))
2134 {
2135 if (!can_use_hw_watchpoints)
2136 error (_("Can't set read/access watchpoint when "
2137 "hardware watchpoints are disabled."));
2138 else
2139 error (_("Expression cannot be implemented with "
2140 "read/access watchpoint."));
2141 }
2142 else
2143 b->base.type = bp_watchpoint;
2144
2145 loc_type = (b->base.type == bp_watchpoint? bp_loc_other
2146 : bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint);
2147 for (bl = b->base.loc; bl; bl = bl->next)
2148 bl->loc_type = loc_type;
2149 }
2150
2151 for (v = val_chain; v; v = next)
2152 {
2153 next = value_next (v);
2154 if (v != b->val)
2155 value_free (v);
2156 }
2157
2158 /* If a software watchpoint is not watching any memory, then the
2159 above left it without any location set up. But,
2160 bpstat_stop_status requires a location to be able to report
2161 stops, so make sure there's at least a dummy one. */
2162 if (b->base.type == bp_watchpoint && b->base.loc == NULL)
2163 software_watchpoint_add_no_memory_location (&b->base, frame_pspace);
2164 }
2165 else if (!within_current_scope)
2166 {
2167 printf_filtered (_("\
2168 Watchpoint %d deleted because the program has left the block\n\
2169 in which its expression is valid.\n"),
2170 b->base.number);
2171 watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (b);
2172 }
2173
2174 /* Restore the selected frame. */
2175 if (frame_saved)
2176 select_frame (frame_find_by_id (saved_frame_id));
2177 }
2178
2179
2180 /* Returns 1 iff breakpoint location should be
2181 inserted in the inferior. We don't differentiate the type of BL's owner
2182 (breakpoint vs. tracepoint), although insert_location in tracepoint's
2183 breakpoint_ops is not defined, because in insert_bp_location,
2184 tracepoint's insert_location will not be called. */
2185 static int
2186 should_be_inserted (struct bp_location *bl)
2187 {
2188 if (bl->owner == NULL || !breakpoint_enabled (bl->owner))
2189 return 0;
2190
2191 if (bl->owner->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
2192 return 0;
2193
2194 if (!bl->enabled || bl->shlib_disabled || bl->duplicate)
2195 return 0;
2196
2197 if (user_breakpoint_p (bl->owner) && bl->pspace->executing_startup)
2198 return 0;
2199
2200 /* This is set for example, when we're attached to the parent of a
2201 vfork, and have detached from the child. The child is running
2202 free, and we expect it to do an exec or exit, at which point the
2203 OS makes the parent schedulable again (and the target reports
2204 that the vfork is done). Until the child is done with the shared
2205 memory region, do not insert breakpoints in the parent, otherwise
2206 the child could still trip on the parent's breakpoints. Since
2207 the parent is blocked anyway, it won't miss any breakpoint. */
2208 if (bl->pspace->breakpoints_not_allowed)
2209 return 0;
2210
2211 /* Don't insert a breakpoint if we're trying to step past its
2212 location, except if the breakpoint is a single-step breakpoint,
2213 and the breakpoint's thread is the thread which is stepping past
2214 a breakpoint. */
2215 if ((bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2216 || bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2217 && stepping_past_instruction_at (bl->pspace->aspace,
2218 bl->address)
2219 /* The single-step breakpoint may be inserted at the location
2220 we're trying to step if the instruction branches to itself.
2221 However, the instruction won't be executed at all and it may
2222 break the semantics of the instruction, for example, the
2223 instruction is a conditional branch or updates some flags.
2224 We can't fix it unless GDB is able to emulate the instruction
2225 or switch to displaced stepping. */
2226 && !(bl->owner->type == bp_single_step
2227 && thread_is_stepping_over_breakpoint (bl->owner->thread)))
2228 {
2229 if (debug_infrun)
2230 {
2231 fprintf_unfiltered (gdb_stdlog,
2232 "infrun: skipping breakpoint: "
2233 "stepping past insn at: %s\n",
2234 paddress (bl->gdbarch, bl->address));
2235 }
2236 return 0;
2237 }
2238
2239 /* Don't insert watchpoints if we're trying to step past the
2240 instruction that triggered one. */
2241 if ((bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint)
2242 && stepping_past_nonsteppable_watchpoint ())
2243 {
2244 if (debug_infrun)
2245 {
2246 fprintf_unfiltered (gdb_stdlog,
2247 "infrun: stepping past non-steppable watchpoint. "
2248 "skipping watchpoint at %s:%d\n",
2249 paddress (bl->gdbarch, bl->address),
2250 bl->length);
2251 }
2252 return 0;
2253 }
2254
2255 return 1;
2256 }
2257
2258 /* Same as should_be_inserted but does the check assuming
2259 that the location is not duplicated. */
2260
2261 static int
2262 unduplicated_should_be_inserted (struct bp_location *bl)
2263 {
2264 int result;
2265 const int save_duplicate = bl->duplicate;
2266
2267 bl->duplicate = 0;
2268 result = should_be_inserted (bl);
2269 bl->duplicate = save_duplicate;
2270 return result;
2271 }
2272
2273 /* Parses a conditional described by an expression COND into an
2274 agent expression bytecode suitable for evaluation
2275 by the bytecode interpreter. Return NULL if there was
2276 any error during parsing. */
2277
2278 static struct agent_expr *
2279 parse_cond_to_aexpr (CORE_ADDR scope, struct expression *cond)
2280 {
2281 struct agent_expr *aexpr = NULL;
2282
2283 if (!cond)
2284 return NULL;
2285
2286 /* We don't want to stop processing, so catch any errors
2287 that may show up. */
2288 TRY
2289 {
2290 aexpr = gen_eval_for_expr (scope, cond);
2291 }
2292
2293 CATCH (ex, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
2294 {
2295 /* If we got here, it means the condition could not be parsed to a valid
2296 bytecode expression and thus can't be evaluated on the target's side.
2297 It's no use iterating through the conditions. */
2298 return NULL;
2299 }
2300 END_CATCH
2301
2302 /* We have a valid agent expression. */
2303 return aexpr;
2304 }
2305
2306 /* Based on location BL, create a list of breakpoint conditions to be
2307 passed on to the target. If we have duplicated locations with different
2308 conditions, we will add such conditions to the list. The idea is that the
2309 target will evaluate the list of conditions and will only notify GDB when
2310 one of them is true. */
2311
2312 static void
2313 build_target_condition_list (struct bp_location *bl)
2314 {
2315 struct bp_location **locp = NULL, **loc2p;
2316 int null_condition_or_parse_error = 0;
2317 int modified = bl->needs_update;
2318 struct bp_location *loc;
2319
2320 /* Release conditions left over from a previous insert. */
2321 VEC_free (agent_expr_p, bl->target_info.conditions);
2322
2323 /* This is only meaningful if the target is
2324 evaluating conditions and if the user has
2325 opted for condition evaluation on the target's
2326 side. */
2327 if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
2328 || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
2329 return;
2330
2331 /* Do a first pass to check for locations with no assigned
2332 conditions or conditions that fail to parse to a valid agent expression
2333 bytecode. If any of these happen, then it's no use to send conditions
2334 to the target since this location will always trigger and generate a
2335 response back to GDB. */
2336 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, bl->address)
2337 {
2338 loc = (*loc2p);
2339 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num)
2340 {
2341 if (modified)
2342 {
2343 struct agent_expr *aexpr;
2344
2345 /* Re-parse the conditions since something changed. In that
2346 case we already freed the condition bytecodes (see
2347 force_breakpoint_reinsertion). We just
2348 need to parse the condition to bytecodes again. */
2349 aexpr = parse_cond_to_aexpr (bl->address, loc->cond);
2350 loc->cond_bytecode = aexpr;
2351 }
2352
2353 /* If we have a NULL bytecode expression, it means something
2354 went wrong or we have a null condition expression. */
2355 if (!loc->cond_bytecode)
2356 {
2357 null_condition_or_parse_error = 1;
2358 break;
2359 }
2360 }
2361 }
2362
2363 /* If any of these happened, it means we will have to evaluate the conditions
2364 for the location's address on gdb's side. It is no use keeping bytecodes
2365 for all the other duplicate locations, thus we free all of them here.
2366
2367 This is so we have a finer control over which locations' conditions are
2368 being evaluated by GDB or the remote stub. */
2369 if (null_condition_or_parse_error)
2370 {
2371 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, bl->address)
2372 {
2373 loc = (*loc2p);
2374 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num)
2375 {
2376 /* Only go as far as the first NULL bytecode is
2377 located. */
2378 if (!loc->cond_bytecode)
2379 return;
2380
2381 free_agent_expr (loc->cond_bytecode);
2382 loc->cond_bytecode = NULL;
2383 }
2384 }
2385 }
2386
2387 /* No NULL conditions or failed bytecode generation. Build a condition list
2388 for this location's address. */
2389 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, bl->address)
2390 {
2391 loc = (*loc2p);
2392 if (loc->cond
2393 && is_breakpoint (loc->owner)
2394 && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num
2395 && loc->owner->enable_state == bp_enabled
2396 && loc->enabled)
2397 /* Add the condition to the vector. This will be used later to send the
2398 conditions to the target. */
2399 VEC_safe_push (agent_expr_p, bl->target_info.conditions,
2400 loc->cond_bytecode);
2401 }
2402
2403 return;
2404 }
2405
2406 /* Parses a command described by string CMD into an agent expression
2407 bytecode suitable for evaluation by the bytecode interpreter.
2408 Return NULL if there was any error during parsing. */
2409
2410 static struct agent_expr *
2411 parse_cmd_to_aexpr (CORE_ADDR scope, char *cmd)
2412 {
2413 struct cleanup *old_cleanups = 0;
2414 struct expression *expr, **argvec;
2415 struct agent_expr *aexpr = NULL;
2416 const char *cmdrest;
2417 const char *format_start, *format_end;
2418 struct format_piece *fpieces;
2419 int nargs;
2420 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
2421
2422 if (!cmd)
2423 return NULL;
2424
2425 cmdrest = cmd;
2426
2427 if (*cmdrest == ',')
2428 ++cmdrest;
2429 cmdrest = skip_spaces_const (cmdrest);
2430
2431 if (*cmdrest++ != '"')
2432 error (_("No format string following the location"));
2433
2434 format_start = cmdrest;
2435
2436 fpieces = parse_format_string (&cmdrest);
2437
2438 old_cleanups = make_cleanup (free_format_pieces_cleanup, &fpieces);
2439
2440 format_end = cmdrest;
2441
2442 if (*cmdrest++ != '"')
2443 error (_("Bad format string, non-terminated '\"'."));
2444
2445 cmdrest = skip_spaces_const (cmdrest);
2446
2447 if (!(*cmdrest == ',' || *cmdrest == '\0'))
2448 error (_("Invalid argument syntax"));
2449
2450 if (*cmdrest == ',')
2451 cmdrest++;
2452 cmdrest = skip_spaces_const (cmdrest);
2453
2454 /* For each argument, make an expression. */
2455
2456 argvec = (struct expression **) alloca (strlen (cmd)
2457 * sizeof (struct expression *));
2458
2459 nargs = 0;
2460 while (*cmdrest != '\0')
2461 {
2462 const char *cmd1;
2463
2464 cmd1 = cmdrest;
2465 expr = parse_exp_1 (&cmd1, scope, block_for_pc (scope), 1);
2466 argvec[nargs++] = expr;
2467 cmdrest = cmd1;
2468 if (*cmdrest == ',')
2469 ++cmdrest;
2470 }
2471
2472 /* We don't want to stop processing, so catch any errors
2473 that may show up. */
2474 TRY
2475 {
2476 aexpr = gen_printf (scope, gdbarch, 0, 0,
2477 format_start, format_end - format_start,
2478 fpieces, nargs, argvec);
2479 }
2480 CATCH (ex, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
2481 {
2482 /* If we got here, it means the command could not be parsed to a valid
2483 bytecode expression and thus can't be evaluated on the target's side.
2484 It's no use iterating through the other commands. */
2485 aexpr = NULL;
2486 }
2487 END_CATCH
2488
2489 do_cleanups (old_cleanups);
2490
2491 /* We have a valid agent expression, return it. */
2492 return aexpr;
2493 }
2494
2495 /* Based on location BL, create a list of breakpoint commands to be
2496 passed on to the target. If we have duplicated locations with
2497 different commands, we will add any such to the list. */
2498
2499 static void
2500 build_target_command_list (struct bp_location *bl)
2501 {
2502 struct bp_location **locp = NULL, **loc2p;
2503 int null_command_or_parse_error = 0;
2504 int modified = bl->needs_update;
2505 struct bp_location *loc;
2506
2507 /* Release commands left over from a previous insert. */
2508 VEC_free (agent_expr_p, bl->target_info.tcommands);
2509
2510 if (!target_can_run_breakpoint_commands ())
2511 return;
2512
2513 /* For now, limit to agent-style dprintf breakpoints. */
2514 if (dprintf_style != dprintf_style_agent)
2515 return;
2516
2517 /* For now, if we have any duplicate location that isn't a dprintf,
2518 don't install the target-side commands, as that would make the
2519 breakpoint not be reported to the core, and we'd lose
2520 control. */
2521 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, bl->address)
2522 {
2523 loc = (*loc2p);
2524 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner)
2525 && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num
2526 && loc->owner->type != bp_dprintf)
2527 return;
2528 }
2529
2530 /* Do a first pass to check for locations with no assigned
2531 conditions or conditions that fail to parse to a valid agent expression
2532 bytecode. If any of these happen, then it's no use to send conditions
2533 to the target since this location will always trigger and generate a
2534 response back to GDB. */
2535 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, bl->address)
2536 {
2537 loc = (*loc2p);
2538 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num)
2539 {
2540 if (modified)
2541 {
2542 struct agent_expr *aexpr;
2543
2544 /* Re-parse the commands since something changed. In that
2545 case we already freed the command bytecodes (see
2546 force_breakpoint_reinsertion). We just
2547 need to parse the command to bytecodes again. */
2548 aexpr = parse_cmd_to_aexpr (bl->address,
2549 loc->owner->extra_string);
2550 loc->cmd_bytecode = aexpr;
2551 }
2552
2553 /* If we have a NULL bytecode expression, it means something
2554 went wrong or we have a null command expression. */
2555 if (!loc->cmd_bytecode)
2556 {
2557 null_command_or_parse_error = 1;
2558 break;
2559 }
2560 }
2561 }
2562
2563 /* If anything failed, then we're not doing target-side commands,
2564 and so clean up. */
2565 if (null_command_or_parse_error)
2566 {
2567 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, bl->address)
2568 {
2569 loc = (*loc2p);
2570 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner)
2571 && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num)
2572 {
2573 /* Only go as far as the first NULL bytecode is
2574 located. */
2575 if (loc->cmd_bytecode == NULL)
2576 return;
2577
2578 free_agent_expr (loc->cmd_bytecode);
2579 loc->cmd_bytecode = NULL;
2580 }
2581 }
2582 }
2583
2584 /* No NULL commands or failed bytecode generation. Build a command list
2585 for this location's address. */
2586 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, bl->address)
2587 {
2588 loc = (*loc2p);
2589 if (loc->owner->extra_string
2590 && is_breakpoint (loc->owner)
2591 && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num
2592 && loc->owner->enable_state == bp_enabled
2593 && loc->enabled)
2594 /* Add the command to the vector. This will be used later
2595 to send the commands to the target. */
2596 VEC_safe_push (agent_expr_p, bl->target_info.tcommands,
2597 loc->cmd_bytecode);
2598 }
2599
2600 bl->target_info.persist = 0;
2601 /* Maybe flag this location as persistent. */
2602 if (bl->owner->type == bp_dprintf && disconnected_dprintf)
2603 bl->target_info.persist = 1;
2604 }
2605
2606 /* Insert a low-level "breakpoint" of some type. BL is the breakpoint
2607 location. Any error messages are printed to TMP_ERROR_STREAM; and
2608 DISABLED_BREAKS, and HW_BREAKPOINT_ERROR are used to report problems.
2609 Returns 0 for success, 1 if the bp_location type is not supported or
2610 -1 for failure.
2611
2612 NOTE drow/2003-09-09: This routine could be broken down to an
2613 object-style method for each breakpoint or catchpoint type. */
2614 static int
2615 insert_bp_location (struct bp_location *bl,
2616 struct ui_file *tmp_error_stream,
2617 int *disabled_breaks,
2618 int *hw_breakpoint_error,
2619 int *hw_bp_error_explained_already)
2620 {
2621 enum errors bp_err = GDB_NO_ERROR;
2622 const char *bp_err_message = NULL;
2623
2624 if (!should_be_inserted (bl) || (bl->inserted && !bl->needs_update))
2625 return 0;
2626
2627 /* Note we don't initialize bl->target_info, as that wipes out
2628 the breakpoint location's shadow_contents if the breakpoint
2629 is still inserted at that location. This in turn breaks
2630 target_read_memory which depends on these buffers when
2631 a memory read is requested at the breakpoint location:
2632 Once the target_info has been wiped, we fail to see that
2633 we have a breakpoint inserted at that address and thus
2634 read the breakpoint instead of returning the data saved in
2635 the breakpoint location's shadow contents. */
2636 bl->target_info.reqstd_address = bl->address;
2637 bl->target_info.placed_address_space = bl->pspace->aspace;
2638 bl->target_info.length = bl->length;
2639
2640 /* When working with target-side conditions, we must pass all the conditions
2641 for the same breakpoint address down to the target since GDB will not
2642 insert those locations. With a list of breakpoint conditions, the target
2643 can decide when to stop and notify GDB. */
2644
2645 if (is_breakpoint (bl->owner))
2646 {
2647 build_target_condition_list (bl);
2648 build_target_command_list (bl);
2649 /* Reset the modification marker. */
2650 bl->needs_update = 0;
2651 }
2652
2653 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2654 || bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2655 {
2656 if (bl->owner->type != bp_hardware_breakpoint)
2657 {
2658 /* If the explicitly specified breakpoint type
2659 is not hardware breakpoint, check the memory map to see
2660 if the breakpoint address is in read only memory or not.
2661
2662 Two important cases are:
2663 - location type is not hardware breakpoint, memory
2664 is readonly. We change the type of the location to
2665 hardware breakpoint.
2666 - location type is hardware breakpoint, memory is
2667 read-write. This means we've previously made the
2668 location hardware one, but then the memory map changed,
2669 so we undo.
2670
2671 When breakpoints are removed, remove_breakpoints will use
2672 location types we've just set here, the only possible
2673 problem is that memory map has changed during running
2674 program, but it's not going to work anyway with current
2675 gdb. */
2676 struct mem_region *mr
2677 = lookup_mem_region (bl->target_info.reqstd_address);
2678
2679 if (mr)
2680 {
2681 if (automatic_hardware_breakpoints)
2682 {
2683 enum bp_loc_type new_type;
2684
2685 if (mr->attrib.mode != MEM_RW)
2686 new_type = bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint;
2687 else
2688 new_type = bp_loc_software_breakpoint;
2689
2690 if (new_type != bl->loc_type)
2691 {
2692 static int said = 0;
2693
2694 bl->loc_type = new_type;
2695 if (!said)
2696 {
2697 fprintf_filtered (gdb_stdout,
2698 _("Note: automatically using "
2699 "hardware breakpoints for "
2700 "read-only addresses.\n"));
2701 said = 1;
2702 }
2703 }
2704 }
2705 else if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2706 && mr->attrib.mode != MEM_RW)
2707 {
2708 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2709 _("Cannot insert breakpoint %d.\n"
2710 "Cannot set software breakpoint "
2711 "at read-only address %s\n"),
2712 bl->owner->number,
2713 paddress (bl->gdbarch, bl->address));
2714 return 1;
2715 }
2716 }
2717 }
2718
2719 /* First check to see if we have to handle an overlay. */
2720 if (overlay_debugging == ovly_off
2721 || bl->section == NULL
2722 || !(section_is_overlay (bl->section)))
2723 {
2724 /* No overlay handling: just set the breakpoint. */
2725 TRY
2726 {
2727 int val;
2728
2729 val = bl->owner->ops->insert_location (bl);
2730 if (val)
2731 bp_err = GENERIC_ERROR;
2732 }
2733 CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ALL)
2734 {
2735 bp_err = e.error;
2736 bp_err_message = e.message;
2737 }
2738 END_CATCH
2739 }
2740 else
2741 {
2742 /* This breakpoint is in an overlay section.
2743 Shall we set a breakpoint at the LMA? */
2744 if (!overlay_events_enabled)
2745 {
2746 /* Yes -- overlay event support is not active,
2747 so we must try to set a breakpoint at the LMA.
2748 This will not work for a hardware breakpoint. */
2749 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2750 warning (_("hardware breakpoint %d not supported in overlay!"),
2751 bl->owner->number);
2752 else
2753 {
2754 CORE_ADDR addr = overlay_unmapped_address (bl->address,
2755 bl->section);
2756 /* Set a software (trap) breakpoint at the LMA. */
2757 bl->overlay_target_info = bl->target_info;
2758 bl->overlay_target_info.reqstd_address = addr;
2759
2760 /* No overlay handling: just set the breakpoint. */
2761 TRY
2762 {
2763 int val;
2764
2765 val = target_insert_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch,
2766 &bl->overlay_target_info);
2767 if (val)
2768 bp_err = GENERIC_ERROR;
2769 }
2770 CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ALL)
2771 {
2772 bp_err = e.error;
2773 bp_err_message = e.message;
2774 }
2775 END_CATCH
2776
2777 if (bp_err != GDB_NO_ERROR)
2778 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2779 "Overlay breakpoint %d "
2780 "failed: in ROM?\n",
2781 bl->owner->number);
2782 }
2783 }
2784 /* Shall we set a breakpoint at the VMA? */
2785 if (section_is_mapped (bl->section))
2786 {
2787 /* Yes. This overlay section is mapped into memory. */
2788 TRY
2789 {
2790 int val;
2791
2792 val = bl->owner->ops->insert_location (bl);
2793 if (val)
2794 bp_err = GENERIC_ERROR;
2795 }
2796 CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ALL)
2797 {
2798 bp_err = e.error;
2799 bp_err_message = e.message;
2800 }
2801 END_CATCH
2802 }
2803 else
2804 {
2805 /* No. This breakpoint will not be inserted.
2806 No error, but do not mark the bp as 'inserted'. */
2807 return 0;
2808 }
2809 }
2810
2811 if (bp_err != GDB_NO_ERROR)
2812 {
2813 /* Can't set the breakpoint. */
2814
2815 /* In some cases, we might not be able to insert a
2816 breakpoint in a shared library that has already been
2817 removed, but we have not yet processed the shlib unload
2818 event. Unfortunately, some targets that implement
2819 breakpoint insertion themselves can't tell why the
2820 breakpoint insertion failed (e.g., the remote target
2821 doesn't define error codes), so we must treat generic
2822 errors as memory errors. */
2823 if ((bp_err == GENERIC_ERROR || bp_err == MEMORY_ERROR)
2824 && bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2825 && (solib_name_from_address (bl->pspace, bl->address)
2826 || shared_objfile_contains_address_p (bl->pspace,
2827 bl->address)))
2828 {
2829 /* See also: disable_breakpoints_in_shlibs. */
2830 bl->shlib_disabled = 1;
2831 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (bl->owner);
2832 if (!*disabled_breaks)
2833 {
2834 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2835 "Cannot insert breakpoint %d.\n",
2836 bl->owner->number);
2837 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2838 "Temporarily disabling shared "
2839 "library breakpoints:\n");
2840 }
2841 *disabled_breaks = 1;
2842 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2843 "breakpoint #%d\n", bl->owner->number);
2844 return 0;
2845 }
2846 else
2847 {
2848 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2849 {
2850 *hw_breakpoint_error = 1;
2851 *hw_bp_error_explained_already = bp_err_message != NULL;
2852 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2853 "Cannot insert hardware breakpoint %d%s",
2854 bl->owner->number, bp_err_message ? ":" : ".\n");
2855 if (bp_err_message != NULL)
2856 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream, "%s.\n", bp_err_message);
2857 }
2858 else
2859 {
2860 if (bp_err_message == NULL)
2861 {
2862 char *message
2863 = memory_error_message (TARGET_XFER_E_IO,
2864 bl->gdbarch, bl->address);
2865 struct cleanup *old_chain = make_cleanup (xfree, message);
2866
2867 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2868 "Cannot insert breakpoint %d.\n"
2869 "%s\n",
2870 bl->owner->number, message);
2871 do_cleanups (old_chain);
2872 }
2873 else
2874 {
2875 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2876 "Cannot insert breakpoint %d: %s\n",
2877 bl->owner->number,
2878 bp_err_message);
2879 }
2880 }
2881 return 1;
2882
2883 }
2884 }
2885 else
2886 bl->inserted = 1;
2887
2888 return 0;
2889 }
2890
2891 else if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint
2892 /* NOTE drow/2003-09-08: This state only exists for removing
2893 watchpoints. It's not clear that it's necessary... */
2894 && bl->owner->disposition != disp_del_at_next_stop)
2895 {
2896 int val;
2897
2898 gdb_assert (bl->owner->ops != NULL
2899 && bl->owner->ops->insert_location != NULL);
2900
2901 val = bl->owner->ops->insert_location (bl);
2902
2903 /* If trying to set a read-watchpoint, and it turns out it's not
2904 supported, try emulating one with an access watchpoint. */
2905 if (val == 1 && bl->watchpoint_type == hw_read)
2906 {
2907 struct bp_location *loc, **loc_temp;
2908
2909 /* But don't try to insert it, if there's already another
2910 hw_access location that would be considered a duplicate
2911 of this one. */
2912 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, loc_temp)
2913 if (loc != bl
2914 && loc->watchpoint_type == hw_access
2915 && watchpoint_locations_match (bl, loc))
2916 {
2917 bl->duplicate = 1;
2918 bl->inserted = 1;
2919 bl->target_info = loc->target_info;
2920 bl->watchpoint_type = hw_access;
2921 val = 0;
2922 break;
2923 }
2924
2925 if (val == 1)
2926 {
2927 bl->watchpoint_type = hw_access;
2928 val = bl->owner->ops->insert_location (bl);
2929
2930 if (val)
2931 /* Back to the original value. */
2932 bl->watchpoint_type = hw_read;
2933 }
2934 }
2935
2936 bl->inserted = (val == 0);
2937 }
2938
2939 else if (bl->owner->type == bp_catchpoint)
2940 {
2941 int val;
2942
2943 gdb_assert (bl->owner->ops != NULL
2944 && bl->owner->ops->insert_location != NULL);
2945
2946 val = bl->owner->ops->insert_location (bl);
2947 if (val)
2948 {
2949 bl->owner->enable_state = bp_disabled;
2950
2951 if (val == 1)
2952 warning (_("\
2953 Error inserting catchpoint %d: Your system does not support this type\n\
2954 of catchpoint."), bl->owner->number);
2955 else
2956 warning (_("Error inserting catchpoint %d."), bl->owner->number);
2957 }
2958
2959 bl->inserted = (val == 0);
2960
2961 /* We've already printed an error message if there was a problem
2962 inserting this catchpoint, and we've disabled the catchpoint,
2963 so just return success. */
2964 return 0;
2965 }
2966
2967 return 0;
2968 }
2969
2970 /* This function is called when program space PSPACE is about to be
2971 deleted. It takes care of updating breakpoints to not reference
2972 PSPACE anymore. */
2973
2974 void
2975 breakpoint_program_space_exit (struct program_space *pspace)
2976 {
2977 struct breakpoint *b, *b_temp;
2978 struct bp_location *loc, **loc_temp;
2979
2980 /* Remove any breakpoint that was set through this program space. */
2981 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_temp)
2982 {
2983 if (b->pspace == pspace)
2984 delete_breakpoint (b);
2985 }
2986
2987 /* Breakpoints set through other program spaces could have locations
2988 bound to PSPACE as well. Remove those. */
2989 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, loc_temp)
2990 {
2991 struct bp_location *tmp;
2992
2993 if (loc->pspace == pspace)
2994 {
2995 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has LOC->OWNER always non-NULL. */
2996 if (loc->owner->loc == loc)
2997 loc->owner->loc = loc->next;
2998 else
2999 for (tmp = loc->owner->loc; tmp->next != NULL; tmp = tmp->next)
3000 if (tmp->next == loc)
3001 {
3002 tmp->next = loc->next;
3003 break;
3004 }
3005 }
3006 }
3007
3008 /* Now update the global location list to permanently delete the
3009 removed locations above. */
3010 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
3011 }
3012
3013 /* Make sure all breakpoints are inserted in inferior.
3014 Throws exception on any error.
3015 A breakpoint that is already inserted won't be inserted
3016 again, so calling this function twice is safe. */
3017 void
3018 insert_breakpoints (void)
3019 {
3020 struct breakpoint *bpt;
3021
3022 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
3023 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (bpt))
3024 {
3025 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bpt;
3026
3027 update_watchpoint (w, 0 /* don't reparse. */);
3028 }
3029
3030 /* Updating watchpoints creates new locations, so update the global
3031 location list. Explicitly tell ugll to insert locations and
3032 ignore breakpoints_always_inserted_mode. */
3033 update_global_location_list (UGLL_INSERT);
3034 }
3035
3036 /* Invoke CALLBACK for each of bp_location. */
3037
3038 void
3039 iterate_over_bp_locations (walk_bp_location_callback callback)
3040 {
3041 struct bp_location *loc, **loc_tmp;
3042
3043 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, loc_tmp)
3044 {
3045 callback (loc, NULL);
3046 }
3047 }
3048
3049 /* This is used when we need to synch breakpoint conditions between GDB and the
3050 target. It is the case with deleting and disabling of breakpoints when using
3051 always-inserted mode. */
3052
3053 static void
3054 update_inserted_breakpoint_locations (void)
3055 {
3056 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
3057 int error_flag = 0;
3058 int val = 0;
3059 int disabled_breaks = 0;
3060 int hw_breakpoint_error = 0;
3061 int hw_bp_details_reported = 0;
3062
3063 struct ui_file *tmp_error_stream = mem_fileopen ();
3064 struct cleanup *cleanups = make_cleanup_ui_file_delete (tmp_error_stream);
3065
3066 /* Explicitly mark the warning -- this will only be printed if
3067 there was an error. */
3068 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream, "Warning:\n");
3069
3070 save_current_space_and_thread ();
3071
3072 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
3073 {
3074 /* We only want to update software breakpoints and hardware
3075 breakpoints. */
3076 if (!is_breakpoint (bl->owner))
3077 continue;
3078
3079 /* We only want to update locations that are already inserted
3080 and need updating. This is to avoid unwanted insertion during
3081 deletion of breakpoints. */
3082 if (!bl->inserted || (bl->inserted && !bl->needs_update))
3083 continue;
3084
3085 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (bl->pspace);
3086
3087 /* For targets that support global breakpoints, there's no need
3088 to select an inferior to insert breakpoint to. In fact, even
3089 if we aren't attached to any process yet, we should still
3090 insert breakpoints. */
3091 if (!gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ())
3092 && ptid_equal (inferior_ptid, null_ptid))
3093 continue;
3094
3095 val = insert_bp_location (bl, tmp_error_stream, &disabled_breaks,
3096 &hw_breakpoint_error, &hw_bp_details_reported);
3097 if (val)
3098 error_flag = val;
3099 }
3100
3101 if (error_flag)
3102 {
3103 target_terminal_ours_for_output ();
3104 error_stream (tmp_error_stream);
3105 }
3106
3107 do_cleanups (cleanups);
3108 }
3109
3110 /* Used when starting or continuing the program. */
3111
3112 static void
3113 insert_breakpoint_locations (void)
3114 {
3115 struct breakpoint *bpt;
3116 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
3117 int error_flag = 0;
3118 int val = 0;
3119 int disabled_breaks = 0;
3120 int hw_breakpoint_error = 0;
3121 int hw_bp_error_explained_already = 0;
3122
3123 struct ui_file *tmp_error_stream = mem_fileopen ();
3124 struct cleanup *cleanups = make_cleanup_ui_file_delete (tmp_error_stream);
3125
3126 /* Explicitly mark the warning -- this will only be printed if
3127 there was an error. */
3128 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream, "Warning:\n");
3129
3130 save_current_space_and_thread ();
3131
3132 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
3133 {
3134 if (!should_be_inserted (bl) || (bl->inserted && !bl->needs_update))
3135 continue;
3136
3137 /* There is no point inserting thread-specific breakpoints if
3138 the thread no longer exists. ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location
3139 has BL->OWNER always non-NULL. */
3140 if (bl->owner->thread != -1
3141 && !valid_global_thread_id (bl->owner->thread))
3142 continue;
3143
3144 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (bl->pspace);
3145
3146 /* For targets that support global breakpoints, there's no need
3147 to select an inferior to insert breakpoint to. In fact, even
3148 if we aren't attached to any process yet, we should still
3149 insert breakpoints. */
3150 if (!gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ())
3151 && ptid_equal (inferior_ptid, null_ptid))
3152 continue;
3153
3154 val = insert_bp_location (bl, tmp_error_stream, &disabled_breaks,
3155 &hw_breakpoint_error, &hw_bp_error_explained_already);
3156 if (val)
3157 error_flag = val;
3158 }
3159
3160 /* If we failed to insert all locations of a watchpoint, remove
3161 them, as half-inserted watchpoint is of limited use. */
3162 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
3163 {
3164 int some_failed = 0;
3165 struct bp_location *loc;
3166
3167 if (!is_hardware_watchpoint (bpt))
3168 continue;
3169
3170 if (!breakpoint_enabled (bpt))
3171 continue;
3172
3173 if (bpt->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
3174 continue;
3175
3176 for (loc = bpt->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
3177 if (!loc->inserted && should_be_inserted (loc))
3178 {
3179 some_failed = 1;
3180 break;
3181 }
3182 if (some_failed)
3183 {
3184 for (loc = bpt->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
3185 if (loc->inserted)
3186 remove_breakpoint (loc);
3187
3188 hw_breakpoint_error = 1;
3189 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
3190 "Could not insert hardware watchpoint %d.\n",
3191 bpt->number);
3192 error_flag = -1;
3193 }
3194 }
3195
3196 if (error_flag)
3197 {
3198 /* If a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint was inserted, add a
3199 message about possibly exhausted resources. */
3200 if (hw_breakpoint_error && !hw_bp_error_explained_already)
3201 {
3202 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
3203 "Could not insert hardware breakpoints:\n\
3204 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints/watchpoints.\n");
3205 }
3206 target_terminal_ours_for_output ();
3207 error_stream (tmp_error_stream);
3208 }
3209
3210 do_cleanups (cleanups);
3211 }
3212
3213 /* Used when the program stops.
3214 Returns zero if successful, or non-zero if there was a problem
3215 removing a breakpoint location. */
3216
3217 int
3218 remove_breakpoints (void)
3219 {
3220 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
3221 int val = 0;
3222
3223 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
3224 {
3225 if (bl->inserted && !is_tracepoint (bl->owner))
3226 val |= remove_breakpoint (bl);
3227 }
3228 return val;
3229 }
3230
3231 /* When a thread exits, remove breakpoints that are related to
3232 that thread. */
3233
3234 static void
3235 remove_threaded_breakpoints (struct thread_info *tp, int silent)
3236 {
3237 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
3238
3239 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
3240 {
3241 if (b->thread == tp->global_num && user_breakpoint_p (b))
3242 {
3243 b->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
3244
3245 printf_filtered (_("\
3246 Thread-specific breakpoint %d deleted - thread %s no longer in the thread list.\n"),
3247 b->number, print_thread_id (tp));
3248
3249 /* Hide it from the user. */
3250 b->number = 0;
3251 }
3252 }
3253 }
3254
3255 /* Remove breakpoints of process PID. */
3256
3257 int
3258 remove_breakpoints_pid (int pid)
3259 {
3260 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
3261 int val;
3262 struct inferior *inf = find_inferior_pid (pid);
3263
3264 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
3265 {
3266 if (bl->pspace != inf->pspace)
3267 continue;
3268
3269 if (bl->inserted && !bl->target_info.persist)
3270 {
3271 val = remove_breakpoint (bl);
3272 if (val != 0)
3273 return val;
3274 }
3275 }
3276 return 0;
3277 }
3278
3279 int
3280 reattach_breakpoints (int pid)
3281 {
3282 struct cleanup *old_chain;
3283 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
3284 int val;
3285 struct ui_file *tmp_error_stream;
3286 int dummy1 = 0, dummy2 = 0, dummy3 = 0;
3287 struct inferior *inf;
3288 struct thread_info *tp;
3289
3290 tp = any_live_thread_of_process (pid);
3291 if (tp == NULL)
3292 return 1;
3293
3294 inf = find_inferior_pid (pid);
3295 old_chain = save_inferior_ptid ();
3296
3297 inferior_ptid = tp->ptid;
3298
3299 tmp_error_stream = mem_fileopen ();
3300 make_cleanup_ui_file_delete (tmp_error_stream);
3301
3302 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
3303 {
3304 if (bl->pspace != inf->pspace)
3305 continue;
3306
3307 if (bl->inserted)
3308 {
3309 bl->inserted = 0;
3310 val = insert_bp_location (bl, tmp_error_stream, &dummy1, &dummy2, &dummy3);
3311 if (val != 0)
3312 {
3313 do_cleanups (old_chain);
3314 return val;
3315 }
3316 }
3317 }
3318 do_cleanups (old_chain);
3319 return 0;
3320 }
3321
3322 static int internal_breakpoint_number = -1;
3323
3324 /* Set the breakpoint number of B, depending on the value of INTERNAL.
3325 If INTERNAL is non-zero, the breakpoint number will be populated
3326 from internal_breakpoint_number and that variable decremented.
3327 Otherwise the breakpoint number will be populated from
3328 breakpoint_count and that value incremented. Internal breakpoints
3329 do not set the internal var bpnum. */
3330 static void
3331 set_breakpoint_number (int internal, struct breakpoint *b)
3332 {
3333 if (internal)
3334 b->number = internal_breakpoint_number--;
3335 else
3336 {
3337 set_breakpoint_count (breakpoint_count + 1);
3338 b->number = breakpoint_count;
3339 }
3340 }
3341
3342 static struct breakpoint *
3343 create_internal_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
3344 CORE_ADDR address, enum bptype type,
3345 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
3346 {
3347 struct symtab_and_line sal;
3348 struct breakpoint *b;
3349
3350 init_sal (&sal); /* Initialize to zeroes. */
3351
3352 sal.pc = address;
3353 sal.section = find_pc_overlay (sal.pc);
3354 sal.pspace = current_program_space;
3355
3356 b = set_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, type, ops);
3357 b->number = internal_breakpoint_number--;
3358 b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
3359
3360 return b;
3361 }
3362
3363 static const char *const longjmp_names[] =
3364 {
3365 "longjmp", "_longjmp", "siglongjmp", "_siglongjmp"
3366 };
3367 #define NUM_LONGJMP_NAMES ARRAY_SIZE(longjmp_names)
3368
3369 /* Per-objfile data private to breakpoint.c. */
3370 struct breakpoint_objfile_data
3371 {
3372 /* Minimal symbol for "_ovly_debug_event" (if any). */
3373 struct bound_minimal_symbol overlay_msym;
3374
3375 /* Minimal symbol(s) for "longjmp", "siglongjmp", etc. (if any). */
3376 struct bound_minimal_symbol longjmp_msym[NUM_LONGJMP_NAMES];
3377
3378 /* True if we have looked for longjmp probes. */
3379 int longjmp_searched;
3380
3381 /* SystemTap probe points for longjmp (if any). */
3382 VEC (probe_p) *longjmp_probes;
3383
3384 /* Minimal symbol for "std::terminate()" (if any). */
3385 struct bound_minimal_symbol terminate_msym;
3386
3387 /* Minimal symbol for "_Unwind_DebugHook" (if any). */
3388 struct bound_minimal_symbol exception_msym;
3389
3390 /* True if we have looked for exception probes. */
3391 int exception_searched;
3392
3393 /* SystemTap probe points for unwinding (if any). */
3394 VEC (probe_p) *exception_probes;
3395 };
3396
3397 static const struct objfile_data *breakpoint_objfile_key;
3398
3399 /* Minimal symbol not found sentinel. */
3400 static struct minimal_symbol msym_not_found;
3401
3402 /* Returns TRUE if MSYM point to the "not found" sentinel. */
3403
3404 static int
3405 msym_not_found_p (const struct minimal_symbol *msym)
3406 {
3407 return msym == &msym_not_found;
3408 }
3409
3410 /* Return per-objfile data needed by breakpoint.c.
3411 Allocate the data if necessary. */
3412
3413 static struct breakpoint_objfile_data *
3414 get_breakpoint_objfile_data (struct objfile *objfile)
3415 {
3416 struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data;
3417
3418 bp_objfile_data = ((struct breakpoint_objfile_data *)
3419 objfile_data (objfile, breakpoint_objfile_key));
3420 if (bp_objfile_data == NULL)
3421 {
3422 bp_objfile_data =
3423 XOBNEW (&objfile->objfile_obstack, struct breakpoint_objfile_data);
3424
3425 memset (bp_objfile_data, 0, sizeof (*bp_objfile_data));
3426 set_objfile_data (objfile, breakpoint_objfile_key, bp_objfile_data);
3427 }
3428 return bp_objfile_data;
3429 }
3430
3431 static void
3432 free_breakpoint_probes (struct objfile *obj, void *data)
3433 {
3434 struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data
3435 = (struct breakpoint_objfile_data *) data;
3436
3437 VEC_free (probe_p, bp_objfile_data->longjmp_probes);
3438 VEC_free (probe_p, bp_objfile_data->exception_probes);
3439 }
3440
3441 static void
3442 create_overlay_event_breakpoint (void)
3443 {
3444 struct objfile *objfile;
3445 const char *const func_name = "_ovly_debug_event";
3446
3447 ALL_OBJFILES (objfile)
3448 {
3449 struct breakpoint *b;
3450 struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data;
3451 CORE_ADDR addr;
3452 struct explicit_location explicit_loc;
3453
3454 bp_objfile_data = get_breakpoint_objfile_data (objfile);
3455
3456 if (msym_not_found_p (bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym.minsym))
3457 continue;
3458
3459 if (bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym.minsym == NULL)
3460 {
3461 struct bound_minimal_symbol m;
3462
3463 m = lookup_minimal_symbol_text (func_name, objfile);
3464 if (m.minsym == NULL)
3465 {
3466 /* Avoid future lookups in this objfile. */
3467 bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym.minsym = &msym_not_found;
3468 continue;
3469 }
3470 bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym = m;
3471 }
3472
3473 addr = BMSYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym);
3474 b = create_internal_breakpoint (get_objfile_arch (objfile), addr,
3475 bp_overlay_event,
3476 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
3477 initialize_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3478 explicit_loc.function_name = ASTRDUP (func_name);
3479 b->location = new_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3480
3481 if (overlay_debugging == ovly_auto)
3482 {
3483 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
3484 overlay_events_enabled = 1;
3485 }
3486 else
3487 {
3488 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
3489 overlay_events_enabled = 0;
3490 }
3491 }
3492 }
3493
3494 static void
3495 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint (void)
3496 {
3497 struct program_space *pspace;
3498 struct cleanup *old_chain;
3499
3500 old_chain = save_current_program_space ();
3501
3502 ALL_PSPACES (pspace)
3503 {
3504 struct objfile *objfile;
3505
3506 set_current_program_space (pspace);
3507
3508 ALL_OBJFILES (objfile)
3509 {
3510 int i;
3511 struct gdbarch *gdbarch;
3512 struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data;
3513
3514 gdbarch = get_objfile_arch (objfile);
3515
3516 bp_objfile_data = get_breakpoint_objfile_data (objfile);
3517
3518 if (!bp_objfile_data->longjmp_searched)
3519 {
3520 VEC (probe_p) *ret;
3521
3522 ret = find_probes_in_objfile (objfile, "libc", "longjmp");
3523 if (ret != NULL)
3524 {
3525 /* We are only interested in checking one element. */
3526 struct probe *p = VEC_index (probe_p, ret, 0);
3527
3528 if (!can_evaluate_probe_arguments (p))
3529 {
3530 /* We cannot use the probe interface here, because it does
3531 not know how to evaluate arguments. */
3532 VEC_free (probe_p, ret);
3533 ret = NULL;
3534 }
3535 }
3536 bp_objfile_data->longjmp_probes = ret;
3537 bp_objfile_data->longjmp_searched = 1;
3538 }
3539
3540 if (bp_objfile_data->longjmp_probes != NULL)
3541 {
3542 int i;
3543 struct probe *probe;
3544 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_objfile_arch (objfile);
3545
3546 for (i = 0;
3547 VEC_iterate (probe_p,
3548 bp_objfile_data->longjmp_probes,
3549 i, probe);
3550 ++i)
3551 {
3552 struct breakpoint *b;
3553
3554 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch,
3555 get_probe_address (probe,
3556 objfile),
3557 bp_longjmp_master,
3558 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
3559 b->location
3560 = new_probe_location ("-probe-stap libc:longjmp");
3561 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
3562 }
3563
3564 continue;
3565 }
3566
3567 if (!gdbarch_get_longjmp_target_p (gdbarch))
3568 continue;
3569
3570 for (i = 0; i < NUM_LONGJMP_NAMES; i++)
3571 {
3572 struct breakpoint *b;
3573 const char *func_name;
3574 CORE_ADDR addr;
3575 struct explicit_location explicit_loc;
3576
3577 if (msym_not_found_p (bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i].minsym))
3578 continue;
3579
3580 func_name = longjmp_names[i];
3581 if (bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i].minsym == NULL)
3582 {
3583 struct bound_minimal_symbol m;
3584
3585 m = lookup_minimal_symbol_text (func_name, objfile);
3586 if (m.minsym == NULL)
3587 {
3588 /* Prevent future lookups in this objfile. */
3589 bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i].minsym = &msym_not_found;
3590 continue;
3591 }
3592 bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i] = m;
3593 }
3594
3595 addr = BMSYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i]);
3596 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, addr, bp_longjmp_master,
3597 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
3598 initialize_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3599 explicit_loc.function_name = ASTRDUP (func_name);
3600 b->location = new_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3601 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
3602 }
3603 }
3604 }
3605
3606 do_cleanups (old_chain);
3607 }
3608
3609 /* Create a master std::terminate breakpoint. */
3610 static void
3611 create_std_terminate_master_breakpoint (void)
3612 {
3613 struct program_space *pspace;
3614 struct cleanup *old_chain;
3615 const char *const func_name = "std::terminate()";
3616
3617 old_chain = save_current_program_space ();
3618
3619 ALL_PSPACES (pspace)
3620 {
3621 struct objfile *objfile;
3622 CORE_ADDR addr;
3623
3624 set_current_program_space (pspace);
3625
3626 ALL_OBJFILES (objfile)
3627 {
3628 struct breakpoint *b;
3629 struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data;
3630 struct explicit_location explicit_loc;
3631
3632 bp_objfile_data = get_breakpoint_objfile_data (objfile);
3633
3634 if (msym_not_found_p (bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym.minsym))
3635 continue;
3636
3637 if (bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym.minsym == NULL)
3638 {
3639 struct bound_minimal_symbol m;
3640
3641 m = lookup_minimal_symbol (func_name, NULL, objfile);
3642 if (m.minsym == NULL || (MSYMBOL_TYPE (m.minsym) != mst_text
3643 && MSYMBOL_TYPE (m.minsym) != mst_file_text))
3644 {
3645 /* Prevent future lookups in this objfile. */
3646 bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym.minsym = &msym_not_found;
3647 continue;
3648 }
3649 bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym = m;
3650 }
3651
3652 addr = BMSYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym);
3653 b = create_internal_breakpoint (get_objfile_arch (objfile), addr,
3654 bp_std_terminate_master,
3655 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
3656 initialize_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3657 explicit_loc.function_name = ASTRDUP (func_name);
3658 b->location = new_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3659 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
3660 }
3661 }
3662
3663 do_cleanups (old_chain);
3664 }
3665
3666 /* Install a master breakpoint on the unwinder's debug hook. */
3667
3668 static void
3669 create_exception_master_breakpoint (void)
3670 {
3671 struct objfile *objfile;
3672 const char *const func_name = "_Unwind_DebugHook";
3673
3674 ALL_OBJFILES (objfile)
3675 {
3676 struct breakpoint *b;
3677 struct gdbarch *gdbarch;
3678 struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data;
3679 CORE_ADDR addr;
3680 struct explicit_location explicit_loc;
3681
3682 bp_objfile_data = get_breakpoint_objfile_data (objfile);
3683
3684 /* We prefer the SystemTap probe point if it exists. */
3685 if (!bp_objfile_data->exception_searched)
3686 {
3687 VEC (probe_p) *ret;
3688
3689 ret = find_probes_in_objfile (objfile, "libgcc", "unwind");
3690
3691 if (ret != NULL)
3692 {
3693 /* We are only interested in checking one element. */
3694 struct probe *p = VEC_index (probe_p, ret, 0);
3695
3696 if (!can_evaluate_probe_arguments (p))
3697 {
3698 /* We cannot use the probe interface here, because it does
3699 not know how to evaluate arguments. */
3700 VEC_free (probe_p, ret);
3701 ret = NULL;
3702 }
3703 }
3704 bp_objfile_data->exception_probes = ret;
3705 bp_objfile_data->exception_searched = 1;
3706 }
3707
3708 if (bp_objfile_data->exception_probes != NULL)
3709 {
3710 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_objfile_arch (objfile);
3711 int i;
3712 struct probe *probe;
3713
3714 for (i = 0;
3715 VEC_iterate (probe_p,
3716 bp_objfile_data->exception_probes,
3717 i, probe);
3718 ++i)
3719 {
3720 struct breakpoint *b;
3721
3722 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch,
3723 get_probe_address (probe,
3724 objfile),
3725 bp_exception_master,
3726 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
3727 b->location
3728 = new_probe_location ("-probe-stap libgcc:unwind");
3729 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
3730 }
3731
3732 continue;
3733 }
3734
3735 /* Otherwise, try the hook function. */
3736
3737 if (msym_not_found_p (bp_objfile_data->exception_msym.minsym))
3738 continue;
3739
3740 gdbarch = get_objfile_arch (objfile);
3741
3742 if (bp_objfile_data->exception_msym.minsym == NULL)
3743 {
3744 struct bound_minimal_symbol debug_hook;
3745
3746 debug_hook = lookup_minimal_symbol (func_name, NULL, objfile);
3747 if (debug_hook.minsym == NULL)
3748 {
3749 bp_objfile_data->exception_msym.minsym = &msym_not_found;
3750 continue;
3751 }
3752
3753 bp_objfile_data->exception_msym = debug_hook;
3754 }
3755
3756 addr = BMSYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (bp_objfile_data->exception_msym);
3757 addr = gdbarch_convert_from_func_ptr_addr (gdbarch, addr,
3758 &current_target);
3759 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, addr, bp_exception_master,
3760 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
3761 initialize_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3762 explicit_loc.function_name = ASTRDUP (func_name);
3763 b->location = new_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3764 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
3765 }
3766 }
3767
3768 /* Does B have a location spec? */
3769
3770 static int
3771 breakpoint_event_location_empty_p (const struct breakpoint *b)
3772 {
3773 return b->location != NULL && event_location_empty_p (b->location);
3774 }
3775
3776 void
3777 update_breakpoints_after_exec (void)
3778 {
3779 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
3780 struct bp_location *bploc, **bplocp_tmp;
3781
3782 /* We're about to delete breakpoints from GDB's lists. If the
3783 INSERTED flag is true, GDB will try to lift the breakpoints by
3784 writing the breakpoints' "shadow contents" back into memory. The
3785 "shadow contents" are NOT valid after an exec, so GDB should not
3786 do that. Instead, the target is responsible from marking
3787 breakpoints out as soon as it detects an exec. We don't do that
3788 here instead, because there may be other attempts to delete
3789 breakpoints after detecting an exec and before reaching here. */
3790 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bploc, bplocp_tmp)
3791 if (bploc->pspace == current_program_space)
3792 gdb_assert (!bploc->inserted);
3793
3794 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
3795 {
3796 if (b->pspace != current_program_space)
3797 continue;
3798
3799 /* Solib breakpoints must be explicitly reset after an exec(). */
3800 if (b->type == bp_shlib_event)
3801 {
3802 delete_breakpoint (b);
3803 continue;
3804 }
3805
3806 /* JIT breakpoints must be explicitly reset after an exec(). */
3807 if (b->type == bp_jit_event)
3808 {
3809 delete_breakpoint (b);
3810 continue;
3811 }
3812
3813 /* Thread event breakpoints must be set anew after an exec(),
3814 as must overlay event and longjmp master breakpoints. */
3815 if (b->type == bp_thread_event || b->type == bp_overlay_event
3816 || b->type == bp_longjmp_master || b->type == bp_std_terminate_master
3817 || b->type == bp_exception_master)
3818 {
3819 delete_breakpoint (b);
3820 continue;
3821 }
3822
3823 /* Step-resume breakpoints are meaningless after an exec(). */
3824 if (b->type == bp_step_resume || b->type == bp_hp_step_resume)
3825 {
3826 delete_breakpoint (b);
3827 continue;
3828 }
3829
3830 /* Just like single-step breakpoints. */
3831 if (b->type == bp_single_step)
3832 {
3833 delete_breakpoint (b);
3834 continue;
3835 }
3836
3837 /* Longjmp and longjmp-resume breakpoints are also meaningless
3838 after an exec. */
3839 if (b->type == bp_longjmp || b->type == bp_longjmp_resume
3840 || b->type == bp_longjmp_call_dummy
3841 || b->type == bp_exception || b->type == bp_exception_resume)
3842 {
3843 delete_breakpoint (b);
3844 continue;
3845 }
3846
3847 if (b->type == bp_catchpoint)
3848 {
3849 /* For now, none of the bp_catchpoint breakpoints need to
3850 do anything at this point. In the future, if some of
3851 the catchpoints need to something, we will need to add
3852 a new method, and call this method from here. */
3853 continue;
3854 }
3855
3856 /* bp_finish is a special case. The only way we ought to be able
3857 to see one of these when an exec() has happened, is if the user
3858 caught a vfork, and then said "finish". Ordinarily a finish just
3859 carries them to the call-site of the current callee, by setting
3860 a temporary bp there and resuming. But in this case, the finish
3861 will carry them entirely through the vfork & exec.
3862
3863 We don't want to allow a bp_finish to remain inserted now. But
3864 we can't safely delete it, 'cause finish_command has a handle to
3865 the bp on a bpstat, and will later want to delete it. There's a
3866 chance (and I've seen it happen) that if we delete the bp_finish
3867 here, that its storage will get reused by the time finish_command
3868 gets 'round to deleting the "use to be a bp_finish" breakpoint.
3869 We really must allow finish_command to delete a bp_finish.
3870
3871 In the absence of a general solution for the "how do we know
3872 it's safe to delete something others may have handles to?"
3873 problem, what we'll do here is just uninsert the bp_finish, and
3874 let finish_command delete it.
3875
3876 (We know the bp_finish is "doomed" in the sense that it's
3877 momentary, and will be deleted as soon as finish_command sees
3878 the inferior stopped. So it doesn't matter that the bp's
3879 address is probably bogus in the new a.out, unlike e.g., the
3880 solib breakpoints.) */
3881
3882 if (b->type == bp_finish)
3883 {
3884 continue;
3885 }
3886
3887 /* Without a symbolic address, we have little hope of the
3888 pre-exec() address meaning the same thing in the post-exec()
3889 a.out. */
3890 if (breakpoint_event_location_empty_p (b))
3891 {
3892 delete_breakpoint (b);
3893 continue;
3894 }
3895 }
3896 }
3897
3898 int
3899 detach_breakpoints (ptid_t ptid)
3900 {
3901 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
3902 int val = 0;
3903 struct cleanup *old_chain = save_inferior_ptid ();
3904 struct inferior *inf = current_inferior ();
3905
3906 if (ptid_get_pid (ptid) == ptid_get_pid (inferior_ptid))
3907 error (_("Cannot detach breakpoints of inferior_ptid"));
3908
3909 /* Set inferior_ptid; remove_breakpoint_1 uses this global. */
3910 inferior_ptid = ptid;
3911 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
3912 {
3913 if (bl->pspace != inf->pspace)
3914 continue;
3915
3916 /* This function must physically remove breakpoints locations
3917 from the specified ptid, without modifying the breakpoint
3918 package's state. Locations of type bp_loc_other are only
3919 maintained at GDB side. So, there is no need to remove
3920 these bp_loc_other locations. Moreover, removing these
3921 would modify the breakpoint package's state. */
3922 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_other)
3923 continue;
3924
3925 if (bl->inserted)
3926 val |= remove_breakpoint_1 (bl, DETACH_BREAKPOINT);
3927 }
3928
3929 do_cleanups (old_chain);
3930 return val;
3931 }
3932
3933 /* Remove the breakpoint location BL from the current address space.
3934 Note that this is used to detach breakpoints from a child fork.
3935 When we get here, the child isn't in the inferior list, and neither
3936 do we have objects to represent its address space --- we should
3937 *not* look at bl->pspace->aspace here. */
3938
3939 static int
3940 remove_breakpoint_1 (struct bp_location *bl, enum remove_bp_reason reason)
3941 {
3942 int val;
3943
3944 /* BL is never in moribund_locations by our callers. */
3945 gdb_assert (bl->owner != NULL);
3946
3947 /* The type of none suggests that owner is actually deleted.
3948 This should not ever happen. */
3949 gdb_assert (bl->owner->type != bp_none);
3950
3951 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
3952 || bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
3953 {
3954 /* "Normal" instruction breakpoint: either the standard
3955 trap-instruction bp (bp_breakpoint), or a
3956 bp_hardware_breakpoint. */
3957
3958 /* First check to see if we have to handle an overlay. */
3959 if (overlay_debugging == ovly_off
3960 || bl->section == NULL
3961 || !(section_is_overlay (bl->section)))
3962 {
3963 /* No overlay handling: just remove the breakpoint. */
3964
3965 /* If we're trying to uninsert a memory breakpoint that we
3966 know is set in a dynamic object that is marked
3967 shlib_disabled, then either the dynamic object was
3968 removed with "remove-symbol-file" or with
3969 "nosharedlibrary". In the former case, we don't know
3970 whether another dynamic object might have loaded over the
3971 breakpoint's address -- the user might well let us know
3972 about it next with add-symbol-file (the whole point of
3973 add-symbol-file is letting the user manually maintain a
3974 list of dynamically loaded objects). If we have the
3975 breakpoint's shadow memory, that is, this is a software
3976 breakpoint managed by GDB, check whether the breakpoint
3977 is still inserted in memory, to avoid overwriting wrong
3978 code with stale saved shadow contents. Note that HW
3979 breakpoints don't have shadow memory, as they're
3980 implemented using a mechanism that is not dependent on
3981 being able to modify the target's memory, and as such
3982 they should always be removed. */
3983 if (bl->shlib_disabled
3984 && bl->target_info.shadow_len != 0
3985 && !memory_validate_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, &bl->target_info))
3986 val = 0;
3987 else
3988 val = bl->owner->ops->remove_location (bl, reason);
3989 }
3990 else
3991 {
3992 /* This breakpoint is in an overlay section.
3993 Did we set a breakpoint at the LMA? */
3994 if (!overlay_events_enabled)
3995 {
3996 /* Yes -- overlay event support is not active, so we
3997 should have set a breakpoint at the LMA. Remove it.
3998 */
3999 /* Ignore any failures: if the LMA is in ROM, we will
4000 have already warned when we failed to insert it. */
4001 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
4002 target_remove_hw_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch,
4003 &bl->overlay_target_info);
4004 else
4005 target_remove_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch,
4006 &bl->overlay_target_info,
4007 reason);
4008 }
4009 /* Did we set a breakpoint at the VMA?
4010 If so, we will have marked the breakpoint 'inserted'. */
4011 if (bl->inserted)
4012 {
4013 /* Yes -- remove it. Previously we did not bother to
4014 remove the breakpoint if the section had been
4015 unmapped, but let's not rely on that being safe. We
4016 don't know what the overlay manager might do. */
4017
4018 /* However, we should remove *software* breakpoints only
4019 if the section is still mapped, or else we overwrite
4020 wrong code with the saved shadow contents. */
4021 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
4022 || section_is_mapped (bl->section))
4023 val = bl->owner->ops->remove_location (bl, reason);
4024 else
4025 val = 0;
4026 }
4027 else
4028 {
4029 /* No -- not inserted, so no need to remove. No error. */
4030 val = 0;
4031 }
4032 }
4033
4034 /* In some cases, we might not be able to remove a breakpoint in
4035 a shared library that has already been removed, but we have
4036 not yet processed the shlib unload event. Similarly for an
4037 unloaded add-symbol-file object - the user might not yet have
4038 had the chance to remove-symbol-file it. shlib_disabled will
4039 be set if the library/object has already been removed, but
4040 the breakpoint hasn't been uninserted yet, e.g., after
4041 "nosharedlibrary" or "remove-symbol-file" with breakpoints
4042 always-inserted mode. */
4043 if (val
4044 && (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
4045 && (bl->shlib_disabled
4046 || solib_name_from_address (bl->pspace, bl->address)
4047 || shared_objfile_contains_address_p (bl->pspace,
4048 bl->address))))
4049 val = 0;
4050
4051 if (val)
4052 return val;
4053 bl->inserted = (reason == DETACH_BREAKPOINT);
4054 }
4055 else if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint)
4056 {
4057 gdb_assert (bl->owner->ops != NULL
4058 && bl->owner->ops->remove_location != NULL);
4059
4060 bl->inserted = (reason == DETACH_BREAKPOINT);
4061 bl->owner->ops->remove_location (bl, reason);
4062
4063 /* Failure to remove any of the hardware watchpoints comes here. */
4064 if (reason == REMOVE_BREAKPOINT && bl->inserted)
4065 warning (_("Could not remove hardware watchpoint %d."),
4066 bl->owner->number);
4067 }
4068 else if (bl->owner->type == bp_catchpoint
4069 && breakpoint_enabled (bl->owner)
4070 && !bl->duplicate)
4071 {
4072 gdb_assert (bl->owner->ops != NULL
4073 && bl->owner->ops->remove_location != NULL);
4074
4075 val = bl->owner->ops->remove_location (bl, reason);
4076 if (val)
4077 return val;
4078
4079 bl->inserted = (reason == DETACH_BREAKPOINT);
4080 }
4081
4082 return 0;
4083 }
4084
4085 static int
4086 remove_breakpoint (struct bp_location *bl)
4087 {
4088 int ret;
4089 struct cleanup *old_chain;
4090
4091 /* BL is never in moribund_locations by our callers. */
4092 gdb_assert (bl->owner != NULL);
4093
4094 /* The type of none suggests that owner is actually deleted.
4095 This should not ever happen. */
4096 gdb_assert (bl->owner->type != bp_none);
4097
4098 old_chain = save_current_space_and_thread ();
4099
4100 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (bl->pspace);
4101
4102 ret = remove_breakpoint_1 (bl, REMOVE_BREAKPOINT);
4103
4104 do_cleanups (old_chain);
4105 return ret;
4106 }
4107
4108 /* Clear the "inserted" flag in all breakpoints. */
4109
4110 void
4111 mark_breakpoints_out (void)
4112 {
4113 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
4114
4115 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
4116 if (bl->pspace == current_program_space)
4117 bl->inserted = 0;
4118 }
4119
4120 /* Clear the "inserted" flag in all breakpoints and delete any
4121 breakpoints which should go away between runs of the program.
4122
4123 Plus other such housekeeping that has to be done for breakpoints
4124 between runs.
4125
4126 Note: this function gets called at the end of a run (by
4127 generic_mourn_inferior) and when a run begins (by
4128 init_wait_for_inferior). */
4129
4130
4131
4132 void
4133 breakpoint_init_inferior (enum inf_context context)
4134 {
4135 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
4136 struct bp_location *bl;
4137 int ix;
4138 struct program_space *pspace = current_program_space;
4139
4140 /* If breakpoint locations are shared across processes, then there's
4141 nothing to do. */
4142 if (gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ()))
4143 return;
4144
4145 mark_breakpoints_out ();
4146
4147 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
4148 {
4149 if (b->loc && b->loc->pspace != pspace)
4150 continue;
4151
4152 switch (b->type)
4153 {
4154 case bp_call_dummy:
4155 case bp_longjmp_call_dummy:
4156
4157 /* If the call dummy breakpoint is at the entry point it will
4158 cause problems when the inferior is rerun, so we better get
4159 rid of it. */
4160
4161 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
4162
4163 /* Also get rid of scope breakpoints. */
4164
4165 case bp_shlib_event:
4166
4167 /* Also remove solib event breakpoints. Their addresses may
4168 have changed since the last time we ran the program.
4169 Actually we may now be debugging against different target;
4170 and so the solib backend that installed this breakpoint may
4171 not be used in by the target. E.g.,
4172
4173 (gdb) file prog-linux
4174 (gdb) run # native linux target
4175 ...
4176 (gdb) kill
4177 (gdb) file prog-win.exe
4178 (gdb) tar rem :9999 # remote Windows gdbserver.
4179 */
4180
4181 case bp_step_resume:
4182
4183 /* Also remove step-resume breakpoints. */
4184
4185 case bp_single_step:
4186
4187 /* Also remove single-step breakpoints. */
4188
4189 delete_breakpoint (b);
4190 break;
4191
4192 case bp_watchpoint:
4193 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
4194 case bp_read_watchpoint:
4195 case bp_access_watchpoint:
4196 {
4197 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
4198
4199 /* Likewise for watchpoints on local expressions. */
4200 if (w->exp_valid_block != NULL)
4201 delete_breakpoint (b);
4202 else
4203 {
4204 /* Get rid of existing locations, which are no longer
4205 valid. New ones will be created in
4206 update_watchpoint, when the inferior is restarted.
4207 The next update_global_location_list call will
4208 garbage collect them. */
4209 b->loc = NULL;
4210
4211 if (context == inf_starting)
4212 {
4213 /* Reset val field to force reread of starting value in
4214 insert_breakpoints. */
4215 if (w->val)
4216 value_free (w->val);
4217 w->val = NULL;
4218 w->val_valid = 0;
4219 }
4220 }
4221 }
4222 break;
4223 default:
4224 break;
4225 }
4226 }
4227
4228 /* Get rid of the moribund locations. */
4229 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix, bl); ++ix)
4230 decref_bp_location (&bl);
4231 VEC_free (bp_location_p, moribund_locations);
4232 }
4233
4234 /* These functions concern about actual breakpoints inserted in the
4235 target --- to e.g. check if we need to do decr_pc adjustment or if
4236 we need to hop over the bkpt --- so we check for address space
4237 match, not program space. */
4238
4239 /* breakpoint_here_p (PC) returns non-zero if an enabled breakpoint
4240 exists at PC. It returns ordinary_breakpoint_here if it's an
4241 ordinary breakpoint, or permanent_breakpoint_here if it's a
4242 permanent breakpoint.
4243 - When continuing from a location with an ordinary breakpoint, we
4244 actually single step once before calling insert_breakpoints.
4245 - When continuing from a location with a permanent breakpoint, we
4246 need to use the `SKIP_PERMANENT_BREAKPOINT' macro, provided by
4247 the target, to advance the PC past the breakpoint. */
4248
4249 enum breakpoint_here
4250 breakpoint_here_p (struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
4251 {
4252 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
4253 int any_breakpoint_here = 0;
4254
4255 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
4256 {
4257 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint
4258 && bl->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
4259 continue;
4260
4261 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has BL->OWNER always non-NULL. */
4262 if ((breakpoint_enabled (bl->owner)
4263 || bl->permanent)
4264 && breakpoint_location_address_match (bl, aspace, pc))
4265 {
4266 if (overlay_debugging
4267 && section_is_overlay (bl->section)
4268 && !section_is_mapped (bl->section))
4269 continue; /* unmapped overlay -- can't be a match */
4270 else if (bl->permanent)
4271 return permanent_breakpoint_here;
4272 else
4273 any_breakpoint_here = 1;
4274 }
4275 }
4276
4277 return any_breakpoint_here ? ordinary_breakpoint_here : no_breakpoint_here;
4278 }
4279
4280 /* See breakpoint.h. */
4281
4282 int
4283 breakpoint_in_range_p (struct address_space *aspace,
4284 CORE_ADDR addr, ULONGEST len)
4285 {
4286 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
4287
4288 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
4289 {
4290 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint
4291 && bl->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
4292 continue;
4293
4294 if ((breakpoint_enabled (bl->owner)
4295 || bl->permanent)
4296 && breakpoint_location_address_range_overlap (bl, aspace,
4297 addr, len))
4298 {
4299 if (overlay_debugging
4300 && section_is_overlay (bl->section)
4301 && !section_is_mapped (bl->section))
4302 {
4303 /* Unmapped overlay -- can't be a match. */
4304 continue;
4305 }
4306
4307 return 1;
4308 }
4309 }
4310
4311 return 0;
4312 }
4313
4314 /* Return true if there's a moribund breakpoint at PC. */
4315
4316 int
4317 moribund_breakpoint_here_p (struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
4318 {
4319 struct bp_location *loc;
4320 int ix;
4321
4322 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix, loc); ++ix)
4323 if (breakpoint_location_address_match (loc, aspace, pc))
4324 return 1;
4325
4326 return 0;
4327 }
4328
4329 /* Returns non-zero iff BL is inserted at PC, in address space
4330 ASPACE. */
4331
4332 static int
4333 bp_location_inserted_here_p (struct bp_location *bl,
4334 struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
4335 {
4336 if (bl->inserted
4337 && breakpoint_address_match (bl->pspace->aspace, bl->address,
4338 aspace, pc))
4339 {
4340 if (overlay_debugging
4341 && section_is_overlay (bl->section)
4342 && !section_is_mapped (bl->section))
4343 return 0; /* unmapped overlay -- can't be a match */
4344 else
4345 return 1;
4346 }
4347 return 0;
4348 }
4349
4350 /* Returns non-zero iff there's a breakpoint inserted at PC. */
4351
4352 int
4353 breakpoint_inserted_here_p (struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
4354 {
4355 struct bp_location **blp, **blp_tmp = NULL;
4356
4357 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (blp, blp_tmp, pc)
4358 {
4359 struct bp_location *bl = *blp;
4360
4361 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint
4362 && bl->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
4363 continue;
4364
4365 if (bp_location_inserted_here_p (bl, aspace, pc))
4366 return 1;
4367 }
4368 return 0;
4369 }
4370
4371 /* This function returns non-zero iff there is a software breakpoint
4372 inserted at PC. */
4373
4374 int
4375 software_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (struct address_space *aspace,
4376 CORE_ADDR pc)
4377 {
4378 struct bp_location **blp, **blp_tmp = NULL;
4379
4380 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (blp, blp_tmp, pc)
4381 {
4382 struct bp_location *bl = *blp;
4383
4384 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint)
4385 continue;
4386
4387 if (bp_location_inserted_here_p (bl, aspace, pc))
4388 return 1;
4389 }
4390
4391 return 0;
4392 }
4393
4394 /* See breakpoint.h. */
4395
4396 int
4397 hardware_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (struct address_space *aspace,
4398 CORE_ADDR pc)
4399 {
4400 struct bp_location **blp, **blp_tmp = NULL;
4401
4402 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (blp, blp_tmp, pc)
4403 {
4404 struct bp_location *bl = *blp;
4405
4406 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
4407 continue;
4408
4409 if (bp_location_inserted_here_p (bl, aspace, pc))
4410 return 1;
4411 }
4412
4413 return 0;
4414 }
4415
4416 int
4417 hardware_watchpoint_inserted_in_range (struct address_space *aspace,
4418 CORE_ADDR addr, ULONGEST len)
4419 {
4420 struct breakpoint *bpt;
4421
4422 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
4423 {
4424 struct bp_location *loc;
4425
4426 if (bpt->type != bp_hardware_watchpoint
4427 && bpt->type != bp_access_watchpoint)
4428 continue;
4429
4430 if (!breakpoint_enabled (bpt))
4431 continue;
4432
4433 for (loc = bpt->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
4434 if (loc->pspace->aspace == aspace && loc->inserted)
4435 {
4436 CORE_ADDR l, h;
4437
4438 /* Check for intersection. */
4439 l = std::max<CORE_ADDR> (loc->address, addr);
4440 h = std::min<CORE_ADDR> (loc->address + loc->length, addr + len);
4441 if (l < h)
4442 return 1;
4443 }
4444 }
4445 return 0;
4446 }
4447 \f
4448
4449 /* bpstat stuff. External routines' interfaces are documented
4450 in breakpoint.h. */
4451
4452 int
4453 is_catchpoint (struct breakpoint *ep)
4454 {
4455 return (ep->type == bp_catchpoint);
4456 }
4457
4458 /* Frees any storage that is part of a bpstat. Does not walk the
4459 'next' chain. */
4460
4461 static void
4462 bpstat_free (bpstat bs)
4463 {
4464 if (bs->old_val != NULL)
4465 value_free (bs->old_val);
4466 decref_counted_command_line (&bs->commands);
4467 decref_bp_location (&bs->bp_location_at);
4468 xfree (bs);
4469 }
4470
4471 /* Clear a bpstat so that it says we are not at any breakpoint.
4472 Also free any storage that is part of a bpstat. */
4473
4474 void
4475 bpstat_clear (bpstat *bsp)
4476 {
4477 bpstat p;
4478 bpstat q;
4479
4480 if (bsp == 0)
4481 return;
4482 p = *bsp;
4483 while (p != NULL)
4484 {
4485 q = p->next;
4486 bpstat_free (p);
4487 p = q;
4488 }
4489 *bsp = NULL;
4490 }
4491
4492 /* Return a copy of a bpstat. Like "bs1 = bs2" but all storage that
4493 is part of the bpstat is copied as well. */
4494
4495 bpstat
4496 bpstat_copy (bpstat bs)
4497 {
4498 bpstat p = NULL;
4499 bpstat tmp;
4500 bpstat retval = NULL;
4501
4502 if (bs == NULL)
4503 return bs;
4504
4505 for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
4506 {
4507 tmp = (bpstat) xmalloc (sizeof (*tmp));
4508 memcpy (tmp, bs, sizeof (*tmp));
4509 incref_counted_command_line (tmp->commands);
4510 incref_bp_location (tmp->bp_location_at);
4511 if (bs->old_val != NULL)
4512 {
4513 tmp->old_val = value_copy (bs->old_val);
4514 release_value (tmp->old_val);
4515 }
4516
4517 if (p == NULL)
4518 /* This is the first thing in the chain. */
4519 retval = tmp;
4520 else
4521 p->next = tmp;
4522 p = tmp;
4523 }
4524 p->next = NULL;
4525 return retval;
4526 }
4527
4528 /* Find the bpstat associated with this breakpoint. */
4529
4530 bpstat
4531 bpstat_find_breakpoint (bpstat bsp, struct breakpoint *breakpoint)
4532 {
4533 if (bsp == NULL)
4534 return NULL;
4535
4536 for (; bsp != NULL; bsp = bsp->next)
4537 {
4538 if (bsp->breakpoint_at == breakpoint)
4539 return bsp;
4540 }
4541 return NULL;
4542 }
4543
4544 /* See breakpoint.h. */
4545
4546 int
4547 bpstat_explains_signal (bpstat bsp, enum gdb_signal sig)
4548 {
4549 for (; bsp != NULL; bsp = bsp->next)
4550 {
4551 if (bsp->breakpoint_at == NULL)
4552 {
4553 /* A moribund location can never explain a signal other than
4554 GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP. */
4555 if (sig == GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP)
4556 return 1;
4557 }
4558 else
4559 {
4560 if (bsp->breakpoint_at->ops->explains_signal (bsp->breakpoint_at,
4561 sig))
4562 return 1;
4563 }
4564 }
4565
4566 return 0;
4567 }
4568
4569 /* Put in *NUM the breakpoint number of the first breakpoint we are
4570 stopped at. *BSP upon return is a bpstat which points to the
4571 remaining breakpoints stopped at (but which is not guaranteed to be
4572 good for anything but further calls to bpstat_num).
4573
4574 Return 0 if passed a bpstat which does not indicate any breakpoints.
4575 Return -1 if stopped at a breakpoint that has been deleted since
4576 we set it.
4577 Return 1 otherwise. */
4578
4579 int
4580 bpstat_num (bpstat *bsp, int *num)
4581 {
4582 struct breakpoint *b;
4583
4584 if ((*bsp) == NULL)
4585 return 0; /* No more breakpoint values */
4586
4587 /* We assume we'll never have several bpstats that correspond to a
4588 single breakpoint -- otherwise, this function might return the
4589 same number more than once and this will look ugly. */
4590 b = (*bsp)->breakpoint_at;
4591 *bsp = (*bsp)->next;
4592 if (b == NULL)
4593 return -1; /* breakpoint that's been deleted since */
4594
4595 *num = b->number; /* We have its number */
4596 return 1;
4597 }
4598
4599 /* See breakpoint.h. */
4600
4601 void
4602 bpstat_clear_actions (void)
4603 {
4604 struct thread_info *tp;
4605 bpstat bs;
4606
4607 if (ptid_equal (inferior_ptid, null_ptid))
4608 return;
4609
4610 tp = find_thread_ptid (inferior_ptid);
4611 if (tp == NULL)
4612 return;
4613
4614 for (bs = tp->control.stop_bpstat; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
4615 {
4616 decref_counted_command_line (&bs->commands);
4617
4618 if (bs->old_val != NULL)
4619 {
4620 value_free (bs->old_val);
4621 bs->old_val = NULL;
4622 }
4623 }
4624 }
4625
4626 /* Called when a command is about to proceed the inferior. */
4627
4628 static void
4629 breakpoint_about_to_proceed (void)
4630 {
4631 if (!ptid_equal (inferior_ptid, null_ptid))
4632 {
4633 struct thread_info *tp = inferior_thread ();
4634
4635 /* Allow inferior function calls in breakpoint commands to not
4636 interrupt the command list. When the call finishes
4637 successfully, the inferior will be standing at the same
4638 breakpoint as if nothing happened. */
4639 if (tp->control.in_infcall)
4640 return;
4641 }
4642
4643 breakpoint_proceeded = 1;
4644 }
4645
4646 /* Stub for cleaning up our state if we error-out of a breakpoint
4647 command. */
4648 static void
4649 cleanup_executing_breakpoints (void *ignore)
4650 {
4651 executing_breakpoint_commands = 0;
4652 }
4653
4654 /* Return non-zero iff CMD as the first line of a command sequence is `silent'
4655 or its equivalent. */
4656
4657 static int
4658 command_line_is_silent (struct command_line *cmd)
4659 {
4660 return cmd && (strcmp ("silent", cmd->line) == 0);
4661 }
4662
4663 /* Execute all the commands associated with all the breakpoints at
4664 this location. Any of these commands could cause the process to
4665 proceed beyond this point, etc. We look out for such changes by
4666 checking the global "breakpoint_proceeded" after each command.
4667
4668 Returns true if a breakpoint command resumed the inferior. In that
4669 case, it is the caller's responsibility to recall it again with the
4670 bpstat of the current thread. */
4671
4672 static int
4673 bpstat_do_actions_1 (bpstat *bsp)
4674 {
4675 bpstat bs;
4676 struct cleanup *old_chain;
4677 int again = 0;
4678
4679 /* Avoid endless recursion if a `source' command is contained
4680 in bs->commands. */
4681 if (executing_breakpoint_commands)
4682 return 0;
4683
4684 executing_breakpoint_commands = 1;
4685 old_chain = make_cleanup (cleanup_executing_breakpoints, 0);
4686
4687 prevent_dont_repeat ();
4688
4689 /* This pointer will iterate over the list of bpstat's. */
4690 bs = *bsp;
4691
4692 breakpoint_proceeded = 0;
4693 for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
4694 {
4695 struct counted_command_line *ccmd;
4696 struct command_line *cmd;
4697 struct cleanup *this_cmd_tree_chain;
4698
4699 /* Take ownership of the BSP's command tree, if it has one.
4700
4701 The command tree could legitimately contain commands like
4702 'step' and 'next', which call clear_proceed_status, which
4703 frees stop_bpstat's command tree. To make sure this doesn't
4704 free the tree we're executing out from under us, we need to
4705 take ownership of the tree ourselves. Since a given bpstat's
4706 commands are only executed once, we don't need to copy it; we
4707 can clear the pointer in the bpstat, and make sure we free
4708 the tree when we're done. */
4709 ccmd = bs->commands;
4710 bs->commands = NULL;
4711 this_cmd_tree_chain = make_cleanup_decref_counted_command_line (&ccmd);
4712 cmd = ccmd ? ccmd->commands : NULL;
4713 if (command_line_is_silent (cmd))
4714 {
4715 /* The action has been already done by bpstat_stop_status. */
4716 cmd = cmd->next;
4717 }
4718
4719 while (cmd != NULL)
4720 {
4721 execute_control_command (cmd);
4722
4723 if (breakpoint_proceeded)
4724 break;
4725 else
4726 cmd = cmd->next;
4727 }
4728
4729 /* We can free this command tree now. */
4730 do_cleanups (this_cmd_tree_chain);
4731
4732 if (breakpoint_proceeded)
4733 {
4734 if (current_ui->async)
4735 /* If we are in async mode, then the target might be still
4736 running, not stopped at any breakpoint, so nothing for
4737 us to do here -- just return to the event loop. */
4738 ;
4739 else
4740 /* In sync mode, when execute_control_command returns
4741 we're already standing on the next breakpoint.
4742 Breakpoint commands for that stop were not run, since
4743 execute_command does not run breakpoint commands --
4744 only command_line_handler does, but that one is not
4745 involved in execution of breakpoint commands. So, we
4746 can now execute breakpoint commands. It should be
4747 noted that making execute_command do bpstat actions is
4748 not an option -- in this case we'll have recursive
4749 invocation of bpstat for each breakpoint with a
4750 command, and can easily blow up GDB stack. Instead, we
4751 return true, which will trigger the caller to recall us
4752 with the new stop_bpstat. */
4753 again = 1;
4754 break;
4755 }
4756 }
4757 do_cleanups (old_chain);
4758 return again;
4759 }
4760
4761 void
4762 bpstat_do_actions (void)
4763 {
4764 struct cleanup *cleanup_if_error = make_bpstat_clear_actions_cleanup ();
4765
4766 /* Do any commands attached to breakpoint we are stopped at. */
4767 while (!ptid_equal (inferior_ptid, null_ptid)
4768 && target_has_execution
4769 && !is_exited (inferior_ptid)
4770 && !is_executing (inferior_ptid))
4771 /* Since in sync mode, bpstat_do_actions may resume the inferior,
4772 and only return when it is stopped at the next breakpoint, we
4773 keep doing breakpoint actions until it returns false to
4774 indicate the inferior was not resumed. */
4775 if (!bpstat_do_actions_1 (&inferior_thread ()->control.stop_bpstat))
4776 break;
4777
4778 discard_cleanups (cleanup_if_error);
4779 }
4780
4781 /* Print out the (old or new) value associated with a watchpoint. */
4782
4783 static void
4784 watchpoint_value_print (struct value *val, struct ui_file *stream)
4785 {
4786 if (val == NULL)
4787 fprintf_unfiltered (stream, _("<unreadable>"));
4788 else
4789 {
4790 struct value_print_options opts;
4791 get_user_print_options (&opts);
4792 value_print (val, stream, &opts);
4793 }
4794 }
4795
4796 /* Print the "Thread ID hit" part of "Thread ID hit Breakpoint N" if
4797 debugging multiple threads. */
4798
4799 void
4800 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (struct ui_out *uiout)
4801 {
4802 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
4803 return;
4804
4805 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
4806
4807 if (show_thread_that_caused_stop ())
4808 {
4809 const char *name;
4810 struct thread_info *thr = inferior_thread ();
4811
4812 ui_out_text (uiout, "Thread ");
4813 ui_out_field_fmt (uiout, "thread-id", "%s", print_thread_id (thr));
4814
4815 name = thr->name != NULL ? thr->name : target_thread_name (thr);
4816 if (name != NULL)
4817 {
4818 ui_out_text (uiout, " \"");
4819 ui_out_field_fmt (uiout, "name", "%s", name);
4820 ui_out_text (uiout, "\"");
4821 }
4822
4823 ui_out_text (uiout, " hit ");
4824 }
4825 }
4826
4827 /* Generic routine for printing messages indicating why we
4828 stopped. The behavior of this function depends on the value
4829 'print_it' in the bpstat structure. Under some circumstances we
4830 may decide not to print anything here and delegate the task to
4831 normal_stop(). */
4832
4833 static enum print_stop_action
4834 print_bp_stop_message (bpstat bs)
4835 {
4836 switch (bs->print_it)
4837 {
4838 case print_it_noop:
4839 /* Nothing should be printed for this bpstat entry. */
4840 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
4841 break;
4842
4843 case print_it_done:
4844 /* We still want to print the frame, but we already printed the
4845 relevant messages. */
4846 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
4847 break;
4848
4849 case print_it_normal:
4850 {
4851 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
4852
4853 /* bs->breakpoint_at can be NULL if it was a momentary breakpoint
4854 which has since been deleted. */
4855 if (b == NULL)
4856 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
4857
4858 /* Normal case. Call the breakpoint's print_it method. */
4859 return b->ops->print_it (bs);
4860 }
4861 break;
4862
4863 default:
4864 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
4865 _("print_bp_stop_message: unrecognized enum value"));
4866 break;
4867 }
4868 }
4869
4870 /* A helper function that prints a shared library stopped event. */
4871
4872 static void
4873 print_solib_event (int is_catchpoint)
4874 {
4875 int any_deleted
4876 = !VEC_empty (char_ptr, current_program_space->deleted_solibs);
4877 int any_added
4878 = !VEC_empty (so_list_ptr, current_program_space->added_solibs);
4879
4880 if (!is_catchpoint)
4881 {
4882 if (any_added || any_deleted)
4883 ui_out_text (current_uiout,
4884 _("Stopped due to shared library event:\n"));
4885 else
4886 ui_out_text (current_uiout,
4887 _("Stopped due to shared library event (no "
4888 "libraries added or removed)\n"));
4889 }
4890
4891 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (current_uiout))
4892 ui_out_field_string (current_uiout, "reason",
4893 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_SOLIB_EVENT));
4894
4895 if (any_deleted)
4896 {
4897 struct cleanup *cleanup;
4898 char *name;
4899 int ix;
4900
4901 ui_out_text (current_uiout, _(" Inferior unloaded "));
4902 cleanup = make_cleanup_ui_out_list_begin_end (current_uiout,
4903 "removed");
4904 for (ix = 0;
4905 VEC_iterate (char_ptr, current_program_space->deleted_solibs,
4906 ix, name);
4907 ++ix)
4908 {
4909 if (ix > 0)
4910 ui_out_text (current_uiout, " ");
4911 ui_out_field_string (current_uiout, "library", name);
4912 ui_out_text (current_uiout, "\n");
4913 }
4914
4915 do_cleanups (cleanup);
4916 }
4917
4918 if (any_added)
4919 {
4920 struct so_list *iter;
4921 int ix;
4922 struct cleanup *cleanup;
4923
4924 ui_out_text (current_uiout, _(" Inferior loaded "));
4925 cleanup = make_cleanup_ui_out_list_begin_end (current_uiout,
4926 "added");
4927 for (ix = 0;
4928 VEC_iterate (so_list_ptr, current_program_space->added_solibs,
4929 ix, iter);
4930 ++ix)
4931 {
4932 if (ix > 0)
4933 ui_out_text (current_uiout, " ");
4934 ui_out_field_string (current_uiout, "library", iter->so_name);
4935 ui_out_text (current_uiout, "\n");
4936 }
4937
4938 do_cleanups (cleanup);
4939 }
4940 }
4941
4942 /* Print a message indicating what happened. This is called from
4943 normal_stop(). The input to this routine is the head of the bpstat
4944 list - a list of the eventpoints that caused this stop. KIND is
4945 the target_waitkind for the stopping event. This
4946 routine calls the generic print routine for printing a message
4947 about reasons for stopping. This will print (for example) the
4948 "Breakpoint n," part of the output. The return value of this
4949 routine is one of:
4950
4951 PRINT_UNKNOWN: Means we printed nothing.
4952 PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC: Means we printed something, and expect subsequent
4953 code to print the location. An example is
4954 "Breakpoint 1, " which should be followed by
4955 the location.
4956 PRINT_SRC_ONLY: Means we printed something, but there is no need
4957 to also print the location part of the message.
4958 An example is the catch/throw messages, which
4959 don't require a location appended to the end.
4960 PRINT_NOTHING: We have done some printing and we don't need any
4961 further info to be printed. */
4962
4963 enum print_stop_action
4964 bpstat_print (bpstat bs, int kind)
4965 {
4966 enum print_stop_action val;
4967
4968 /* Maybe another breakpoint in the chain caused us to stop.
4969 (Currently all watchpoints go on the bpstat whether hit or not.
4970 That probably could (should) be changed, provided care is taken
4971 with respect to bpstat_explains_signal). */
4972 for (; bs; bs = bs->next)
4973 {
4974 val = print_bp_stop_message (bs);
4975 if (val == PRINT_SRC_ONLY
4976 || val == PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC
4977 || val == PRINT_NOTHING)
4978 return val;
4979 }
4980
4981 /* If we had hit a shared library event breakpoint,
4982 print_bp_stop_message would print out this message. If we hit an
4983 OS-level shared library event, do the same thing. */
4984 if (kind == TARGET_WAITKIND_LOADED)
4985 {
4986 print_solib_event (0);
4987 return PRINT_NOTHING;
4988 }
4989
4990 /* We reached the end of the chain, or we got a null BS to start
4991 with and nothing was printed. */
4992 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
4993 }
4994
4995 /* Evaluate the expression EXP and return 1 if value is zero.
4996 This returns the inverse of the condition because it is called
4997 from catch_errors which returns 0 if an exception happened, and if an
4998 exception happens we want execution to stop.
4999 The argument is a "struct expression *" that has been cast to a
5000 "void *" to make it pass through catch_errors. */
5001
5002 static int
5003 breakpoint_cond_eval (void *exp)
5004 {
5005 struct value *mark = value_mark ();
5006 int i = !value_true (evaluate_expression ((struct expression *) exp));
5007
5008 value_free_to_mark (mark);
5009 return i;
5010 }
5011
5012 /* Allocate a new bpstat. Link it to the FIFO list by BS_LINK_POINTER. */
5013
5014 static bpstat
5015 bpstat_alloc (struct bp_location *bl, bpstat **bs_link_pointer)
5016 {
5017 bpstat bs;
5018
5019 bs = (bpstat) xmalloc (sizeof (*bs));
5020 bs->next = NULL;
5021 **bs_link_pointer = bs;
5022 *bs_link_pointer = &bs->next;
5023 bs->breakpoint_at = bl->owner;
5024 bs->bp_location_at = bl;
5025 incref_bp_location (bl);
5026 /* If the condition is false, etc., don't do the commands. */
5027 bs->commands = NULL;
5028 bs->old_val = NULL;
5029 bs->print_it = print_it_normal;
5030 return bs;
5031 }
5032 \f
5033 /* The target has stopped with waitstatus WS. Check if any hardware
5034 watchpoints have triggered, according to the target. */
5035
5036 int
5037 watchpoints_triggered (struct target_waitstatus *ws)
5038 {
5039 int stopped_by_watchpoint = target_stopped_by_watchpoint ();
5040 CORE_ADDR addr;
5041 struct breakpoint *b;
5042
5043 if (!stopped_by_watchpoint)
5044 {
5045 /* We were not stopped by a watchpoint. Mark all watchpoints
5046 as not triggered. */
5047 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
5048 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b))
5049 {
5050 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
5051
5052 w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_no;
5053 }
5054
5055 return 0;
5056 }
5057
5058 if (!target_stopped_data_address (&current_target, &addr))
5059 {
5060 /* We were stopped by a watchpoint, but we don't know where.
5061 Mark all watchpoints as unknown. */
5062 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
5063 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b))
5064 {
5065 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
5066
5067 w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_unknown;
5068 }
5069
5070 return 1;
5071 }
5072
5073 /* The target could report the data address. Mark watchpoints
5074 affected by this data address as triggered, and all others as not
5075 triggered. */
5076
5077 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
5078 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b))
5079 {
5080 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
5081 struct bp_location *loc;
5082
5083 w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_no;
5084 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
5085 {
5086 if (is_masked_watchpoint (b))
5087 {
5088 CORE_ADDR newaddr = addr & w->hw_wp_mask;
5089 CORE_ADDR start = loc->address & w->hw_wp_mask;
5090
5091 if (newaddr == start)
5092 {
5093 w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_yes;
5094 break;
5095 }
5096 }
5097 /* Exact match not required. Within range is sufficient. */
5098 else if (target_watchpoint_addr_within_range (&current_target,
5099 addr, loc->address,
5100 loc->length))
5101 {
5102 w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_yes;
5103 break;
5104 }
5105 }
5106 }
5107
5108 return 1;
5109 }
5110
5111 /* Possible return values for watchpoint_check (this can't be an enum
5112 because of check_errors). */
5113 /* The watchpoint has been deleted. */
5114 #define WP_DELETED 1
5115 /* The value has changed. */
5116 #define WP_VALUE_CHANGED 2
5117 /* The value has not changed. */
5118 #define WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED 3
5119 /* Ignore this watchpoint, no matter if the value changed or not. */
5120 #define WP_IGNORE 4
5121
5122 #define BP_TEMPFLAG 1
5123 #define BP_HARDWAREFLAG 2
5124
5125 /* Evaluate watchpoint condition expression and check if its value
5126 changed.
5127
5128 P should be a pointer to struct bpstat, but is defined as a void *
5129 in order for this function to be usable with catch_errors. */
5130
5131 static int
5132 watchpoint_check (void *p)
5133 {
5134 bpstat bs = (bpstat) p;
5135 struct watchpoint *b;
5136 struct frame_info *fr;
5137 int within_current_scope;
5138
5139 /* BS is built from an existing struct breakpoint. */
5140 gdb_assert (bs->breakpoint_at != NULL);
5141 b = (struct watchpoint *) bs->breakpoint_at;
5142
5143 /* If this is a local watchpoint, we only want to check if the
5144 watchpoint frame is in scope if the current thread is the thread
5145 that was used to create the watchpoint. */
5146 if (!watchpoint_in_thread_scope (b))
5147 return WP_IGNORE;
5148
5149 if (b->exp_valid_block == NULL)
5150 within_current_scope = 1;
5151 else
5152 {
5153 struct frame_info *frame = get_current_frame ();
5154 struct gdbarch *frame_arch = get_frame_arch (frame);
5155 CORE_ADDR frame_pc = get_frame_pc (frame);
5156
5157 /* stack_frame_destroyed_p() returns a non-zero value if we're
5158 still in the function but the stack frame has already been
5159 invalidated. Since we can't rely on the values of local
5160 variables after the stack has been destroyed, we are treating
5161 the watchpoint in that state as `not changed' without further
5162 checking. Don't mark watchpoints as changed if the current
5163 frame is in an epilogue - even if they are in some other
5164 frame, our view of the stack is likely to be wrong and
5165 frame_find_by_id could error out. */
5166 if (gdbarch_stack_frame_destroyed_p (frame_arch, frame_pc))
5167 return WP_IGNORE;
5168
5169 fr = frame_find_by_id (b->watchpoint_frame);
5170 within_current_scope = (fr != NULL);
5171
5172 /* If we've gotten confused in the unwinder, we might have
5173 returned a frame that can't describe this variable. */
5174 if (within_current_scope)
5175 {
5176 struct symbol *function;
5177
5178 function = get_frame_function (fr);
5179 if (function == NULL
5180 || !contained_in (b->exp_valid_block,
5181 SYMBOL_BLOCK_VALUE (function)))
5182 within_current_scope = 0;
5183 }
5184
5185 if (within_current_scope)
5186 /* If we end up stopping, the current frame will get selected
5187 in normal_stop. So this call to select_frame won't affect
5188 the user. */
5189 select_frame (fr);
5190 }
5191
5192 if (within_current_scope)
5193 {
5194 /* We use value_{,free_to_}mark because it could be a *long*
5195 time before we return to the command level and call
5196 free_all_values. We can't call free_all_values because we
5197 might be in the middle of evaluating a function call. */
5198
5199 int pc = 0;
5200 struct value *mark;
5201 struct value *new_val;
5202
5203 if (is_masked_watchpoint (&b->base))
5204 /* Since we don't know the exact trigger address (from
5205 stopped_data_address), just tell the user we've triggered
5206 a mask watchpoint. */
5207 return WP_VALUE_CHANGED;
5208
5209 mark = value_mark ();
5210 fetch_subexp_value (b->exp, &pc, &new_val, NULL, NULL, 0);
5211
5212 if (b->val_bitsize != 0)
5213 new_val = extract_bitfield_from_watchpoint_value (b, new_val);
5214
5215 /* We use value_equal_contents instead of value_equal because
5216 the latter coerces an array to a pointer, thus comparing just
5217 the address of the array instead of its contents. This is
5218 not what we want. */
5219 if ((b->val != NULL) != (new_val != NULL)
5220 || (b->val != NULL && !value_equal_contents (b->val, new_val)))
5221 {
5222 if (new_val != NULL)
5223 {
5224 release_value (new_val);
5225 value_free_to_mark (mark);
5226 }
5227 bs->old_val = b->val;
5228 b->val = new_val;
5229 b->val_valid = 1;
5230 return WP_VALUE_CHANGED;
5231 }
5232 else
5233 {
5234 /* Nothing changed. */
5235 value_free_to_mark (mark);
5236 return WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED;
5237 }
5238 }
5239 else
5240 {
5241 struct switch_thru_all_uis state;
5242
5243 /* This seems like the only logical thing to do because
5244 if we temporarily ignored the watchpoint, then when
5245 we reenter the block in which it is valid it contains
5246 garbage (in the case of a function, it may have two
5247 garbage values, one before and one after the prologue).
5248 So we can't even detect the first assignment to it and
5249 watch after that (since the garbage may or may not equal
5250 the first value assigned). */
5251 /* We print all the stop information in
5252 breakpoint_ops->print_it, but in this case, by the time we
5253 call breakpoint_ops->print_it this bp will be deleted
5254 already. So we have no choice but print the information
5255 here. */
5256
5257 SWITCH_THRU_ALL_UIS (state)
5258 {
5259 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
5260
5261 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
5262 ui_out_field_string
5263 (uiout, "reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_WATCHPOINT_SCOPE));
5264 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nWatchpoint ");
5265 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "wpnum", b->base.number);
5266 ui_out_text (uiout,
5267 " deleted because the program has left the block in\n"
5268 "which its expression is valid.\n");
5269 }
5270
5271 /* Make sure the watchpoint's commands aren't executed. */
5272 decref_counted_command_line (&b->base.commands);
5273 watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (b);
5274
5275 return WP_DELETED;
5276 }
5277 }
5278
5279 /* Return true if it looks like target has stopped due to hitting
5280 breakpoint location BL. This function does not check if we should
5281 stop, only if BL explains the stop. */
5282
5283 static int
5284 bpstat_check_location (const struct bp_location *bl,
5285 struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
5286 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
5287 {
5288 struct breakpoint *b = bl->owner;
5289
5290 /* BL is from an existing breakpoint. */
5291 gdb_assert (b != NULL);
5292
5293 return b->ops->breakpoint_hit (bl, aspace, bp_addr, ws);
5294 }
5295
5296 /* Determine if the watched values have actually changed, and we
5297 should stop. If not, set BS->stop to 0. */
5298
5299 static void
5300 bpstat_check_watchpoint (bpstat bs)
5301 {
5302 const struct bp_location *bl;
5303 struct watchpoint *b;
5304
5305 /* BS is built for existing struct breakpoint. */
5306 bl = bs->bp_location_at;
5307 gdb_assert (bl != NULL);
5308 b = (struct watchpoint *) bs->breakpoint_at;
5309 gdb_assert (b != NULL);
5310
5311 {
5312 int must_check_value = 0;
5313
5314 if (b->base.type == bp_watchpoint)
5315 /* For a software watchpoint, we must always check the
5316 watched value. */
5317 must_check_value = 1;
5318 else if (b->watchpoint_triggered == watch_triggered_yes)
5319 /* We have a hardware watchpoint (read, write, or access)
5320 and the target earlier reported an address watched by
5321 this watchpoint. */
5322 must_check_value = 1;
5323 else if (b->watchpoint_triggered == watch_triggered_unknown
5324 && b->base.type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
5325 /* We were stopped by a hardware watchpoint, but the target could
5326 not report the data address. We must check the watchpoint's
5327 value. Access and read watchpoints are out of luck; without
5328 a data address, we can't figure it out. */
5329 must_check_value = 1;
5330
5331 if (must_check_value)
5332 {
5333 char *message
5334 = xstrprintf ("Error evaluating expression for watchpoint %d\n",
5335 b->base.number);
5336 struct cleanup *cleanups = make_cleanup (xfree, message);
5337 int e = catch_errors (watchpoint_check, bs, message,
5338 RETURN_MASK_ALL);
5339 do_cleanups (cleanups);
5340 switch (e)
5341 {
5342 case WP_DELETED:
5343 /* We've already printed what needs to be printed. */
5344 bs->print_it = print_it_done;
5345 /* Stop. */
5346 break;
5347 case WP_IGNORE:
5348 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
5349 bs->stop = 0;
5350 break;
5351 case WP_VALUE_CHANGED:
5352 if (b->base.type == bp_read_watchpoint)
5353 {
5354 /* There are two cases to consider here:
5355
5356 1. We're watching the triggered memory for reads.
5357 In that case, trust the target, and always report
5358 the watchpoint hit to the user. Even though
5359 reads don't cause value changes, the value may
5360 have changed since the last time it was read, and
5361 since we're not trapping writes, we will not see
5362 those, and as such we should ignore our notion of
5363 old value.
5364
5365 2. We're watching the triggered memory for both
5366 reads and writes. There are two ways this may
5367 happen:
5368
5369 2.1. This is a target that can't break on data
5370 reads only, but can break on accesses (reads or
5371 writes), such as e.g., x86. We detect this case
5372 at the time we try to insert read watchpoints.
5373
5374 2.2. Otherwise, the target supports read
5375 watchpoints, but, the user set an access or write
5376 watchpoint watching the same memory as this read
5377 watchpoint.
5378
5379 If we're watching memory writes as well as reads,
5380 ignore watchpoint hits when we find that the
5381 value hasn't changed, as reads don't cause
5382 changes. This still gives false positives when
5383 the program writes the same value to memory as
5384 what there was already in memory (we will confuse
5385 it for a read), but it's much better than
5386 nothing. */
5387
5388 int other_write_watchpoint = 0;
5389
5390 if (bl->watchpoint_type == hw_read)
5391 {
5392 struct breakpoint *other_b;
5393
5394 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (other_b)
5395 if (other_b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
5396 || other_b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
5397 {
5398 struct watchpoint *other_w =
5399 (struct watchpoint *) other_b;
5400
5401 if (other_w->watchpoint_triggered
5402 == watch_triggered_yes)
5403 {
5404 other_write_watchpoint = 1;
5405 break;
5406 }
5407 }
5408 }
5409
5410 if (other_write_watchpoint
5411 || bl->watchpoint_type == hw_access)
5412 {
5413 /* We're watching the same memory for writes,
5414 and the value changed since the last time we
5415 updated it, so this trap must be for a write.
5416 Ignore it. */
5417 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
5418 bs->stop = 0;
5419 }
5420 }
5421 break;
5422 case WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED:
5423 if (b->base.type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
5424 || b->base.type == bp_watchpoint)
5425 {
5426 /* Don't stop: write watchpoints shouldn't fire if
5427 the value hasn't changed. */
5428 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
5429 bs->stop = 0;
5430 }
5431 /* Stop. */
5432 break;
5433 default:
5434 /* Can't happen. */
5435 case 0:
5436 /* Error from catch_errors. */
5437 {
5438 struct switch_thru_all_uis state;
5439
5440 SWITCH_THRU_ALL_UIS (state)
5441 {
5442 printf_filtered (_("Watchpoint %d deleted.\n"),
5443 b->base.number);
5444 }
5445 watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (b);
5446 /* We've already printed what needs to be printed. */
5447 bs->print_it = print_it_done;
5448 }
5449 break;
5450 }
5451 }
5452 else /* must_check_value == 0 */
5453 {
5454 /* This is a case where some watchpoint(s) triggered, but
5455 not at the address of this watchpoint, or else no
5456 watchpoint triggered after all. So don't print
5457 anything for this watchpoint. */
5458 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
5459 bs->stop = 0;
5460 }
5461 }
5462 }
5463
5464 /* For breakpoints that are currently marked as telling gdb to stop,
5465 check conditions (condition proper, frame, thread and ignore count)
5466 of breakpoint referred to by BS. If we should not stop for this
5467 breakpoint, set BS->stop to 0. */
5468
5469 static void
5470 bpstat_check_breakpoint_conditions (bpstat bs, ptid_t ptid)
5471 {
5472 const struct bp_location *bl;
5473 struct breakpoint *b;
5474 int value_is_zero = 0;
5475 struct expression *cond;
5476
5477 gdb_assert (bs->stop);
5478
5479 /* BS is built for existing struct breakpoint. */
5480 bl = bs->bp_location_at;
5481 gdb_assert (bl != NULL);
5482 b = bs->breakpoint_at;
5483 gdb_assert (b != NULL);
5484
5485 /* Even if the target evaluated the condition on its end and notified GDB, we
5486 need to do so again since GDB does not know if we stopped due to a
5487 breakpoint or a single step breakpoint. */
5488
5489 if (frame_id_p (b->frame_id)
5490 && !frame_id_eq (b->frame_id, get_stack_frame_id (get_current_frame ())))
5491 {
5492 bs->stop = 0;
5493 return;
5494 }
5495
5496 /* If this is a thread/task-specific breakpoint, don't waste cpu
5497 evaluating the condition if this isn't the specified
5498 thread/task. */
5499 if ((b->thread != -1 && b->thread != ptid_to_global_thread_id (ptid))
5500 || (b->task != 0 && b->task != ada_get_task_number (ptid)))
5501
5502 {
5503 bs->stop = 0;
5504 return;
5505 }
5506
5507 /* Evaluate extension language breakpoints that have a "stop" method
5508 implemented. */
5509 bs->stop = breakpoint_ext_lang_cond_says_stop (b);
5510
5511 if (is_watchpoint (b))
5512 {
5513 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
5514
5515 cond = w->cond_exp;
5516 }
5517 else
5518 cond = bl->cond;
5519
5520 if (cond && b->disposition != disp_del_at_next_stop)
5521 {
5522 int within_current_scope = 1;
5523 struct watchpoint * w;
5524
5525 /* We use value_mark and value_free_to_mark because it could
5526 be a long time before we return to the command level and
5527 call free_all_values. We can't call free_all_values
5528 because we might be in the middle of evaluating a
5529 function call. */
5530 struct value *mark = value_mark ();
5531
5532 if (is_watchpoint (b))
5533 w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
5534 else
5535 w = NULL;
5536
5537 /* Need to select the frame, with all that implies so that
5538 the conditions will have the right context. Because we
5539 use the frame, we will not see an inlined function's
5540 variables when we arrive at a breakpoint at the start
5541 of the inlined function; the current frame will be the
5542 call site. */
5543 if (w == NULL || w->cond_exp_valid_block == NULL)
5544 select_frame (get_current_frame ());
5545 else
5546 {
5547 struct frame_info *frame;
5548
5549 /* For local watchpoint expressions, which particular
5550 instance of a local is being watched matters, so we
5551 keep track of the frame to evaluate the expression
5552 in. To evaluate the condition however, it doesn't
5553 really matter which instantiation of the function
5554 where the condition makes sense triggers the
5555 watchpoint. This allows an expression like "watch
5556 global if q > 10" set in `func', catch writes to
5557 global on all threads that call `func', or catch
5558 writes on all recursive calls of `func' by a single
5559 thread. We simply always evaluate the condition in
5560 the innermost frame that's executing where it makes
5561 sense to evaluate the condition. It seems
5562 intuitive. */
5563 frame = block_innermost_frame (w->cond_exp_valid_block);
5564 if (frame != NULL)
5565 select_frame (frame);
5566 else
5567 within_current_scope = 0;
5568 }
5569 if (within_current_scope)
5570 value_is_zero
5571 = catch_errors (breakpoint_cond_eval, cond,
5572 "Error in testing breakpoint condition:\n",
5573 RETURN_MASK_ALL);
5574 else
5575 {
5576 warning (_("Watchpoint condition cannot be tested "
5577 "in the current scope"));
5578 /* If we failed to set the right context for this
5579 watchpoint, unconditionally report it. */
5580 value_is_zero = 0;
5581 }
5582 /* FIXME-someday, should give breakpoint #. */
5583 value_free_to_mark (mark);
5584 }
5585
5586 if (cond && value_is_zero)
5587 {
5588 bs->stop = 0;
5589 }
5590 else if (b->ignore_count > 0)
5591 {
5592 b->ignore_count--;
5593 bs->stop = 0;
5594 /* Increase the hit count even though we don't stop. */
5595 ++(b->hit_count);
5596 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b);
5597 }
5598 }
5599
5600 /* Returns true if we need to track moribund locations of LOC's type
5601 on the current target. */
5602
5603 static int
5604 need_moribund_for_location_type (struct bp_location *loc)
5605 {
5606 return ((loc->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
5607 && !target_supports_stopped_by_sw_breakpoint ())
5608 || (loc->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
5609 && !target_supports_stopped_by_hw_breakpoint ()));
5610 }
5611
5612
5613 /* Get a bpstat associated with having just stopped at address
5614 BP_ADDR in thread PTID.
5615
5616 Determine whether we stopped at a breakpoint, etc, or whether we
5617 don't understand this stop. Result is a chain of bpstat's such
5618 that:
5619
5620 if we don't understand the stop, the result is a null pointer.
5621
5622 if we understand why we stopped, the result is not null.
5623
5624 Each element of the chain refers to a particular breakpoint or
5625 watchpoint at which we have stopped. (We may have stopped for
5626 several reasons concurrently.)
5627
5628 Each element of the chain has valid next, breakpoint_at,
5629 commands, FIXME??? fields. */
5630
5631 bpstat
5632 bpstat_stop_status (struct address_space *aspace,
5633 CORE_ADDR bp_addr, ptid_t ptid,
5634 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
5635 {
5636 struct breakpoint *b = NULL;
5637 struct bp_location *bl;
5638 struct bp_location *loc;
5639 /* First item of allocated bpstat's. */
5640 bpstat bs_head = NULL, *bs_link = &bs_head;
5641 /* Pointer to the last thing in the chain currently. */
5642 bpstat bs;
5643 int ix;
5644 int need_remove_insert;
5645 int removed_any;
5646
5647 /* First, build the bpstat chain with locations that explain a
5648 target stop, while being careful to not set the target running,
5649 as that may invalidate locations (in particular watchpoint
5650 locations are recreated). Resuming will happen here with
5651 breakpoint conditions or watchpoint expressions that include
5652 inferior function calls. */
5653
5654 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
5655 {
5656 if (!breakpoint_enabled (b))
5657 continue;
5658
5659 for (bl = b->loc; bl != NULL; bl = bl->next)
5660 {
5661 /* For hardware watchpoints, we look only at the first
5662 location. The watchpoint_check function will work on the
5663 entire expression, not the individual locations. For
5664 read watchpoints, the watchpoints_triggered function has
5665 checked all locations already. */
5666 if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint && bl != b->loc)
5667 break;
5668
5669 if (!bl->enabled || bl->shlib_disabled)
5670 continue;
5671
5672 if (!bpstat_check_location (bl, aspace, bp_addr, ws))
5673 continue;
5674
5675 /* Come here if it's a watchpoint, or if the break address
5676 matches. */
5677
5678 bs = bpstat_alloc (bl, &bs_link); /* Alloc a bpstat to
5679 explain stop. */
5680
5681 /* Assume we stop. Should we find a watchpoint that is not
5682 actually triggered, or if the condition of the breakpoint
5683 evaluates as false, we'll reset 'stop' to 0. */
5684 bs->stop = 1;
5685 bs->print = 1;
5686
5687 /* If this is a scope breakpoint, mark the associated
5688 watchpoint as triggered so that we will handle the
5689 out-of-scope event. We'll get to the watchpoint next
5690 iteration. */
5691 if (b->type == bp_watchpoint_scope && b->related_breakpoint != b)
5692 {
5693 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b->related_breakpoint;
5694
5695 w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_yes;
5696 }
5697 }
5698 }
5699
5700 /* Check if a moribund breakpoint explains the stop. */
5701 if (!target_supports_stopped_by_sw_breakpoint ()
5702 || !target_supports_stopped_by_hw_breakpoint ())
5703 {
5704 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix, loc); ++ix)
5705 {
5706 if (breakpoint_location_address_match (loc, aspace, bp_addr)
5707 && need_moribund_for_location_type (loc))
5708 {
5709 bs = bpstat_alloc (loc, &bs_link);
5710 /* For hits of moribund locations, we should just proceed. */
5711 bs->stop = 0;
5712 bs->print = 0;
5713 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
5714 }
5715 }
5716 }
5717
5718 /* A bit of special processing for shlib breakpoints. We need to
5719 process solib loading here, so that the lists of loaded and
5720 unloaded libraries are correct before we handle "catch load" and
5721 "catch unload". */
5722 for (bs = bs_head; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
5723 {
5724 if (bs->breakpoint_at && bs->breakpoint_at->type == bp_shlib_event)
5725 {
5726 handle_solib_event ();
5727 break;
5728 }
5729 }
5730
5731 /* Now go through the locations that caused the target to stop, and
5732 check whether we're interested in reporting this stop to higher
5733 layers, or whether we should resume the target transparently. */
5734
5735 removed_any = 0;
5736
5737 for (bs = bs_head; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
5738 {
5739 if (!bs->stop)
5740 continue;
5741
5742 b = bs->breakpoint_at;
5743 b->ops->check_status (bs);
5744 if (bs->stop)
5745 {
5746 bpstat_check_breakpoint_conditions (bs, ptid);
5747
5748 if (bs->stop)
5749 {
5750 ++(b->hit_count);
5751 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b);
5752
5753 /* We will stop here. */
5754 if (b->disposition == disp_disable)
5755 {
5756 --(b->enable_count);
5757 if (b->enable_count <= 0)
5758 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
5759 removed_any = 1;
5760 }
5761 if (b->silent)
5762 bs->print = 0;
5763 bs->commands = b->commands;
5764 incref_counted_command_line (bs->commands);
5765 if (command_line_is_silent (bs->commands
5766 ? bs->commands->commands : NULL))
5767 bs->print = 0;
5768
5769 b->ops->after_condition_true (bs);
5770 }
5771
5772 }
5773
5774 /* Print nothing for this entry if we don't stop or don't
5775 print. */
5776 if (!bs->stop || !bs->print)
5777 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
5778 }
5779
5780 /* If we aren't stopping, the value of some hardware watchpoint may
5781 not have changed, but the intermediate memory locations we are
5782 watching may have. Don't bother if we're stopping; this will get
5783 done later. */
5784 need_remove_insert = 0;
5785 if (! bpstat_causes_stop (bs_head))
5786 for (bs = bs_head; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
5787 if (!bs->stop
5788 && bs->breakpoint_at
5789 && is_hardware_watchpoint (bs->breakpoint_at))
5790 {
5791 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bs->breakpoint_at;
5792
5793 update_watchpoint (w, 0 /* don't reparse. */);
5794 need_remove_insert = 1;
5795 }
5796
5797 if (need_remove_insert)
5798 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
5799 else if (removed_any)
5800 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
5801
5802 return bs_head;
5803 }
5804
5805 static void
5806 handle_jit_event (void)
5807 {
5808 struct frame_info *frame;
5809 struct gdbarch *gdbarch;
5810
5811 if (debug_infrun)
5812 fprintf_unfiltered (gdb_stdlog, "handling bp_jit_event\n");
5813
5814 /* Switch terminal for any messages produced by
5815 breakpoint_re_set. */
5816 target_terminal_ours_for_output ();
5817
5818 frame = get_current_frame ();
5819 gdbarch = get_frame_arch (frame);
5820
5821 jit_event_handler (gdbarch);
5822
5823 target_terminal_inferior ();
5824 }
5825
5826 /* Prepare WHAT final decision for infrun. */
5827
5828 /* Decide what infrun needs to do with this bpstat. */
5829
5830 struct bpstat_what
5831 bpstat_what (bpstat bs_head)
5832 {
5833 struct bpstat_what retval;
5834 bpstat bs;
5835
5836 retval.main_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_KEEP_CHECKING;
5837 retval.call_dummy = STOP_NONE;
5838 retval.is_longjmp = 0;
5839
5840 for (bs = bs_head; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
5841 {
5842 /* Extract this BS's action. After processing each BS, we check
5843 if its action overrides all we've seem so far. */
5844 enum bpstat_what_main_action this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_KEEP_CHECKING;
5845 enum bptype bptype;
5846
5847 if (bs->breakpoint_at == NULL)
5848 {
5849 /* I suspect this can happen if it was a momentary
5850 breakpoint which has since been deleted. */
5851 bptype = bp_none;
5852 }
5853 else
5854 bptype = bs->breakpoint_at->type;
5855
5856 switch (bptype)
5857 {
5858 case bp_none:
5859 break;
5860 case bp_breakpoint:
5861 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
5862 case bp_single_step:
5863 case bp_until:
5864 case bp_finish:
5865 case bp_shlib_event:
5866 if (bs->stop)
5867 {
5868 if (bs->print)
5869 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_NOISY;
5870 else
5871 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
5872 }
5873 else
5874 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5875 break;
5876 case bp_watchpoint:
5877 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
5878 case bp_read_watchpoint:
5879 case bp_access_watchpoint:
5880 if (bs->stop)
5881 {
5882 if (bs->print)
5883 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_NOISY;
5884 else
5885 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
5886 }
5887 else
5888 {
5889 /* There was a watchpoint, but we're not stopping.
5890 This requires no further action. */
5891 }
5892 break;
5893 case bp_longjmp:
5894 case bp_longjmp_call_dummy:
5895 case bp_exception:
5896 if (bs->stop)
5897 {
5898 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SET_LONGJMP_RESUME;
5899 retval.is_longjmp = bptype != bp_exception;
5900 }
5901 else
5902 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5903 break;
5904 case bp_longjmp_resume:
5905 case bp_exception_resume:
5906 if (bs->stop)
5907 {
5908 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_CLEAR_LONGJMP_RESUME;
5909 retval.is_longjmp = bptype == bp_longjmp_resume;
5910 }
5911 else
5912 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5913 break;
5914 case bp_step_resume:
5915 if (bs->stop)
5916 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STEP_RESUME;
5917 else
5918 {
5919 /* It is for the wrong frame. */
5920 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5921 }
5922 break;
5923 case bp_hp_step_resume:
5924 if (bs->stop)
5925 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_HP_STEP_RESUME;
5926 else
5927 {
5928 /* It is for the wrong frame. */
5929 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5930 }
5931 break;
5932 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
5933 case bp_thread_event:
5934 case bp_overlay_event:
5935 case bp_longjmp_master:
5936 case bp_std_terminate_master:
5937 case bp_exception_master:
5938 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5939 break;
5940 case bp_catchpoint:
5941 if (bs->stop)
5942 {
5943 if (bs->print)
5944 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_NOISY;
5945 else
5946 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
5947 }
5948 else
5949 {
5950 /* There was a catchpoint, but we're not stopping.
5951 This requires no further action. */
5952 }
5953 break;
5954 case bp_jit_event:
5955 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5956 break;
5957 case bp_call_dummy:
5958 /* Make sure the action is stop (silent or noisy),
5959 so infrun.c pops the dummy frame. */
5960 retval.call_dummy = STOP_STACK_DUMMY;
5961 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
5962 break;
5963 case bp_std_terminate:
5964 /* Make sure the action is stop (silent or noisy),
5965 so infrun.c pops the dummy frame. */
5966 retval.call_dummy = STOP_STD_TERMINATE;
5967 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
5968 break;
5969 case bp_tracepoint:
5970 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
5971 case bp_static_tracepoint:
5972 /* Tracepoint hits should not be reported back to GDB, and
5973 if one got through somehow, it should have been filtered
5974 out already. */
5975 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
5976 _("bpstat_what: tracepoint encountered"));
5977 break;
5978 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver:
5979 /* Step over it (and insert bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return). */
5980 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5981 break;
5982 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return:
5983 /* The breakpoint will be removed, execution will restart from the
5984 PC of the former breakpoint. */
5985 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_KEEP_CHECKING;
5986 break;
5987
5988 case bp_dprintf:
5989 if (bs->stop)
5990 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
5991 else
5992 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5993 break;
5994
5995 default:
5996 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
5997 _("bpstat_what: unhandled bptype %d"), (int) bptype);
5998 }
5999
6000 retval.main_action = std::max (retval.main_action, this_action);
6001 }
6002
6003 return retval;
6004 }
6005
6006 void
6007 bpstat_run_callbacks (bpstat bs_head)
6008 {
6009 bpstat bs;
6010
6011 for (bs = bs_head; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
6012 {
6013 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
6014
6015 if (b == NULL)
6016 continue;
6017 switch (b->type)
6018 {
6019 case bp_jit_event:
6020 handle_jit_event ();
6021 break;
6022 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver:
6023 gnu_ifunc_resolver_stop (b);
6024 break;
6025 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return:
6026 gnu_ifunc_resolver_return_stop (b);
6027 break;
6028 }
6029 }
6030 }
6031
6032 /* Nonzero if we should step constantly (e.g. watchpoints on machines
6033 without hardware support). This isn't related to a specific bpstat,
6034 just to things like whether watchpoints are set. */
6035
6036 int
6037 bpstat_should_step (void)
6038 {
6039 struct breakpoint *b;
6040
6041 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
6042 if (breakpoint_enabled (b) && b->type == bp_watchpoint && b->loc != NULL)
6043 return 1;
6044 return 0;
6045 }
6046
6047 int
6048 bpstat_causes_stop (bpstat bs)
6049 {
6050 for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
6051 if (bs->stop)
6052 return 1;
6053
6054 return 0;
6055 }
6056
6057 \f
6058
6059 /* Compute a string of spaces suitable to indent the next line
6060 so it starts at the position corresponding to the table column
6061 named COL_NAME in the currently active table of UIOUT. */
6062
6063 static char *
6064 wrap_indent_at_field (struct ui_out *uiout, const char *col_name)
6065 {
6066 static char wrap_indent[80];
6067 int i, total_width, width, align;
6068 char *text;
6069
6070 total_width = 0;
6071 for (i = 1; ui_out_query_field (uiout, i, &width, &align, &text); i++)
6072 {
6073 if (strcmp (text, col_name) == 0)
6074 {
6075 gdb_assert (total_width < sizeof wrap_indent);
6076 memset (wrap_indent, ' ', total_width);
6077 wrap_indent[total_width] = 0;
6078
6079 return wrap_indent;
6080 }
6081
6082 total_width += width + 1;
6083 }
6084
6085 return NULL;
6086 }
6087
6088 /* Determine if the locations of this breakpoint will have their conditions
6089 evaluated by the target, host or a mix of both. Returns the following:
6090
6091 "host": Host evals condition.
6092 "host or target": Host or Target evals condition.
6093 "target": Target evals condition.
6094 */
6095
6096 static const char *
6097 bp_condition_evaluator (struct breakpoint *b)
6098 {
6099 struct bp_location *bl;
6100 char host_evals = 0;
6101 char target_evals = 0;
6102
6103 if (!b)
6104 return NULL;
6105
6106 if (!is_breakpoint (b))
6107 return NULL;
6108
6109 if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
6110 || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
6111 return condition_evaluation_host;
6112
6113 for (bl = b->loc; bl; bl = bl->next)
6114 {
6115 if (bl->cond_bytecode)
6116 target_evals++;
6117 else
6118 host_evals++;
6119 }
6120
6121 if (host_evals && target_evals)
6122 return condition_evaluation_both;
6123 else if (target_evals)
6124 return condition_evaluation_target;
6125 else
6126 return condition_evaluation_host;
6127 }
6128
6129 /* Determine the breakpoint location's condition evaluator. This is
6130 similar to bp_condition_evaluator, but for locations. */
6131
6132 static const char *
6133 bp_location_condition_evaluator (struct bp_location *bl)
6134 {
6135 if (bl && !is_breakpoint (bl->owner))
6136 return NULL;
6137
6138 if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
6139 || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
6140 return condition_evaluation_host;
6141
6142 if (bl && bl->cond_bytecode)
6143 return condition_evaluation_target;
6144 else
6145 return condition_evaluation_host;
6146 }
6147
6148 /* Print the LOC location out of the list of B->LOC locations. */
6149
6150 static void
6151 print_breakpoint_location (struct breakpoint *b,
6152 struct bp_location *loc)
6153 {
6154 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
6155 struct cleanup *old_chain = save_current_program_space ();
6156
6157 if (loc != NULL && loc->shlib_disabled)
6158 loc = NULL;
6159
6160 if (loc != NULL)
6161 set_current_program_space (loc->pspace);
6162
6163 if (b->display_canonical)
6164 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what",
6165 event_location_to_string (b->location));
6166 else if (loc && loc->symtab)
6167 {
6168 struct symbol *sym
6169 = find_pc_sect_function (loc->address, loc->section);
6170 if (sym)
6171 {
6172 ui_out_text (uiout, "in ");
6173 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "func",
6174 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (sym));
6175 ui_out_text (uiout, " ");
6176 ui_out_wrap_hint (uiout, wrap_indent_at_field (uiout, "what"));
6177 ui_out_text (uiout, "at ");
6178 }
6179 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "file",
6180 symtab_to_filename_for_display (loc->symtab));
6181 ui_out_text (uiout, ":");
6182
6183 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
6184 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "fullname",
6185 symtab_to_fullname (loc->symtab));
6186
6187 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "line", loc->line_number);
6188 }
6189 else if (loc)
6190 {
6191 struct ui_file *stb = mem_fileopen ();
6192 struct cleanup *stb_chain = make_cleanup_ui_file_delete (stb);
6193
6194 print_address_symbolic (loc->gdbarch, loc->address, stb,
6195 demangle, "");
6196 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "at", stb);
6197
6198 do_cleanups (stb_chain);
6199 }
6200 else
6201 {
6202 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "pending",
6203 event_location_to_string (b->location));
6204 /* If extra_string is available, it could be holding a condition
6205 or dprintf arguments. In either case, make sure it is printed,
6206 too, but only for non-MI streams. */
6207 if (!ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout) && b->extra_string != NULL)
6208 {
6209 if (b->type == bp_dprintf)
6210 ui_out_text (uiout, ",");
6211 else
6212 ui_out_text (uiout, " ");
6213 ui_out_text (uiout, b->extra_string);
6214 }
6215 }
6216
6217 if (loc && is_breakpoint (b)
6218 && breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode () == condition_evaluation_target
6219 && bp_condition_evaluator (b) == condition_evaluation_both)
6220 {
6221 ui_out_text (uiout, " (");
6222 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "evaluated-by",
6223 bp_location_condition_evaluator (loc));
6224 ui_out_text (uiout, ")");
6225 }
6226
6227 do_cleanups (old_chain);
6228 }
6229
6230 static const char *
6231 bptype_string (enum bptype type)
6232 {
6233 struct ep_type_description
6234 {
6235 enum bptype type;
6236 char *description;
6237 };
6238 static struct ep_type_description bptypes[] =
6239 {
6240 {bp_none, "?deleted?"},
6241 {bp_breakpoint, "breakpoint"},
6242 {bp_hardware_breakpoint, "hw breakpoint"},
6243 {bp_single_step, "sw single-step"},
6244 {bp_until, "until"},
6245 {bp_finish, "finish"},
6246 {bp_watchpoint, "watchpoint"},
6247 {bp_hardware_watchpoint, "hw watchpoint"},
6248 {bp_read_watchpoint, "read watchpoint"},
6249 {bp_access_watchpoint, "acc watchpoint"},
6250 {bp_longjmp, "longjmp"},
6251 {bp_longjmp_resume, "longjmp resume"},
6252 {bp_longjmp_call_dummy, "longjmp for call dummy"},
6253 {bp_exception, "exception"},
6254 {bp_exception_resume, "exception resume"},
6255 {bp_step_resume, "step resume"},
6256 {bp_hp_step_resume, "high-priority step resume"},
6257 {bp_watchpoint_scope, "watchpoint scope"},
6258 {bp_call_dummy, "call dummy"},
6259 {bp_std_terminate, "std::terminate"},
6260 {bp_shlib_event, "shlib events"},
6261 {bp_thread_event, "thread events"},
6262 {bp_overlay_event, "overlay events"},
6263 {bp_longjmp_master, "longjmp master"},
6264 {bp_std_terminate_master, "std::terminate master"},
6265 {bp_exception_master, "exception master"},
6266 {bp_catchpoint, "catchpoint"},
6267 {bp_tracepoint, "tracepoint"},
6268 {bp_fast_tracepoint, "fast tracepoint"},
6269 {bp_static_tracepoint, "static tracepoint"},
6270 {bp_dprintf, "dprintf"},
6271 {bp_jit_event, "jit events"},
6272 {bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver, "STT_GNU_IFUNC resolver"},
6273 {bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return, "STT_GNU_IFUNC resolver return"},
6274 };
6275
6276 if (((int) type >= (sizeof (bptypes) / sizeof (bptypes[0])))
6277 || ((int) type != bptypes[(int) type].type))
6278 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
6279 _("bptypes table does not describe type #%d."),
6280 (int) type);
6281
6282 return bptypes[(int) type].description;
6283 }
6284
6285 /* For MI, output a field named 'thread-groups' with a list as the value.
6286 For CLI, prefix the list with the string 'inf'. */
6287
6288 static void
6289 output_thread_groups (struct ui_out *uiout,
6290 const char *field_name,
6291 VEC(int) *inf_num,
6292 int mi_only)
6293 {
6294 struct cleanup *back_to;
6295 int is_mi = ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout);
6296 int inf;
6297 int i;
6298
6299 /* For backward compatibility, don't display inferiors in CLI unless
6300 there are several. Always display them for MI. */
6301 if (!is_mi && mi_only)
6302 return;
6303
6304 back_to = make_cleanup_ui_out_list_begin_end (uiout, field_name);
6305
6306 for (i = 0; VEC_iterate (int, inf_num, i, inf); ++i)
6307 {
6308 if (is_mi)
6309 {
6310 char mi_group[10];
6311
6312 xsnprintf (mi_group, sizeof (mi_group), "i%d", inf);
6313 ui_out_field_string (uiout, NULL, mi_group);
6314 }
6315 else
6316 {
6317 if (i == 0)
6318 ui_out_text (uiout, " inf ");
6319 else
6320 ui_out_text (uiout, ", ");
6321
6322 ui_out_text (uiout, plongest (inf));
6323 }
6324 }
6325
6326 do_cleanups (back_to);
6327 }
6328
6329 /* Print B to gdb_stdout. */
6330
6331 static void
6332 print_one_breakpoint_location (struct breakpoint *b,
6333 struct bp_location *loc,
6334 int loc_number,
6335 struct bp_location **last_loc,
6336 int allflag)
6337 {
6338 struct command_line *l;
6339 static char bpenables[] = "nynny";
6340
6341 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
6342 int header_of_multiple = 0;
6343 int part_of_multiple = (loc != NULL);
6344 struct value_print_options opts;
6345
6346 get_user_print_options (&opts);
6347
6348 gdb_assert (!loc || loc_number != 0);
6349 /* See comment in print_one_breakpoint concerning treatment of
6350 breakpoints with single disabled location. */
6351 if (loc == NULL
6352 && (b->loc != NULL
6353 && (b->loc->next != NULL || !b->loc->enabled)))
6354 header_of_multiple = 1;
6355 if (loc == NULL)
6356 loc = b->loc;
6357
6358 annotate_record ();
6359
6360 /* 1 */
6361 annotate_field (0);
6362 if (part_of_multiple)
6363 {
6364 char *formatted;
6365 formatted = xstrprintf ("%d.%d", b->number, loc_number);
6366 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "number", formatted);
6367 xfree (formatted);
6368 }
6369 else
6370 {
6371 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "number", b->number);
6372 }
6373
6374 /* 2 */
6375 annotate_field (1);
6376 if (part_of_multiple)
6377 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "type");
6378 else
6379 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "type", bptype_string (b->type));
6380
6381 /* 3 */
6382 annotate_field (2);
6383 if (part_of_multiple)
6384 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "disp");
6385 else
6386 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
6387
6388
6389 /* 4 */
6390 annotate_field (3);
6391 if (part_of_multiple)
6392 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "enabled", loc->enabled ? "y" : "n");
6393 else
6394 ui_out_field_fmt (uiout, "enabled", "%c",
6395 bpenables[(int) b->enable_state]);
6396 ui_out_spaces (uiout, 2);
6397
6398
6399 /* 5 and 6 */
6400 if (b->ops != NULL && b->ops->print_one != NULL)
6401 {
6402 /* Although the print_one can possibly print all locations,
6403 calling it here is not likely to get any nice result. So,
6404 make sure there's just one location. */
6405 gdb_assert (b->loc == NULL || b->loc->next == NULL);
6406 b->ops->print_one (b, last_loc);
6407 }
6408 else
6409 switch (b->type)
6410 {
6411 case bp_none:
6412 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
6413 _("print_one_breakpoint: bp_none encountered\n"));
6414 break;
6415
6416 case bp_watchpoint:
6417 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
6418 case bp_read_watchpoint:
6419 case bp_access_watchpoint:
6420 {
6421 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
6422
6423 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns
6424 not line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect
6425 is relatively readable). */
6426 if (opts.addressprint)
6427 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "addr");
6428 annotate_field (5);
6429 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", w->exp_string);
6430 }
6431 break;
6432
6433 case bp_breakpoint:
6434 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
6435 case bp_single_step:
6436 case bp_until:
6437 case bp_finish:
6438 case bp_longjmp:
6439 case bp_longjmp_resume:
6440 case bp_longjmp_call_dummy:
6441 case bp_exception:
6442 case bp_exception_resume:
6443 case bp_step_resume:
6444 case bp_hp_step_resume:
6445 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
6446 case bp_call_dummy:
6447 case bp_std_terminate:
6448 case bp_shlib_event:
6449 case bp_thread_event:
6450 case bp_overlay_event:
6451 case bp_longjmp_master:
6452 case bp_std_terminate_master:
6453 case bp_exception_master:
6454 case bp_tracepoint:
6455 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
6456 case bp_static_tracepoint:
6457 case bp_dprintf:
6458 case bp_jit_event:
6459 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver:
6460 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return:
6461 if (opts.addressprint)
6462 {
6463 annotate_field (4);
6464 if (header_of_multiple)
6465 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "addr", "<MULTIPLE>");
6466 else if (b->loc == NULL || loc->shlib_disabled)
6467 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "addr", "<PENDING>");
6468 else
6469 ui_out_field_core_addr (uiout, "addr",
6470 loc->gdbarch, loc->address);
6471 }
6472 annotate_field (5);
6473 if (!header_of_multiple)
6474 print_breakpoint_location (b, loc);
6475 if (b->loc)
6476 *last_loc = b->loc;
6477 break;
6478 }
6479
6480
6481 if (loc != NULL && !header_of_multiple)
6482 {
6483 struct inferior *inf;
6484 VEC(int) *inf_num = NULL;
6485 int mi_only = 1;
6486
6487 ALL_INFERIORS (inf)
6488 {
6489 if (inf->pspace == loc->pspace)
6490 VEC_safe_push (int, inf_num, inf->num);
6491 }
6492
6493 /* For backward compatibility, don't display inferiors in CLI unless
6494 there are several. Always display for MI. */
6495 if (allflag
6496 || (!gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ())
6497 && (number_of_program_spaces () > 1
6498 || number_of_inferiors () > 1)
6499 /* LOC is for existing B, it cannot be in
6500 moribund_locations and thus having NULL OWNER. */
6501 && loc->owner->type != bp_catchpoint))
6502 mi_only = 0;
6503 output_thread_groups (uiout, "thread-groups", inf_num, mi_only);
6504 VEC_free (int, inf_num);
6505 }
6506
6507 if (!part_of_multiple)
6508 {
6509 if (b->thread != -1)
6510 {
6511 /* FIXME: This seems to be redundant and lost here; see the
6512 "stop only in" line a little further down. */
6513 ui_out_text (uiout, " thread ");
6514 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "thread", b->thread);
6515 }
6516 else if (b->task != 0)
6517 {
6518 ui_out_text (uiout, " task ");
6519 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "task", b->task);
6520 }
6521 }
6522
6523 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
6524
6525 if (!part_of_multiple)
6526 b->ops->print_one_detail (b, uiout);
6527
6528 if (part_of_multiple && frame_id_p (b->frame_id))
6529 {
6530 annotate_field (6);
6531 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tstop only in stack frame at ");
6532 /* FIXME: cagney/2002-12-01: Shouldn't be poking around inside
6533 the frame ID. */
6534 ui_out_field_core_addr (uiout, "frame",
6535 b->gdbarch, b->frame_id.stack_addr);
6536 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
6537 }
6538
6539 if (!part_of_multiple && b->cond_string)
6540 {
6541 annotate_field (7);
6542 if (is_tracepoint (b))
6543 ui_out_text (uiout, "\ttrace only if ");
6544 else
6545 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tstop only if ");
6546 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "cond", b->cond_string);
6547
6548 /* Print whether the target is doing the breakpoint's condition
6549 evaluation. If GDB is doing the evaluation, don't print anything. */
6550 if (is_breakpoint (b)
6551 && breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode ()
6552 == condition_evaluation_target)
6553 {
6554 ui_out_text (uiout, " (");
6555 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "evaluated-by",
6556 bp_condition_evaluator (b));
6557 ui_out_text (uiout, " evals)");
6558 }
6559 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
6560 }
6561
6562 if (!part_of_multiple && b->thread != -1)
6563 {
6564 /* FIXME should make an annotation for this. */
6565 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tstop only in thread ");
6566 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
6567 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "thread", b->thread);
6568 else
6569 {
6570 struct thread_info *thr = find_thread_global_id (b->thread);
6571
6572 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "thread", print_thread_id (thr));
6573 }
6574 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
6575 }
6576
6577 if (!part_of_multiple)
6578 {
6579 if (b->hit_count)
6580 {
6581 /* FIXME should make an annotation for this. */
6582 if (is_catchpoint (b))
6583 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tcatchpoint");
6584 else if (is_tracepoint (b))
6585 ui_out_text (uiout, "\ttracepoint");
6586 else
6587 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tbreakpoint");
6588 ui_out_text (uiout, " already hit ");
6589 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "times", b->hit_count);
6590 if (b->hit_count == 1)
6591 ui_out_text (uiout, " time\n");
6592 else
6593 ui_out_text (uiout, " times\n");
6594 }
6595 else
6596 {
6597 /* Output the count also if it is zero, but only if this is mi. */
6598 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
6599 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "times", b->hit_count);
6600 }
6601 }
6602
6603 if (!part_of_multiple && b->ignore_count)
6604 {
6605 annotate_field (8);
6606 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tignore next ");
6607 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "ignore", b->ignore_count);
6608 ui_out_text (uiout, " hits\n");
6609 }
6610
6611 /* Note that an enable count of 1 corresponds to "enable once"
6612 behavior, which is reported by the combination of enablement and
6613 disposition, so we don't need to mention it here. */
6614 if (!part_of_multiple && b->enable_count > 1)
6615 {
6616 annotate_field (8);
6617 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tdisable after ");
6618 /* Tweak the wording to clarify that ignore and enable counts
6619 are distinct, and have additive effect. */
6620 if (b->ignore_count)
6621 ui_out_text (uiout, "additional ");
6622 else
6623 ui_out_text (uiout, "next ");
6624 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "enable", b->enable_count);
6625 ui_out_text (uiout, " hits\n");
6626 }
6627
6628 if (!part_of_multiple && is_tracepoint (b))
6629 {
6630 struct tracepoint *tp = (struct tracepoint *) b;
6631
6632 if (tp->traceframe_usage)
6633 {
6634 ui_out_text (uiout, "\ttrace buffer usage ");
6635 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "traceframe-usage", tp->traceframe_usage);
6636 ui_out_text (uiout, " bytes\n");
6637 }
6638 }
6639
6640 l = b->commands ? b->commands->commands : NULL;
6641 if (!part_of_multiple && l)
6642 {
6643 struct cleanup *script_chain;
6644
6645 annotate_field (9);
6646 script_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "script");
6647 print_command_lines (uiout, l, 4);
6648 do_cleanups (script_chain);
6649 }
6650
6651 if (is_tracepoint (b))
6652 {
6653 struct tracepoint *t = (struct tracepoint *) b;
6654
6655 if (!part_of_multiple && t->pass_count)
6656 {
6657 annotate_field (10);
6658 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tpass count ");
6659 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "pass", t->pass_count);
6660 ui_out_text (uiout, " \n");
6661 }
6662
6663 /* Don't display it when tracepoint or tracepoint location is
6664 pending. */
6665 if (!header_of_multiple && loc != NULL && !loc->shlib_disabled)
6666 {
6667 annotate_field (11);
6668
6669 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
6670 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "installed",
6671 loc->inserted ? "y" : "n");
6672 else
6673 {
6674 if (loc->inserted)
6675 ui_out_text (uiout, "\t");
6676 else
6677 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tnot ");
6678 ui_out_text (uiout, "installed on target\n");
6679 }
6680 }
6681 }
6682
6683 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout) && !part_of_multiple)
6684 {
6685 if (is_watchpoint (b))
6686 {
6687 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
6688
6689 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "original-location", w->exp_string);
6690 }
6691 else if (b->location != NULL
6692 && event_location_to_string (b->location) != NULL)
6693 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "original-location",
6694 event_location_to_string (b->location));
6695 }
6696 }
6697
6698 static void
6699 print_one_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
6700 struct bp_location **last_loc,
6701 int allflag)
6702 {
6703 struct cleanup *bkpt_chain;
6704 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
6705
6706 bkpt_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "bkpt");
6707
6708 print_one_breakpoint_location (b, NULL, 0, last_loc, allflag);
6709 do_cleanups (bkpt_chain);
6710
6711 /* If this breakpoint has custom print function,
6712 it's already printed. Otherwise, print individual
6713 locations, if any. */
6714 if (b->ops == NULL || b->ops->print_one == NULL)
6715 {
6716 /* If breakpoint has a single location that is disabled, we
6717 print it as if it had several locations, since otherwise it's
6718 hard to represent "breakpoint enabled, location disabled"
6719 situation.
6720
6721 Note that while hardware watchpoints have several locations
6722 internally, that's not a property exposed to user. */
6723 if (b->loc
6724 && !is_hardware_watchpoint (b)
6725 && (b->loc->next || !b->loc->enabled))
6726 {
6727 struct bp_location *loc;
6728 int n = 1;
6729
6730 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next, ++n)
6731 {
6732 struct cleanup *inner2 =
6733 make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, NULL);
6734 print_one_breakpoint_location (b, loc, n, last_loc, allflag);
6735 do_cleanups (inner2);
6736 }
6737 }
6738 }
6739 }
6740
6741 static int
6742 breakpoint_address_bits (struct breakpoint *b)
6743 {
6744 int print_address_bits = 0;
6745 struct bp_location *loc;
6746
6747 /* Software watchpoints that aren't watching memory don't have an
6748 address to print. */
6749 if (is_no_memory_software_watchpoint (b))
6750 return 0;
6751
6752 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
6753 {
6754 int addr_bit;
6755
6756 addr_bit = gdbarch_addr_bit (loc->gdbarch);
6757 if (addr_bit > print_address_bits)
6758 print_address_bits = addr_bit;
6759 }
6760
6761 return print_address_bits;
6762 }
6763
6764 struct captured_breakpoint_query_args
6765 {
6766 int bnum;
6767 };
6768
6769 static int
6770 do_captured_breakpoint_query (struct ui_out *uiout, void *data)
6771 {
6772 struct captured_breakpoint_query_args *args
6773 = (struct captured_breakpoint_query_args *) data;
6774 struct breakpoint *b;
6775 struct bp_location *dummy_loc = NULL;
6776
6777 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
6778 {
6779 if (args->bnum == b->number)
6780 {
6781 print_one_breakpoint (b, &dummy_loc, 0);
6782 return GDB_RC_OK;
6783 }
6784 }
6785 return GDB_RC_NONE;
6786 }
6787
6788 enum gdb_rc
6789 gdb_breakpoint_query (struct ui_out *uiout, int bnum,
6790 char **error_message)
6791 {
6792 struct captured_breakpoint_query_args args;
6793
6794 args.bnum = bnum;
6795 /* For the moment we don't trust print_one_breakpoint() to not throw
6796 an error. */
6797 if (catch_exceptions_with_msg (uiout, do_captured_breakpoint_query, &args,
6798 error_message, RETURN_MASK_ALL) < 0)
6799 return GDB_RC_FAIL;
6800 else
6801 return GDB_RC_OK;
6802 }
6803
6804 /* Return true if this breakpoint was set by the user, false if it is
6805 internal or momentary. */
6806
6807 int
6808 user_breakpoint_p (struct breakpoint *b)
6809 {
6810 return b->number > 0;
6811 }
6812
6813 /* See breakpoint.h. */
6814
6815 int
6816 pending_breakpoint_p (struct breakpoint *b)
6817 {
6818 return b->loc == NULL;
6819 }
6820
6821 /* Print information on user settable breakpoint (watchpoint, etc)
6822 number BNUM. If BNUM is -1 print all user-settable breakpoints.
6823 If ALLFLAG is non-zero, include non-user-settable breakpoints. If
6824 FILTER is non-NULL, call it on each breakpoint and only include the
6825 ones for which it returns non-zero. Return the total number of
6826 breakpoints listed. */
6827
6828 static int
6829 breakpoint_1 (char *args, int allflag,
6830 int (*filter) (const struct breakpoint *))
6831 {
6832 struct breakpoint *b;
6833 struct bp_location *last_loc = NULL;
6834 int nr_printable_breakpoints;
6835 struct cleanup *bkpttbl_chain;
6836 struct value_print_options opts;
6837 int print_address_bits = 0;
6838 int print_type_col_width = 14;
6839 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
6840
6841 get_user_print_options (&opts);
6842
6843 /* Compute the number of rows in the table, as well as the size
6844 required for address fields. */
6845 nr_printable_breakpoints = 0;
6846 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
6847 {
6848 /* If we have a filter, only list the breakpoints it accepts. */
6849 if (filter && !filter (b))
6850 continue;
6851
6852 /* If we have an "args" string, it is a list of breakpoints to
6853 accept. Skip the others. */
6854 if (args != NULL && *args != '\0')
6855 {
6856 if (allflag && parse_and_eval_long (args) != b->number)
6857 continue;
6858 if (!allflag && !number_is_in_list (args, b->number))
6859 continue;
6860 }
6861
6862 if (allflag || user_breakpoint_p (b))
6863 {
6864 int addr_bit, type_len;
6865
6866 addr_bit = breakpoint_address_bits (b);
6867 if (addr_bit > print_address_bits)
6868 print_address_bits = addr_bit;
6869
6870 type_len = strlen (bptype_string (b->type));
6871 if (type_len > print_type_col_width)
6872 print_type_col_width = type_len;
6873
6874 nr_printable_breakpoints++;
6875 }
6876 }
6877
6878 if (opts.addressprint)
6879 bkpttbl_chain
6880 = make_cleanup_ui_out_table_begin_end (uiout, 6,
6881 nr_printable_breakpoints,
6882 "BreakpointTable");
6883 else
6884 bkpttbl_chain
6885 = make_cleanup_ui_out_table_begin_end (uiout, 5,
6886 nr_printable_breakpoints,
6887 "BreakpointTable");
6888
6889 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6890 annotate_breakpoints_headers ();
6891 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6892 annotate_field (0);
6893 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 7, ui_left, "number", "Num"); /* 1 */
6894 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6895 annotate_field (1);
6896 ui_out_table_header (uiout, print_type_col_width, ui_left,
6897 "type", "Type"); /* 2 */
6898 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6899 annotate_field (2);
6900 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 4, ui_left, "disp", "Disp"); /* 3 */
6901 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6902 annotate_field (3);
6903 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 3, ui_left, "enabled", "Enb"); /* 4 */
6904 if (opts.addressprint)
6905 {
6906 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6907 annotate_field (4);
6908 if (print_address_bits <= 32)
6909 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 10, ui_left,
6910 "addr", "Address"); /* 5 */
6911 else
6912 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 18, ui_left,
6913 "addr", "Address"); /* 5 */
6914 }
6915 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6916 annotate_field (5);
6917 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 40, ui_noalign, "what", "What"); /* 6 */
6918 ui_out_table_body (uiout);
6919 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6920 annotate_breakpoints_table ();
6921
6922 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
6923 {
6924 QUIT;
6925 /* If we have a filter, only list the breakpoints it accepts. */
6926 if (filter && !filter (b))
6927 continue;
6928
6929 /* If we have an "args" string, it is a list of breakpoints to
6930 accept. Skip the others. */
6931
6932 if (args != NULL && *args != '\0')
6933 {
6934 if (allflag) /* maintenance info breakpoint */
6935 {
6936 if (parse_and_eval_long (args) != b->number)
6937 continue;
6938 }
6939 else /* all others */
6940 {
6941 if (!number_is_in_list (args, b->number))
6942 continue;
6943 }
6944 }
6945 /* We only print out user settable breakpoints unless the
6946 allflag is set. */
6947 if (allflag || user_breakpoint_p (b))
6948 print_one_breakpoint (b, &last_loc, allflag);
6949 }
6950
6951 do_cleanups (bkpttbl_chain);
6952
6953 if (nr_printable_breakpoints == 0)
6954 {
6955 /* If there's a filter, let the caller decide how to report
6956 empty list. */
6957 if (!filter)
6958 {
6959 if (args == NULL || *args == '\0')
6960 ui_out_message (uiout, 0, "No breakpoints or watchpoints.\n");
6961 else
6962 ui_out_message (uiout, 0,
6963 "No breakpoint or watchpoint matching '%s'.\n",
6964 args);
6965 }
6966 }
6967 else
6968 {
6969 if (last_loc && !server_command)
6970 set_next_address (last_loc->gdbarch, last_loc->address);
6971 }
6972
6973 /* FIXME? Should this be moved up so that it is only called when
6974 there have been breakpoints? */
6975 annotate_breakpoints_table_end ();
6976
6977 return nr_printable_breakpoints;
6978 }
6979
6980 /* Display the value of default-collect in a way that is generally
6981 compatible with the breakpoint list. */
6982
6983 static void
6984 default_collect_info (void)
6985 {
6986 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
6987
6988 /* If it has no value (which is frequently the case), say nothing; a
6989 message like "No default-collect." gets in user's face when it's
6990 not wanted. */
6991 if (!*default_collect)
6992 return;
6993
6994 /* The following phrase lines up nicely with per-tracepoint collect
6995 actions. */
6996 ui_out_text (uiout, "default collect ");
6997 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "default-collect", default_collect);
6998 ui_out_text (uiout, " \n");
6999 }
7000
7001 static void
7002 breakpoints_info (char *args, int from_tty)
7003 {
7004 breakpoint_1 (args, 0, NULL);
7005
7006 default_collect_info ();
7007 }
7008
7009 static void
7010 watchpoints_info (char *args, int from_tty)
7011 {
7012 int num_printed = breakpoint_1 (args, 0, is_watchpoint);
7013 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
7014
7015 if (num_printed == 0)
7016 {
7017 if (args == NULL || *args == '\0')
7018 ui_out_message (uiout, 0, "No watchpoints.\n");
7019 else
7020 ui_out_message (uiout, 0, "No watchpoint matching '%s'.\n", args);
7021 }
7022 }
7023
7024 static void
7025 maintenance_info_breakpoints (char *args, int from_tty)
7026 {
7027 breakpoint_1 (args, 1, NULL);
7028
7029 default_collect_info ();
7030 }
7031
7032 static int
7033 breakpoint_has_pc (struct breakpoint *b,
7034 struct program_space *pspace,
7035 CORE_ADDR pc, struct obj_section *section)
7036 {
7037 struct bp_location *bl = b->loc;
7038
7039 for (; bl; bl = bl->next)
7040 {
7041 if (bl->pspace == pspace
7042 && bl->address == pc
7043 && (!overlay_debugging || bl->section == section))
7044 return 1;
7045 }
7046 return 0;
7047 }
7048
7049 /* Print a message describing any user-breakpoints set at PC. This
7050 concerns with logical breakpoints, so we match program spaces, not
7051 address spaces. */
7052
7053 static void
7054 describe_other_breakpoints (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
7055 struct program_space *pspace, CORE_ADDR pc,
7056 struct obj_section *section, int thread)
7057 {
7058 int others = 0;
7059 struct breakpoint *b;
7060
7061 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
7062 others += (user_breakpoint_p (b)
7063 && breakpoint_has_pc (b, pspace, pc, section));
7064 if (others > 0)
7065 {
7066 if (others == 1)
7067 printf_filtered (_("Note: breakpoint "));
7068 else /* if (others == ???) */
7069 printf_filtered (_("Note: breakpoints "));
7070 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
7071 if (user_breakpoint_p (b) && breakpoint_has_pc (b, pspace, pc, section))
7072 {
7073 others--;
7074 printf_filtered ("%d", b->number);
7075 if (b->thread == -1 && thread != -1)
7076 printf_filtered (" (all threads)");
7077 else if (b->thread != -1)
7078 printf_filtered (" (thread %d)", b->thread);
7079 printf_filtered ("%s%s ",
7080 ((b->enable_state == bp_disabled
7081 || b->enable_state == bp_call_disabled)
7082 ? " (disabled)"
7083 : ""),
7084 (others > 1) ? ","
7085 : ((others == 1) ? " and" : ""));
7086 }
7087 printf_filtered (_("also set at pc "));
7088 fputs_filtered (paddress (gdbarch, pc), gdb_stdout);
7089 printf_filtered (".\n");
7090 }
7091 }
7092 \f
7093
7094 /* Return true iff it is meaningful to use the address member of
7095 BPT locations. For some breakpoint types, the locations' address members
7096 are irrelevant and it makes no sense to attempt to compare them to other
7097 addresses (or use them for any other purpose either).
7098
7099 More specifically, each of the following breakpoint types will
7100 always have a zero valued location address and we don't want to mark
7101 breakpoints of any of these types to be a duplicate of an actual
7102 breakpoint location at address zero:
7103
7104 bp_watchpoint
7105 bp_catchpoint
7106
7107 */
7108
7109 static int
7110 breakpoint_address_is_meaningful (struct breakpoint *bpt)
7111 {
7112 enum bptype type = bpt->type;
7113
7114 return (type != bp_watchpoint && type != bp_catchpoint);
7115 }
7116
7117 /* Assuming LOC1 and LOC2's owners are hardware watchpoints, returns
7118 true if LOC1 and LOC2 represent the same watchpoint location. */
7119
7120 static int
7121 watchpoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1,
7122 struct bp_location *loc2)
7123 {
7124 struct watchpoint *w1 = (struct watchpoint *) loc1->owner;
7125 struct watchpoint *w2 = (struct watchpoint *) loc2->owner;
7126
7127 /* Both of them must exist. */
7128 gdb_assert (w1 != NULL);
7129 gdb_assert (w2 != NULL);
7130
7131 /* If the target can evaluate the condition expression in hardware,
7132 then we we need to insert both watchpoints even if they are at
7133 the same place. Otherwise the watchpoint will only trigger when
7134 the condition of whichever watchpoint was inserted evaluates to
7135 true, not giving a chance for GDB to check the condition of the
7136 other watchpoint. */
7137 if ((w1->cond_exp
7138 && target_can_accel_watchpoint_condition (loc1->address,
7139 loc1->length,
7140 loc1->watchpoint_type,
7141 w1->cond_exp))
7142 || (w2->cond_exp
7143 && target_can_accel_watchpoint_condition (loc2->address,
7144 loc2->length,
7145 loc2->watchpoint_type,
7146 w2->cond_exp)))
7147 return 0;
7148
7149 /* Note that this checks the owner's type, not the location's. In
7150 case the target does not support read watchpoints, but does
7151 support access watchpoints, we'll have bp_read_watchpoint
7152 watchpoints with hw_access locations. Those should be considered
7153 duplicates of hw_read locations. The hw_read locations will
7154 become hw_access locations later. */
7155 return (loc1->owner->type == loc2->owner->type
7156 && loc1->pspace->aspace == loc2->pspace->aspace
7157 && loc1->address == loc2->address
7158 && loc1->length == loc2->length);
7159 }
7160
7161 /* See breakpoint.h. */
7162
7163 int
7164 breakpoint_address_match (struct address_space *aspace1, CORE_ADDR addr1,
7165 struct address_space *aspace2, CORE_ADDR addr2)
7166 {
7167 return ((gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ())
7168 || aspace1 == aspace2)
7169 && addr1 == addr2);
7170 }
7171
7172 /* Returns true if {ASPACE2,ADDR2} falls within the range determined by
7173 {ASPACE1,ADDR1,LEN1}. In most targets, this can only be true if ASPACE1
7174 matches ASPACE2. On targets that have global breakpoints, the address
7175 space doesn't really matter. */
7176
7177 static int
7178 breakpoint_address_match_range (struct address_space *aspace1, CORE_ADDR addr1,
7179 int len1, struct address_space *aspace2,
7180 CORE_ADDR addr2)
7181 {
7182 return ((gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ())
7183 || aspace1 == aspace2)
7184 && addr2 >= addr1 && addr2 < addr1 + len1);
7185 }
7186
7187 /* Returns true if {ASPACE,ADDR} matches the breakpoint BL. BL may be
7188 a ranged breakpoint. In most targets, a match happens only if ASPACE
7189 matches the breakpoint's address space. On targets that have global
7190 breakpoints, the address space doesn't really matter. */
7191
7192 static int
7193 breakpoint_location_address_match (struct bp_location *bl,
7194 struct address_space *aspace,
7195 CORE_ADDR addr)
7196 {
7197 return (breakpoint_address_match (bl->pspace->aspace, bl->address,
7198 aspace, addr)
7199 || (bl->length
7200 && breakpoint_address_match_range (bl->pspace->aspace,
7201 bl->address, bl->length,
7202 aspace, addr)));
7203 }
7204
7205 /* Returns true if the [ADDR,ADDR+LEN) range in ASPACE overlaps
7206 breakpoint BL. BL may be a ranged breakpoint. In most targets, a
7207 match happens only if ASPACE matches the breakpoint's address
7208 space. On targets that have global breakpoints, the address space
7209 doesn't really matter. */
7210
7211 static int
7212 breakpoint_location_address_range_overlap (struct bp_location *bl,
7213 struct address_space *aspace,
7214 CORE_ADDR addr, int len)
7215 {
7216 if (gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ())
7217 || bl->pspace->aspace == aspace)
7218 {
7219 int bl_len = bl->length != 0 ? bl->length : 1;
7220
7221 if (mem_ranges_overlap (addr, len, bl->address, bl_len))
7222 return 1;
7223 }
7224 return 0;
7225 }
7226
7227 /* If LOC1 and LOC2's owners are not tracepoints, returns false directly.
7228 Then, if LOC1 and LOC2 represent the same tracepoint location, returns
7229 true, otherwise returns false. */
7230
7231 static int
7232 tracepoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1,
7233 struct bp_location *loc2)
7234 {
7235 if (is_tracepoint (loc1->owner) && is_tracepoint (loc2->owner))
7236 /* Since tracepoint locations are never duplicated with others', tracepoint
7237 locations at the same address of different tracepoints are regarded as
7238 different locations. */
7239 return (loc1->address == loc2->address && loc1->owner == loc2->owner);
7240 else
7241 return 0;
7242 }
7243
7244 /* Assuming LOC1 and LOC2's types' have meaningful target addresses
7245 (breakpoint_address_is_meaningful), returns true if LOC1 and LOC2
7246 represent the same location. */
7247
7248 static int
7249 breakpoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1,
7250 struct bp_location *loc2)
7251 {
7252 int hw_point1, hw_point2;
7253
7254 /* Both of them must not be in moribund_locations. */
7255 gdb_assert (loc1->owner != NULL);
7256 gdb_assert (loc2->owner != NULL);
7257
7258 hw_point1 = is_hardware_watchpoint (loc1->owner);
7259 hw_point2 = is_hardware_watchpoint (loc2->owner);
7260
7261 if (hw_point1 != hw_point2)
7262 return 0;
7263 else if (hw_point1)
7264 return watchpoint_locations_match (loc1, loc2);
7265 else if (is_tracepoint (loc1->owner) || is_tracepoint (loc2->owner))
7266 return tracepoint_locations_match (loc1, loc2);
7267 else
7268 /* We compare bp_location.length in order to cover ranged breakpoints. */
7269 return (breakpoint_address_match (loc1->pspace->aspace, loc1->address,
7270 loc2->pspace->aspace, loc2->address)
7271 && loc1->length == loc2->length);
7272 }
7273
7274 static void
7275 breakpoint_adjustment_warning (CORE_ADDR from_addr, CORE_ADDR to_addr,
7276 int bnum, int have_bnum)
7277 {
7278 /* The longest string possibly returned by hex_string_custom
7279 is 50 chars. These must be at least that big for safety. */
7280 char astr1[64];
7281 char astr2[64];
7282
7283 strcpy (astr1, hex_string_custom ((unsigned long) from_addr, 8));
7284 strcpy (astr2, hex_string_custom ((unsigned long) to_addr, 8));
7285 if (have_bnum)
7286 warning (_("Breakpoint %d address previously adjusted from %s to %s."),
7287 bnum, astr1, astr2);
7288 else
7289 warning (_("Breakpoint address adjusted from %s to %s."), astr1, astr2);
7290 }
7291
7292 /* Adjust a breakpoint's address to account for architectural
7293 constraints on breakpoint placement. Return the adjusted address.
7294 Note: Very few targets require this kind of adjustment. For most
7295 targets, this function is simply the identity function. */
7296
7297 static CORE_ADDR
7298 adjust_breakpoint_address (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
7299 CORE_ADDR bpaddr, enum bptype bptype)
7300 {
7301 if (!gdbarch_adjust_breakpoint_address_p (gdbarch))
7302 {
7303 /* Very few targets need any kind of breakpoint adjustment. */
7304 return bpaddr;
7305 }
7306 else if (bptype == bp_watchpoint
7307 || bptype == bp_hardware_watchpoint
7308 || bptype == bp_read_watchpoint
7309 || bptype == bp_access_watchpoint
7310 || bptype == bp_catchpoint)
7311 {
7312 /* Watchpoints and the various bp_catch_* eventpoints should not
7313 have their addresses modified. */
7314 return bpaddr;
7315 }
7316 else if (bptype == bp_single_step)
7317 {
7318 /* Single-step breakpoints should not have their addresses
7319 modified. If there's any architectural constrain that
7320 applies to this address, then it should have already been
7321 taken into account when the breakpoint was created in the
7322 first place. If we didn't do this, stepping through e.g.,
7323 Thumb-2 IT blocks would break. */
7324 return bpaddr;
7325 }
7326 else
7327 {
7328 CORE_ADDR adjusted_bpaddr;
7329
7330 /* Some targets have architectural constraints on the placement
7331 of breakpoint instructions. Obtain the adjusted address. */
7332 adjusted_bpaddr = gdbarch_adjust_breakpoint_address (gdbarch, bpaddr);
7333
7334 /* An adjusted breakpoint address can significantly alter
7335 a user's expectations. Print a warning if an adjustment
7336 is required. */
7337 if (adjusted_bpaddr != bpaddr)
7338 breakpoint_adjustment_warning (bpaddr, adjusted_bpaddr, 0, 0);
7339
7340 return adjusted_bpaddr;
7341 }
7342 }
7343
7344 void
7345 init_bp_location (struct bp_location *loc, const struct bp_location_ops *ops,
7346 struct breakpoint *owner)
7347 {
7348 memset (loc, 0, sizeof (*loc));
7349
7350 gdb_assert (ops != NULL);
7351
7352 loc->ops = ops;
7353 loc->owner = owner;
7354 loc->cond = NULL;
7355 loc->cond_bytecode = NULL;
7356 loc->shlib_disabled = 0;
7357 loc->enabled = 1;
7358
7359 switch (owner->type)
7360 {
7361 case bp_breakpoint:
7362 case bp_single_step:
7363 case bp_until:
7364 case bp_finish:
7365 case bp_longjmp:
7366 case bp_longjmp_resume:
7367 case bp_longjmp_call_dummy:
7368 case bp_exception:
7369 case bp_exception_resume:
7370 case bp_step_resume:
7371 case bp_hp_step_resume:
7372 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
7373 case bp_call_dummy:
7374 case bp_std_terminate:
7375 case bp_shlib_event:
7376 case bp_thread_event:
7377 case bp_overlay_event:
7378 case bp_jit_event:
7379 case bp_longjmp_master:
7380 case bp_std_terminate_master:
7381 case bp_exception_master:
7382 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver:
7383 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return:
7384 case bp_dprintf:
7385 loc->loc_type = bp_loc_software_breakpoint;
7386 mark_breakpoint_location_modified (loc);
7387 break;
7388 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
7389 loc->loc_type = bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint;
7390 mark_breakpoint_location_modified (loc);
7391 break;
7392 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
7393 case bp_read_watchpoint:
7394 case bp_access_watchpoint:
7395 loc->loc_type = bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint;
7396 break;
7397 case bp_watchpoint:
7398 case bp_catchpoint:
7399 case bp_tracepoint:
7400 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
7401 case bp_static_tracepoint:
7402 loc->loc_type = bp_loc_other;
7403 break;
7404 default:
7405 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, _("unknown breakpoint type"));
7406 }
7407
7408 loc->refc = 1;
7409 }
7410
7411 /* Allocate a struct bp_location. */
7412
7413 static struct bp_location *
7414 allocate_bp_location (struct breakpoint *bpt)
7415 {
7416 return bpt->ops->allocate_location (bpt);
7417 }
7418
7419 static void
7420 free_bp_location (struct bp_location *loc)
7421 {
7422 loc->ops->dtor (loc);
7423 xfree (loc);
7424 }
7425
7426 /* Increment reference count. */
7427
7428 static void
7429 incref_bp_location (struct bp_location *bl)
7430 {
7431 ++bl->refc;
7432 }
7433
7434 /* Decrement reference count. If the reference count reaches 0,
7435 destroy the bp_location. Sets *BLP to NULL. */
7436
7437 static void
7438 decref_bp_location (struct bp_location **blp)
7439 {
7440 gdb_assert ((*blp)->refc > 0);
7441
7442 if (--(*blp)->refc == 0)
7443 free_bp_location (*blp);
7444 *blp = NULL;
7445 }
7446
7447 /* Add breakpoint B at the end of the global breakpoint chain. */
7448
7449 static void
7450 add_to_breakpoint_chain (struct breakpoint *b)
7451 {
7452 struct breakpoint *b1;
7453
7454 /* Add this breakpoint to the end of the chain so that a list of
7455 breakpoints will come out in order of increasing numbers. */
7456
7457 b1 = breakpoint_chain;
7458 if (b1 == 0)
7459 breakpoint_chain = b;
7460 else
7461 {
7462 while (b1->next)
7463 b1 = b1->next;
7464 b1->next = b;
7465 }
7466 }
7467
7468 /* Initializes breakpoint B with type BPTYPE and no locations yet. */
7469
7470 static void
7471 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (struct breakpoint *b,
7472 struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
7473 enum bptype bptype,
7474 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
7475 {
7476 memset (b, 0, sizeof (*b));
7477
7478 gdb_assert (ops != NULL);
7479
7480 b->ops = ops;
7481 b->type = bptype;
7482 b->gdbarch = gdbarch;
7483 b->language = current_language->la_language;
7484 b->input_radix = input_radix;
7485 b->thread = -1;
7486 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
7487 b->next = 0;
7488 b->silent = 0;
7489 b->ignore_count = 0;
7490 b->commands = NULL;
7491 b->frame_id = null_frame_id;
7492 b->condition_not_parsed = 0;
7493 b->py_bp_object = NULL;
7494 b->related_breakpoint = b;
7495 b->location = NULL;
7496 }
7497
7498 /* Helper to set_raw_breakpoint below. Creates a breakpoint
7499 that has type BPTYPE and has no locations as yet. */
7500
7501 static struct breakpoint *
7502 set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
7503 enum bptype bptype,
7504 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
7505 {
7506 struct breakpoint *b = XNEW (struct breakpoint);
7507
7508 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (b, gdbarch, bptype, ops);
7509 add_to_breakpoint_chain (b);
7510 return b;
7511 }
7512
7513 /* Initialize loc->function_name. EXPLICIT_LOC says no indirect function
7514 resolutions should be made as the user specified the location explicitly
7515 enough. */
7516
7517 static void
7518 set_breakpoint_location_function (struct bp_location *loc, int explicit_loc)
7519 {
7520 gdb_assert (loc->owner != NULL);
7521
7522 if (loc->owner->type == bp_breakpoint
7523 || loc->owner->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint
7524 || is_tracepoint (loc->owner))
7525 {
7526 int is_gnu_ifunc;
7527 const char *function_name;
7528 CORE_ADDR func_addr;
7529
7530 find_pc_partial_function_gnu_ifunc (loc->address, &function_name,
7531 &func_addr, NULL, &is_gnu_ifunc);
7532
7533 if (is_gnu_ifunc && !explicit_loc)
7534 {
7535 struct breakpoint *b = loc->owner;
7536
7537 gdb_assert (loc->pspace == current_program_space);
7538 if (gnu_ifunc_resolve_name (function_name,
7539 &loc->requested_address))
7540 {
7541 /* Recalculate ADDRESS based on new REQUESTED_ADDRESS. */
7542 loc->address = adjust_breakpoint_address (loc->gdbarch,
7543 loc->requested_address,
7544 b->type);
7545 }
7546 else if (b->type == bp_breakpoint && b->loc == loc
7547 && loc->next == NULL && b->related_breakpoint == b)
7548 {
7549 /* Create only the whole new breakpoint of this type but do not
7550 mess more complicated breakpoints with multiple locations. */
7551 b->type = bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver;
7552 /* Remember the resolver's address for use by the return
7553 breakpoint. */
7554 loc->related_address = func_addr;
7555 }
7556 }
7557
7558 if (function_name)
7559 loc->function_name = xstrdup (function_name);
7560 }
7561 }
7562
7563 /* Attempt to determine architecture of location identified by SAL. */
7564 struct gdbarch *
7565 get_sal_arch (struct symtab_and_line sal)
7566 {
7567 if (sal.section)
7568 return get_objfile_arch (sal.section->objfile);
7569 if (sal.symtab)
7570 return get_objfile_arch (SYMTAB_OBJFILE (sal.symtab));
7571
7572 return NULL;
7573 }
7574
7575 /* Low level routine for partially initializing a breakpoint of type
7576 BPTYPE. The newly created breakpoint's address, section, source
7577 file name, and line number are provided by SAL.
7578
7579 It is expected that the caller will complete the initialization of
7580 the newly created breakpoint struct as well as output any status
7581 information regarding the creation of a new breakpoint. */
7582
7583 static void
7584 init_raw_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b, struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
7585 struct symtab_and_line sal, enum bptype bptype,
7586 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
7587 {
7588 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (b, gdbarch, bptype, ops);
7589
7590 add_location_to_breakpoint (b, &sal);
7591
7592 if (bptype != bp_catchpoint)
7593 gdb_assert (sal.pspace != NULL);
7594
7595 /* Store the program space that was used to set the breakpoint,
7596 except for ordinary breakpoints, which are independent of the
7597 program space. */
7598 if (bptype != bp_breakpoint && bptype != bp_hardware_breakpoint)
7599 b->pspace = sal.pspace;
7600 }
7601
7602 /* set_raw_breakpoint is a low level routine for allocating and
7603 partially initializing a breakpoint of type BPTYPE. The newly
7604 created breakpoint's address, section, source file name, and line
7605 number are provided by SAL. The newly created and partially
7606 initialized breakpoint is added to the breakpoint chain and
7607 is also returned as the value of this function.
7608
7609 It is expected that the caller will complete the initialization of
7610 the newly created breakpoint struct as well as output any status
7611 information regarding the creation of a new breakpoint. In
7612 particular, set_raw_breakpoint does NOT set the breakpoint
7613 number! Care should be taken to not allow an error to occur
7614 prior to completing the initialization of the breakpoint. If this
7615 should happen, a bogus breakpoint will be left on the chain. */
7616
7617 struct breakpoint *
7618 set_raw_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
7619 struct symtab_and_line sal, enum bptype bptype,
7620 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
7621 {
7622 struct breakpoint *b = XNEW (struct breakpoint);
7623
7624 init_raw_breakpoint (b, gdbarch, sal, bptype, ops);
7625 add_to_breakpoint_chain (b);
7626 return b;
7627 }
7628
7629 /* Call this routine when stepping and nexting to enable a breakpoint
7630 if we do a longjmp() or 'throw' in TP. FRAME is the frame which
7631 initiated the operation. */
7632
7633 void
7634 set_longjmp_breakpoint (struct thread_info *tp, struct frame_id frame)
7635 {
7636 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7637 int thread = tp->global_num;
7638
7639 /* To avoid having to rescan all objfile symbols at every step,
7640 we maintain a list of continually-inserted but always disabled
7641 longjmp "master" breakpoints. Here, we simply create momentary
7642 clones of those and enable them for the requested thread. */
7643 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7644 if (b->pspace == current_program_space
7645 && (b->type == bp_longjmp_master
7646 || b->type == bp_exception_master))
7647 {
7648 enum bptype type = b->type == bp_longjmp_master ? bp_longjmp : bp_exception;
7649 struct breakpoint *clone;
7650
7651 /* longjmp_breakpoint_ops ensures INITIATING_FRAME is cleared again
7652 after their removal. */
7653 clone = momentary_breakpoint_from_master (b, type,
7654 &longjmp_breakpoint_ops, 1);
7655 clone->thread = thread;
7656 }
7657
7658 tp->initiating_frame = frame;
7659 }
7660
7661 /* Delete all longjmp breakpoints from THREAD. */
7662 void
7663 delete_longjmp_breakpoint (int thread)
7664 {
7665 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7666
7667 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7668 if (b->type == bp_longjmp || b->type == bp_exception)
7669 {
7670 if (b->thread == thread)
7671 delete_breakpoint (b);
7672 }
7673 }
7674
7675 void
7676 delete_longjmp_breakpoint_at_next_stop (int thread)
7677 {
7678 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7679
7680 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7681 if (b->type == bp_longjmp || b->type == bp_exception)
7682 {
7683 if (b->thread == thread)
7684 b->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
7685 }
7686 }
7687
7688 /* Place breakpoints of type bp_longjmp_call_dummy to catch longjmp for
7689 INFERIOR_PTID thread. Chain them all by RELATED_BREAKPOINT and return
7690 pointer to any of them. Return NULL if this system cannot place longjmp
7691 breakpoints. */
7692
7693 struct breakpoint *
7694 set_longjmp_breakpoint_for_call_dummy (void)
7695 {
7696 struct breakpoint *b, *retval = NULL;
7697
7698 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
7699 if (b->pspace == current_program_space && b->type == bp_longjmp_master)
7700 {
7701 struct breakpoint *new_b;
7702
7703 new_b = momentary_breakpoint_from_master (b, bp_longjmp_call_dummy,
7704 &momentary_breakpoint_ops,
7705 1);
7706 new_b->thread = ptid_to_global_thread_id (inferior_ptid);
7707
7708 /* Link NEW_B into the chain of RETVAL breakpoints. */
7709
7710 gdb_assert (new_b->related_breakpoint == new_b);
7711 if (retval == NULL)
7712 retval = new_b;
7713 new_b->related_breakpoint = retval;
7714 while (retval->related_breakpoint != new_b->related_breakpoint)
7715 retval = retval->related_breakpoint;
7716 retval->related_breakpoint = new_b;
7717 }
7718
7719 return retval;
7720 }
7721
7722 /* Verify all existing dummy frames and their associated breakpoints for
7723 TP. Remove those which can no longer be found in the current frame
7724 stack.
7725
7726 You should call this function only at places where it is safe to currently
7727 unwind the whole stack. Failed stack unwind would discard live dummy
7728 frames. */
7729
7730 void
7731 check_longjmp_breakpoint_for_call_dummy (struct thread_info *tp)
7732 {
7733 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7734
7735 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7736 if (b->type == bp_longjmp_call_dummy && b->thread == tp->global_num)
7737 {
7738 struct breakpoint *dummy_b = b->related_breakpoint;
7739
7740 while (dummy_b != b && dummy_b->type != bp_call_dummy)
7741 dummy_b = dummy_b->related_breakpoint;
7742 if (dummy_b->type != bp_call_dummy
7743 || frame_find_by_id (dummy_b->frame_id) != NULL)
7744 continue;
7745
7746 dummy_frame_discard (dummy_b->frame_id, tp->ptid);
7747
7748 while (b->related_breakpoint != b)
7749 {
7750 if (b_tmp == b->related_breakpoint)
7751 b_tmp = b->related_breakpoint->next;
7752 delete_breakpoint (b->related_breakpoint);
7753 }
7754 delete_breakpoint (b);
7755 }
7756 }
7757
7758 void
7759 enable_overlay_breakpoints (void)
7760 {
7761 struct breakpoint *b;
7762
7763 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
7764 if (b->type == bp_overlay_event)
7765 {
7766 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
7767 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
7768 overlay_events_enabled = 1;
7769 }
7770 }
7771
7772 void
7773 disable_overlay_breakpoints (void)
7774 {
7775 struct breakpoint *b;
7776
7777 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
7778 if (b->type == bp_overlay_event)
7779 {
7780 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
7781 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
7782 overlay_events_enabled = 0;
7783 }
7784 }
7785
7786 /* Set an active std::terminate breakpoint for each std::terminate
7787 master breakpoint. */
7788 void
7789 set_std_terminate_breakpoint (void)
7790 {
7791 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7792
7793 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7794 if (b->pspace == current_program_space
7795 && b->type == bp_std_terminate_master)
7796 {
7797 momentary_breakpoint_from_master (b, bp_std_terminate,
7798 &momentary_breakpoint_ops, 1);
7799 }
7800 }
7801
7802 /* Delete all the std::terminate breakpoints. */
7803 void
7804 delete_std_terminate_breakpoint (void)
7805 {
7806 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7807
7808 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7809 if (b->type == bp_std_terminate)
7810 delete_breakpoint (b);
7811 }
7812
7813 struct breakpoint *
7814 create_thread_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
7815 {
7816 struct breakpoint *b;
7817
7818 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, address, bp_thread_event,
7819 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
7820
7821 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
7822 /* location has to be used or breakpoint_re_set will delete me. */
7823 b->location = new_address_location (b->loc->address, NULL, 0);
7824
7825 update_global_location_list_nothrow (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
7826
7827 return b;
7828 }
7829
7830 struct lang_and_radix
7831 {
7832 enum language lang;
7833 int radix;
7834 };
7835
7836 /* Create a breakpoint for JIT code registration and unregistration. */
7837
7838 struct breakpoint *
7839 create_jit_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
7840 {
7841 return create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, address, bp_jit_event,
7842 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
7843 }
7844
7845 /* Remove JIT code registration and unregistration breakpoint(s). */
7846
7847 void
7848 remove_jit_event_breakpoints (void)
7849 {
7850 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7851
7852 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7853 if (b->type == bp_jit_event
7854 && b->loc->pspace == current_program_space)
7855 delete_breakpoint (b);
7856 }
7857
7858 void
7859 remove_solib_event_breakpoints (void)
7860 {
7861 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7862
7863 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7864 if (b->type == bp_shlib_event
7865 && b->loc->pspace == current_program_space)
7866 delete_breakpoint (b);
7867 }
7868
7869 /* See breakpoint.h. */
7870
7871 void
7872 remove_solib_event_breakpoints_at_next_stop (void)
7873 {
7874 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7875
7876 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7877 if (b->type == bp_shlib_event
7878 && b->loc->pspace == current_program_space)
7879 b->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
7880 }
7881
7882 /* Helper for create_solib_event_breakpoint /
7883 create_and_insert_solib_event_breakpoint. Allows specifying which
7884 INSERT_MODE to pass through to update_global_location_list. */
7885
7886 static struct breakpoint *
7887 create_solib_event_breakpoint_1 (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address,
7888 enum ugll_insert_mode insert_mode)
7889 {
7890 struct breakpoint *b;
7891
7892 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, address, bp_shlib_event,
7893 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
7894 update_global_location_list_nothrow (insert_mode);
7895 return b;
7896 }
7897
7898 struct breakpoint *
7899 create_solib_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
7900 {
7901 return create_solib_event_breakpoint_1 (gdbarch, address, UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
7902 }
7903
7904 /* See breakpoint.h. */
7905
7906 struct breakpoint *
7907 create_and_insert_solib_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
7908 {
7909 struct breakpoint *b;
7910
7911 /* Explicitly tell update_global_location_list to insert
7912 locations. */
7913 b = create_solib_event_breakpoint_1 (gdbarch, address, UGLL_INSERT);
7914 if (!b->loc->inserted)
7915 {
7916 delete_breakpoint (b);
7917 return NULL;
7918 }
7919 return b;
7920 }
7921
7922 /* Disable any breakpoints that are on code in shared libraries. Only
7923 apply to enabled breakpoints, disabled ones can just stay disabled. */
7924
7925 void
7926 disable_breakpoints_in_shlibs (void)
7927 {
7928 struct bp_location *loc, **locp_tmp;
7929
7930 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, locp_tmp)
7931 {
7932 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has LOC->OWNER always non-NULL. */
7933 struct breakpoint *b = loc->owner;
7934
7935 /* We apply the check to all breakpoints, including disabled for
7936 those with loc->duplicate set. This is so that when breakpoint
7937 becomes enabled, or the duplicate is removed, gdb will try to
7938 insert all breakpoints. If we don't set shlib_disabled here,
7939 we'll try to insert those breakpoints and fail. */
7940 if (((b->type == bp_breakpoint)
7941 || (b->type == bp_jit_event)
7942 || (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
7943 || (is_tracepoint (b)))
7944 && loc->pspace == current_program_space
7945 && !loc->shlib_disabled
7946 && solib_name_from_address (loc->pspace, loc->address)
7947 )
7948 {
7949 loc->shlib_disabled = 1;
7950 }
7951 }
7952 }
7953
7954 /* Disable any breakpoints and tracepoints that are in SOLIB upon
7955 notification of unloaded_shlib. Only apply to enabled breakpoints,
7956 disabled ones can just stay disabled. */
7957
7958 static void
7959 disable_breakpoints_in_unloaded_shlib (struct so_list *solib)
7960 {
7961 struct bp_location *loc, **locp_tmp;
7962 int disabled_shlib_breaks = 0;
7963
7964 /* SunOS a.out shared libraries are always mapped, so do not
7965 disable breakpoints; they will only be reported as unloaded
7966 through clear_solib when GDB discards its shared library
7967 list. See clear_solib for more information. */
7968 if (exec_bfd != NULL
7969 && bfd_get_flavour (exec_bfd) == bfd_target_aout_flavour)
7970 return;
7971
7972 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, locp_tmp)
7973 {
7974 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has LOC->OWNER always non-NULL. */
7975 struct breakpoint *b = loc->owner;
7976
7977 if (solib->pspace == loc->pspace
7978 && !loc->shlib_disabled
7979 && (((b->type == bp_breakpoint
7980 || b->type == bp_jit_event
7981 || b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
7982 && (loc->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
7983 || loc->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint))
7984 || is_tracepoint (b))
7985 && solib_contains_address_p (solib, loc->address))
7986 {
7987 loc->shlib_disabled = 1;
7988 /* At this point, we cannot rely on remove_breakpoint
7989 succeeding so we must mark the breakpoint as not inserted
7990 to prevent future errors occurring in remove_breakpoints. */
7991 loc->inserted = 0;
7992
7993 /* This may cause duplicate notifications for the same breakpoint. */
7994 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b);
7995
7996 if (!disabled_shlib_breaks)
7997 {
7998 target_terminal_ours_for_output ();
7999 warning (_("Temporarily disabling breakpoints "
8000 "for unloaded shared library \"%s\""),
8001 solib->so_name);
8002 }
8003 disabled_shlib_breaks = 1;
8004 }
8005 }
8006 }
8007
8008 /* Disable any breakpoints and tracepoints in OBJFILE upon
8009 notification of free_objfile. Only apply to enabled breakpoints,
8010 disabled ones can just stay disabled. */
8011
8012 static void
8013 disable_breakpoints_in_freed_objfile (struct objfile *objfile)
8014 {
8015 struct breakpoint *b;
8016
8017 if (objfile == NULL)
8018 return;
8019
8020 /* OBJF_SHARED|OBJF_USERLOADED objfiles are dynamic modules manually
8021 managed by the user with add-symbol-file/remove-symbol-file.
8022 Similarly to how breakpoints in shared libraries are handled in
8023 response to "nosharedlibrary", mark breakpoints in such modules
8024 shlib_disabled so they end up uninserted on the next global
8025 location list update. Shared libraries not loaded by the user
8026 aren't handled here -- they're already handled in
8027 disable_breakpoints_in_unloaded_shlib, called by solib.c's
8028 solib_unloaded observer. We skip objfiles that are not
8029 OBJF_SHARED as those aren't considered dynamic objects (e.g. the
8030 main objfile). */
8031 if ((objfile->flags & OBJF_SHARED) == 0
8032 || (objfile->flags & OBJF_USERLOADED) == 0)
8033 return;
8034
8035 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
8036 {
8037 struct bp_location *loc;
8038 int bp_modified = 0;
8039
8040 if (!is_breakpoint (b) && !is_tracepoint (b))
8041 continue;
8042
8043 for (loc = b->loc; loc != NULL; loc = loc->next)
8044 {
8045 CORE_ADDR loc_addr = loc->address;
8046
8047 if (loc->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
8048 && loc->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint)
8049 continue;
8050
8051 if (loc->shlib_disabled != 0)
8052 continue;
8053
8054 if (objfile->pspace != loc->pspace)
8055 continue;
8056
8057 if (loc->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
8058 && loc->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint)
8059 continue;
8060
8061 if (is_addr_in_objfile (loc_addr, objfile))
8062 {
8063 loc->shlib_disabled = 1;
8064 /* At this point, we don't know whether the object was
8065 unmapped from the inferior or not, so leave the
8066 inserted flag alone. We'll handle failure to
8067 uninsert quietly, in case the object was indeed
8068 unmapped. */
8069
8070 mark_breakpoint_location_modified (loc);
8071
8072 bp_modified = 1;
8073 }
8074 }
8075
8076 if (bp_modified)
8077 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b);
8078 }
8079 }
8080
8081 /* FORK & VFORK catchpoints. */
8082
8083 /* An instance of this type is used to represent a fork or vfork
8084 catchpoint. It includes a "struct breakpoint" as a kind of base
8085 class; users downcast to "struct breakpoint *" when needed. A
8086 breakpoint is really of this type iff its ops pointer points to
8087 CATCH_FORK_BREAKPOINT_OPS. */
8088
8089 struct fork_catchpoint
8090 {
8091 /* The base class. */
8092 struct breakpoint base;
8093
8094 /* Process id of a child process whose forking triggered this
8095 catchpoint. This field is only valid immediately after this
8096 catchpoint has triggered. */
8097 ptid_t forked_inferior_pid;
8098 };
8099
8100 /* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for fork
8101 catchpoints. */
8102
8103 static int
8104 insert_catch_fork (struct bp_location *bl)
8105 {
8106 return target_insert_fork_catchpoint (ptid_get_pid (inferior_ptid));
8107 }
8108
8109 /* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for fork
8110 catchpoints. */
8111
8112 static int
8113 remove_catch_fork (struct bp_location *bl, enum remove_bp_reason reason)
8114 {
8115 return target_remove_fork_catchpoint (ptid_get_pid (inferior_ptid));
8116 }
8117
8118 /* Implement the "breakpoint_hit" breakpoint_ops method for fork
8119 catchpoints. */
8120
8121 static int
8122 breakpoint_hit_catch_fork (const struct bp_location *bl,
8123 struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
8124 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
8125 {
8126 struct fork_catchpoint *c = (struct fork_catchpoint *) bl->owner;
8127
8128 if (ws->kind != TARGET_WAITKIND_FORKED)
8129 return 0;
8130
8131 c->forked_inferior_pid = ws->value.related_pid;
8132 return 1;
8133 }
8134
8135 /* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for fork
8136 catchpoints. */
8137
8138 static enum print_stop_action
8139 print_it_catch_fork (bpstat bs)
8140 {
8141 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
8142 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
8143 struct fork_catchpoint *c = (struct fork_catchpoint *) bs->breakpoint_at;
8144
8145 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
8146 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout);
8147 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
8148 ui_out_text (uiout, "Temporary catchpoint ");
8149 else
8150 ui_out_text (uiout, "Catchpoint ");
8151 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
8152 {
8153 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "reason",
8154 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_FORK));
8155 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
8156 }
8157 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "bkptno", b->number);
8158 ui_out_text (uiout, " (forked process ");
8159 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "newpid", ptid_get_pid (c->forked_inferior_pid));
8160 ui_out_text (uiout, "), ");
8161 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
8162 }
8163
8164 /* Implement the "print_one" breakpoint_ops method for fork
8165 catchpoints. */
8166
8167 static void
8168 print_one_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
8169 {
8170 struct fork_catchpoint *c = (struct fork_catchpoint *) b;
8171 struct value_print_options opts;
8172 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
8173
8174 get_user_print_options (&opts);
8175
8176 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns not
8177 line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect is relatively
8178 readable). */
8179 if (opts.addressprint)
8180 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "addr");
8181 annotate_field (5);
8182 ui_out_text (uiout, "fork");
8183 if (!ptid_equal (c->forked_inferior_pid, null_ptid))
8184 {
8185 ui_out_text (uiout, ", process ");
8186 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "what",
8187 ptid_get_pid (c->forked_inferior_pid));
8188 ui_out_spaces (uiout, 1);
8189 }
8190
8191 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
8192 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "catch-type", "fork");
8193 }
8194
8195 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for fork
8196 catchpoints. */
8197
8198 static void
8199 print_mention_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b)
8200 {
8201 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (fork)"), b->number);
8202 }
8203
8204 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for fork
8205 catchpoints. */
8206
8207 static void
8208 print_recreate_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
8209 {
8210 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "catch fork");
8211 print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
8212 }
8213
8214 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in fork catchpoints. */
8215
8216 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_fork_breakpoint_ops;
8217
8218 /* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
8219 catchpoints. */
8220
8221 static int
8222 insert_catch_vfork (struct bp_location *bl)
8223 {
8224 return target_insert_vfork_catchpoint (ptid_get_pid (inferior_ptid));
8225 }
8226
8227 /* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
8228 catchpoints. */
8229
8230 static int
8231 remove_catch_vfork (struct bp_location *bl, enum remove_bp_reason reason)
8232 {
8233 return target_remove_vfork_catchpoint (ptid_get_pid (inferior_ptid));
8234 }
8235
8236 /* Implement the "breakpoint_hit" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
8237 catchpoints. */
8238
8239 static int
8240 breakpoint_hit_catch_vfork (const struct bp_location *bl,
8241 struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
8242 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
8243 {
8244 struct fork_catchpoint *c = (struct fork_catchpoint *) bl->owner;
8245
8246 if (ws->kind != TARGET_WAITKIND_VFORKED)
8247 return 0;
8248
8249 c->forked_inferior_pid = ws->value.related_pid;
8250 return 1;
8251 }
8252
8253 /* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
8254 catchpoints. */
8255
8256 static enum print_stop_action
8257 print_it_catch_vfork (bpstat bs)
8258 {
8259 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
8260 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
8261 struct fork_catchpoint *c = (struct fork_catchpoint *) b;
8262
8263 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
8264 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout);
8265 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
8266 ui_out_text (uiout, "Temporary catchpoint ");
8267 else
8268 ui_out_text (uiout, "Catchpoint ");
8269 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
8270 {
8271 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "reason",
8272 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_VFORK));
8273 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
8274 }
8275 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "bkptno", b->number);
8276 ui_out_text (uiout, " (vforked process ");
8277 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "newpid", ptid_get_pid (c->forked_inferior_pid));
8278 ui_out_text (uiout, "), ");
8279 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
8280 }
8281
8282 /* Implement the "print_one" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
8283 catchpoints. */
8284
8285 static void
8286 print_one_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
8287 {
8288 struct fork_catchpoint *c = (struct fork_catchpoint *) b;
8289 struct value_print_options opts;
8290 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
8291
8292 get_user_print_options (&opts);
8293 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns not
8294 line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect is relatively
8295 readable). */
8296 if (opts.addressprint)
8297 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "addr");
8298 annotate_field (5);
8299 ui_out_text (uiout, "vfork");
8300 if (!ptid_equal (c->forked_inferior_pid, null_ptid))
8301 {
8302 ui_out_text (uiout, ", process ");
8303 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "what",
8304 ptid_get_pid (c->forked_inferior_pid));
8305 ui_out_spaces (uiout, 1);
8306 }
8307
8308 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
8309 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "catch-type", "vfork");
8310 }
8311
8312 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
8313 catchpoints. */
8314
8315 static void
8316 print_mention_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b)
8317 {
8318 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (vfork)"), b->number);
8319 }
8320
8321 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
8322 catchpoints. */
8323
8324 static void
8325 print_recreate_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
8326 {
8327 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "catch vfork");
8328 print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
8329 }
8330
8331 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in vfork catchpoints. */
8332
8333 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_vfork_breakpoint_ops;
8334
8335 /* An instance of this type is used to represent an solib catchpoint.
8336 It includes a "struct breakpoint" as a kind of base class; users
8337 downcast to "struct breakpoint *" when needed. A breakpoint is
8338 really of this type iff its ops pointer points to
8339 CATCH_SOLIB_BREAKPOINT_OPS. */
8340
8341 struct solib_catchpoint
8342 {
8343 /* The base class. */
8344 struct breakpoint base;
8345
8346 /* True for "catch load", false for "catch unload". */
8347 unsigned char is_load;
8348
8349 /* Regular expression to match, if any. COMPILED is only valid when
8350 REGEX is non-NULL. */
8351 char *regex;
8352 regex_t compiled;
8353 };
8354
8355 static void
8356 dtor_catch_solib (struct breakpoint *b)
8357 {
8358 struct solib_catchpoint *self = (struct solib_catchpoint *) b;
8359
8360 if (self->regex)
8361 regfree (&self->compiled);
8362 xfree (self->regex);
8363
8364 base_breakpoint_ops.dtor (b);
8365 }
8366
8367 static int
8368 insert_catch_solib (struct bp_location *ignore)
8369 {
8370 return 0;
8371 }
8372
8373 static int
8374 remove_catch_solib (struct bp_location *ignore, enum remove_bp_reason reason)
8375 {
8376 return 0;
8377 }
8378
8379 static int
8380 breakpoint_hit_catch_solib (const struct bp_location *bl,
8381 struct address_space *aspace,
8382 CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
8383 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
8384 {
8385 struct solib_catchpoint *self = (struct solib_catchpoint *) bl->owner;
8386 struct breakpoint *other;
8387
8388 if (ws->kind == TARGET_WAITKIND_LOADED)
8389 return 1;
8390
8391 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (other)
8392 {
8393 struct bp_location *other_bl;
8394
8395 if (other == bl->owner)
8396 continue;
8397
8398 if (other->type != bp_shlib_event)
8399 continue;
8400
8401 if (self->base.pspace != NULL && other->pspace != self->base.pspace)
8402 continue;
8403
8404 for (other_bl = other->loc; other_bl != NULL; other_bl = other_bl->next)
8405 {
8406 if (other->ops->breakpoint_hit (other_bl, aspace, bp_addr, ws))
8407 return 1;
8408 }
8409 }
8410
8411 return 0;
8412 }
8413
8414 static void
8415 check_status_catch_solib (struct bpstats *bs)
8416 {
8417 struct solib_catchpoint *self
8418 = (struct solib_catchpoint *) bs->breakpoint_at;
8419 int ix;
8420
8421 if (self->is_load)
8422 {
8423 struct so_list *iter;
8424
8425 for (ix = 0;
8426 VEC_iterate (so_list_ptr, current_program_space->added_solibs,
8427 ix, iter);
8428 ++ix)
8429 {
8430 if (!self->regex
8431 || regexec (&self->compiled, iter->so_name, 0, NULL, 0) == 0)
8432 return;
8433 }
8434 }
8435 else
8436 {
8437 char *iter;
8438
8439 for (ix = 0;
8440 VEC_iterate (char_ptr, current_program_space->deleted_solibs,
8441 ix, iter);
8442 ++ix)
8443 {
8444 if (!self->regex
8445 || regexec (&self->compiled, iter, 0, NULL, 0) == 0)
8446 return;
8447 }
8448 }
8449
8450 bs->stop = 0;
8451 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
8452 }
8453
8454 static enum print_stop_action
8455 print_it_catch_solib (bpstat bs)
8456 {
8457 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
8458 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
8459
8460 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
8461 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout);
8462 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
8463 ui_out_text (uiout, "Temporary catchpoint ");
8464 else
8465 ui_out_text (uiout, "Catchpoint ");
8466 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "bkptno", b->number);
8467 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
8468 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
8469 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
8470 print_solib_event (1);
8471 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
8472 }
8473
8474 static void
8475 print_one_catch_solib (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **locs)
8476 {
8477 struct solib_catchpoint *self = (struct solib_catchpoint *) b;
8478 struct value_print_options opts;
8479 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
8480 char *msg;
8481
8482 get_user_print_options (&opts);
8483 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns not
8484 line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect is relatively
8485 readable). */
8486 if (opts.addressprint)
8487 {
8488 annotate_field (4);
8489 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "addr");
8490 }
8491
8492 annotate_field (5);
8493 if (self->is_load)
8494 {
8495 if (self->regex)
8496 msg = xstrprintf (_("load of library matching %s"), self->regex);
8497 else
8498 msg = xstrdup (_("load of library"));
8499 }
8500 else
8501 {
8502 if (self->regex)
8503 msg = xstrprintf (_("unload of library matching %s"), self->regex);
8504 else
8505 msg = xstrdup (_("unload of library"));
8506 }
8507 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", msg);
8508 xfree (msg);
8509
8510 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
8511 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "catch-type",
8512 self->is_load ? "load" : "unload");
8513 }
8514
8515 static void
8516 print_mention_catch_solib (struct breakpoint *b)
8517 {
8518 struct solib_catchpoint *self = (struct solib_catchpoint *) b;
8519
8520 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (%s)"), b->number,
8521 self->is_load ? "load" : "unload");
8522 }
8523
8524 static void
8525 print_recreate_catch_solib (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
8526 {
8527 struct solib_catchpoint *self = (struct solib_catchpoint *) b;
8528
8529 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "%s %s",
8530 b->disposition == disp_del ? "tcatch" : "catch",
8531 self->is_load ? "load" : "unload");
8532 if (self->regex)
8533 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s", self->regex);
8534 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "\n");
8535 }
8536
8537 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_solib_breakpoint_ops;
8538
8539 /* Shared helper function (MI and CLI) for creating and installing
8540 a shared object event catchpoint. If IS_LOAD is non-zero then
8541 the events to be caught are load events, otherwise they are
8542 unload events. If IS_TEMP is non-zero the catchpoint is a
8543 temporary one. If ENABLED is non-zero the catchpoint is
8544 created in an enabled state. */
8545
8546 void
8547 add_solib_catchpoint (char *arg, int is_load, int is_temp, int enabled)
8548 {
8549 struct solib_catchpoint *c;
8550 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
8551 struct cleanup *cleanup;
8552
8553 if (!arg)
8554 arg = "";
8555 arg = skip_spaces (arg);
8556
8557 c = XCNEW (struct solib_catchpoint);
8558 cleanup = make_cleanup (xfree, c);
8559
8560 if (*arg != '\0')
8561 {
8562 int errcode;
8563
8564 errcode = regcomp (&c->compiled, arg, REG_NOSUB);
8565 if (errcode != 0)
8566 {
8567 char *err = get_regcomp_error (errcode, &c->compiled);
8568
8569 make_cleanup (xfree, err);
8570 error (_("Invalid regexp (%s): %s"), err, arg);
8571 }
8572 c->regex = xstrdup (arg);
8573 }
8574
8575 c->is_load = is_load;
8576 init_catchpoint (&c->base, gdbarch, is_temp, NULL,
8577 &catch_solib_breakpoint_ops);
8578
8579 c->base.enable_state = enabled ? bp_enabled : bp_disabled;
8580
8581 discard_cleanups (cleanup);
8582 install_breakpoint (0, &c->base, 1);
8583 }
8584
8585 /* A helper function that does all the work for "catch load" and
8586 "catch unload". */
8587
8588 static void
8589 catch_load_or_unload (char *arg, int from_tty, int is_load,
8590 struct cmd_list_element *command)
8591 {
8592 int tempflag;
8593 const int enabled = 1;
8594
8595 tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
8596
8597 add_solib_catchpoint (arg, is_load, tempflag, enabled);
8598 }
8599
8600 static void
8601 catch_load_command_1 (char *arg, int from_tty,
8602 struct cmd_list_element *command)
8603 {
8604 catch_load_or_unload (arg, from_tty, 1, command);
8605 }
8606
8607 static void
8608 catch_unload_command_1 (char *arg, int from_tty,
8609 struct cmd_list_element *command)
8610 {
8611 catch_load_or_unload (arg, from_tty, 0, command);
8612 }
8613
8614 /* Initialize a new breakpoint of the bp_catchpoint kind. If TEMPFLAG
8615 is non-zero, then make the breakpoint temporary. If COND_STRING is
8616 not NULL, then store it in the breakpoint. OPS, if not NULL, is
8617 the breakpoint_ops structure associated to the catchpoint. */
8618
8619 void
8620 init_catchpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
8621 struct gdbarch *gdbarch, int tempflag,
8622 char *cond_string,
8623 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
8624 {
8625 struct symtab_and_line sal;
8626
8627 init_sal (&sal);
8628 sal.pspace = current_program_space;
8629
8630 init_raw_breakpoint (b, gdbarch, sal, bp_catchpoint, ops);
8631
8632 b->cond_string = (cond_string == NULL) ? NULL : xstrdup (cond_string);
8633 b->disposition = tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch;
8634 }
8635
8636 void
8637 install_breakpoint (int internal, struct breakpoint *b, int update_gll)
8638 {
8639 add_to_breakpoint_chain (b);
8640 set_breakpoint_number (internal, b);
8641 if (is_tracepoint (b))
8642 set_tracepoint_count (breakpoint_count);
8643 if (!internal)
8644 mention (b);
8645 observer_notify_breakpoint_created (b);
8646
8647 if (update_gll)
8648 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
8649 }
8650
8651 static void
8652 create_fork_vfork_event_catchpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
8653 int tempflag, char *cond_string,
8654 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
8655 {
8656 struct fork_catchpoint *c = XNEW (struct fork_catchpoint);
8657
8658 init_catchpoint (&c->base, gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string, ops);
8659
8660 c->forked_inferior_pid = null_ptid;
8661
8662 install_breakpoint (0, &c->base, 1);
8663 }
8664
8665 /* Exec catchpoints. */
8666
8667 /* An instance of this type is used to represent an exec catchpoint.
8668 It includes a "struct breakpoint" as a kind of base class; users
8669 downcast to "struct breakpoint *" when needed. A breakpoint is
8670 really of this type iff its ops pointer points to
8671 CATCH_EXEC_BREAKPOINT_OPS. */
8672
8673 struct exec_catchpoint
8674 {
8675 /* The base class. */
8676 struct breakpoint base;
8677
8678 /* Filename of a program whose exec triggered this catchpoint.
8679 This field is only valid immediately after this catchpoint has
8680 triggered. */
8681 char *exec_pathname;
8682 };
8683
8684 /* Implement the "dtor" breakpoint_ops method for exec
8685 catchpoints. */
8686
8687 static void
8688 dtor_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b)
8689 {
8690 struct exec_catchpoint *c = (struct exec_catchpoint *) b;
8691
8692 xfree (c->exec_pathname);
8693
8694 base_breakpoint_ops.dtor (b);
8695 }
8696
8697 static int
8698 insert_catch_exec (struct bp_location *bl)
8699 {
8700 return target_insert_exec_catchpoint (ptid_get_pid (inferior_ptid));
8701 }
8702
8703 static int
8704 remove_catch_exec (struct bp_location *bl, enum remove_bp_reason reason)
8705 {
8706 return target_remove_exec_catchpoint (ptid_get_pid (inferior_ptid));
8707 }
8708
8709 static int
8710 breakpoint_hit_catch_exec (const struct bp_location *bl,
8711 struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
8712 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
8713 {
8714 struct exec_catchpoint *c = (struct exec_catchpoint *) bl->owner;
8715
8716 if (ws->kind != TARGET_WAITKIND_EXECD)
8717 return 0;
8718
8719 c->exec_pathname = xstrdup (ws->value.execd_pathname);
8720 return 1;
8721 }
8722
8723 static enum print_stop_action
8724 print_it_catch_exec (bpstat bs)
8725 {
8726 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
8727 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
8728 struct exec_catchpoint *c = (struct exec_catchpoint *) b;
8729
8730 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
8731 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout);
8732 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
8733 ui_out_text (uiout, "Temporary catchpoint ");
8734 else
8735 ui_out_text (uiout, "Catchpoint ");
8736 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
8737 {
8738 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "reason",
8739 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_EXEC));
8740 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
8741 }
8742 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "bkptno", b->number);
8743 ui_out_text (uiout, " (exec'd ");
8744 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "new-exec", c->exec_pathname);
8745 ui_out_text (uiout, "), ");
8746
8747 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
8748 }
8749
8750 static void
8751 print_one_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
8752 {
8753 struct exec_catchpoint *c = (struct exec_catchpoint *) b;
8754 struct value_print_options opts;
8755 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
8756
8757 get_user_print_options (&opts);
8758
8759 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns
8760 not line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect
8761 is relatively readable). */
8762 if (opts.addressprint)
8763 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "addr");
8764 annotate_field (5);
8765 ui_out_text (uiout, "exec");
8766 if (c->exec_pathname != NULL)
8767 {
8768 ui_out_text (uiout, ", program \"");
8769 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", c->exec_pathname);
8770 ui_out_text (uiout, "\" ");
8771 }
8772
8773 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
8774 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "catch-type", "exec");
8775 }
8776
8777 static void
8778 print_mention_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b)
8779 {
8780 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (exec)"), b->number);
8781 }
8782
8783 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for exec
8784 catchpoints. */
8785
8786 static void
8787 print_recreate_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
8788 {
8789 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "catch exec");
8790 print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
8791 }
8792
8793 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_exec_breakpoint_ops;
8794
8795 static int
8796 hw_breakpoint_used_count (void)
8797 {
8798 int i = 0;
8799 struct breakpoint *b;
8800 struct bp_location *bl;
8801
8802 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
8803 {
8804 if (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint && breakpoint_enabled (b))
8805 for (bl = b->loc; bl; bl = bl->next)
8806 {
8807 /* Special types of hardware breakpoints may use more than
8808 one register. */
8809 i += b->ops->resources_needed (bl);
8810 }
8811 }
8812
8813 return i;
8814 }
8815
8816 /* Returns the resources B would use if it were a hardware
8817 watchpoint. */
8818
8819 static int
8820 hw_watchpoint_use_count (struct breakpoint *b)
8821 {
8822 int i = 0;
8823 struct bp_location *bl;
8824
8825 if (!breakpoint_enabled (b))
8826 return 0;
8827
8828 for (bl = b->loc; bl; bl = bl->next)
8829 {
8830 /* Special types of hardware watchpoints may use more than
8831 one register. */
8832 i += b->ops->resources_needed (bl);
8833 }
8834
8835 return i;
8836 }
8837
8838 /* Returns the sum the used resources of all hardware watchpoints of
8839 type TYPE in the breakpoints list. Also returns in OTHER_TYPE_USED
8840 the sum of the used resources of all hardware watchpoints of other
8841 types _not_ TYPE. */
8842
8843 static int
8844 hw_watchpoint_used_count_others (struct breakpoint *except,
8845 enum bptype type, int *other_type_used)
8846 {
8847 int i = 0;
8848 struct breakpoint *b;
8849
8850 *other_type_used = 0;
8851 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
8852 {
8853 if (b == except)
8854 continue;
8855 if (!breakpoint_enabled (b))
8856 continue;
8857
8858 if (b->type == type)
8859 i += hw_watchpoint_use_count (b);
8860 else if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b))
8861 *other_type_used = 1;
8862 }
8863
8864 return i;
8865 }
8866
8867 void
8868 disable_watchpoints_before_interactive_call_start (void)
8869 {
8870 struct breakpoint *b;
8871
8872 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
8873 {
8874 if (is_watchpoint (b) && breakpoint_enabled (b))
8875 {
8876 b->enable_state = bp_call_disabled;
8877 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
8878 }
8879 }
8880 }
8881
8882 void
8883 enable_watchpoints_after_interactive_call_stop (void)
8884 {
8885 struct breakpoint *b;
8886
8887 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
8888 {
8889 if (is_watchpoint (b) && b->enable_state == bp_call_disabled)
8890 {
8891 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
8892 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
8893 }
8894 }
8895 }
8896
8897 void
8898 disable_breakpoints_before_startup (void)
8899 {
8900 current_program_space->executing_startup = 1;
8901 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
8902 }
8903
8904 void
8905 enable_breakpoints_after_startup (void)
8906 {
8907 current_program_space->executing_startup = 0;
8908 breakpoint_re_set ();
8909 }
8910
8911 /* Create a new single-step breakpoint for thread THREAD, with no
8912 locations. */
8913
8914 static struct breakpoint *
8915 new_single_step_breakpoint (int thread, struct gdbarch *gdbarch)
8916 {
8917 struct breakpoint *b = XNEW (struct breakpoint);
8918
8919 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (b, gdbarch, bp_single_step,
8920 &momentary_breakpoint_ops);
8921
8922 b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
8923 b->frame_id = null_frame_id;
8924
8925 b->thread = thread;
8926 gdb_assert (b->thread != 0);
8927
8928 add_to_breakpoint_chain (b);
8929
8930 return b;
8931 }
8932
8933 /* Set a momentary breakpoint of type TYPE at address specified by
8934 SAL. If FRAME_ID is valid, the breakpoint is restricted to that
8935 frame. */
8936
8937 struct breakpoint *
8938 set_momentary_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, struct symtab_and_line sal,
8939 struct frame_id frame_id, enum bptype type)
8940 {
8941 struct breakpoint *b;
8942
8943 /* If FRAME_ID is valid, it should be a real frame, not an inlined or
8944 tail-called one. */
8945 gdb_assert (!frame_id_artificial_p (frame_id));
8946
8947 b = set_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, type, &momentary_breakpoint_ops);
8948 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
8949 b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
8950 b->frame_id = frame_id;
8951
8952 /* If we're debugging a multi-threaded program, then we want
8953 momentary breakpoints to be active in only a single thread of
8954 control. */
8955 if (in_thread_list (inferior_ptid))
8956 b->thread = ptid_to_global_thread_id (inferior_ptid);
8957
8958 update_global_location_list_nothrow (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
8959
8960 return b;
8961 }
8962
8963 /* Make a momentary breakpoint based on the master breakpoint ORIG.
8964 The new breakpoint will have type TYPE, use OPS as its
8965 breakpoint_ops, and will set enabled to LOC_ENABLED. */
8966
8967 static struct breakpoint *
8968 momentary_breakpoint_from_master (struct breakpoint *orig,
8969 enum bptype type,
8970 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
8971 int loc_enabled)
8972 {
8973 struct breakpoint *copy;
8974
8975 copy = set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (orig->gdbarch, type, ops);
8976 copy->loc = allocate_bp_location (copy);
8977 set_breakpoint_location_function (copy->loc, 1);
8978
8979 copy->loc->gdbarch = orig->loc->gdbarch;
8980 copy->loc->requested_address = orig->loc->requested_address;
8981 copy->loc->address = orig->loc->address;
8982 copy->loc->section = orig->loc->section;
8983 copy->loc->pspace = orig->loc->pspace;
8984 copy->loc->probe = orig->loc->probe;
8985 copy->loc->line_number = orig->loc->line_number;
8986 copy->loc->symtab = orig->loc->symtab;
8987 copy->loc->enabled = loc_enabled;
8988 copy->frame_id = orig->frame_id;
8989 copy->thread = orig->thread;
8990 copy->pspace = orig->pspace;
8991
8992 copy->enable_state = bp_enabled;
8993 copy->disposition = disp_donttouch;
8994 copy->number = internal_breakpoint_number--;
8995
8996 update_global_location_list_nothrow (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
8997 return copy;
8998 }
8999
9000 /* Make a deep copy of momentary breakpoint ORIG. Returns NULL if
9001 ORIG is NULL. */
9002
9003 struct breakpoint *
9004 clone_momentary_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *orig)
9005 {
9006 /* If there's nothing to clone, then return nothing. */
9007 if (orig == NULL)
9008 return NULL;
9009
9010 return momentary_breakpoint_from_master (orig, orig->type, orig->ops, 0);
9011 }
9012
9013 struct breakpoint *
9014 set_momentary_breakpoint_at_pc (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR pc,
9015 enum bptype type)
9016 {
9017 struct symtab_and_line sal;
9018
9019 sal = find_pc_line (pc, 0);
9020 sal.pc = pc;
9021 sal.section = find_pc_overlay (pc);
9022 sal.explicit_pc = 1;
9023
9024 return set_momentary_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, null_frame_id, type);
9025 }
9026 \f
9027
9028 /* Tell the user we have just set a breakpoint B. */
9029
9030 static void
9031 mention (struct breakpoint *b)
9032 {
9033 b->ops->print_mention (b);
9034 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (current_uiout))
9035 return;
9036 printf_filtered ("\n");
9037 }
9038 \f
9039
9040 static int bp_loc_is_permanent (struct bp_location *loc);
9041
9042 static struct bp_location *
9043 add_location_to_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
9044 const struct symtab_and_line *sal)
9045 {
9046 struct bp_location *loc, **tmp;
9047 CORE_ADDR adjusted_address;
9048 struct gdbarch *loc_gdbarch = get_sal_arch (*sal);
9049
9050 if (loc_gdbarch == NULL)
9051 loc_gdbarch = b->gdbarch;
9052
9053 /* Adjust the breakpoint's address prior to allocating a location.
9054 Once we call allocate_bp_location(), that mostly uninitialized
9055 location will be placed on the location chain. Adjustment of the
9056 breakpoint may cause target_read_memory() to be called and we do
9057 not want its scan of the location chain to find a breakpoint and
9058 location that's only been partially initialized. */
9059 adjusted_address = adjust_breakpoint_address (loc_gdbarch,
9060 sal->pc, b->type);
9061
9062 /* Sort the locations by their ADDRESS. */
9063 loc = allocate_bp_location (b);
9064 for (tmp = &(b->loc); *tmp != NULL && (*tmp)->address <= adjusted_address;
9065 tmp = &((*tmp)->next))
9066 ;
9067 loc->next = *tmp;
9068 *tmp = loc;
9069
9070 loc->requested_address = sal->pc;
9071 loc->address = adjusted_address;
9072 loc->pspace = sal->pspace;
9073 loc->probe.probe = sal->probe;
9074 loc->probe.objfile = sal->objfile;
9075 gdb_assert (loc->pspace != NULL);
9076 loc->section = sal->section;
9077 loc->gdbarch = loc_gdbarch;
9078 loc->line_number = sal->line;
9079 loc->symtab = sal->symtab;
9080
9081 set_breakpoint_location_function (loc,
9082 sal->explicit_pc || sal->explicit_line);
9083
9084 /* While by definition, permanent breakpoints are already present in the
9085 code, we don't mark the location as inserted. Normally one would expect
9086 that GDB could rely on that breakpoint instruction to stop the program,
9087 thus removing the need to insert its own breakpoint, except that executing
9088 the breakpoint instruction can kill the target instead of reporting a
9089 SIGTRAP. E.g., on SPARC, when interrupts are disabled, executing the
9090 instruction resets the CPU, so QEMU 2.0.0 for SPARC correspondingly dies
9091 with "Trap 0x02 while interrupts disabled, Error state". Letting the
9092 breakpoint be inserted normally results in QEMU knowing about the GDB
9093 breakpoint, and thus trap before the breakpoint instruction is executed.
9094 (If GDB later needs to continue execution past the permanent breakpoint,
9095 it manually increments the PC, thus avoiding executing the breakpoint
9096 instruction.) */
9097 if (bp_loc_is_permanent (loc))
9098 loc->permanent = 1;
9099
9100 return loc;
9101 }
9102 \f
9103
9104 /* See breakpoint.h. */
9105
9106 int
9107 program_breakpoint_here_p (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
9108 {
9109 int len;
9110 CORE_ADDR addr;
9111 const gdb_byte *bpoint;
9112 gdb_byte *target_mem;
9113 struct cleanup *cleanup;
9114 int retval = 0;
9115
9116 addr = address;
9117 bpoint = gdbarch_breakpoint_from_pc (gdbarch, &addr, &len);
9118
9119 /* Software breakpoints unsupported? */
9120 if (bpoint == NULL)
9121 return 0;
9122
9123 target_mem = (gdb_byte *) alloca (len);
9124
9125 /* Enable the automatic memory restoration from breakpoints while
9126 we read the memory. Otherwise we could say about our temporary
9127 breakpoints they are permanent. */
9128 cleanup = make_show_memory_breakpoints_cleanup (0);
9129
9130 if (target_read_memory (address, target_mem, len) == 0
9131 && memcmp (target_mem, bpoint, len) == 0)
9132 retval = 1;
9133
9134 do_cleanups (cleanup);
9135
9136 return retval;
9137 }
9138
9139 /* Return 1 if LOC is pointing to a permanent breakpoint,
9140 return 0 otherwise. */
9141
9142 static int
9143 bp_loc_is_permanent (struct bp_location *loc)
9144 {
9145 struct cleanup *cleanup;
9146 int retval;
9147
9148 gdb_assert (loc != NULL);
9149
9150 /* If we have a catchpoint or a watchpoint, just return 0. We should not
9151 attempt to read from the addresses the locations of these breakpoint types
9152 point to. program_breakpoint_here_p, below, will attempt to read
9153 memory. */
9154 if (!breakpoint_address_is_meaningful (loc->owner))
9155 return 0;
9156
9157 cleanup = save_current_space_and_thread ();
9158 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (loc->pspace);
9159
9160 retval = program_breakpoint_here_p (loc->gdbarch, loc->address);
9161
9162 do_cleanups (cleanup);
9163
9164 return retval;
9165 }
9166
9167 /* Build a command list for the dprintf corresponding to the current
9168 settings of the dprintf style options. */
9169
9170 static void
9171 update_dprintf_command_list (struct breakpoint *b)
9172 {
9173 char *dprintf_args = b->extra_string;
9174 char *printf_line = NULL;
9175
9176 if (!dprintf_args)
9177 return;
9178
9179 dprintf_args = skip_spaces (dprintf_args);
9180
9181 /* Allow a comma, as it may have terminated a location, but don't
9182 insist on it. */
9183 if (*dprintf_args == ',')
9184 ++dprintf_args;
9185 dprintf_args = skip_spaces (dprintf_args);
9186
9187 if (*dprintf_args != '"')
9188 error (_("Bad format string, missing '\"'."));
9189
9190 if (strcmp (dprintf_style, dprintf_style_gdb) == 0)
9191 printf_line = xstrprintf ("printf %s", dprintf_args);
9192 else if (strcmp (dprintf_style, dprintf_style_call) == 0)
9193 {
9194 if (!dprintf_function)
9195 error (_("No function supplied for dprintf call"));
9196
9197 if (dprintf_channel && strlen (dprintf_channel) > 0)
9198 printf_line = xstrprintf ("call (void) %s (%s,%s)",
9199 dprintf_function,
9200 dprintf_channel,
9201 dprintf_args);
9202 else
9203 printf_line = xstrprintf ("call (void) %s (%s)",
9204 dprintf_function,
9205 dprintf_args);
9206 }
9207 else if (strcmp (dprintf_style, dprintf_style_agent) == 0)
9208 {
9209 if (target_can_run_breakpoint_commands ())
9210 printf_line = xstrprintf ("agent-printf %s", dprintf_args);
9211 else
9212 {
9213 warning (_("Target cannot run dprintf commands, falling back to GDB printf"));
9214 printf_line = xstrprintf ("printf %s", dprintf_args);
9215 }
9216 }
9217 else
9218 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
9219 _("Invalid dprintf style."));
9220
9221 gdb_assert (printf_line != NULL);
9222 /* Manufacture a printf sequence. */
9223 {
9224 struct command_line *printf_cmd_line = XNEW (struct command_line);
9225
9226 printf_cmd_line->control_type = simple_control;
9227 printf_cmd_line->body_count = 0;
9228 printf_cmd_line->body_list = NULL;
9229 printf_cmd_line->next = NULL;
9230 printf_cmd_line->line = printf_line;
9231
9232 breakpoint_set_commands (b, printf_cmd_line);
9233 }
9234 }
9235
9236 /* Update all dprintf commands, making their command lists reflect
9237 current style settings. */
9238
9239 static void
9240 update_dprintf_commands (char *args, int from_tty,
9241 struct cmd_list_element *c)
9242 {
9243 struct breakpoint *b;
9244
9245 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
9246 {
9247 if (b->type == bp_dprintf)
9248 update_dprintf_command_list (b);
9249 }
9250 }
9251
9252 /* Create a breakpoint with SAL as location. Use LOCATION
9253 as a description of the location, and COND_STRING
9254 as condition expression. If LOCATION is NULL then create an
9255 "address location" from the address in the SAL. */
9256
9257 static void
9258 init_breakpoint_sal (struct breakpoint *b, struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
9259 struct symtabs_and_lines sals,
9260 struct event_location *location,
9261 char *filter, char *cond_string,
9262 char *extra_string,
9263 enum bptype type, enum bpdisp disposition,
9264 int thread, int task, int ignore_count,
9265 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops, int from_tty,
9266 int enabled, int internal, unsigned flags,
9267 int display_canonical)
9268 {
9269 int i;
9270
9271 if (type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
9272 {
9273 int target_resources_ok;
9274
9275 i = hw_breakpoint_used_count ();
9276 target_resources_ok =
9277 target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (bp_hardware_breakpoint,
9278 i + 1, 0);
9279 if (target_resources_ok == 0)
9280 error (_("No hardware breakpoint support in the target."));
9281 else if (target_resources_ok < 0)
9282 error (_("Hardware breakpoints used exceeds limit."));
9283 }
9284
9285 gdb_assert (sals.nelts > 0);
9286
9287 for (i = 0; i < sals.nelts; ++i)
9288 {
9289 struct symtab_and_line sal = sals.sals[i];
9290 struct bp_location *loc;
9291
9292 if (from_tty)
9293 {
9294 struct gdbarch *loc_gdbarch = get_sal_arch (sal);
9295 if (!loc_gdbarch)
9296 loc_gdbarch = gdbarch;
9297
9298 describe_other_breakpoints (loc_gdbarch,
9299 sal.pspace, sal.pc, sal.section, thread);
9300 }
9301
9302 if (i == 0)
9303 {
9304 init_raw_breakpoint (b, gdbarch, sal, type, ops);
9305 b->thread = thread;
9306 b->task = task;
9307
9308 b->cond_string = cond_string;
9309 b->extra_string = extra_string;
9310 b->ignore_count = ignore_count;
9311 b->enable_state = enabled ? bp_enabled : bp_disabled;
9312 b->disposition = disposition;
9313
9314 if ((flags & CREATE_BREAKPOINT_FLAGS_INSERTED) != 0)
9315 b->loc->inserted = 1;
9316
9317 if (type == bp_static_tracepoint)
9318 {
9319 struct tracepoint *t = (struct tracepoint *) b;
9320 struct static_tracepoint_marker marker;
9321
9322 if (strace_marker_p (b))
9323 {
9324 /* We already know the marker exists, otherwise, we
9325 wouldn't see a sal for it. */
9326 const char *p = &event_location_to_string (b->location)[3];
9327 const char *endp;
9328 char *marker_str;
9329
9330 p = skip_spaces_const (p);
9331
9332 endp = skip_to_space_const (p);
9333
9334 marker_str = savestring (p, endp - p);
9335 t->static_trace_marker_id = marker_str;
9336
9337 printf_filtered (_("Probed static tracepoint "
9338 "marker \"%s\"\n"),
9339 t->static_trace_marker_id);
9340 }
9341 else if (target_static_tracepoint_marker_at (sal.pc, &marker))
9342 {
9343 t->static_trace_marker_id = xstrdup (marker.str_id);
9344 release_static_tracepoint_marker (&marker);
9345
9346 printf_filtered (_("Probed static tracepoint "
9347 "marker \"%s\"\n"),
9348 t->static_trace_marker_id);
9349 }
9350 else
9351 warning (_("Couldn't determine the static "
9352 "tracepoint marker to probe"));
9353 }
9354
9355 loc = b->loc;
9356 }
9357 else
9358 {
9359 loc = add_location_to_breakpoint (b, &sal);
9360 if ((flags & CREATE_BREAKPOINT_FLAGS_INSERTED) != 0)
9361 loc->inserted = 1;
9362 }
9363
9364 if (b->cond_string)
9365 {
9366 const char *arg = b->cond_string;
9367
9368 loc->cond = parse_exp_1 (&arg, loc->address,
9369 block_for_pc (loc->address), 0);
9370 if (*arg)
9371 error (_("Garbage '%s' follows condition"), arg);
9372 }
9373
9374 /* Dynamic printf requires and uses additional arguments on the
9375 command line, otherwise it's an error. */
9376 if (type == bp_dprintf)
9377 {
9378 if (b->extra_string)
9379 update_dprintf_command_list (b);
9380 else
9381 error (_("Format string required"));
9382 }
9383 else if (b->extra_string)
9384 error (_("Garbage '%s' at end of command"), b->extra_string);
9385 }
9386
9387 b->display_canonical = display_canonical;
9388 if (location != NULL)
9389 b->location = location;
9390 else
9391 {
9392 const char *addr_string = NULL;
9393 int addr_string_len = 0;
9394
9395 if (location != NULL)
9396 addr_string = event_location_to_string (location);
9397 if (addr_string != NULL)
9398 addr_string_len = strlen (addr_string);
9399
9400 b->location = new_address_location (b->loc->address,
9401 addr_string, addr_string_len);
9402 }
9403 b->filter = filter;
9404 }
9405
9406 static void
9407 create_breakpoint_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
9408 struct symtabs_and_lines sals,
9409 struct event_location *location,
9410 char *filter, char *cond_string,
9411 char *extra_string,
9412 enum bptype type, enum bpdisp disposition,
9413 int thread, int task, int ignore_count,
9414 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops, int from_tty,
9415 int enabled, int internal, unsigned flags,
9416 int display_canonical)
9417 {
9418 struct breakpoint *b;
9419 struct cleanup *old_chain;
9420
9421 if (is_tracepoint_type (type))
9422 {
9423 struct tracepoint *t;
9424
9425 t = XCNEW (struct tracepoint);
9426 b = &t->base;
9427 }
9428 else
9429 b = XNEW (struct breakpoint);
9430
9431 old_chain = make_cleanup (xfree, b);
9432
9433 init_breakpoint_sal (b, gdbarch,
9434 sals, location,
9435 filter, cond_string, extra_string,
9436 type, disposition,
9437 thread, task, ignore_count,
9438 ops, from_tty,
9439 enabled, internal, flags,
9440 display_canonical);
9441 discard_cleanups (old_chain);
9442
9443 install_breakpoint (internal, b, 0);
9444 }
9445
9446 /* Add SALS.nelts breakpoints to the breakpoint table. For each
9447 SALS.sal[i] breakpoint, include the corresponding ADDR_STRING[i]
9448 value. COND_STRING, if not NULL, specified the condition to be
9449 used for all breakpoints. Essentially the only case where
9450 SALS.nelts is not 1 is when we set a breakpoint on an overloaded
9451 function. In that case, it's still not possible to specify
9452 separate conditions for different overloaded functions, so
9453 we take just a single condition string.
9454
9455 NOTE: If the function succeeds, the caller is expected to cleanup
9456 the arrays ADDR_STRING, COND_STRING, and SALS (but not the
9457 array contents). If the function fails (error() is called), the
9458 caller is expected to cleanups both the ADDR_STRING, COND_STRING,
9459 COND and SALS arrays and each of those arrays contents. */
9460
9461 static void
9462 create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
9463 struct linespec_result *canonical,
9464 char *cond_string, char *extra_string,
9465 enum bptype type, enum bpdisp disposition,
9466 int thread, int task, int ignore_count,
9467 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops, int from_tty,
9468 int enabled, int internal, unsigned flags)
9469 {
9470 int i;
9471 struct linespec_sals *lsal;
9472
9473 if (canonical->pre_expanded)
9474 gdb_assert (VEC_length (linespec_sals, canonical->sals) == 1);
9475
9476 for (i = 0; VEC_iterate (linespec_sals, canonical->sals, i, lsal); ++i)
9477 {
9478 /* Note that 'location' can be NULL in the case of a plain
9479 'break', without arguments. */
9480 struct event_location *location
9481 = (canonical->location != NULL
9482 ? copy_event_location (canonical->location) : NULL);
9483 char *filter_string = lsal->canonical ? xstrdup (lsal->canonical) : NULL;
9484 struct cleanup *inner = make_cleanup_delete_event_location (location);
9485
9486 make_cleanup (xfree, filter_string);
9487 create_breakpoint_sal (gdbarch, lsal->sals,
9488 location,
9489 filter_string,
9490 cond_string, extra_string,
9491 type, disposition,
9492 thread, task, ignore_count, ops,
9493 from_tty, enabled, internal, flags,
9494 canonical->special_display);
9495 discard_cleanups (inner);
9496 }
9497 }
9498
9499 /* Parse LOCATION which is assumed to be a SAL specification possibly
9500 followed by conditionals. On return, SALS contains an array of SAL
9501 addresses found. LOCATION points to the end of the SAL (for
9502 linespec locations).
9503
9504 The array and the line spec strings are allocated on the heap, it is
9505 the caller's responsibility to free them. */
9506
9507 static void
9508 parse_breakpoint_sals (const struct event_location *location,
9509 struct linespec_result *canonical)
9510 {
9511 struct symtab_and_line cursal;
9512
9513 if (event_location_type (location) == LINESPEC_LOCATION)
9514 {
9515 const char *address = get_linespec_location (location);
9516
9517 if (address == NULL)
9518 {
9519 /* The last displayed codepoint, if it's valid, is our default
9520 breakpoint address. */
9521 if (last_displayed_sal_is_valid ())
9522 {
9523 struct linespec_sals lsal;
9524 struct symtab_and_line sal;
9525 CORE_ADDR pc;
9526
9527 init_sal (&sal); /* Initialize to zeroes. */
9528 lsal.sals.sals = XNEW (struct symtab_and_line);
9529
9530 /* Set sal's pspace, pc, symtab, and line to the values
9531 corresponding to the last call to print_frame_info.
9532 Be sure to reinitialize LINE with NOTCURRENT == 0
9533 as the breakpoint line number is inappropriate otherwise.
9534 find_pc_line would adjust PC, re-set it back. */
9535 get_last_displayed_sal (&sal);
9536 pc = sal.pc;
9537 sal = find_pc_line (pc, 0);
9538
9539 /* "break" without arguments is equivalent to "break *PC"
9540 where PC is the last displayed codepoint's address. So
9541 make sure to set sal.explicit_pc to prevent GDB from
9542 trying to expand the list of sals to include all other
9543 instances with the same symtab and line. */
9544 sal.pc = pc;
9545 sal.explicit_pc = 1;
9546
9547 lsal.sals.sals[0] = sal;
9548 lsal.sals.nelts = 1;
9549 lsal.canonical = NULL;
9550
9551 VEC_safe_push (linespec_sals, canonical->sals, &lsal);
9552 return;
9553 }
9554 else
9555 error (_("No default breakpoint address now."));
9556 }
9557 }
9558
9559 /* Force almost all breakpoints to be in terms of the
9560 current_source_symtab (which is decode_line_1's default).
9561 This should produce the results we want almost all of the
9562 time while leaving default_breakpoint_* alone.
9563
9564 ObjC: However, don't match an Objective-C method name which
9565 may have a '+' or '-' succeeded by a '['. */
9566 cursal = get_current_source_symtab_and_line ();
9567 if (last_displayed_sal_is_valid ())
9568 {
9569 const char *address = NULL;
9570
9571 if (event_location_type (location) == LINESPEC_LOCATION)
9572 address = get_linespec_location (location);
9573
9574 if (!cursal.symtab
9575 || (address != NULL
9576 && strchr ("+-", address[0]) != NULL
9577 && address[1] != '['))
9578 {
9579 decode_line_full (location, DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE, NULL,
9580 get_last_displayed_symtab (),
9581 get_last_displayed_line (),
9582 canonical, NULL, NULL);
9583 return;
9584 }
9585 }
9586
9587 decode_line_full (location, DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE, NULL,
9588 cursal.symtab, cursal.line, canonical, NULL, NULL);
9589 }
9590
9591
9592 /* Convert each SAL into a real PC. Verify that the PC can be
9593 inserted as a breakpoint. If it can't throw an error. */
9594
9595 static void
9596 breakpoint_sals_to_pc (struct symtabs_and_lines *sals)
9597 {
9598 int i;
9599
9600 for (i = 0; i < sals->nelts; i++)
9601 resolve_sal_pc (&sals->sals[i]);
9602 }
9603
9604 /* Fast tracepoints may have restrictions on valid locations. For
9605 instance, a fast tracepoint using a jump instead of a trap will
9606 likely have to overwrite more bytes than a trap would, and so can
9607 only be placed where the instruction is longer than the jump, or a
9608 multi-instruction sequence does not have a jump into the middle of
9609 it, etc. */
9610
9611 static void
9612 check_fast_tracepoint_sals (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
9613 struct symtabs_and_lines *sals)
9614 {
9615 int i, rslt;
9616 struct symtab_and_line *sal;
9617 char *msg;
9618 struct cleanup *old_chain;
9619
9620 for (i = 0; i < sals->nelts; i++)
9621 {
9622 struct gdbarch *sarch;
9623
9624 sal = &sals->sals[i];
9625
9626 sarch = get_sal_arch (*sal);
9627 /* We fall back to GDBARCH if there is no architecture
9628 associated with SAL. */
9629 if (sarch == NULL)
9630 sarch = gdbarch;
9631 rslt = gdbarch_fast_tracepoint_valid_at (sarch, sal->pc, &msg);
9632 old_chain = make_cleanup (xfree, msg);
9633
9634 if (!rslt)
9635 error (_("May not have a fast tracepoint at 0x%s%s"),
9636 paddress (sarch, sal->pc), (msg ? msg : ""));
9637
9638 do_cleanups (old_chain);
9639 }
9640 }
9641
9642 /* Given TOK, a string specification of condition and thread, as
9643 accepted by the 'break' command, extract the condition
9644 string and thread number and set *COND_STRING and *THREAD.
9645 PC identifies the context at which the condition should be parsed.
9646 If no condition is found, *COND_STRING is set to NULL.
9647 If no thread is found, *THREAD is set to -1. */
9648
9649 static void
9650 find_condition_and_thread (const char *tok, CORE_ADDR pc,
9651 char **cond_string, int *thread, int *task,
9652 char **rest)
9653 {
9654 *cond_string = NULL;
9655 *thread = -1;
9656 *task = 0;
9657 *rest = NULL;
9658
9659 while (tok && *tok)
9660 {
9661 const char *end_tok;
9662 int toklen;
9663 const char *cond_start = NULL;
9664 const char *cond_end = NULL;
9665
9666 tok = skip_spaces_const (tok);
9667
9668 if ((*tok == '"' || *tok == ',') && rest)
9669 {
9670 *rest = savestring (tok, strlen (tok));
9671 return;
9672 }
9673
9674 end_tok = skip_to_space_const (tok);
9675
9676 toklen = end_tok - tok;
9677
9678 if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "if", toklen) == 0)
9679 {
9680 struct expression *expr;
9681
9682 tok = cond_start = end_tok + 1;
9683 expr = parse_exp_1 (&tok, pc, block_for_pc (pc), 0);
9684 xfree (expr);
9685 cond_end = tok;
9686 *cond_string = savestring (cond_start, cond_end - cond_start);
9687 }
9688 else if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "thread", toklen) == 0)
9689 {
9690 const char *tmptok;
9691 struct thread_info *thr;
9692
9693 tok = end_tok + 1;
9694 thr = parse_thread_id (tok, &tmptok);
9695 if (tok == tmptok)
9696 error (_("Junk after thread keyword."));
9697 *thread = thr->global_num;
9698 tok = tmptok;
9699 }
9700 else if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "task", toklen) == 0)
9701 {
9702 char *tmptok;
9703
9704 tok = end_tok + 1;
9705 *task = strtol (tok, &tmptok, 0);
9706 if (tok == tmptok)
9707 error (_("Junk after task keyword."));
9708 if (!valid_task_id (*task))
9709 error (_("Unknown task %d."), *task);
9710 tok = tmptok;
9711 }
9712 else if (rest)
9713 {
9714 *rest = savestring (tok, strlen (tok));
9715 return;
9716 }
9717 else
9718 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
9719 }
9720 }
9721
9722 /* Decode a static tracepoint marker spec. */
9723
9724 static struct symtabs_and_lines
9725 decode_static_tracepoint_spec (const char **arg_p)
9726 {
9727 VEC(static_tracepoint_marker_p) *markers = NULL;
9728 struct symtabs_and_lines sals;
9729 struct cleanup *old_chain;
9730 const char *p = &(*arg_p)[3];
9731 const char *endp;
9732 char *marker_str;
9733 int i;
9734
9735 p = skip_spaces_const (p);
9736
9737 endp = skip_to_space_const (p);
9738
9739 marker_str = savestring (p, endp - p);
9740 old_chain = make_cleanup (xfree, marker_str);
9741
9742 markers = target_static_tracepoint_markers_by_strid (marker_str);
9743 if (VEC_empty(static_tracepoint_marker_p, markers))
9744 error (_("No known static tracepoint marker named %s"), marker_str);
9745
9746 sals.nelts = VEC_length(static_tracepoint_marker_p, markers);
9747 sals.sals = XNEWVEC (struct symtab_and_line, sals.nelts);
9748
9749 for (i = 0; i < sals.nelts; i++)
9750 {
9751 struct static_tracepoint_marker *marker;
9752
9753 marker = VEC_index (static_tracepoint_marker_p, markers, i);
9754
9755 init_sal (&sals.sals[i]);
9756
9757 sals.sals[i] = find_pc_line (marker->address, 0);
9758 sals.sals[i].pc = marker->address;
9759
9760 release_static_tracepoint_marker (marker);
9761 }
9762
9763 do_cleanups (old_chain);
9764
9765 *arg_p = endp;
9766 return sals;
9767 }
9768
9769 /* See breakpoint.h. */
9770
9771 int
9772 create_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
9773 const struct event_location *location, char *cond_string,
9774 int thread, char *extra_string,
9775 int parse_extra,
9776 int tempflag, enum bptype type_wanted,
9777 int ignore_count,
9778 enum auto_boolean pending_break_support,
9779 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
9780 int from_tty, int enabled, int internal,
9781 unsigned flags)
9782 {
9783 struct linespec_result canonical;
9784 struct cleanup *old_chain;
9785 struct cleanup *bkpt_chain = NULL;
9786 int pending = 0;
9787 int task = 0;
9788 int prev_bkpt_count = breakpoint_count;
9789
9790 gdb_assert (ops != NULL);
9791
9792 /* If extra_string isn't useful, set it to NULL. */
9793 if (extra_string != NULL && *extra_string == '\0')
9794 extra_string = NULL;
9795
9796 init_linespec_result (&canonical);
9797
9798 TRY
9799 {
9800 ops->create_sals_from_location (location, &canonical, type_wanted);
9801 }
9802 CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
9803 {
9804 /* If caller is interested in rc value from parse, set
9805 value. */
9806 if (e.error == NOT_FOUND_ERROR)
9807 {
9808 /* If pending breakpoint support is turned off, throw
9809 error. */
9810
9811 if (pending_break_support == AUTO_BOOLEAN_FALSE)
9812 throw_exception (e);
9813
9814 exception_print (gdb_stderr, e);
9815
9816 /* If pending breakpoint support is auto query and the user
9817 selects no, then simply return the error code. */
9818 if (pending_break_support == AUTO_BOOLEAN_AUTO
9819 && !nquery (_("Make %s pending on future shared library load? "),
9820 bptype_string (type_wanted)))
9821 return 0;
9822
9823 /* At this point, either the user was queried about setting
9824 a pending breakpoint and selected yes, or pending
9825 breakpoint behavior is on and thus a pending breakpoint
9826 is defaulted on behalf of the user. */
9827 pending = 1;
9828 }
9829 else
9830 throw_exception (e);
9831 }
9832 END_CATCH
9833
9834 if (!pending && VEC_empty (linespec_sals, canonical.sals))
9835 return 0;
9836
9837 /* Create a chain of things that always need to be cleaned up. */
9838 old_chain = make_cleanup_destroy_linespec_result (&canonical);
9839
9840 /* ----------------------------- SNIP -----------------------------
9841 Anything added to the cleanup chain beyond this point is assumed
9842 to be part of a breakpoint. If the breakpoint create succeeds
9843 then the memory is not reclaimed. */
9844 bkpt_chain = make_cleanup (null_cleanup, 0);
9845
9846 /* Resolve all line numbers to PC's and verify that the addresses
9847 are ok for the target. */
9848 if (!pending)
9849 {
9850 int ix;
9851 struct linespec_sals *iter;
9852
9853 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (linespec_sals, canonical.sals, ix, iter); ++ix)
9854 breakpoint_sals_to_pc (&iter->sals);
9855 }
9856
9857 /* Fast tracepoints may have additional restrictions on location. */
9858 if (!pending && type_wanted == bp_fast_tracepoint)
9859 {
9860 int ix;
9861 struct linespec_sals *iter;
9862
9863 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (linespec_sals, canonical.sals, ix, iter); ++ix)
9864 check_fast_tracepoint_sals (gdbarch, &iter->sals);
9865 }
9866
9867 /* Verify that condition can be parsed, before setting any
9868 breakpoints. Allocate a separate condition expression for each
9869 breakpoint. */
9870 if (!pending)
9871 {
9872 if (parse_extra)
9873 {
9874 char *rest;
9875 struct linespec_sals *lsal;
9876
9877 lsal = VEC_index (linespec_sals, canonical.sals, 0);
9878
9879 /* Here we only parse 'arg' to separate condition
9880 from thread number, so parsing in context of first
9881 sal is OK. When setting the breakpoint we'll
9882 re-parse it in context of each sal. */
9883
9884 find_condition_and_thread (extra_string, lsal->sals.sals[0].pc,
9885 &cond_string, &thread, &task, &rest);
9886 if (cond_string)
9887 make_cleanup (xfree, cond_string);
9888 if (rest)
9889 make_cleanup (xfree, rest);
9890 if (rest)
9891 extra_string = rest;
9892 else
9893 extra_string = NULL;
9894 }
9895 else
9896 {
9897 if (type_wanted != bp_dprintf
9898 && extra_string != NULL && *extra_string != '\0')
9899 error (_("Garbage '%s' at end of location"), extra_string);
9900
9901 /* Create a private copy of condition string. */
9902 if (cond_string)
9903 {
9904 cond_string = xstrdup (cond_string);
9905 make_cleanup (xfree, cond_string);
9906 }
9907 /* Create a private copy of any extra string. */
9908 if (extra_string)
9909 {
9910 extra_string = xstrdup (extra_string);
9911 make_cleanup (xfree, extra_string);
9912 }
9913 }
9914
9915 ops->create_breakpoints_sal (gdbarch, &canonical,
9916 cond_string, extra_string, type_wanted,
9917 tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch,
9918 thread, task, ignore_count, ops,
9919 from_tty, enabled, internal, flags);
9920 }
9921 else
9922 {
9923 struct breakpoint *b;
9924
9925 if (is_tracepoint_type (type_wanted))
9926 {
9927 struct tracepoint *t;
9928
9929 t = XCNEW (struct tracepoint);
9930 b = &t->base;
9931 }
9932 else
9933 b = XNEW (struct breakpoint);
9934
9935 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (b, gdbarch, type_wanted, ops);
9936 b->location = copy_event_location (location);
9937
9938 if (parse_extra)
9939 b->cond_string = NULL;
9940 else
9941 {
9942 /* Create a private copy of condition string. */
9943 if (cond_string)
9944 {
9945 cond_string = xstrdup (cond_string);
9946 make_cleanup (xfree, cond_string);
9947 }
9948 b->cond_string = cond_string;
9949 b->thread = thread;
9950 }
9951
9952 /* Create a private copy of any extra string. */
9953 if (extra_string != NULL)
9954 {
9955 extra_string = xstrdup (extra_string);
9956 make_cleanup (xfree, extra_string);
9957 }
9958 b->extra_string = extra_string;
9959 b->ignore_count = ignore_count;
9960 b->disposition = tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch;
9961 b->condition_not_parsed = 1;
9962 b->enable_state = enabled ? bp_enabled : bp_disabled;
9963 if ((type_wanted != bp_breakpoint
9964 && type_wanted != bp_hardware_breakpoint) || thread != -1)
9965 b->pspace = current_program_space;
9966
9967 install_breakpoint (internal, b, 0);
9968 }
9969
9970 if (VEC_length (linespec_sals, canonical.sals) > 1)
9971 {
9972 warning (_("Multiple breakpoints were set.\nUse the "
9973 "\"delete\" command to delete unwanted breakpoints."));
9974 prev_breakpoint_count = prev_bkpt_count;
9975 }
9976
9977 /* That's it. Discard the cleanups for data inserted into the
9978 breakpoint. */
9979 discard_cleanups (bkpt_chain);
9980 /* But cleanup everything else. */
9981 do_cleanups (old_chain);
9982
9983 /* error call may happen here - have BKPT_CHAIN already discarded. */
9984 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
9985
9986 return 1;
9987 }
9988
9989 /* Set a breakpoint.
9990 ARG is a string describing breakpoint address,
9991 condition, and thread.
9992 FLAG specifies if a breakpoint is hardware on,
9993 and if breakpoint is temporary, using BP_HARDWARE_FLAG
9994 and BP_TEMPFLAG. */
9995
9996 static void
9997 break_command_1 (char *arg, int flag, int from_tty)
9998 {
9999 int tempflag = flag & BP_TEMPFLAG;
10000 enum bptype type_wanted = (flag & BP_HARDWAREFLAG
10001 ? bp_hardware_breakpoint
10002 : bp_breakpoint);
10003 struct breakpoint_ops *ops;
10004 struct event_location *location;
10005 struct cleanup *cleanup;
10006
10007 location = string_to_event_location (&arg, current_language);
10008 cleanup = make_cleanup_delete_event_location (location);
10009
10010 /* Matching breakpoints on probes. */
10011 if (location != NULL
10012 && event_location_type (location) == PROBE_LOCATION)
10013 ops = &bkpt_probe_breakpoint_ops;
10014 else
10015 ops = &bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
10016
10017 create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
10018 location,
10019 NULL, 0, arg, 1 /* parse arg */,
10020 tempflag, type_wanted,
10021 0 /* Ignore count */,
10022 pending_break_support,
10023 ops,
10024 from_tty,
10025 1 /* enabled */,
10026 0 /* internal */,
10027 0);
10028 do_cleanups (cleanup);
10029 }
10030
10031 /* Helper function for break_command_1 and disassemble_command. */
10032
10033 void
10034 resolve_sal_pc (struct symtab_and_line *sal)
10035 {
10036 CORE_ADDR pc;
10037
10038 if (sal->pc == 0 && sal->symtab != NULL)
10039 {
10040 if (!find_line_pc (sal->symtab, sal->line, &pc))
10041 error (_("No line %d in file \"%s\"."),
10042 sal->line, symtab_to_filename_for_display (sal->symtab));
10043 sal->pc = pc;
10044
10045 /* If this SAL corresponds to a breakpoint inserted using a line
10046 number, then skip the function prologue if necessary. */
10047 if (sal->explicit_line)
10048 skip_prologue_sal (sal);
10049 }
10050
10051 if (sal->section == 0 && sal->symtab != NULL)
10052 {
10053 const struct blockvector *bv;
10054 const struct block *b;
10055 struct symbol *sym;
10056
10057 bv = blockvector_for_pc_sect (sal->pc, 0, &b,
10058 SYMTAB_COMPUNIT (sal->symtab));
10059 if (bv != NULL)
10060 {
10061 sym = block_linkage_function (b);
10062 if (sym != NULL)
10063 {
10064 fixup_symbol_section (sym, SYMTAB_OBJFILE (sal->symtab));
10065 sal->section = SYMBOL_OBJ_SECTION (SYMTAB_OBJFILE (sal->symtab),
10066 sym);
10067 }
10068 else
10069 {
10070 /* It really is worthwhile to have the section, so we'll
10071 just have to look harder. This case can be executed
10072 if we have line numbers but no functions (as can
10073 happen in assembly source). */
10074
10075 struct bound_minimal_symbol msym;
10076 struct cleanup *old_chain = save_current_space_and_thread ();
10077
10078 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (sal->pspace);
10079
10080 msym = lookup_minimal_symbol_by_pc (sal->pc);
10081 if (msym.minsym)
10082 sal->section = MSYMBOL_OBJ_SECTION (msym.objfile, msym.minsym);
10083
10084 do_cleanups (old_chain);
10085 }
10086 }
10087 }
10088 }
10089
10090 void
10091 break_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
10092 {
10093 break_command_1 (arg, 0, from_tty);
10094 }
10095
10096 void
10097 tbreak_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
10098 {
10099 break_command_1 (arg, BP_TEMPFLAG, from_tty);
10100 }
10101
10102 static void
10103 hbreak_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
10104 {
10105 break_command_1 (arg, BP_HARDWAREFLAG, from_tty);
10106 }
10107
10108 static void
10109 thbreak_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
10110 {
10111 break_command_1 (arg, (BP_TEMPFLAG | BP_HARDWAREFLAG), from_tty);
10112 }
10113
10114 static void
10115 stop_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
10116 {
10117 printf_filtered (_("Specify the type of breakpoint to set.\n\
10118 Usage: stop in <function | address>\n\
10119 stop at <line>\n"));
10120 }
10121
10122 static void
10123 stopin_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
10124 {
10125 int badInput = 0;
10126
10127 if (arg == (char *) NULL)
10128 badInput = 1;
10129 else if (*arg != '*')
10130 {
10131 char *argptr = arg;
10132 int hasColon = 0;
10133
10134 /* Look for a ':'. If this is a line number specification, then
10135 say it is bad, otherwise, it should be an address or
10136 function/method name. */
10137 while (*argptr && !hasColon)
10138 {
10139 hasColon = (*argptr == ':');
10140 argptr++;
10141 }
10142
10143 if (hasColon)
10144 badInput = (*argptr != ':'); /* Not a class::method */
10145 else
10146 badInput = isdigit (*arg); /* a simple line number */
10147 }
10148
10149 if (badInput)
10150 printf_filtered (_("Usage: stop in <function | address>\n"));
10151 else
10152 break_command_1 (arg, 0, from_tty);
10153 }
10154
10155 static void
10156 stopat_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
10157 {
10158 int badInput = 0;
10159
10160 if (arg == (char *) NULL || *arg == '*') /* no line number */
10161 badInput = 1;
10162 else
10163 {
10164 char *argptr = arg;
10165 int hasColon = 0;
10166
10167 /* Look for a ':'. If there is a '::' then get out, otherwise
10168 it is probably a line number. */
10169 while (*argptr && !hasColon)
10170 {
10171 hasColon = (*argptr == ':');
10172 argptr++;
10173 }
10174
10175 if (hasColon)
10176 badInput = (*argptr == ':'); /* we have class::method */
10177 else
10178 badInput = !isdigit (*arg); /* not a line number */
10179 }
10180
10181 if (badInput)
10182 printf_filtered (_("Usage: stop at <line>\n"));
10183 else
10184 break_command_1 (arg, 0, from_tty);
10185 }
10186
10187 /* The dynamic printf command is mostly like a regular breakpoint, but
10188 with a prewired command list consisting of a single output command,
10189 built from extra arguments supplied on the dprintf command
10190 line. */
10191
10192 static void
10193 dprintf_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
10194 {
10195 struct event_location *location;
10196 struct cleanup *cleanup;
10197
10198 location = string_to_event_location (&arg, current_language);
10199 cleanup = make_cleanup_delete_event_location (location);
10200
10201 /* If non-NULL, ARG should have been advanced past the location;
10202 the next character must be ','. */
10203 if (arg != NULL)
10204 {
10205 if (arg[0] != ',' || arg[1] == '\0')
10206 error (_("Format string required"));
10207 else
10208 {
10209 /* Skip the comma. */
10210 ++arg;
10211 }
10212 }
10213
10214 create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
10215 location,
10216 NULL, 0, arg, 1 /* parse arg */,
10217 0, bp_dprintf,
10218 0 /* Ignore count */,
10219 pending_break_support,
10220 &dprintf_breakpoint_ops,
10221 from_tty,
10222 1 /* enabled */,
10223 0 /* internal */,
10224 0);
10225 do_cleanups (cleanup);
10226 }
10227
10228 static void
10229 agent_printf_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
10230 {
10231 error (_("May only run agent-printf on the target"));
10232 }
10233
10234 /* Implement the "breakpoint_hit" breakpoint_ops method for
10235 ranged breakpoints. */
10236
10237 static int
10238 breakpoint_hit_ranged_breakpoint (const struct bp_location *bl,
10239 struct address_space *aspace,
10240 CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
10241 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
10242 {
10243 if (ws->kind != TARGET_WAITKIND_STOPPED
10244 || ws->value.sig != GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP)
10245 return 0;
10246
10247 return breakpoint_address_match_range (bl->pspace->aspace, bl->address,
10248 bl->length, aspace, bp_addr);
10249 }
10250
10251 /* Implement the "resources_needed" breakpoint_ops method for
10252 ranged breakpoints. */
10253
10254 static int
10255 resources_needed_ranged_breakpoint (const struct bp_location *bl)
10256 {
10257 return target_ranged_break_num_registers ();
10258 }
10259
10260 /* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for
10261 ranged breakpoints. */
10262
10263 static enum print_stop_action
10264 print_it_ranged_breakpoint (bpstat bs)
10265 {
10266 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
10267 struct bp_location *bl = b->loc;
10268 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
10269
10270 gdb_assert (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint);
10271
10272 /* Ranged breakpoints have only one location. */
10273 gdb_assert (bl && bl->next == NULL);
10274
10275 annotate_breakpoint (b->number);
10276
10277 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout);
10278
10279 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
10280 ui_out_text (uiout, "Temporary ranged breakpoint ");
10281 else
10282 ui_out_text (uiout, "Ranged breakpoint ");
10283 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
10284 {
10285 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "reason",
10286 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_BREAKPOINT_HIT));
10287 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
10288 }
10289 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "bkptno", b->number);
10290 ui_out_text (uiout, ", ");
10291
10292 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
10293 }
10294
10295 /* Implement the "print_one" breakpoint_ops method for
10296 ranged breakpoints. */
10297
10298 static void
10299 print_one_ranged_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
10300 struct bp_location **last_loc)
10301 {
10302 struct bp_location *bl = b->loc;
10303 struct value_print_options opts;
10304 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
10305
10306 /* Ranged breakpoints have only one location. */
10307 gdb_assert (bl && bl->next == NULL);
10308
10309 get_user_print_options (&opts);
10310
10311 if (opts.addressprint)
10312 /* We don't print the address range here, it will be printed later
10313 by print_one_detail_ranged_breakpoint. */
10314 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "addr");
10315 annotate_field (5);
10316 print_breakpoint_location (b, bl);
10317 *last_loc = bl;
10318 }
10319
10320 /* Implement the "print_one_detail" breakpoint_ops method for
10321 ranged breakpoints. */
10322
10323 static void
10324 print_one_detail_ranged_breakpoint (const struct breakpoint *b,
10325 struct ui_out *uiout)
10326 {
10327 CORE_ADDR address_start, address_end;
10328 struct bp_location *bl = b->loc;
10329 struct ui_file *stb = mem_fileopen ();
10330 struct cleanup *cleanup = make_cleanup_ui_file_delete (stb);
10331
10332 gdb_assert (bl);
10333
10334 address_start = bl->address;
10335 address_end = address_start + bl->length - 1;
10336
10337 ui_out_text (uiout, "\taddress range: ");
10338 fprintf_unfiltered (stb, "[%s, %s]",
10339 print_core_address (bl->gdbarch, address_start),
10340 print_core_address (bl->gdbarch, address_end));
10341 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "addr", stb);
10342 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
10343
10344 do_cleanups (cleanup);
10345 }
10346
10347 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for
10348 ranged breakpoints. */
10349
10350 static void
10351 print_mention_ranged_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
10352 {
10353 struct bp_location *bl = b->loc;
10354 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
10355
10356 gdb_assert (bl);
10357 gdb_assert (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint);
10358
10359 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
10360 return;
10361
10362 printf_filtered (_("Hardware assisted ranged breakpoint %d from %s to %s."),
10363 b->number, paddress (bl->gdbarch, bl->address),
10364 paddress (bl->gdbarch, bl->address + bl->length - 1));
10365 }
10366
10367 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for
10368 ranged breakpoints. */
10369
10370 static void
10371 print_recreate_ranged_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
10372 {
10373 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "break-range %s, %s",
10374 event_location_to_string (b->location),
10375 event_location_to_string (b->location_range_end));
10376 print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
10377 }
10378
10379 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in ranged breakpoints. */
10380
10381 static struct breakpoint_ops ranged_breakpoint_ops;
10382
10383 /* Find the address where the end of the breakpoint range should be
10384 placed, given the SAL of the end of the range. This is so that if
10385 the user provides a line number, the end of the range is set to the
10386 last instruction of the given line. */
10387
10388 static CORE_ADDR
10389 find_breakpoint_range_end (struct symtab_and_line sal)
10390 {
10391 CORE_ADDR end;
10392
10393 /* If the user provided a PC value, use it. Otherwise,
10394 find the address of the end of the given location. */
10395 if (sal.explicit_pc)
10396 end = sal.pc;
10397 else
10398 {
10399 int ret;
10400 CORE_ADDR start;
10401
10402 ret = find_line_pc_range (sal, &start, &end);
10403 if (!ret)
10404 error (_("Could not find location of the end of the range."));
10405
10406 /* find_line_pc_range returns the start of the next line. */
10407 end--;
10408 }
10409
10410 return end;
10411 }
10412
10413 /* Implement the "break-range" CLI command. */
10414
10415 static void
10416 break_range_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
10417 {
10418 char *arg_start, *addr_string_start;
10419 struct linespec_result canonical_start, canonical_end;
10420 int bp_count, can_use_bp, length;
10421 CORE_ADDR end;
10422 struct breakpoint *b;
10423 struct symtab_and_line sal_start, sal_end;
10424 struct cleanup *cleanup_bkpt;
10425 struct linespec_sals *lsal_start, *lsal_end;
10426 struct event_location *start_location, *end_location;
10427
10428 /* We don't support software ranged breakpoints. */
10429 if (target_ranged_break_num_registers () < 0)
10430 error (_("This target does not support hardware ranged breakpoints."));
10431
10432 bp_count = hw_breakpoint_used_count ();
10433 bp_count += target_ranged_break_num_registers ();
10434 can_use_bp = target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (bp_hardware_breakpoint,
10435 bp_count, 0);
10436 if (can_use_bp < 0)
10437 error (_("Hardware breakpoints used exceeds limit."));
10438
10439 arg = skip_spaces (arg);
10440 if (arg == NULL || arg[0] == '\0')
10441 error(_("No address range specified."));
10442
10443 init_linespec_result (&canonical_start);
10444
10445 arg_start = arg;
10446 start_location = string_to_event_location (&arg, current_language);
10447 cleanup_bkpt = make_cleanup_delete_event_location (start_location);
10448 parse_breakpoint_sals (start_location, &canonical_start);
10449 make_cleanup_destroy_linespec_result (&canonical_start);
10450
10451 if (arg[0] != ',')
10452 error (_("Too few arguments."));
10453 else if (VEC_empty (linespec_sals, canonical_start.sals))
10454 error (_("Could not find location of the beginning of the range."));
10455
10456 lsal_start = VEC_index (linespec_sals, canonical_start.sals, 0);
10457
10458 if (VEC_length (linespec_sals, canonical_start.sals) > 1
10459 || lsal_start->sals.nelts != 1)
10460 error (_("Cannot create a ranged breakpoint with multiple locations."));
10461
10462 sal_start = lsal_start->sals.sals[0];
10463 addr_string_start = savestring (arg_start, arg - arg_start);
10464 make_cleanup (xfree, addr_string_start);
10465
10466 arg++; /* Skip the comma. */
10467 arg = skip_spaces (arg);
10468
10469 /* Parse the end location. */
10470
10471 init_linespec_result (&canonical_end);
10472 arg_start = arg;
10473
10474 /* We call decode_line_full directly here instead of using
10475 parse_breakpoint_sals because we need to specify the start location's
10476 symtab and line as the default symtab and line for the end of the
10477 range. This makes it possible to have ranges like "foo.c:27, +14",
10478 where +14 means 14 lines from the start location. */
10479 end_location = string_to_event_location (&arg, current_language);
10480 make_cleanup_delete_event_location (end_location);
10481 decode_line_full (end_location, DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE, NULL,
10482 sal_start.symtab, sal_start.line,
10483 &canonical_end, NULL, NULL);
10484
10485 make_cleanup_destroy_linespec_result (&canonical_end);
10486
10487 if (VEC_empty (linespec_sals, canonical_end.sals))
10488 error (_("Could not find location of the end of the range."));
10489
10490 lsal_end = VEC_index (linespec_sals, canonical_end.sals, 0);
10491 if (VEC_length (linespec_sals, canonical_end.sals) > 1
10492 || lsal_end->sals.nelts != 1)
10493 error (_("Cannot create a ranged breakpoint with multiple locations."));
10494
10495 sal_end = lsal_end->sals.sals[0];
10496
10497 end = find_breakpoint_range_end (sal_end);
10498 if (sal_start.pc > end)
10499 error (_("Invalid address range, end precedes start."));
10500
10501 length = end - sal_start.pc + 1;
10502 if (length < 0)
10503 /* Length overflowed. */
10504 error (_("Address range too large."));
10505 else if (length == 1)
10506 {
10507 /* This range is simple enough to be handled by
10508 the `hbreak' command. */
10509 hbreak_command (addr_string_start, 1);
10510
10511 do_cleanups (cleanup_bkpt);
10512
10513 return;
10514 }
10515
10516 /* Now set up the breakpoint. */
10517 b = set_raw_breakpoint (get_current_arch (), sal_start,
10518 bp_hardware_breakpoint, &ranged_breakpoint_ops);
10519 set_breakpoint_count (breakpoint_count + 1);
10520 b->number = breakpoint_count;
10521 b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
10522 b->location = copy_event_location (start_location);
10523 b->location_range_end = copy_event_location (end_location);
10524 b->loc->length = length;
10525
10526 do_cleanups (cleanup_bkpt);
10527
10528 mention (b);
10529 observer_notify_breakpoint_created (b);
10530 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
10531 }
10532
10533 /* Return non-zero if EXP is verified as constant. Returned zero
10534 means EXP is variable. Also the constant detection may fail for
10535 some constant expressions and in such case still falsely return
10536 zero. */
10537
10538 static int
10539 watchpoint_exp_is_const (const struct expression *exp)
10540 {
10541 int i = exp->nelts;
10542
10543 while (i > 0)
10544 {
10545 int oplenp, argsp;
10546
10547 /* We are only interested in the descriptor of each element. */
10548 operator_length (exp, i, &oplenp, &argsp);
10549 i -= oplenp;
10550
10551 switch (exp->elts[i].opcode)
10552 {
10553 case BINOP_ADD:
10554 case BINOP_SUB:
10555 case BINOP_MUL:
10556 case BINOP_DIV:
10557 case BINOP_REM:
10558 case BINOP_MOD:
10559 case BINOP_LSH:
10560 case BINOP_RSH:
10561 case BINOP_LOGICAL_AND:
10562 case BINOP_LOGICAL_OR:
10563 case BINOP_BITWISE_AND:
10564 case BINOP_BITWISE_IOR:
10565 case BINOP_BITWISE_XOR:
10566 case BINOP_EQUAL:
10567 case BINOP_NOTEQUAL:
10568 case BINOP_LESS:
10569 case BINOP_GTR:
10570 case BINOP_LEQ:
10571 case BINOP_GEQ:
10572 case BINOP_REPEAT:
10573 case BINOP_COMMA:
10574 case BINOP_EXP:
10575 case BINOP_MIN:
10576 case BINOP_MAX:
10577 case BINOP_INTDIV:
10578 case BINOP_CONCAT:
10579 case TERNOP_COND:
10580 case TERNOP_SLICE:
10581
10582 case OP_LONG:
10583 case OP_DOUBLE:
10584 case OP_DECFLOAT:
10585 case OP_LAST:
10586 case OP_COMPLEX:
10587 case OP_STRING:
10588 case OP_ARRAY:
10589 case OP_TYPE:
10590 case OP_TYPEOF:
10591 case OP_DECLTYPE:
10592 case OP_TYPEID:
10593 case OP_NAME:
10594 case OP_OBJC_NSSTRING:
10595
10596 case UNOP_NEG:
10597 case UNOP_LOGICAL_NOT:
10598 case UNOP_COMPLEMENT:
10599 case UNOP_ADDR:
10600 case UNOP_HIGH:
10601 case UNOP_CAST:
10602
10603 case UNOP_CAST_TYPE:
10604 case UNOP_REINTERPRET_CAST:
10605 case UNOP_DYNAMIC_CAST:
10606 /* Unary, binary and ternary operators: We have to check
10607 their operands. If they are constant, then so is the
10608 result of that operation. For instance, if A and B are
10609 determined to be constants, then so is "A + B".
10610
10611 UNOP_IND is one exception to the rule above, because the
10612 value of *ADDR is not necessarily a constant, even when
10613 ADDR is. */
10614 break;
10615
10616 case OP_VAR_VALUE:
10617 /* Check whether the associated symbol is a constant.
10618
10619 We use SYMBOL_CLASS rather than TYPE_CONST because it's
10620 possible that a buggy compiler could mark a variable as
10621 constant even when it is not, and TYPE_CONST would return
10622 true in this case, while SYMBOL_CLASS wouldn't.
10623
10624 We also have to check for function symbols because they
10625 are always constant. */
10626 {
10627 struct symbol *s = exp->elts[i + 2].symbol;
10628
10629 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (s) != LOC_BLOCK
10630 && SYMBOL_CLASS (s) != LOC_CONST
10631 && SYMBOL_CLASS (s) != LOC_CONST_BYTES)
10632 return 0;
10633 break;
10634 }
10635
10636 /* The default action is to return 0 because we are using
10637 the optimistic approach here: If we don't know something,
10638 then it is not a constant. */
10639 default:
10640 return 0;
10641 }
10642 }
10643
10644 return 1;
10645 }
10646
10647 /* Implement the "dtor" breakpoint_ops method for watchpoints. */
10648
10649 static void
10650 dtor_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *self)
10651 {
10652 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) self;
10653
10654 xfree (w->cond_exp);
10655 xfree (w->exp);
10656 xfree (w->exp_string);
10657 xfree (w->exp_string_reparse);
10658 value_free (w->val);
10659
10660 base_breakpoint_ops.dtor (self);
10661 }
10662
10663 /* Implement the "re_set" breakpoint_ops method for watchpoints. */
10664
10665 static void
10666 re_set_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
10667 {
10668 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10669
10670 /* Watchpoint can be either on expression using entirely global
10671 variables, or it can be on local variables.
10672
10673 Watchpoints of the first kind are never auto-deleted, and even
10674 persist across program restarts. Since they can use variables
10675 from shared libraries, we need to reparse expression as libraries
10676 are loaded and unloaded.
10677
10678 Watchpoints on local variables can also change meaning as result
10679 of solib event. For example, if a watchpoint uses both a local
10680 and a global variables in expression, it's a local watchpoint,
10681 but unloading of a shared library will make the expression
10682 invalid. This is not a very common use case, but we still
10683 re-evaluate expression, to avoid surprises to the user.
10684
10685 Note that for local watchpoints, we re-evaluate it only if
10686 watchpoints frame id is still valid. If it's not, it means the
10687 watchpoint is out of scope and will be deleted soon. In fact,
10688 I'm not sure we'll ever be called in this case.
10689
10690 If a local watchpoint's frame id is still valid, then
10691 w->exp_valid_block is likewise valid, and we can safely use it.
10692
10693 Don't do anything about disabled watchpoints, since they will be
10694 reevaluated again when enabled. */
10695 update_watchpoint (w, 1 /* reparse */);
10696 }
10697
10698 /* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for hardware watchpoints. */
10699
10700 static int
10701 insert_watchpoint (struct bp_location *bl)
10702 {
10703 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner;
10704 int length = w->exact ? 1 : bl->length;
10705
10706 return target_insert_watchpoint (bl->address, length, bl->watchpoint_type,
10707 w->cond_exp);
10708 }
10709
10710 /* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for hardware watchpoints. */
10711
10712 static int
10713 remove_watchpoint (struct bp_location *bl, enum remove_bp_reason reason)
10714 {
10715 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner;
10716 int length = w->exact ? 1 : bl->length;
10717
10718 return target_remove_watchpoint (bl->address, length, bl->watchpoint_type,
10719 w->cond_exp);
10720 }
10721
10722 static int
10723 breakpoint_hit_watchpoint (const struct bp_location *bl,
10724 struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
10725 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
10726 {
10727 struct breakpoint *b = bl->owner;
10728 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10729
10730 /* Continuable hardware watchpoints are treated as non-existent if the
10731 reason we stopped wasn't a hardware watchpoint (we didn't stop on
10732 some data address). Otherwise gdb won't stop on a break instruction
10733 in the code (not from a breakpoint) when a hardware watchpoint has
10734 been defined. Also skip watchpoints which we know did not trigger
10735 (did not match the data address). */
10736 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b)
10737 && w->watchpoint_triggered == watch_triggered_no)
10738 return 0;
10739
10740 return 1;
10741 }
10742
10743 static void
10744 check_status_watchpoint (bpstat bs)
10745 {
10746 gdb_assert (is_watchpoint (bs->breakpoint_at));
10747
10748 bpstat_check_watchpoint (bs);
10749 }
10750
10751 /* Implement the "resources_needed" breakpoint_ops method for
10752 hardware watchpoints. */
10753
10754 static int
10755 resources_needed_watchpoint (const struct bp_location *bl)
10756 {
10757 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner;
10758 int length = w->exact? 1 : bl->length;
10759
10760 return target_region_ok_for_hw_watchpoint (bl->address, length);
10761 }
10762
10763 /* Implement the "works_in_software_mode" breakpoint_ops method for
10764 hardware watchpoints. */
10765
10766 static int
10767 works_in_software_mode_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *b)
10768 {
10769 /* Read and access watchpoints only work with hardware support. */
10770 return b->type == bp_watchpoint || b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint;
10771 }
10772
10773 static enum print_stop_action
10774 print_it_watchpoint (bpstat bs)
10775 {
10776 struct cleanup *old_chain;
10777 struct breakpoint *b;
10778 struct ui_file *stb;
10779 enum print_stop_action result;
10780 struct watchpoint *w;
10781 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
10782
10783 gdb_assert (bs->bp_location_at != NULL);
10784
10785 b = bs->breakpoint_at;
10786 w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10787
10788 stb = mem_fileopen ();
10789 old_chain = make_cleanup_ui_file_delete (stb);
10790
10791 annotate_watchpoint (b->number);
10792 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout);
10793
10794 switch (b->type)
10795 {
10796 case bp_watchpoint:
10797 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
10798 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
10799 ui_out_field_string
10800 (uiout, "reason",
10801 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
10802 mention (b);
10803 make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "value");
10804 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nOld value = ");
10805 watchpoint_value_print (bs->old_val, stb);
10806 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "old", stb);
10807 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nNew value = ");
10808 watchpoint_value_print (w->val, stb);
10809 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "new", stb);
10810 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
10811 /* More than one watchpoint may have been triggered. */
10812 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
10813 break;
10814
10815 case bp_read_watchpoint:
10816 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
10817 ui_out_field_string
10818 (uiout, "reason",
10819 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_READ_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
10820 mention (b);
10821 make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "value");
10822 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nValue = ");
10823 watchpoint_value_print (w->val, stb);
10824 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "value", stb);
10825 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
10826 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
10827 break;
10828
10829 case bp_access_watchpoint:
10830 if (bs->old_val != NULL)
10831 {
10832 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
10833 ui_out_field_string
10834 (uiout, "reason",
10835 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
10836 mention (b);
10837 make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "value");
10838 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nOld value = ");
10839 watchpoint_value_print (bs->old_val, stb);
10840 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "old", stb);
10841 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nNew value = ");
10842 }
10843 else
10844 {
10845 mention (b);
10846 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
10847 ui_out_field_string
10848 (uiout, "reason",
10849 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
10850 make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "value");
10851 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nValue = ");
10852 }
10853 watchpoint_value_print (w->val, stb);
10854 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "new", stb);
10855 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
10856 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
10857 break;
10858 default:
10859 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
10860 }
10861
10862 do_cleanups (old_chain);
10863 return result;
10864 }
10865
10866 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for hardware
10867 watchpoints. */
10868
10869 static void
10870 print_mention_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
10871 {
10872 struct cleanup *ui_out_chain;
10873 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10874 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
10875
10876 switch (b->type)
10877 {
10878 case bp_watchpoint:
10879 ui_out_text (uiout, "Watchpoint ");
10880 ui_out_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "wpt");
10881 break;
10882 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
10883 ui_out_text (uiout, "Hardware watchpoint ");
10884 ui_out_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "wpt");
10885 break;
10886 case bp_read_watchpoint:
10887 ui_out_text (uiout, "Hardware read watchpoint ");
10888 ui_out_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "hw-rwpt");
10889 break;
10890 case bp_access_watchpoint:
10891 ui_out_text (uiout, "Hardware access (read/write) watchpoint ");
10892 ui_out_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "hw-awpt");
10893 break;
10894 default:
10895 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
10896 _("Invalid hardware watchpoint type."));
10897 }
10898
10899 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "number", b->number);
10900 ui_out_text (uiout, ": ");
10901 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "exp", w->exp_string);
10902 do_cleanups (ui_out_chain);
10903 }
10904
10905 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for
10906 watchpoints. */
10907
10908 static void
10909 print_recreate_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
10910 {
10911 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10912
10913 switch (b->type)
10914 {
10915 case bp_watchpoint:
10916 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
10917 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "watch");
10918 break;
10919 case bp_read_watchpoint:
10920 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "rwatch");
10921 break;
10922 case bp_access_watchpoint:
10923 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "awatch");
10924 break;
10925 default:
10926 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
10927 _("Invalid watchpoint type."));
10928 }
10929
10930 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s", w->exp_string);
10931 print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
10932 }
10933
10934 /* Implement the "explains_signal" breakpoint_ops method for
10935 watchpoints. */
10936
10937 static int
10938 explains_signal_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b, enum gdb_signal sig)
10939 {
10940 /* A software watchpoint cannot cause a signal other than
10941 GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP. */
10942 if (b->type == bp_watchpoint && sig != GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP)
10943 return 0;
10944
10945 return 1;
10946 }
10947
10948 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in hardware watchpoints. */
10949
10950 static struct breakpoint_ops watchpoint_breakpoint_ops;
10951
10952 /* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for
10953 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10954
10955 static int
10956 insert_masked_watchpoint (struct bp_location *bl)
10957 {
10958 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner;
10959
10960 return target_insert_mask_watchpoint (bl->address, w->hw_wp_mask,
10961 bl->watchpoint_type);
10962 }
10963
10964 /* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for
10965 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10966
10967 static int
10968 remove_masked_watchpoint (struct bp_location *bl, enum remove_bp_reason reason)
10969 {
10970 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner;
10971
10972 return target_remove_mask_watchpoint (bl->address, w->hw_wp_mask,
10973 bl->watchpoint_type);
10974 }
10975
10976 /* Implement the "resources_needed" breakpoint_ops method for
10977 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10978
10979 static int
10980 resources_needed_masked_watchpoint (const struct bp_location *bl)
10981 {
10982 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner;
10983
10984 return target_masked_watch_num_registers (bl->address, w->hw_wp_mask);
10985 }
10986
10987 /* Implement the "works_in_software_mode" breakpoint_ops method for
10988 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10989
10990 static int
10991 works_in_software_mode_masked_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *b)
10992 {
10993 return 0;
10994 }
10995
10996 /* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for
10997 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10998
10999 static enum print_stop_action
11000 print_it_masked_watchpoint (bpstat bs)
11001 {
11002 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
11003 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
11004
11005 /* Masked watchpoints have only one location. */
11006 gdb_assert (b->loc && b->loc->next == NULL);
11007
11008 annotate_watchpoint (b->number);
11009 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout);
11010
11011 switch (b->type)
11012 {
11013 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
11014 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
11015 ui_out_field_string
11016 (uiout, "reason",
11017 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
11018 break;
11019
11020 case bp_read_watchpoint:
11021 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
11022 ui_out_field_string
11023 (uiout, "reason",
11024 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_READ_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
11025 break;
11026
11027 case bp_access_watchpoint:
11028 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
11029 ui_out_field_string
11030 (uiout, "reason",
11031 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
11032 break;
11033 default:
11034 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
11035 _("Invalid hardware watchpoint type."));
11036 }
11037
11038 mention (b);
11039 ui_out_text (uiout, _("\n\
11040 Check the underlying instruction at PC for the memory\n\
11041 address and value which triggered this watchpoint.\n"));
11042 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
11043
11044 /* More than one watchpoint may have been triggered. */
11045 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
11046 }
11047
11048 /* Implement the "print_one_detail" breakpoint_ops method for
11049 masked hardware watchpoints. */
11050
11051 static void
11052 print_one_detail_masked_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *b,
11053 struct ui_out *uiout)
11054 {
11055 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
11056
11057 /* Masked watchpoints have only one location. */
11058 gdb_assert (b->loc && b->loc->next == NULL);
11059
11060 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tmask ");
11061 ui_out_field_core_addr (uiout, "mask", b->loc->gdbarch, w->hw_wp_mask);
11062 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
11063 }
11064
11065 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for
11066 masked hardware watchpoints. */
11067
11068 static void
11069 print_mention_masked_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
11070 {
11071 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
11072 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
11073 struct cleanup *ui_out_chain;
11074
11075 switch (b->type)
11076 {
11077 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
11078 ui_out_text (uiout, "Masked hardware watchpoint ");
11079 ui_out_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "wpt");
11080 break;
11081 case bp_read_watchpoint:
11082 ui_out_text (uiout, "Masked hardware read watchpoint ");
11083 ui_out_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "hw-rwpt");
11084 break;
11085 case bp_access_watchpoint:
11086 ui_out_text (uiout, "Masked hardware access (read/write) watchpoint ");
11087 ui_out_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "hw-awpt");
11088 break;
11089 default:
11090 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
11091 _("Invalid hardware watchpoint type."));
11092 }
11093
11094 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "number", b->number);
11095 ui_out_text (uiout, ": ");
11096 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "exp", w->exp_string);
11097 do_cleanups (ui_out_chain);
11098 }
11099
11100 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for
11101 masked hardware watchpoints. */
11102
11103 static void
11104 print_recreate_masked_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
11105 {
11106 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
11107 char tmp[40];
11108
11109 switch (b->type)
11110 {
11111 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
11112 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "watch");
11113 break;
11114 case bp_read_watchpoint:
11115 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "rwatch");
11116 break;
11117 case bp_access_watchpoint:
11118 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "awatch");
11119 break;
11120 default:
11121 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
11122 _("Invalid hardware watchpoint type."));
11123 }
11124
11125 sprintf_vma (tmp, w->hw_wp_mask);
11126 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s mask 0x%s", w->exp_string, tmp);
11127 print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
11128 }
11129
11130 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in masked hardware watchpoints. */
11131
11132 static struct breakpoint_ops masked_watchpoint_breakpoint_ops;
11133
11134 /* Tell whether the given watchpoint is a masked hardware watchpoint. */
11135
11136 static int
11137 is_masked_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *b)
11138 {
11139 return b->ops == &masked_watchpoint_breakpoint_ops;
11140 }
11141
11142 /* accessflag: hw_write: watch write,
11143 hw_read: watch read,
11144 hw_access: watch access (read or write) */
11145 static void
11146 watch_command_1 (const char *arg, int accessflag, int from_tty,
11147 int just_location, int internal)
11148 {
11149 struct breakpoint *b, *scope_breakpoint = NULL;
11150 struct expression *exp;
11151 const struct block *exp_valid_block = NULL, *cond_exp_valid_block = NULL;
11152 struct value *val, *mark, *result;
11153 int saved_bitpos = 0, saved_bitsize = 0;
11154 struct frame_info *frame;
11155 const char *exp_start = NULL;
11156 const char *exp_end = NULL;
11157 const char *tok, *end_tok;
11158 int toklen = -1;
11159 const char *cond_start = NULL;
11160 const char *cond_end = NULL;
11161 enum bptype bp_type;
11162 int thread = -1;
11163 int pc = 0;
11164 /* Flag to indicate whether we are going to use masks for
11165 the hardware watchpoint. */
11166 int use_mask = 0;
11167 CORE_ADDR mask = 0;
11168 struct watchpoint *w;
11169 char *expression;
11170 struct cleanup *back_to;
11171
11172 /* Make sure that we actually have parameters to parse. */
11173 if (arg != NULL && arg[0] != '\0')
11174 {
11175 const char *value_start;
11176
11177 exp_end = arg + strlen (arg);
11178
11179 /* Look for "parameter value" pairs at the end
11180 of the arguments string. */
11181 for (tok = exp_end - 1; tok > arg; tok--)
11182 {
11183 /* Skip whitespace at the end of the argument list. */
11184 while (tok > arg && (*tok == ' ' || *tok == '\t'))
11185 tok--;
11186
11187 /* Find the beginning of the last token.
11188 This is the value of the parameter. */
11189 while (tok > arg && (*tok != ' ' && *tok != '\t'))
11190 tok--;
11191 value_start = tok + 1;
11192
11193 /* Skip whitespace. */
11194 while (tok > arg && (*tok == ' ' || *tok == '\t'))
11195 tok--;
11196
11197 end_tok = tok;
11198
11199 /* Find the beginning of the second to last token.
11200 This is the parameter itself. */
11201 while (tok > arg && (*tok != ' ' && *tok != '\t'))
11202 tok--;
11203 tok++;
11204 toklen = end_tok - tok + 1;
11205
11206 if (toklen == 6 && startswith (tok, "thread"))
11207 {
11208 struct thread_info *thr;
11209 /* At this point we've found a "thread" token, which means
11210 the user is trying to set a watchpoint that triggers
11211 only in a specific thread. */
11212 const char *endp;
11213
11214 if (thread != -1)
11215 error(_("You can specify only one thread."));
11216
11217 /* Extract the thread ID from the next token. */
11218 thr = parse_thread_id (value_start, &endp);
11219
11220 /* Check if the user provided a valid thread ID. */
11221 if (*endp != ' ' && *endp != '\t' && *endp != '\0')
11222 invalid_thread_id_error (value_start);
11223
11224 thread = thr->global_num;
11225 }
11226 else if (toklen == 4 && startswith (tok, "mask"))
11227 {
11228 /* We've found a "mask" token, which means the user wants to
11229 create a hardware watchpoint that is going to have the mask
11230 facility. */
11231 struct value *mask_value, *mark;
11232
11233 if (use_mask)
11234 error(_("You can specify only one mask."));
11235
11236 use_mask = just_location = 1;
11237
11238 mark = value_mark ();
11239 mask_value = parse_to_comma_and_eval (&value_start);
11240 mask = value_as_address (mask_value);
11241 value_free_to_mark (mark);
11242 }
11243 else
11244 /* We didn't recognize what we found. We should stop here. */
11245 break;
11246
11247 /* Truncate the string and get rid of the "parameter value" pair before
11248 the arguments string is parsed by the parse_exp_1 function. */
11249 exp_end = tok;
11250 }
11251 }
11252 else
11253 exp_end = arg;
11254
11255 /* Parse the rest of the arguments. From here on out, everything
11256 is in terms of a newly allocated string instead of the original
11257 ARG. */
11258 innermost_block = NULL;
11259 expression = savestring (arg, exp_end - arg);
11260 back_to = make_cleanup (xfree, expression);
11261 exp_start = arg = expression;
11262 exp = parse_exp_1 (&arg, 0, 0, 0);
11263 exp_end = arg;
11264 /* Remove trailing whitespace from the expression before saving it.
11265 This makes the eventual display of the expression string a bit
11266 prettier. */
11267 while (exp_end > exp_start && (exp_end[-1] == ' ' || exp_end[-1] == '\t'))
11268 --exp_end;
11269
11270 /* Checking if the expression is not constant. */
11271 if (watchpoint_exp_is_const (exp))
11272 {
11273 int len;
11274
11275 len = exp_end - exp_start;
11276 while (len > 0 && isspace (exp_start[len - 1]))
11277 len--;
11278 error (_("Cannot watch constant value `%.*s'."), len, exp_start);
11279 }
11280
11281 exp_valid_block = innermost_block;
11282 mark = value_mark ();
11283 fetch_subexp_value (exp, &pc, &val, &result, NULL, just_location);
11284
11285 if (val != NULL && just_location)
11286 {
11287 saved_bitpos = value_bitpos (val);
11288 saved_bitsize = value_bitsize (val);
11289 }
11290
11291 if (just_location)
11292 {
11293 int ret;
11294
11295 exp_valid_block = NULL;
11296 val = value_addr (result);
11297 release_value (val);
11298 value_free_to_mark (mark);
11299
11300 if (use_mask)
11301 {
11302 ret = target_masked_watch_num_registers (value_as_address (val),
11303 mask);
11304 if (ret == -1)
11305 error (_("This target does not support masked watchpoints."));
11306 else if (ret == -2)
11307 error (_("Invalid mask or memory region."));
11308 }
11309 }
11310 else if (val != NULL)
11311 release_value (val);
11312
11313 tok = skip_spaces_const (arg);
11314 end_tok = skip_to_space_const (tok);
11315
11316 toklen = end_tok - tok;
11317 if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "if", toklen) == 0)
11318 {
11319 struct expression *cond;
11320
11321 innermost_block = NULL;
11322 tok = cond_start = end_tok + 1;
11323 cond = parse_exp_1 (&tok, 0, 0, 0);
11324
11325 /* The watchpoint expression may not be local, but the condition
11326 may still be. E.g.: `watch global if local > 0'. */
11327 cond_exp_valid_block = innermost_block;
11328
11329 xfree (cond);
11330 cond_end = tok;
11331 }
11332 if (*tok)
11333 error (_("Junk at end of command."));
11334
11335 frame = block_innermost_frame (exp_valid_block);
11336
11337 /* If the expression is "local", then set up a "watchpoint scope"
11338 breakpoint at the point where we've left the scope of the watchpoint
11339 expression. Create the scope breakpoint before the watchpoint, so
11340 that we will encounter it first in bpstat_stop_status. */
11341 if (exp_valid_block && frame)
11342 {
11343 if (frame_id_p (frame_unwind_caller_id (frame)))
11344 {
11345 scope_breakpoint
11346 = create_internal_breakpoint (frame_unwind_caller_arch (frame),
11347 frame_unwind_caller_pc (frame),
11348 bp_watchpoint_scope,
11349 &momentary_breakpoint_ops);
11350
11351 scope_breakpoint->enable_state = bp_enabled;
11352
11353 /* Automatically delete the breakpoint when it hits. */
11354 scope_breakpoint->disposition = disp_del;
11355
11356 /* Only break in the proper frame (help with recursion). */
11357 scope_breakpoint->frame_id = frame_unwind_caller_id (frame);
11358
11359 /* Set the address at which we will stop. */
11360 scope_breakpoint->loc->gdbarch
11361 = frame_unwind_caller_arch (frame);
11362 scope_breakpoint->loc->requested_address
11363 = frame_unwind_caller_pc (frame);
11364 scope_breakpoint->loc->address
11365 = adjust_breakpoint_address (scope_breakpoint->loc->gdbarch,
11366 scope_breakpoint->loc->requested_address,
11367 scope_breakpoint->type);
11368 }
11369 }
11370
11371 /* Now set up the breakpoint. We create all watchpoints as hardware
11372 watchpoints here even if hardware watchpoints are turned off, a call
11373 to update_watchpoint later in this function will cause the type to
11374 drop back to bp_watchpoint (software watchpoint) if required. */
11375
11376 if (accessflag == hw_read)
11377 bp_type = bp_read_watchpoint;
11378 else if (accessflag == hw_access)
11379 bp_type = bp_access_watchpoint;
11380 else
11381 bp_type = bp_hardware_watchpoint;
11382
11383 w = XCNEW (struct watchpoint);
11384 b = &w->base;
11385 if (use_mask)
11386 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (b, NULL, bp_type,
11387 &masked_watchpoint_breakpoint_ops);
11388 else
11389 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (b, NULL, bp_type,
11390 &watchpoint_breakpoint_ops);
11391 b->thread = thread;
11392 b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
11393 b->pspace = current_program_space;
11394 w->exp = exp;
11395 w->exp_valid_block = exp_valid_block;
11396 w->cond_exp_valid_block = cond_exp_valid_block;
11397 if (just_location)
11398 {
11399 struct type *t = value_type (val);
11400 CORE_ADDR addr = value_as_address (val);
11401 char *name;
11402
11403 t = check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (check_typedef (t)));
11404 name = type_to_string (t);
11405
11406 w->exp_string_reparse = xstrprintf ("* (%s *) %s", name,
11407 core_addr_to_string (addr));
11408 xfree (name);
11409
11410 w->exp_string = xstrprintf ("-location %.*s",
11411 (int) (exp_end - exp_start), exp_start);
11412
11413 /* The above expression is in C. */
11414 b->language = language_c;
11415 }
11416 else
11417 w->exp_string = savestring (exp_start, exp_end - exp_start);
11418
11419 if (use_mask)
11420 {
11421 w->hw_wp_mask = mask;
11422 }
11423 else
11424 {
11425 w->val = val;
11426 w->val_bitpos = saved_bitpos;
11427 w->val_bitsize = saved_bitsize;
11428 w->val_valid = 1;
11429 }
11430
11431 if (cond_start)
11432 b->cond_string = savestring (cond_start, cond_end - cond_start);
11433 else
11434 b->cond_string = 0;
11435
11436 if (frame)
11437 {
11438 w->watchpoint_frame = get_frame_id (frame);
11439 w->watchpoint_thread = inferior_ptid;
11440 }
11441 else
11442 {
11443 w->watchpoint_frame = null_frame_id;
11444 w->watchpoint_thread = null_ptid;
11445 }
11446
11447 if (scope_breakpoint != NULL)
11448 {
11449 /* The scope breakpoint is related to the watchpoint. We will
11450 need to act on them together. */
11451 b->related_breakpoint = scope_breakpoint;
11452 scope_breakpoint->related_breakpoint = b;
11453 }
11454
11455 if (!just_location)
11456 value_free_to_mark (mark);
11457
11458 TRY
11459 {
11460 /* Finally update the new watchpoint. This creates the locations
11461 that should be inserted. */
11462 update_watchpoint (w, 1);
11463 }
11464 CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ALL)
11465 {
11466 delete_breakpoint (b);
11467 throw_exception (e);
11468 }
11469 END_CATCH
11470
11471 install_breakpoint (internal, b, 1);
11472 do_cleanups (back_to);
11473 }
11474
11475 /* Return count of debug registers needed to watch the given expression.
11476 If the watchpoint cannot be handled in hardware return zero. */
11477
11478 static int
11479 can_use_hardware_watchpoint (struct value *v)
11480 {
11481 int found_memory_cnt = 0;
11482 struct value *head = v;
11483
11484 /* Did the user specifically forbid us to use hardware watchpoints? */
11485 if (!can_use_hw_watchpoints)
11486 return 0;
11487
11488 /* Make sure that the value of the expression depends only upon
11489 memory contents, and values computed from them within GDB. If we
11490 find any register references or function calls, we can't use a
11491 hardware watchpoint.
11492
11493 The idea here is that evaluating an expression generates a series
11494 of values, one holding the value of every subexpression. (The
11495 expression a*b+c has five subexpressions: a, b, a*b, c, and
11496 a*b+c.) GDB's values hold almost enough information to establish
11497 the criteria given above --- they identify memory lvalues,
11498 register lvalues, computed values, etcetera. So we can evaluate
11499 the expression, and then scan the chain of values that leaves
11500 behind to decide whether we can detect any possible change to the
11501 expression's final value using only hardware watchpoints.
11502
11503 However, I don't think that the values returned by inferior
11504 function calls are special in any way. So this function may not
11505 notice that an expression involving an inferior function call
11506 can't be watched with hardware watchpoints. FIXME. */
11507 for (; v; v = value_next (v))
11508 {
11509 if (VALUE_LVAL (v) == lval_memory)
11510 {
11511 if (v != head && value_lazy (v))
11512 /* A lazy memory lvalue in the chain is one that GDB never
11513 needed to fetch; we either just used its address (e.g.,
11514 `a' in `a.b') or we never needed it at all (e.g., `a'
11515 in `a,b'). This doesn't apply to HEAD; if that is
11516 lazy then it was not readable, but watch it anyway. */
11517 ;
11518 else
11519 {
11520 /* Ahh, memory we actually used! Check if we can cover
11521 it with hardware watchpoints. */
11522 struct type *vtype = check_typedef (value_type (v));
11523
11524 /* We only watch structs and arrays if user asked for it
11525 explicitly, never if they just happen to appear in a
11526 middle of some value chain. */
11527 if (v == head
11528 || (TYPE_CODE (vtype) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
11529 && TYPE_CODE (vtype) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY))
11530 {
11531 CORE_ADDR vaddr = value_address (v);
11532 int len;
11533 int num_regs;
11534
11535 len = (target_exact_watchpoints
11536 && is_scalar_type_recursive (vtype))?
11537 1 : TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (v));
11538
11539 num_regs = target_region_ok_for_hw_watchpoint (vaddr, len);
11540 if (!num_regs)
11541 return 0;
11542 else
11543 found_memory_cnt += num_regs;
11544 }
11545 }
11546 }
11547 else if (VALUE_LVAL (v) != not_lval
11548 && deprecated_value_modifiable (v) == 0)
11549 return 0; /* These are values from the history (e.g., $1). */
11550 else if (VALUE_LVAL (v) == lval_register)
11551 return 0; /* Cannot watch a register with a HW watchpoint. */
11552 }
11553
11554 /* The expression itself looks suitable for using a hardware
11555 watchpoint, but give the target machine a chance to reject it. */
11556 return found_memory_cnt;
11557 }
11558
11559 void
11560 watch_command_wrapper (char *arg, int from_tty, int internal)
11561 {
11562 watch_command_1 (arg, hw_write, from_tty, 0, internal);
11563 }
11564
11565 /* A helper function that looks for the "-location" argument and then
11566 calls watch_command_1. */
11567
11568 static void
11569 watch_maybe_just_location (char *arg, int accessflag, int from_tty)
11570 {
11571 int just_location = 0;
11572
11573 if (arg
11574 && (check_for_argument (&arg, "-location", sizeof ("-location") - 1)
11575 || check_for_argument (&arg, "-l", sizeof ("-l") - 1)))
11576 {
11577 arg = skip_spaces (arg);
11578 just_location = 1;
11579 }
11580
11581 watch_command_1 (arg, accessflag, from_tty, just_location, 0);
11582 }
11583
11584 static void
11585 watch_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
11586 {
11587 watch_maybe_just_location (arg, hw_write, from_tty);
11588 }
11589
11590 void
11591 rwatch_command_wrapper (char *arg, int from_tty, int internal)
11592 {
11593 watch_command_1 (arg, hw_read, from_tty, 0, internal);
11594 }
11595
11596 static void
11597 rwatch_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
11598 {
11599 watch_maybe_just_location (arg, hw_read, from_tty);
11600 }
11601
11602 void
11603 awatch_command_wrapper (char *arg, int from_tty, int internal)
11604 {
11605 watch_command_1 (arg, hw_access, from_tty, 0, internal);
11606 }
11607
11608 static void
11609 awatch_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
11610 {
11611 watch_maybe_just_location (arg, hw_access, from_tty);
11612 }
11613 \f
11614
11615 /* Data for the FSM that manages the until(location)/advance commands
11616 in infcmd.c. Here because it uses the mechanisms of
11617 breakpoints. */
11618
11619 struct until_break_fsm
11620 {
11621 /* The base class. */
11622 struct thread_fsm thread_fsm;
11623
11624 /* The thread that as current when the command was executed. */
11625 int thread;
11626
11627 /* The breakpoint set at the destination location. */
11628 struct breakpoint *location_breakpoint;
11629
11630 /* Breakpoint set at the return address in the caller frame. May be
11631 NULL. */
11632 struct breakpoint *caller_breakpoint;
11633 };
11634
11635 static void until_break_fsm_clean_up (struct thread_fsm *self,
11636 struct thread_info *thread);
11637 static int until_break_fsm_should_stop (struct thread_fsm *self,
11638 struct thread_info *thread);
11639 static enum async_reply_reason
11640 until_break_fsm_async_reply_reason (struct thread_fsm *self);
11641
11642 /* until_break_fsm's vtable. */
11643
11644 static struct thread_fsm_ops until_break_fsm_ops =
11645 {
11646 NULL, /* dtor */
11647 until_break_fsm_clean_up,
11648 until_break_fsm_should_stop,
11649 NULL, /* return_value */
11650 until_break_fsm_async_reply_reason,
11651 };
11652
11653 /* Allocate a new until_break_command_fsm. */
11654
11655 static struct until_break_fsm *
11656 new_until_break_fsm (struct interp *cmd_interp, int thread,
11657 struct breakpoint *location_breakpoint,
11658 struct breakpoint *caller_breakpoint)
11659 {
11660 struct until_break_fsm *sm;
11661
11662 sm = XCNEW (struct until_break_fsm);
11663 thread_fsm_ctor (&sm->thread_fsm, &until_break_fsm_ops, cmd_interp);
11664
11665 sm->thread = thread;
11666 sm->location_breakpoint = location_breakpoint;
11667 sm->caller_breakpoint = caller_breakpoint;
11668
11669 return sm;
11670 }
11671
11672 /* Implementation of the 'should_stop' FSM method for the
11673 until(location)/advance commands. */
11674
11675 static int
11676 until_break_fsm_should_stop (struct thread_fsm *self,
11677 struct thread_info *tp)
11678 {
11679 struct until_break_fsm *sm = (struct until_break_fsm *) self;
11680
11681 if (bpstat_find_breakpoint (tp->control.stop_bpstat,
11682 sm->location_breakpoint) != NULL
11683 || (sm->caller_breakpoint != NULL
11684 && bpstat_find_breakpoint (tp->control.stop_bpstat,
11685 sm->caller_breakpoint) != NULL))
11686 thread_fsm_set_finished (self);
11687
11688 return 1;
11689 }
11690
11691 /* Implementation of the 'clean_up' FSM method for the
11692 until(location)/advance commands. */
11693
11694 static void
11695 until_break_fsm_clean_up (struct thread_fsm *self,
11696 struct thread_info *thread)
11697 {
11698 struct until_break_fsm *sm = (struct until_break_fsm *) self;
11699
11700 /* Clean up our temporary breakpoints. */
11701 if (sm->location_breakpoint != NULL)
11702 {
11703 delete_breakpoint (sm->location_breakpoint);
11704 sm->location_breakpoint = NULL;
11705 }
11706 if (sm->caller_breakpoint != NULL)
11707 {
11708 delete_breakpoint (sm->caller_breakpoint);
11709 sm->caller_breakpoint = NULL;
11710 }
11711 delete_longjmp_breakpoint (sm->thread);
11712 }
11713
11714 /* Implementation of the 'async_reply_reason' FSM method for the
11715 until(location)/advance commands. */
11716
11717 static enum async_reply_reason
11718 until_break_fsm_async_reply_reason (struct thread_fsm *self)
11719 {
11720 return EXEC_ASYNC_LOCATION_REACHED;
11721 }
11722
11723 void
11724 until_break_command (char *arg, int from_tty, int anywhere)
11725 {
11726 struct symtabs_and_lines sals;
11727 struct symtab_and_line sal;
11728 struct frame_info *frame;
11729 struct gdbarch *frame_gdbarch;
11730 struct frame_id stack_frame_id;
11731 struct frame_id caller_frame_id;
11732 struct breakpoint *location_breakpoint;
11733 struct breakpoint *caller_breakpoint = NULL;
11734 struct cleanup *old_chain, *cleanup;
11735 int thread;
11736 struct thread_info *tp;
11737 struct event_location *location;
11738 struct until_break_fsm *sm;
11739
11740 clear_proceed_status (0);
11741
11742 /* Set a breakpoint where the user wants it and at return from
11743 this function. */
11744
11745 location = string_to_event_location (&arg, current_language);
11746 cleanup = make_cleanup_delete_event_location (location);
11747
11748 if (last_displayed_sal_is_valid ())
11749 sals = decode_line_1 (location, DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE, NULL,
11750 get_last_displayed_symtab (),
11751 get_last_displayed_line ());
11752 else
11753 sals = decode_line_1 (location, DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE,
11754 NULL, (struct symtab *) NULL, 0);
11755
11756 if (sals.nelts != 1)
11757 error (_("Couldn't get information on specified line."));
11758
11759 sal = sals.sals[0];
11760 xfree (sals.sals); /* malloc'd, so freed. */
11761
11762 if (*arg)
11763 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
11764
11765 resolve_sal_pc (&sal);
11766
11767 tp = inferior_thread ();
11768 thread = tp->global_num;
11769
11770 old_chain = make_cleanup (null_cleanup, NULL);
11771
11772 /* Note linespec handling above invalidates the frame chain.
11773 Installing a breakpoint also invalidates the frame chain (as it
11774 may need to switch threads), so do any frame handling before
11775 that. */
11776
11777 frame = get_selected_frame (NULL);
11778 frame_gdbarch = get_frame_arch (frame);
11779 stack_frame_id = get_stack_frame_id (frame);
11780 caller_frame_id = frame_unwind_caller_id (frame);
11781
11782 /* Keep within the current frame, or in frames called by the current
11783 one. */
11784
11785 if (frame_id_p (caller_frame_id))
11786 {
11787 struct symtab_and_line sal2;
11788 struct gdbarch *caller_gdbarch;
11789
11790 sal2 = find_pc_line (frame_unwind_caller_pc (frame), 0);
11791 sal2.pc = frame_unwind_caller_pc (frame);
11792 caller_gdbarch = frame_unwind_caller_arch (frame);
11793 caller_breakpoint = set_momentary_breakpoint (caller_gdbarch,
11794 sal2,
11795 caller_frame_id,
11796 bp_until);
11797 make_cleanup_delete_breakpoint (caller_breakpoint);
11798
11799 set_longjmp_breakpoint (tp, caller_frame_id);
11800 make_cleanup (delete_longjmp_breakpoint_cleanup, &thread);
11801 }
11802
11803 /* set_momentary_breakpoint could invalidate FRAME. */
11804 frame = NULL;
11805
11806 if (anywhere)
11807 /* If the user told us to continue until a specified location,
11808 we don't specify a frame at which we need to stop. */
11809 location_breakpoint = set_momentary_breakpoint (frame_gdbarch, sal,
11810 null_frame_id, bp_until);
11811 else
11812 /* Otherwise, specify the selected frame, because we want to stop
11813 only at the very same frame. */
11814 location_breakpoint = set_momentary_breakpoint (frame_gdbarch, sal,
11815 stack_frame_id, bp_until);
11816 make_cleanup_delete_breakpoint (location_breakpoint);
11817
11818 sm = new_until_break_fsm (command_interp (), tp->global_num,
11819 location_breakpoint, caller_breakpoint);
11820 tp->thread_fsm = &sm->thread_fsm;
11821
11822 discard_cleanups (old_chain);
11823
11824 proceed (-1, GDB_SIGNAL_DEFAULT);
11825
11826 do_cleanups (cleanup);
11827 }
11828
11829 /* This function attempts to parse an optional "if <cond>" clause
11830 from the arg string. If one is not found, it returns NULL.
11831
11832 Else, it returns a pointer to the condition string. (It does not
11833 attempt to evaluate the string against a particular block.) And,
11834 it updates arg to point to the first character following the parsed
11835 if clause in the arg string. */
11836
11837 char *
11838 ep_parse_optional_if_clause (char **arg)
11839 {
11840 char *cond_string;
11841
11842 if (((*arg)[0] != 'i') || ((*arg)[1] != 'f') || !isspace ((*arg)[2]))
11843 return NULL;
11844
11845 /* Skip the "if" keyword. */
11846 (*arg) += 2;
11847
11848 /* Skip any extra leading whitespace, and record the start of the
11849 condition string. */
11850 *arg = skip_spaces (*arg);
11851 cond_string = *arg;
11852
11853 /* Assume that the condition occupies the remainder of the arg
11854 string. */
11855 (*arg) += strlen (cond_string);
11856
11857 return cond_string;
11858 }
11859
11860 /* Commands to deal with catching events, such as signals, exceptions,
11861 process start/exit, etc. */
11862
11863 typedef enum
11864 {
11865 catch_fork_temporary, catch_vfork_temporary,
11866 catch_fork_permanent, catch_vfork_permanent
11867 }
11868 catch_fork_kind;
11869
11870 static void
11871 catch_fork_command_1 (char *arg, int from_tty,
11872 struct cmd_list_element *command)
11873 {
11874 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
11875 char *cond_string = NULL;
11876 catch_fork_kind fork_kind;
11877 int tempflag;
11878
11879 fork_kind = (catch_fork_kind) (uintptr_t) get_cmd_context (command);
11880 tempflag = (fork_kind == catch_fork_temporary
11881 || fork_kind == catch_vfork_temporary);
11882
11883 if (!arg)
11884 arg = "";
11885 arg = skip_spaces (arg);
11886
11887 /* The allowed syntax is:
11888 catch [v]fork
11889 catch [v]fork if <cond>
11890
11891 First, check if there's an if clause. */
11892 cond_string = ep_parse_optional_if_clause (&arg);
11893
11894 if ((*arg != '\0') && !isspace (*arg))
11895 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
11896
11897 /* If this target supports it, create a fork or vfork catchpoint
11898 and enable reporting of such events. */
11899 switch (fork_kind)
11900 {
11901 case catch_fork_temporary:
11902 case catch_fork_permanent:
11903 create_fork_vfork_event_catchpoint (gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string,
11904 &catch_fork_breakpoint_ops);
11905 break;
11906 case catch_vfork_temporary:
11907 case catch_vfork_permanent:
11908 create_fork_vfork_event_catchpoint (gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string,
11909 &catch_vfork_breakpoint_ops);
11910 break;
11911 default:
11912 error (_("unsupported or unknown fork kind; cannot catch it"));
11913 break;
11914 }
11915 }
11916
11917 static void
11918 catch_exec_command_1 (char *arg, int from_tty,
11919 struct cmd_list_element *command)
11920 {
11921 struct exec_catchpoint *c;
11922 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
11923 int tempflag;
11924 char *cond_string = NULL;
11925
11926 tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
11927
11928 if (!arg)
11929 arg = "";
11930 arg = skip_spaces (arg);
11931
11932 /* The allowed syntax is:
11933 catch exec
11934 catch exec if <cond>
11935
11936 First, check if there's an if clause. */
11937 cond_string = ep_parse_optional_if_clause (&arg);
11938
11939 if ((*arg != '\0') && !isspace (*arg))
11940 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
11941
11942 c = XNEW (struct exec_catchpoint);
11943 init_catchpoint (&c->base, gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string,
11944 &catch_exec_breakpoint_ops);
11945 c->exec_pathname = NULL;
11946
11947 install_breakpoint (0, &c->base, 1);
11948 }
11949
11950 void
11951 init_ada_exception_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
11952 struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
11953 struct symtab_and_line sal,
11954 char *addr_string,
11955 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
11956 int tempflag,
11957 int enabled,
11958 int from_tty)
11959 {
11960 if (from_tty)
11961 {
11962 struct gdbarch *loc_gdbarch = get_sal_arch (sal);
11963 if (!loc_gdbarch)
11964 loc_gdbarch = gdbarch;
11965
11966 describe_other_breakpoints (loc_gdbarch,
11967 sal.pspace, sal.pc, sal.section, -1);
11968 /* FIXME: brobecker/2006-12-28: Actually, re-implement a special
11969 version for exception catchpoints, because two catchpoints
11970 used for different exception names will use the same address.
11971 In this case, a "breakpoint ... also set at..." warning is
11972 unproductive. Besides, the warning phrasing is also a bit
11973 inappropriate, we should use the word catchpoint, and tell
11974 the user what type of catchpoint it is. The above is good
11975 enough for now, though. */
11976 }
11977
11978 init_raw_breakpoint (b, gdbarch, sal, bp_breakpoint, ops);
11979
11980 b->enable_state = enabled ? bp_enabled : bp_disabled;
11981 b->disposition = tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch;
11982 b->location = string_to_event_location (&addr_string,
11983 language_def (language_ada));
11984 b->language = language_ada;
11985 }
11986
11987 static void
11988 catch_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
11989 {
11990 error (_("Catch requires an event name."));
11991 }
11992 \f
11993
11994 static void
11995 tcatch_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
11996 {
11997 error (_("Catch requires an event name."));
11998 }
11999
12000 /* A qsort comparison function that sorts breakpoints in order. */
12001
12002 static int
12003 compare_breakpoints (const void *a, const void *b)
12004 {
12005 const breakpoint_p *ba = (const breakpoint_p *) a;
12006 uintptr_t ua = (uintptr_t) *ba;
12007 const breakpoint_p *bb = (const breakpoint_p *) b;
12008 uintptr_t ub = (uintptr_t) *bb;
12009
12010 if ((*ba)->number < (*bb)->number)
12011 return -1;
12012 else if ((*ba)->number > (*bb)->number)
12013 return 1;
12014
12015 /* Now sort by address, in case we see, e..g, two breakpoints with
12016 the number 0. */
12017 if (ua < ub)
12018 return -1;
12019 return ua > ub ? 1 : 0;
12020 }
12021
12022 /* Delete breakpoints by address or line. */
12023
12024 static void
12025 clear_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
12026 {
12027 struct breakpoint *b, *prev;
12028 VEC(breakpoint_p) *found = 0;
12029 int ix;
12030 int default_match;
12031 struct symtabs_and_lines sals;
12032 struct symtab_and_line sal;
12033 int i;
12034 struct cleanup *cleanups = make_cleanup (null_cleanup, NULL);
12035
12036 if (arg)
12037 {
12038 sals = decode_line_with_current_source (arg,
12039 (DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE
12040 | DECODE_LINE_LIST_MODE));
12041 make_cleanup (xfree, sals.sals);
12042 default_match = 0;
12043 }
12044 else
12045 {
12046 sals.sals = XNEW (struct symtab_and_line);
12047 make_cleanup (xfree, sals.sals);
12048 init_sal (&sal); /* Initialize to zeroes. */
12049
12050 /* Set sal's line, symtab, pc, and pspace to the values
12051 corresponding to the last call to print_frame_info. If the
12052 codepoint is not valid, this will set all the fields to 0. */
12053 get_last_displayed_sal (&sal);
12054 if (sal.symtab == 0)
12055 error (_("No source file specified."));
12056
12057 sals.sals[0] = sal;
12058 sals.nelts = 1;
12059
12060 default_match = 1;
12061 }
12062
12063 /* We don't call resolve_sal_pc here. That's not as bad as it
12064 seems, because all existing breakpoints typically have both
12065 file/line and pc set. So, if clear is given file/line, we can
12066 match this to existing breakpoint without obtaining pc at all.
12067
12068 We only support clearing given the address explicitly
12069 present in breakpoint table. Say, we've set breakpoint
12070 at file:line. There were several PC values for that file:line,
12071 due to optimization, all in one block.
12072
12073 We've picked one PC value. If "clear" is issued with another
12074 PC corresponding to the same file:line, the breakpoint won't
12075 be cleared. We probably can still clear the breakpoint, but
12076 since the other PC value is never presented to user, user
12077 can only find it by guessing, and it does not seem important
12078 to support that. */
12079
12080 /* For each line spec given, delete bps which correspond to it. Do
12081 it in two passes, solely to preserve the current behavior that
12082 from_tty is forced true if we delete more than one
12083 breakpoint. */
12084
12085 found = NULL;
12086 make_cleanup (VEC_cleanup (breakpoint_p), &found);
12087 for (i = 0; i < sals.nelts; i++)
12088 {
12089 const char *sal_fullname;
12090
12091 /* If exact pc given, clear bpts at that pc.
12092 If line given (pc == 0), clear all bpts on specified line.
12093 If defaulting, clear all bpts on default line
12094 or at default pc.
12095
12096 defaulting sal.pc != 0 tests to do
12097
12098 0 1 pc
12099 1 1 pc _and_ line
12100 0 0 line
12101 1 0 <can't happen> */
12102
12103 sal = sals.sals[i];
12104 sal_fullname = (sal.symtab == NULL
12105 ? NULL : symtab_to_fullname (sal.symtab));
12106
12107 /* Find all matching breakpoints and add them to 'found'. */
12108 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
12109 {
12110 int match = 0;
12111 /* Are we going to delete b? */
12112 if (b->type != bp_none && !is_watchpoint (b))
12113 {
12114 struct bp_location *loc = b->loc;
12115 for (; loc; loc = loc->next)
12116 {
12117 /* If the user specified file:line, don't allow a PC
12118 match. This matches historical gdb behavior. */
12119 int pc_match = (!sal.explicit_line
12120 && sal.pc
12121 && (loc->pspace == sal.pspace)
12122 && (loc->address == sal.pc)
12123 && (!section_is_overlay (loc->section)
12124 || loc->section == sal.section));
12125 int line_match = 0;
12126
12127 if ((default_match || sal.explicit_line)
12128 && loc->symtab != NULL
12129 && sal_fullname != NULL
12130 && sal.pspace == loc->pspace
12131 && loc->line_number == sal.line
12132 && filename_cmp (symtab_to_fullname (loc->symtab),
12133 sal_fullname) == 0)
12134 line_match = 1;
12135
12136 if (pc_match || line_match)
12137 {
12138 match = 1;
12139 break;
12140 }
12141 }
12142 }
12143
12144 if (match)
12145 VEC_safe_push(breakpoint_p, found, b);
12146 }
12147 }
12148
12149 /* Now go thru the 'found' chain and delete them. */
12150 if (VEC_empty(breakpoint_p, found))
12151 {
12152 if (arg)
12153 error (_("No breakpoint at %s."), arg);
12154 else
12155 error (_("No breakpoint at this line."));
12156 }
12157
12158 /* Remove duplicates from the vec. */
12159 qsort (VEC_address (breakpoint_p, found),
12160 VEC_length (breakpoint_p, found),
12161 sizeof (breakpoint_p),
12162 compare_breakpoints);
12163 prev = VEC_index (breakpoint_p, found, 0);
12164 for (ix = 1; VEC_iterate (breakpoint_p, found, ix, b); ++ix)
12165 {
12166 if (b == prev)
12167 {
12168 VEC_ordered_remove (breakpoint_p, found, ix);
12169 --ix;
12170 }
12171 }
12172
12173 if (VEC_length(breakpoint_p, found) > 1)
12174 from_tty = 1; /* Always report if deleted more than one. */
12175 if (from_tty)
12176 {
12177 if (VEC_length(breakpoint_p, found) == 1)
12178 printf_unfiltered (_("Deleted breakpoint "));
12179 else
12180 printf_unfiltered (_("Deleted breakpoints "));
12181 }
12182
12183 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate(breakpoint_p, found, ix, b); ix++)
12184 {
12185 if (from_tty)
12186 printf_unfiltered ("%d ", b->number);
12187 delete_breakpoint (b);
12188 }
12189 if (from_tty)
12190 putchar_unfiltered ('\n');
12191
12192 do_cleanups (cleanups);
12193 }
12194 \f
12195 /* Delete breakpoint in BS if they are `delete' breakpoints and
12196 all breakpoints that are marked for deletion, whether hit or not.
12197 This is called after any breakpoint is hit, or after errors. */
12198
12199 void
12200 breakpoint_auto_delete (bpstat bs)
12201 {
12202 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
12203
12204 for (; bs; bs = bs->next)
12205 if (bs->breakpoint_at
12206 && bs->breakpoint_at->disposition == disp_del
12207 && bs->stop)
12208 delete_breakpoint (bs->breakpoint_at);
12209
12210 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
12211 {
12212 if (b->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
12213 delete_breakpoint (b);
12214 }
12215 }
12216
12217 /* A comparison function for bp_location AP and BP being interfaced to
12218 qsort. Sort elements primarily by their ADDRESS (no matter what
12219 does breakpoint_address_is_meaningful say for its OWNER),
12220 secondarily by ordering first permanent elements and
12221 terciarily just ensuring the array is sorted stable way despite
12222 qsort being an unstable algorithm. */
12223
12224 static int
12225 bp_location_compare (const void *ap, const void *bp)
12226 {
12227 const struct bp_location *a = *(const struct bp_location **) ap;
12228 const struct bp_location *b = *(const struct bp_location **) bp;
12229
12230 if (a->address != b->address)
12231 return (a->address > b->address) - (a->address < b->address);
12232
12233 /* Sort locations at the same address by their pspace number, keeping
12234 locations of the same inferior (in a multi-inferior environment)
12235 grouped. */
12236
12237 if (a->pspace->num != b->pspace->num)
12238 return ((a->pspace->num > b->pspace->num)
12239 - (a->pspace->num < b->pspace->num));
12240
12241 /* Sort permanent breakpoints first. */
12242 if (a->permanent != b->permanent)
12243 return (a->permanent < b->permanent) - (a->permanent > b->permanent);
12244
12245 /* Make the internal GDB representation stable across GDB runs
12246 where A and B memory inside GDB can differ. Breakpoint locations of
12247 the same type at the same address can be sorted in arbitrary order. */
12248
12249 if (a->owner->number != b->owner->number)
12250 return ((a->owner->number > b->owner->number)
12251 - (a->owner->number < b->owner->number));
12252
12253 return (a > b) - (a < b);
12254 }
12255
12256 /* Set bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max and
12257 bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max according to the current
12258 content of the bp_location array. */
12259
12260 static void
12261 bp_location_target_extensions_update (void)
12262 {
12263 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
12264
12265 bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max = 0;
12266 bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max = 0;
12267
12268 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
12269 {
12270 CORE_ADDR start, end, addr;
12271
12272 if (!bp_location_has_shadow (bl))
12273 continue;
12274
12275 start = bl->target_info.placed_address;
12276 end = start + bl->target_info.shadow_len;
12277
12278 gdb_assert (bl->address >= start);
12279 addr = bl->address - start;
12280 if (addr > bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max)
12281 bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max = addr;
12282
12283 /* Zero SHADOW_LEN would not pass bp_location_has_shadow. */
12284
12285 gdb_assert (bl->address < end);
12286 addr = end - bl->address;
12287 if (addr > bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max)
12288 bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max = addr;
12289 }
12290 }
12291
12292 /* Download tracepoint locations if they haven't been. */
12293
12294 static void
12295 download_tracepoint_locations (void)
12296 {
12297 struct breakpoint *b;
12298 struct cleanup *old_chain;
12299 enum tribool can_download_tracepoint = TRIBOOL_UNKNOWN;
12300
12301 old_chain = save_current_space_and_thread ();
12302
12303 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (b)
12304 {
12305 struct bp_location *bl;
12306 struct tracepoint *t;
12307 int bp_location_downloaded = 0;
12308
12309 if ((b->type == bp_fast_tracepoint
12310 ? !may_insert_fast_tracepoints
12311 : !may_insert_tracepoints))
12312 continue;
12313
12314 if (can_download_tracepoint == TRIBOOL_UNKNOWN)
12315 {
12316 if (target_can_download_tracepoint ())
12317 can_download_tracepoint = TRIBOOL_TRUE;
12318 else
12319 can_download_tracepoint = TRIBOOL_FALSE;
12320 }
12321
12322 if (can_download_tracepoint == TRIBOOL_FALSE)
12323 break;
12324
12325 for (bl = b->loc; bl; bl = bl->next)
12326 {
12327 /* In tracepoint, locations are _never_ duplicated, so
12328 should_be_inserted is equivalent to
12329 unduplicated_should_be_inserted. */
12330 if (!should_be_inserted (bl) || bl->inserted)
12331 continue;
12332
12333 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (bl->pspace);
12334
12335 target_download_tracepoint (bl);
12336
12337 bl->inserted = 1;
12338 bp_location_downloaded = 1;
12339 }
12340 t = (struct tracepoint *) b;
12341 t->number_on_target = b->number;
12342 if (bp_location_downloaded)
12343 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b);
12344 }
12345
12346 do_cleanups (old_chain);
12347 }
12348
12349 /* Swap the insertion/duplication state between two locations. */
12350
12351 static void
12352 swap_insertion (struct bp_location *left, struct bp_location *right)
12353 {
12354 const int left_inserted = left->inserted;
12355 const int left_duplicate = left->duplicate;
12356 const int left_needs_update = left->needs_update;
12357 const struct bp_target_info left_target_info = left->target_info;
12358
12359 /* Locations of tracepoints can never be duplicated. */
12360 if (is_tracepoint (left->owner))
12361 gdb_assert (!left->duplicate);
12362 if (is_tracepoint (right->owner))
12363 gdb_assert (!right->duplicate);
12364
12365 left->inserted = right->inserted;
12366 left->duplicate = right->duplicate;
12367 left->needs_update = right->needs_update;
12368 left->target_info = right->target_info;
12369 right->inserted = left_inserted;
12370 right->duplicate = left_duplicate;
12371 right->needs_update = left_needs_update;
12372 right->target_info = left_target_info;
12373 }
12374
12375 /* Force the re-insertion of the locations at ADDRESS. This is called
12376 once a new/deleted/modified duplicate location is found and we are evaluating
12377 conditions on the target's side. Such conditions need to be updated on
12378 the target. */
12379
12380 static void
12381 force_breakpoint_reinsertion (struct bp_location *bl)
12382 {
12383 struct bp_location **locp = NULL, **loc2p;
12384 struct bp_location *loc;
12385 CORE_ADDR address = 0;
12386 int pspace_num;
12387
12388 address = bl->address;
12389 pspace_num = bl->pspace->num;
12390
12391 /* This is only meaningful if the target is
12392 evaluating conditions and if the user has
12393 opted for condition evaluation on the target's
12394 side. */
12395 if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
12396 || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
12397 return;
12398
12399 /* Flag all breakpoint locations with this address and
12400 the same program space as the location
12401 as "its condition has changed". We need to
12402 update the conditions on the target's side. */
12403 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, address)
12404 {
12405 loc = *loc2p;
12406
12407 if (!is_breakpoint (loc->owner)
12408 || pspace_num != loc->pspace->num)
12409 continue;
12410
12411 /* Flag the location appropriately. We use a different state to
12412 let everyone know that we already updated the set of locations
12413 with addr bl->address and program space bl->pspace. This is so
12414 we don't have to keep calling these functions just to mark locations
12415 that have already been marked. */
12416 loc->condition_changed = condition_updated;
12417
12418 /* Free the agent expression bytecode as well. We will compute
12419 it later on. */
12420 if (loc->cond_bytecode)
12421 {
12422 free_agent_expr (loc->cond_bytecode);
12423 loc->cond_bytecode = NULL;
12424 }
12425 }
12426 }
12427 /* Called whether new breakpoints are created, or existing breakpoints
12428 deleted, to update the global location list and recompute which
12429 locations are duplicate of which.
12430
12431 The INSERT_MODE flag determines whether locations may not, may, or
12432 shall be inserted now. See 'enum ugll_insert_mode' for more
12433 info. */
12434
12435 static void
12436 update_global_location_list (enum ugll_insert_mode insert_mode)
12437 {
12438 struct breakpoint *b;
12439 struct bp_location **locp, *loc;
12440 struct cleanup *cleanups;
12441 /* Last breakpoint location address that was marked for update. */
12442 CORE_ADDR last_addr = 0;
12443 /* Last breakpoint location program space that was marked for update. */
12444 int last_pspace_num = -1;
12445
12446 /* Used in the duplicates detection below. When iterating over all
12447 bp_locations, points to the first bp_location of a given address.
12448 Breakpoints and watchpoints of different types are never
12449 duplicates of each other. Keep one pointer for each type of
12450 breakpoint/watchpoint, so we only need to loop over all locations
12451 once. */
12452 struct bp_location *bp_loc_first; /* breakpoint */
12453 struct bp_location *wp_loc_first; /* hardware watchpoint */
12454 struct bp_location *awp_loc_first; /* access watchpoint */
12455 struct bp_location *rwp_loc_first; /* read watchpoint */
12456
12457 /* Saved former bp_location array which we compare against the newly
12458 built bp_location from the current state of ALL_BREAKPOINTS. */
12459 struct bp_location **old_location, **old_locp;
12460 unsigned old_location_count;
12461
12462 old_location = bp_location;
12463 old_location_count = bp_location_count;
12464 bp_location = NULL;
12465 bp_location_count = 0;
12466 cleanups = make_cleanup (xfree, old_location);
12467
12468 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
12469 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
12470 bp_location_count++;
12471
12472 bp_location = XNEWVEC (struct bp_location *, bp_location_count);
12473 locp = bp_location;
12474 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
12475 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
12476 *locp++ = loc;
12477 qsort (bp_location, bp_location_count, sizeof (*bp_location),
12478 bp_location_compare);
12479
12480 bp_location_target_extensions_update ();
12481
12482 /* Identify bp_location instances that are no longer present in the
12483 new list, and therefore should be freed. Note that it's not
12484 necessary that those locations should be removed from inferior --
12485 if there's another location at the same address (previously
12486 marked as duplicate), we don't need to remove/insert the
12487 location.
12488
12489 LOCP is kept in sync with OLD_LOCP, each pointing to the current
12490 and former bp_location array state respectively. */
12491
12492 locp = bp_location;
12493 for (old_locp = old_location; old_locp < old_location + old_location_count;
12494 old_locp++)
12495 {
12496 struct bp_location *old_loc = *old_locp;
12497 struct bp_location **loc2p;
12498
12499 /* Tells if 'old_loc' is found among the new locations. If
12500 not, we have to free it. */
12501 int found_object = 0;
12502 /* Tells if the location should remain inserted in the target. */
12503 int keep_in_target = 0;
12504 int removed = 0;
12505
12506 /* Skip LOCP entries which will definitely never be needed.
12507 Stop either at or being the one matching OLD_LOC. */
12508 while (locp < bp_location + bp_location_count
12509 && (*locp)->address < old_loc->address)
12510 locp++;
12511
12512 for (loc2p = locp;
12513 (loc2p < bp_location + bp_location_count
12514 && (*loc2p)->address == old_loc->address);
12515 loc2p++)
12516 {
12517 /* Check if this is a new/duplicated location or a duplicated
12518 location that had its condition modified. If so, we want to send
12519 its condition to the target if evaluation of conditions is taking
12520 place there. */
12521 if ((*loc2p)->condition_changed == condition_modified
12522 && (last_addr != old_loc->address
12523 || last_pspace_num != old_loc->pspace->num))
12524 {
12525 force_breakpoint_reinsertion (*loc2p);
12526 last_pspace_num = old_loc->pspace->num;
12527 }
12528
12529 if (*loc2p == old_loc)
12530 found_object = 1;
12531 }
12532
12533 /* We have already handled this address, update it so that we don't
12534 have to go through updates again. */
12535 last_addr = old_loc->address;
12536
12537 /* Target-side condition evaluation: Handle deleted locations. */
12538 if (!found_object)
12539 force_breakpoint_reinsertion (old_loc);
12540
12541 /* If this location is no longer present, and inserted, look if
12542 there's maybe a new location at the same address. If so,
12543 mark that one inserted, and don't remove this one. This is
12544 needed so that we don't have a time window where a breakpoint
12545 at certain location is not inserted. */
12546
12547 if (old_loc->inserted)
12548 {
12549 /* If the location is inserted now, we might have to remove
12550 it. */
12551
12552 if (found_object && should_be_inserted (old_loc))
12553 {
12554 /* The location is still present in the location list,
12555 and still should be inserted. Don't do anything. */
12556 keep_in_target = 1;
12557 }
12558 else
12559 {
12560 /* This location still exists, but it won't be kept in the
12561 target since it may have been disabled. We proceed to
12562 remove its target-side condition. */
12563
12564 /* The location is either no longer present, or got
12565 disabled. See if there's another location at the
12566 same address, in which case we don't need to remove
12567 this one from the target. */
12568
12569 /* OLD_LOC comes from existing struct breakpoint. */
12570 if (breakpoint_address_is_meaningful (old_loc->owner))
12571 {
12572 for (loc2p = locp;
12573 (loc2p < bp_location + bp_location_count
12574 && (*loc2p)->address == old_loc->address);
12575 loc2p++)
12576 {
12577 struct bp_location *loc2 = *loc2p;
12578
12579 if (breakpoint_locations_match (loc2, old_loc))
12580 {
12581 /* Read watchpoint locations are switched to
12582 access watchpoints, if the former are not
12583 supported, but the latter are. */
12584 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (old_loc->owner))
12585 {
12586 gdb_assert (is_hardware_watchpoint (loc2->owner));
12587 loc2->watchpoint_type = old_loc->watchpoint_type;
12588 }
12589
12590 /* loc2 is a duplicated location. We need to check
12591 if it should be inserted in case it will be
12592 unduplicated. */
12593 if (loc2 != old_loc
12594 && unduplicated_should_be_inserted (loc2))
12595 {
12596 swap_insertion (old_loc, loc2);
12597 keep_in_target = 1;
12598 break;
12599 }
12600 }
12601 }
12602 }
12603 }
12604
12605 if (!keep_in_target)
12606 {
12607 if (remove_breakpoint (old_loc))
12608 {
12609 /* This is just about all we can do. We could keep
12610 this location on the global list, and try to
12611 remove it next time, but there's no particular
12612 reason why we will succeed next time.
12613
12614 Note that at this point, old_loc->owner is still
12615 valid, as delete_breakpoint frees the breakpoint
12616 only after calling us. */
12617 printf_filtered (_("warning: Error removing "
12618 "breakpoint %d\n"),
12619 old_loc->owner->number);
12620 }
12621 removed = 1;
12622 }
12623 }
12624
12625 if (!found_object)
12626 {
12627 if (removed && target_is_non_stop_p ()
12628 && need_moribund_for_location_type (old_loc))
12629 {
12630 /* This location was removed from the target. In
12631 non-stop mode, a race condition is possible where
12632 we've removed a breakpoint, but stop events for that
12633 breakpoint are already queued and will arrive later.
12634 We apply an heuristic to be able to distinguish such
12635 SIGTRAPs from other random SIGTRAPs: we keep this
12636 breakpoint location for a bit, and will retire it
12637 after we see some number of events. The theory here
12638 is that reporting of events should, "on the average",
12639 be fair, so after a while we'll see events from all
12640 threads that have anything of interest, and no longer
12641 need to keep this breakpoint location around. We
12642 don't hold locations forever so to reduce chances of
12643 mistaking a non-breakpoint SIGTRAP for a breakpoint
12644 SIGTRAP.
12645
12646 The heuristic failing can be disastrous on
12647 decr_pc_after_break targets.
12648
12649 On decr_pc_after_break targets, like e.g., x86-linux,
12650 if we fail to recognize a late breakpoint SIGTRAP,
12651 because events_till_retirement has reached 0 too
12652 soon, we'll fail to do the PC adjustment, and report
12653 a random SIGTRAP to the user. When the user resumes
12654 the inferior, it will most likely immediately crash
12655 with SIGILL/SIGBUS/SIGSEGV, or worse, get silently
12656 corrupted, because of being resumed e.g., in the
12657 middle of a multi-byte instruction, or skipped a
12658 one-byte instruction. This was actually seen happen
12659 on native x86-linux, and should be less rare on
12660 targets that do not support new thread events, like
12661 remote, due to the heuristic depending on
12662 thread_count.
12663
12664 Mistaking a random SIGTRAP for a breakpoint trap
12665 causes similar symptoms (PC adjustment applied when
12666 it shouldn't), but then again, playing with SIGTRAPs
12667 behind the debugger's back is asking for trouble.
12668
12669 Since hardware watchpoint traps are always
12670 distinguishable from other traps, so we don't need to
12671 apply keep hardware watchpoint moribund locations
12672 around. We simply always ignore hardware watchpoint
12673 traps we can no longer explain. */
12674
12675 old_loc->events_till_retirement = 3 * (thread_count () + 1);
12676 old_loc->owner = NULL;
12677
12678 VEC_safe_push (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, old_loc);
12679 }
12680 else
12681 {
12682 old_loc->owner = NULL;
12683 decref_bp_location (&old_loc);
12684 }
12685 }
12686 }
12687
12688 /* Rescan breakpoints at the same address and section, marking the
12689 first one as "first" and any others as "duplicates". This is so
12690 that the bpt instruction is only inserted once. If we have a
12691 permanent breakpoint at the same place as BPT, make that one the
12692 official one, and the rest as duplicates. Permanent breakpoints
12693 are sorted first for the same address.
12694
12695 Do the same for hardware watchpoints, but also considering the
12696 watchpoint's type (regular/access/read) and length. */
12697
12698 bp_loc_first = NULL;
12699 wp_loc_first = NULL;
12700 awp_loc_first = NULL;
12701 rwp_loc_first = NULL;
12702 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, locp)
12703 {
12704 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has LOC->OWNER always
12705 non-NULL. */
12706 struct bp_location **loc_first_p;
12707 b = loc->owner;
12708
12709 if (!unduplicated_should_be_inserted (loc)
12710 || !breakpoint_address_is_meaningful (b)
12711 /* Don't detect duplicate for tracepoint locations because they are
12712 never duplicated. See the comments in field `duplicate' of
12713 `struct bp_location'. */
12714 || is_tracepoint (b))
12715 {
12716 /* Clear the condition modification flag. */
12717 loc->condition_changed = condition_unchanged;
12718 continue;
12719 }
12720
12721 if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
12722 loc_first_p = &wp_loc_first;
12723 else if (b->type == bp_read_watchpoint)
12724 loc_first_p = &rwp_loc_first;
12725 else if (b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
12726 loc_first_p = &awp_loc_first;
12727 else
12728 loc_first_p = &bp_loc_first;
12729
12730 if (*loc_first_p == NULL
12731 || (overlay_debugging && loc->section != (*loc_first_p)->section)
12732 || !breakpoint_locations_match (loc, *loc_first_p))
12733 {
12734 *loc_first_p = loc;
12735 loc->duplicate = 0;
12736
12737 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) && loc->condition_changed)
12738 {
12739 loc->needs_update = 1;
12740 /* Clear the condition modification flag. */
12741 loc->condition_changed = condition_unchanged;
12742 }
12743 continue;
12744 }
12745
12746
12747 /* This and the above ensure the invariant that the first location
12748 is not duplicated, and is the inserted one.
12749 All following are marked as duplicated, and are not inserted. */
12750 if (loc->inserted)
12751 swap_insertion (loc, *loc_first_p);
12752 loc->duplicate = 1;
12753
12754 /* Clear the condition modification flag. */
12755 loc->condition_changed = condition_unchanged;
12756 }
12757
12758 if (insert_mode == UGLL_INSERT || breakpoints_should_be_inserted_now ())
12759 {
12760 if (insert_mode != UGLL_DONT_INSERT)
12761 insert_breakpoint_locations ();
12762 else
12763 {
12764 /* Even though the caller told us to not insert new
12765 locations, we may still need to update conditions on the
12766 target's side of breakpoints that were already inserted
12767 if the target is evaluating breakpoint conditions. We
12768 only update conditions for locations that are marked
12769 "needs_update". */
12770 update_inserted_breakpoint_locations ();
12771 }
12772 }
12773
12774 if (insert_mode != UGLL_DONT_INSERT)
12775 download_tracepoint_locations ();
12776
12777 do_cleanups (cleanups);
12778 }
12779
12780 void
12781 breakpoint_retire_moribund (void)
12782 {
12783 struct bp_location *loc;
12784 int ix;
12785
12786 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix, loc); ++ix)
12787 if (--(loc->events_till_retirement) == 0)
12788 {
12789 decref_bp_location (&loc);
12790 VEC_unordered_remove (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix);
12791 --ix;
12792 }
12793 }
12794
12795 static void
12796 update_global_location_list_nothrow (enum ugll_insert_mode insert_mode)
12797 {
12798
12799 TRY
12800 {
12801 update_global_location_list (insert_mode);
12802 }
12803 CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
12804 {
12805 }
12806 END_CATCH
12807 }
12808
12809 /* Clear BKP from a BPS. */
12810
12811 static void
12812 bpstat_remove_bp_location (bpstat bps, struct breakpoint *bpt)
12813 {
12814 bpstat bs;
12815
12816 for (bs = bps; bs; bs = bs->next)
12817 if (bs->breakpoint_at == bpt)
12818 {
12819 bs->breakpoint_at = NULL;
12820 bs->old_val = NULL;
12821 /* bs->commands will be freed later. */
12822 }
12823 }
12824
12825 /* Callback for iterate_over_threads. */
12826 static int
12827 bpstat_remove_breakpoint_callback (struct thread_info *th, void *data)
12828 {
12829 struct breakpoint *bpt = (struct breakpoint *) data;
12830
12831 bpstat_remove_bp_location (th->control.stop_bpstat, bpt);
12832 return 0;
12833 }
12834
12835 /* Helper for breakpoint and tracepoint breakpoint_ops->mention
12836 callbacks. */
12837
12838 static void
12839 say_where (struct breakpoint *b)
12840 {
12841 struct value_print_options opts;
12842
12843 get_user_print_options (&opts);
12844
12845 /* i18n: cagney/2005-02-11: Below needs to be merged into a
12846 single string. */
12847 if (b->loc == NULL)
12848 {
12849 /* For pending locations, the output differs slightly based
12850 on b->extra_string. If this is non-NULL, it contains either
12851 a condition or dprintf arguments. */
12852 if (b->extra_string == NULL)
12853 {
12854 printf_filtered (_(" (%s) pending."),
12855 event_location_to_string (b->location));
12856 }
12857 else if (b->type == bp_dprintf)
12858 {
12859 printf_filtered (_(" (%s,%s) pending."),
12860 event_location_to_string (b->location),
12861 b->extra_string);
12862 }
12863 else
12864 {
12865 printf_filtered (_(" (%s %s) pending."),
12866 event_location_to_string (b->location),
12867 b->extra_string);
12868 }
12869 }
12870 else
12871 {
12872 if (opts.addressprint || b->loc->symtab == NULL)
12873 {
12874 printf_filtered (" at ");
12875 fputs_filtered (paddress (b->loc->gdbarch, b->loc->address),
12876 gdb_stdout);
12877 }
12878 if (b->loc->symtab != NULL)
12879 {
12880 /* If there is a single location, we can print the location
12881 more nicely. */
12882 if (b->loc->next == NULL)
12883 printf_filtered (": file %s, line %d.",
12884 symtab_to_filename_for_display (b->loc->symtab),
12885 b->loc->line_number);
12886 else
12887 /* This is not ideal, but each location may have a
12888 different file name, and this at least reflects the
12889 real situation somewhat. */
12890 printf_filtered (": %s.",
12891 event_location_to_string (b->location));
12892 }
12893
12894 if (b->loc->next)
12895 {
12896 struct bp_location *loc = b->loc;
12897 int n = 0;
12898 for (; loc; loc = loc->next)
12899 ++n;
12900 printf_filtered (" (%d locations)", n);
12901 }
12902 }
12903 }
12904
12905 /* Default bp_location_ops methods. */
12906
12907 static void
12908 bp_location_dtor (struct bp_location *self)
12909 {
12910 xfree (self->cond);
12911 if (self->cond_bytecode)
12912 free_agent_expr (self->cond_bytecode);
12913 xfree (self->function_name);
12914
12915 VEC_free (agent_expr_p, self->target_info.conditions);
12916 VEC_free (agent_expr_p, self->target_info.tcommands);
12917 }
12918
12919 static const struct bp_location_ops bp_location_ops =
12920 {
12921 bp_location_dtor
12922 };
12923
12924 /* Default breakpoint_ops methods all breakpoint_ops ultimately
12925 inherit from. */
12926
12927 static void
12928 base_breakpoint_dtor (struct breakpoint *self)
12929 {
12930 decref_counted_command_line (&self->commands);
12931 xfree (self->cond_string);
12932 xfree (self->extra_string);
12933 xfree (self->filter);
12934 delete_event_location (self->location);
12935 delete_event_location (self->location_range_end);
12936 }
12937
12938 static struct bp_location *
12939 base_breakpoint_allocate_location (struct breakpoint *self)
12940 {
12941 struct bp_location *loc;
12942
12943 loc = XNEW (struct bp_location);
12944 init_bp_location (loc, &bp_location_ops, self);
12945 return loc;
12946 }
12947
12948 static void
12949 base_breakpoint_re_set (struct breakpoint *b)
12950 {
12951 /* Nothing to re-set. */
12952 }
12953
12954 #define internal_error_pure_virtual_called() \
12955 gdb_assert_not_reached ("pure virtual function called")
12956
12957 static int
12958 base_breakpoint_insert_location (struct bp_location *bl)
12959 {
12960 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12961 }
12962
12963 static int
12964 base_breakpoint_remove_location (struct bp_location *bl,
12965 enum remove_bp_reason reason)
12966 {
12967 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12968 }
12969
12970 static int
12971 base_breakpoint_breakpoint_hit (const struct bp_location *bl,
12972 struct address_space *aspace,
12973 CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
12974 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
12975 {
12976 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12977 }
12978
12979 static void
12980 base_breakpoint_check_status (bpstat bs)
12981 {
12982 /* Always stop. */
12983 }
12984
12985 /* A "works_in_software_mode" breakpoint_ops method that just internal
12986 errors. */
12987
12988 static int
12989 base_breakpoint_works_in_software_mode (const struct breakpoint *b)
12990 {
12991 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12992 }
12993
12994 /* A "resources_needed" breakpoint_ops method that just internal
12995 errors. */
12996
12997 static int
12998 base_breakpoint_resources_needed (const struct bp_location *bl)
12999 {
13000 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
13001 }
13002
13003 static enum print_stop_action
13004 base_breakpoint_print_it (bpstat bs)
13005 {
13006 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
13007 }
13008
13009 static void
13010 base_breakpoint_print_one_detail (const struct breakpoint *self,
13011 struct ui_out *uiout)
13012 {
13013 /* nothing */
13014 }
13015
13016 static void
13017 base_breakpoint_print_mention (struct breakpoint *b)
13018 {
13019 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
13020 }
13021
13022 static void
13023 base_breakpoint_print_recreate (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
13024 {
13025 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
13026 }
13027
13028 static void
13029 base_breakpoint_create_sals_from_location
13030 (const struct event_location *location,
13031 struct linespec_result *canonical,
13032 enum bptype type_wanted)
13033 {
13034 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
13035 }
13036
13037 static void
13038 base_breakpoint_create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
13039 struct linespec_result *c,
13040 char *cond_string,
13041 char *extra_string,
13042 enum bptype type_wanted,
13043 enum bpdisp disposition,
13044 int thread,
13045 int task, int ignore_count,
13046 const struct breakpoint_ops *o,
13047 int from_tty, int enabled,
13048 int internal, unsigned flags)
13049 {
13050 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
13051 }
13052
13053 static void
13054 base_breakpoint_decode_location (struct breakpoint *b,
13055 const struct event_location *location,
13056 struct program_space *search_pspace,
13057 struct symtabs_and_lines *sals)
13058 {
13059 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
13060 }
13061
13062 /* The default 'explains_signal' method. */
13063
13064 static int
13065 base_breakpoint_explains_signal (struct breakpoint *b, enum gdb_signal sig)
13066 {
13067 return 1;
13068 }
13069
13070 /* The default "after_condition_true" method. */
13071
13072 static void
13073 base_breakpoint_after_condition_true (struct bpstats *bs)
13074 {
13075 /* Nothing to do. */
13076 }
13077
13078 struct breakpoint_ops base_breakpoint_ops =
13079 {
13080 base_breakpoint_dtor,
13081 base_breakpoint_allocate_location,
13082 base_breakpoint_re_set,
13083 base_breakpoint_insert_location,
13084 base_breakpoint_remove_location,
13085 base_breakpoint_breakpoint_hit,
13086 base_breakpoint_check_status,
13087 base_breakpoint_resources_needed,
13088 base_breakpoint_works_in_software_mode,
13089 base_breakpoint_print_it,
13090 NULL,
13091 base_breakpoint_print_one_detail,
13092 base_breakpoint_print_mention,
13093 base_breakpoint_print_recreate,
13094 base_breakpoint_create_sals_from_location,
13095 base_breakpoint_create_breakpoints_sal,
13096 base_breakpoint_decode_location,
13097 base_breakpoint_explains_signal,
13098 base_breakpoint_after_condition_true,
13099 };
13100
13101 /* Default breakpoint_ops methods. */
13102
13103 static void
13104 bkpt_re_set (struct breakpoint *b)
13105 {
13106 /* FIXME: is this still reachable? */
13107 if (breakpoint_event_location_empty_p (b))
13108 {
13109 /* Anything without a location can't be re-set. */
13110 delete_breakpoint (b);
13111 return;
13112 }
13113
13114 breakpoint_re_set_default (b);
13115 }
13116
13117 static int
13118 bkpt_insert_location (struct bp_location *bl)
13119 {
13120 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
13121 return target_insert_hw_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, &bl->target_info);
13122 else
13123 return target_insert_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, &bl->target_info);
13124 }
13125
13126 static int
13127 bkpt_remove_location (struct bp_location *bl, enum remove_bp_reason reason)
13128 {
13129 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
13130 return target_remove_hw_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, &bl->target_info);
13131 else
13132 return target_remove_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, &bl->target_info, reason);
13133 }
13134
13135 static int
13136 bkpt_breakpoint_hit (const struct bp_location *bl,
13137 struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
13138 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
13139 {
13140 if (ws->kind != TARGET_WAITKIND_STOPPED
13141 || ws->value.sig != GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP)
13142 return 0;
13143
13144 if (!breakpoint_address_match (bl->pspace->aspace, bl->address,
13145 aspace, bp_addr))
13146 return 0;
13147
13148 if (overlay_debugging /* unmapped overlay section */
13149 && section_is_overlay (bl->section)
13150 && !section_is_mapped (bl->section))
13151 return 0;
13152
13153 return 1;
13154 }
13155
13156 static int
13157 dprintf_breakpoint_hit (const struct bp_location *bl,
13158 struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
13159 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
13160 {
13161 if (dprintf_style == dprintf_style_agent
13162 && target_can_run_breakpoint_commands ())
13163 {
13164 /* An agent-style dprintf never causes a stop. If we see a trap
13165 for this address it must be for a breakpoint that happens to
13166 be set at the same address. */
13167 return 0;
13168 }
13169
13170 return bkpt_breakpoint_hit (bl, aspace, bp_addr, ws);
13171 }
13172
13173 static int
13174 bkpt_resources_needed (const struct bp_location *bl)
13175 {
13176 gdb_assert (bl->owner->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint);
13177
13178 return 1;
13179 }
13180
13181 static enum print_stop_action
13182 bkpt_print_it (bpstat bs)
13183 {
13184 struct breakpoint *b;
13185 const struct bp_location *bl;
13186 int bp_temp;
13187 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
13188
13189 gdb_assert (bs->bp_location_at != NULL);
13190
13191 bl = bs->bp_location_at;
13192 b = bs->breakpoint_at;
13193
13194 bp_temp = b->disposition == disp_del;
13195 if (bl->address != bl->requested_address)
13196 breakpoint_adjustment_warning (bl->requested_address,
13197 bl->address,
13198 b->number, 1);
13199 annotate_breakpoint (b->number);
13200 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout);
13201
13202 if (bp_temp)
13203 ui_out_text (uiout, "Temporary breakpoint ");
13204 else
13205 ui_out_text (uiout, "Breakpoint ");
13206 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
13207 {
13208 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "reason",
13209 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_BREAKPOINT_HIT));
13210 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
13211 }
13212 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "bkptno", b->number);
13213 ui_out_text (uiout, ", ");
13214
13215 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
13216 }
13217
13218 static void
13219 bkpt_print_mention (struct breakpoint *b)
13220 {
13221 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (current_uiout))
13222 return;
13223
13224 switch (b->type)
13225 {
13226 case bp_breakpoint:
13227 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver:
13228 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
13229 printf_filtered (_("Temporary breakpoint"));
13230 else
13231 printf_filtered (_("Breakpoint"));
13232 printf_filtered (_(" %d"), b->number);
13233 if (b->type == bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver)
13234 printf_filtered (_(" at gnu-indirect-function resolver"));
13235 break;
13236 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
13237 printf_filtered (_("Hardware assisted breakpoint %d"), b->number);
13238 break;
13239 case bp_dprintf:
13240 printf_filtered (_("Dprintf %d"), b->number);
13241 break;
13242 }
13243
13244 say_where (b);
13245 }
13246
13247 static void
13248 bkpt_print_recreate (struct breakpoint *tp, struct ui_file *fp)
13249 {
13250 if (tp->type == bp_breakpoint && tp->disposition == disp_del)
13251 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "tbreak");
13252 else if (tp->type == bp_breakpoint)
13253 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "break");
13254 else if (tp->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint
13255 && tp->disposition == disp_del)
13256 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "thbreak");
13257 else if (tp->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
13258 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "hbreak");
13259 else
13260 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
13261 _("unhandled breakpoint type %d"), (int) tp->type);
13262
13263 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s",
13264 event_location_to_string (tp->location));
13265
13266 /* Print out extra_string if this breakpoint is pending. It might
13267 contain, for example, conditions that were set by the user. */
13268 if (tp->loc == NULL && tp->extra_string != NULL)
13269 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s", tp->extra_string);
13270
13271 print_recreate_thread (tp, fp);
13272 }
13273
13274 static void
13275 bkpt_create_sals_from_location (const struct event_location *location,
13276 struct linespec_result *canonical,
13277 enum bptype type_wanted)
13278 {
13279 create_sals_from_location_default (location, canonical, type_wanted);
13280 }
13281
13282 static void
13283 bkpt_create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
13284 struct linespec_result *canonical,
13285 char *cond_string,
13286 char *extra_string,
13287 enum bptype type_wanted,
13288 enum bpdisp disposition,
13289 int thread,
13290 int task, int ignore_count,
13291 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
13292 int from_tty, int enabled,
13293 int internal, unsigned flags)
13294 {
13295 create_breakpoints_sal_default (gdbarch, canonical,
13296 cond_string, extra_string,
13297 type_wanted,
13298 disposition, thread, task,
13299 ignore_count, ops, from_tty,
13300 enabled, internal, flags);
13301 }
13302
13303 static void
13304 bkpt_decode_location (struct breakpoint *b,
13305 const struct event_location *location,
13306 struct program_space *search_pspace,
13307 struct symtabs_and_lines *sals)
13308 {
13309 decode_location_default (b, location, search_pspace, sals);
13310 }
13311
13312 /* Virtual table for internal breakpoints. */
13313
13314 static void
13315 internal_bkpt_re_set (struct breakpoint *b)
13316 {
13317 switch (b->type)
13318 {
13319 /* Delete overlay event and longjmp master breakpoints; they
13320 will be reset later by breakpoint_re_set. */
13321 case bp_overlay_event:
13322 case bp_longjmp_master:
13323 case bp_std_terminate_master:
13324 case bp_exception_master:
13325 delete_breakpoint (b);
13326 break;
13327
13328 /* This breakpoint is special, it's set up when the inferior
13329 starts and we really don't want to touch it. */
13330 case bp_shlib_event:
13331
13332 /* Like bp_shlib_event, this breakpoint type is special. Once
13333 it is set up, we do not want to touch it. */
13334 case bp_thread_event:
13335 break;
13336 }
13337 }
13338
13339 static void
13340 internal_bkpt_check_status (bpstat bs)
13341 {
13342 if (bs->breakpoint_at->type == bp_shlib_event)
13343 {
13344 /* If requested, stop when the dynamic linker notifies GDB of
13345 events. This allows the user to get control and place
13346 breakpoints in initializer routines for dynamically loaded
13347 objects (among other things). */
13348 bs->stop = stop_on_solib_events;
13349 bs->print = stop_on_solib_events;
13350 }
13351 else
13352 bs->stop = 0;
13353 }
13354
13355 static enum print_stop_action
13356 internal_bkpt_print_it (bpstat bs)
13357 {
13358 struct breakpoint *b;
13359
13360 b = bs->breakpoint_at;
13361
13362 switch (b->type)
13363 {
13364 case bp_shlib_event:
13365 /* Did we stop because the user set the stop_on_solib_events
13366 variable? (If so, we report this as a generic, "Stopped due
13367 to shlib event" message.) */
13368 print_solib_event (0);
13369 break;
13370
13371 case bp_thread_event:
13372 /* Not sure how we will get here.
13373 GDB should not stop for these breakpoints. */
13374 printf_filtered (_("Thread Event Breakpoint: gdb should not stop!\n"));
13375 break;
13376
13377 case bp_overlay_event:
13378 /* By analogy with the thread event, GDB should not stop for these. */
13379 printf_filtered (_("Overlay Event Breakpoint: gdb should not stop!\n"));
13380 break;
13381
13382 case bp_longjmp_master:
13383 /* These should never be enabled. */
13384 printf_filtered (_("Longjmp Master Breakpoint: gdb should not stop!\n"));
13385 break;
13386
13387 case bp_std_terminate_master:
13388 /* These should never be enabled. */
13389 printf_filtered (_("std::terminate Master Breakpoint: "
13390 "gdb should not stop!\n"));
13391 break;
13392
13393 case bp_exception_master:
13394 /* These should never be enabled. */
13395 printf_filtered (_("Exception Master Breakpoint: "
13396 "gdb should not stop!\n"));
13397 break;
13398 }
13399
13400 return PRINT_NOTHING;
13401 }
13402
13403 static void
13404 internal_bkpt_print_mention (struct breakpoint *b)
13405 {
13406 /* Nothing to mention. These breakpoints are internal. */
13407 }
13408
13409 /* Virtual table for momentary breakpoints */
13410
13411 static void
13412 momentary_bkpt_re_set (struct breakpoint *b)
13413 {
13414 /* Keep temporary breakpoints, which can be encountered when we step
13415 over a dlopen call and solib_add is resetting the breakpoints.
13416 Otherwise these should have been blown away via the cleanup chain
13417 or by breakpoint_init_inferior when we rerun the executable. */
13418 }
13419
13420 static void
13421 momentary_bkpt_check_status (bpstat bs)
13422 {
13423 /* Nothing. The point of these breakpoints is causing a stop. */
13424 }
13425
13426 static enum print_stop_action
13427 momentary_bkpt_print_it (bpstat bs)
13428 {
13429 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
13430 }
13431
13432 static void
13433 momentary_bkpt_print_mention (struct breakpoint *b)
13434 {
13435 /* Nothing to mention. These breakpoints are internal. */
13436 }
13437
13438 /* Ensure INITIATING_FRAME is cleared when no such breakpoint exists.
13439
13440 It gets cleared already on the removal of the first one of such placed
13441 breakpoints. This is OK as they get all removed altogether. */
13442
13443 static void
13444 longjmp_bkpt_dtor (struct breakpoint *self)
13445 {
13446 struct thread_info *tp = find_thread_global_id (self->thread);
13447
13448 if (tp)
13449 tp->initiating_frame = null_frame_id;
13450
13451 momentary_breakpoint_ops.dtor (self);
13452 }
13453
13454 /* Specific methods for probe breakpoints. */
13455
13456 static int
13457 bkpt_probe_insert_location (struct bp_location *bl)
13458 {
13459 int v = bkpt_insert_location (bl);
13460
13461 if (v == 0)
13462 {
13463 /* The insertion was successful, now let's set the probe's semaphore
13464 if needed. */
13465 if (bl->probe.probe->pops->set_semaphore != NULL)
13466 bl->probe.probe->pops->set_semaphore (bl->probe.probe,
13467 bl->probe.objfile,
13468 bl->gdbarch);
13469 }
13470
13471 return v;
13472 }
13473
13474 static int
13475 bkpt_probe_remove_location (struct bp_location *bl,
13476 enum remove_bp_reason reason)
13477 {
13478 /* Let's clear the semaphore before removing the location. */
13479 if (bl->probe.probe->pops->clear_semaphore != NULL)
13480 bl->probe.probe->pops->clear_semaphore (bl->probe.probe,
13481 bl->probe.objfile,
13482 bl->gdbarch);
13483
13484 return bkpt_remove_location (bl, reason);
13485 }
13486
13487 static void
13488 bkpt_probe_create_sals_from_location (const struct event_location *location,
13489 struct linespec_result *canonical,
13490 enum bptype type_wanted)
13491 {
13492 struct linespec_sals lsal;
13493
13494 lsal.sals = parse_probes (location, NULL, canonical);
13495 lsal.canonical = xstrdup (event_location_to_string (canonical->location));
13496 VEC_safe_push (linespec_sals, canonical->sals, &lsal);
13497 }
13498
13499 static void
13500 bkpt_probe_decode_location (struct breakpoint *b,
13501 const struct event_location *location,
13502 struct program_space *search_pspace,
13503 struct symtabs_and_lines *sals)
13504 {
13505 *sals = parse_probes (location, search_pspace, NULL);
13506 if (!sals->sals)
13507 error (_("probe not found"));
13508 }
13509
13510 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in tracepoints. */
13511
13512 static void
13513 tracepoint_re_set (struct breakpoint *b)
13514 {
13515 breakpoint_re_set_default (b);
13516 }
13517
13518 static int
13519 tracepoint_breakpoint_hit (const struct bp_location *bl,
13520 struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
13521 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
13522 {
13523 /* By definition, the inferior does not report stops at
13524 tracepoints. */
13525 return 0;
13526 }
13527
13528 static void
13529 tracepoint_print_one_detail (const struct breakpoint *self,
13530 struct ui_out *uiout)
13531 {
13532 struct tracepoint *tp = (struct tracepoint *) self;
13533 if (tp->static_trace_marker_id)
13534 {
13535 gdb_assert (self->type == bp_static_tracepoint);
13536
13537 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tmarker id is ");
13538 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "static-tracepoint-marker-string-id",
13539 tp->static_trace_marker_id);
13540 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
13541 }
13542 }
13543
13544 static void
13545 tracepoint_print_mention (struct breakpoint *b)
13546 {
13547 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (current_uiout))
13548 return;
13549
13550 switch (b->type)
13551 {
13552 case bp_tracepoint:
13553 printf_filtered (_("Tracepoint"));
13554 printf_filtered (_(" %d"), b->number);
13555 break;
13556 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
13557 printf_filtered (_("Fast tracepoint"));
13558 printf_filtered (_(" %d"), b->number);
13559 break;
13560 case bp_static_tracepoint:
13561 printf_filtered (_("Static tracepoint"));
13562 printf_filtered (_(" %d"), b->number);
13563 break;
13564 default:
13565 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
13566 _("unhandled tracepoint type %d"), (int) b->type);
13567 }
13568
13569 say_where (b);
13570 }
13571
13572 static void
13573 tracepoint_print_recreate (struct breakpoint *self, struct ui_file *fp)
13574 {
13575 struct tracepoint *tp = (struct tracepoint *) self;
13576
13577 if (self->type == bp_fast_tracepoint)
13578 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "ftrace");
13579 else if (self->type == bp_static_tracepoint)
13580 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "strace");
13581 else if (self->type == bp_tracepoint)
13582 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "trace");
13583 else
13584 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
13585 _("unhandled tracepoint type %d"), (int) self->type);
13586
13587 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s",
13588 event_location_to_string (self->location));
13589 print_recreate_thread (self, fp);
13590
13591 if (tp->pass_count)
13592 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " passcount %d\n", tp->pass_count);
13593 }
13594
13595 static void
13596 tracepoint_create_sals_from_location (const struct event_location *location,
13597 struct linespec_result *canonical,
13598 enum bptype type_wanted)
13599 {
13600 create_sals_from_location_default (location, canonical, type_wanted);
13601 }
13602
13603 static void
13604 tracepoint_create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
13605 struct linespec_result *canonical,
13606 char *cond_string,
13607 char *extra_string,
13608 enum bptype type_wanted,
13609 enum bpdisp disposition,
13610 int thread,
13611 int task, int ignore_count,
13612 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
13613 int from_tty, int enabled,
13614 int internal, unsigned flags)
13615 {
13616 create_breakpoints_sal_default (gdbarch, canonical,
13617 cond_string, extra_string,
13618 type_wanted,
13619 disposition, thread, task,
13620 ignore_count, ops, from_tty,
13621 enabled, internal, flags);
13622 }
13623
13624 static void
13625 tracepoint_decode_location (struct breakpoint *b,
13626 const struct event_location *location,
13627 struct program_space *search_pspace,
13628 struct symtabs_and_lines *sals)
13629 {
13630 decode_location_default (b, location, search_pspace, sals);
13631 }
13632
13633 struct breakpoint_ops tracepoint_breakpoint_ops;
13634
13635 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be use on tracepoints placed in a
13636 static probe. */
13637
13638 static void
13639 tracepoint_probe_create_sals_from_location
13640 (const struct event_location *location,
13641 struct linespec_result *canonical,
13642 enum bptype type_wanted)
13643 {
13644 /* We use the same method for breakpoint on probes. */
13645 bkpt_probe_create_sals_from_location (location, canonical, type_wanted);
13646 }
13647
13648 static void
13649 tracepoint_probe_decode_location (struct breakpoint *b,
13650 const struct event_location *location,
13651 struct program_space *search_pspace,
13652 struct symtabs_and_lines *sals)
13653 {
13654 /* We use the same method for breakpoint on probes. */
13655 bkpt_probe_decode_location (b, location, search_pspace, sals);
13656 }
13657
13658 static struct breakpoint_ops tracepoint_probe_breakpoint_ops;
13659
13660 /* Dprintf breakpoint_ops methods. */
13661
13662 static void
13663 dprintf_re_set (struct breakpoint *b)
13664 {
13665 breakpoint_re_set_default (b);
13666
13667 /* extra_string should never be non-NULL for dprintf. */
13668 gdb_assert (b->extra_string != NULL);
13669
13670 /* 1 - connect to target 1, that can run breakpoint commands.
13671 2 - create a dprintf, which resolves fine.
13672 3 - disconnect from target 1
13673 4 - connect to target 2, that can NOT run breakpoint commands.
13674
13675 After steps #3/#4, you'll want the dprintf command list to
13676 be updated, because target 1 and 2 may well return different
13677 answers for target_can_run_breakpoint_commands().
13678 Given absence of finer grained resetting, we get to do
13679 it all the time. */
13680 if (b->extra_string != NULL)
13681 update_dprintf_command_list (b);
13682 }
13683
13684 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for dprintf. */
13685
13686 static void
13687 dprintf_print_recreate (struct breakpoint *tp, struct ui_file *fp)
13688 {
13689 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "dprintf %s,%s",
13690 event_location_to_string (tp->location),
13691 tp->extra_string);
13692 print_recreate_thread (tp, fp);
13693 }
13694
13695 /* Implement the "after_condition_true" breakpoint_ops method for
13696 dprintf.
13697
13698 dprintf's are implemented with regular commands in their command
13699 list, but we run the commands here instead of before presenting the
13700 stop to the user, as dprintf's don't actually cause a stop. This
13701 also makes it so that the commands of multiple dprintfs at the same
13702 address are all handled. */
13703
13704 static void
13705 dprintf_after_condition_true (struct bpstats *bs)
13706 {
13707 struct cleanup *old_chain;
13708 struct bpstats tmp_bs = { NULL };
13709 struct bpstats *tmp_bs_p = &tmp_bs;
13710
13711 /* dprintf's never cause a stop. This wasn't set in the
13712 check_status hook instead because that would make the dprintf's
13713 condition not be evaluated. */
13714 bs->stop = 0;
13715
13716 /* Run the command list here. Take ownership of it instead of
13717 copying. We never want these commands to run later in
13718 bpstat_do_actions, if a breakpoint that causes a stop happens to
13719 be set at same address as this dprintf, or even if running the
13720 commands here throws. */
13721 tmp_bs.commands = bs->commands;
13722 bs->commands = NULL;
13723 old_chain = make_cleanup_decref_counted_command_line (&tmp_bs.commands);
13724
13725 bpstat_do_actions_1 (&tmp_bs_p);
13726
13727 /* 'tmp_bs.commands' will usually be NULL by now, but
13728 bpstat_do_actions_1 may return early without processing the whole
13729 list. */
13730 do_cleanups (old_chain);
13731 }
13732
13733 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used on static tracepoints with
13734 markers (`-m'). */
13735
13736 static void
13737 strace_marker_create_sals_from_location (const struct event_location *location,
13738 struct linespec_result *canonical,
13739 enum bptype type_wanted)
13740 {
13741 struct linespec_sals lsal;
13742 const char *arg_start, *arg;
13743 char *str;
13744 struct cleanup *cleanup;
13745
13746 arg = arg_start = get_linespec_location (location);
13747 lsal.sals = decode_static_tracepoint_spec (&arg);
13748
13749 str = savestring (arg_start, arg - arg_start);
13750 cleanup = make_cleanup (xfree, str);
13751 canonical->location = new_linespec_location (&str);
13752 do_cleanups (cleanup);
13753
13754 lsal.canonical = xstrdup (event_location_to_string (canonical->location));
13755 VEC_safe_push (linespec_sals, canonical->sals, &lsal);
13756 }
13757
13758 static void
13759 strace_marker_create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
13760 struct linespec_result *canonical,
13761 char *cond_string,
13762 char *extra_string,
13763 enum bptype type_wanted,
13764 enum bpdisp disposition,
13765 int thread,
13766 int task, int ignore_count,
13767 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
13768 int from_tty, int enabled,
13769 int internal, unsigned flags)
13770 {
13771 int i;
13772 struct linespec_sals *lsal = VEC_index (linespec_sals,
13773 canonical->sals, 0);
13774
13775 /* If the user is creating a static tracepoint by marker id
13776 (strace -m MARKER_ID), then store the sals index, so that
13777 breakpoint_re_set can try to match up which of the newly
13778 found markers corresponds to this one, and, don't try to
13779 expand multiple locations for each sal, given than SALS
13780 already should contain all sals for MARKER_ID. */
13781
13782 for (i = 0; i < lsal->sals.nelts; ++i)
13783 {
13784 struct symtabs_and_lines expanded;
13785 struct tracepoint *tp;
13786 struct cleanup *old_chain;
13787 struct event_location *location;
13788
13789 expanded.nelts = 1;
13790 expanded.sals = &lsal->sals.sals[i];
13791
13792 location = copy_event_location (canonical->location);
13793 old_chain = make_cleanup_delete_event_location (location);
13794
13795 tp = XCNEW (struct tracepoint);
13796 init_breakpoint_sal (&tp->base, gdbarch, expanded,
13797 location, NULL,
13798 cond_string, extra_string,
13799 type_wanted, disposition,
13800 thread, task, ignore_count, ops,
13801 from_tty, enabled, internal, flags,
13802 canonical->special_display);
13803 /* Given that its possible to have multiple markers with
13804 the same string id, if the user is creating a static
13805 tracepoint by marker id ("strace -m MARKER_ID"), then
13806 store the sals index, so that breakpoint_re_set can
13807 try to match up which of the newly found markers
13808 corresponds to this one */
13809 tp->static_trace_marker_id_idx = i;
13810
13811 install_breakpoint (internal, &tp->base, 0);
13812
13813 discard_cleanups (old_chain);
13814 }
13815 }
13816
13817 static void
13818 strace_marker_decode_location (struct breakpoint *b,
13819 const struct event_location *location,
13820 struct program_space *search_pspace,
13821 struct symtabs_and_lines *sals)
13822 {
13823 struct tracepoint *tp = (struct tracepoint *) b;
13824 const char *s = get_linespec_location (location);
13825
13826 *sals = decode_static_tracepoint_spec (&s);
13827 if (sals->nelts > tp->static_trace_marker_id_idx)
13828 {
13829 sals->sals[0] = sals->sals[tp->static_trace_marker_id_idx];
13830 sals->nelts = 1;
13831 }
13832 else
13833 error (_("marker %s not found"), tp->static_trace_marker_id);
13834 }
13835
13836 static struct breakpoint_ops strace_marker_breakpoint_ops;
13837
13838 static int
13839 strace_marker_p (struct breakpoint *b)
13840 {
13841 return b->ops == &strace_marker_breakpoint_ops;
13842 }
13843
13844 /* Delete a breakpoint and clean up all traces of it in the data
13845 structures. */
13846
13847 void
13848 delete_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
13849 {
13850 struct breakpoint *b;
13851
13852 gdb_assert (bpt != NULL);
13853
13854 /* Has this bp already been deleted? This can happen because
13855 multiple lists can hold pointers to bp's. bpstat lists are
13856 especial culprits.
13857
13858 One example of this happening is a watchpoint's scope bp. When
13859 the scope bp triggers, we notice that the watchpoint is out of
13860 scope, and delete it. We also delete its scope bp. But the
13861 scope bp is marked "auto-deleting", and is already on a bpstat.
13862 That bpstat is then checked for auto-deleting bp's, which are
13863 deleted.
13864
13865 A real solution to this problem might involve reference counts in
13866 bp's, and/or giving them pointers back to their referencing
13867 bpstat's, and teaching delete_breakpoint to only free a bp's
13868 storage when no more references were extent. A cheaper bandaid
13869 was chosen. */
13870 if (bpt->type == bp_none)
13871 return;
13872
13873 /* At least avoid this stale reference until the reference counting
13874 of breakpoints gets resolved. */
13875 if (bpt->related_breakpoint != bpt)
13876 {
13877 struct breakpoint *related;
13878 struct watchpoint *w;
13879
13880 if (bpt->type == bp_watchpoint_scope)
13881 w = (struct watchpoint *) bpt->related_breakpoint;
13882 else if (bpt->related_breakpoint->type == bp_watchpoint_scope)
13883 w = (struct watchpoint *) bpt;
13884 else
13885 w = NULL;
13886 if (w != NULL)
13887 watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (w);
13888
13889 /* Unlink bpt from the bpt->related_breakpoint ring. */
13890 for (related = bpt; related->related_breakpoint != bpt;
13891 related = related->related_breakpoint);
13892 related->related_breakpoint = bpt->related_breakpoint;
13893 bpt->related_breakpoint = bpt;
13894 }
13895
13896 /* watch_command_1 creates a watchpoint but only sets its number if
13897 update_watchpoint succeeds in creating its bp_locations. If there's
13898 a problem in that process, we'll be asked to delete the half-created
13899 watchpoint. In that case, don't announce the deletion. */
13900 if (bpt->number)
13901 observer_notify_breakpoint_deleted (bpt);
13902
13903 if (breakpoint_chain == bpt)
13904 breakpoint_chain = bpt->next;
13905
13906 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
13907 if (b->next == bpt)
13908 {
13909 b->next = bpt->next;
13910 break;
13911 }
13912
13913 /* Be sure no bpstat's are pointing at the breakpoint after it's
13914 been freed. */
13915 /* FIXME, how can we find all bpstat's? We just check stop_bpstat
13916 in all threads for now. Note that we cannot just remove bpstats
13917 pointing at bpt from the stop_bpstat list entirely, as breakpoint
13918 commands are associated with the bpstat; if we remove it here,
13919 then the later call to bpstat_do_actions (&stop_bpstat); in
13920 event-top.c won't do anything, and temporary breakpoints with
13921 commands won't work. */
13922
13923 iterate_over_threads (bpstat_remove_breakpoint_callback, bpt);
13924
13925 /* Now that breakpoint is removed from breakpoint list, update the
13926 global location list. This will remove locations that used to
13927 belong to this breakpoint. Do this before freeing the breakpoint
13928 itself, since remove_breakpoint looks at location's owner. It
13929 might be better design to have location completely
13930 self-contained, but it's not the case now. */
13931 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
13932
13933 bpt->ops->dtor (bpt);
13934 /* On the chance that someone will soon try again to delete this
13935 same bp, we mark it as deleted before freeing its storage. */
13936 bpt->type = bp_none;
13937 xfree (bpt);
13938 }
13939
13940 static void
13941 do_delete_breakpoint_cleanup (void *b)
13942 {
13943 delete_breakpoint ((struct breakpoint *) b);
13944 }
13945
13946 struct cleanup *
13947 make_cleanup_delete_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
13948 {
13949 return make_cleanup (do_delete_breakpoint_cleanup, b);
13950 }
13951
13952 /* Iterator function to call a user-provided callback function once
13953 for each of B and its related breakpoints. */
13954
13955 static void
13956 iterate_over_related_breakpoints (struct breakpoint *b,
13957 void (*function) (struct breakpoint *,
13958 void *),
13959 void *data)
13960 {
13961 struct breakpoint *related;
13962
13963 related = b;
13964 do
13965 {
13966 struct breakpoint *next;
13967
13968 /* FUNCTION may delete RELATED. */
13969 next = related->related_breakpoint;
13970
13971 if (next == related)
13972 {
13973 /* RELATED is the last ring entry. */
13974 function (related, data);
13975
13976 /* FUNCTION may have deleted it, so we'd never reach back to
13977 B. There's nothing left to do anyway, so just break
13978 out. */
13979 break;
13980 }
13981 else
13982 function (related, data);
13983
13984 related = next;
13985 }
13986 while (related != b);
13987 }
13988
13989 static void
13990 do_delete_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b, void *ignore)
13991 {
13992 delete_breakpoint (b);
13993 }
13994
13995 /* A callback for map_breakpoint_numbers that calls
13996 delete_breakpoint. */
13997
13998 static void
13999 do_map_delete_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b, void *ignore)
14000 {
14001 iterate_over_related_breakpoints (b, do_delete_breakpoint, NULL);
14002 }
14003
14004 void
14005 delete_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
14006 {
14007 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
14008
14009 dont_repeat ();
14010
14011 if (arg == 0)
14012 {
14013 int breaks_to_delete = 0;
14014
14015 /* Delete all breakpoints if no argument. Do not delete
14016 internal breakpoints, these have to be deleted with an
14017 explicit breakpoint number argument. */
14018 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
14019 if (user_breakpoint_p (b))
14020 {
14021 breaks_to_delete = 1;
14022 break;
14023 }
14024
14025 /* Ask user only if there are some breakpoints to delete. */
14026 if (!from_tty
14027 || (breaks_to_delete && query (_("Delete all breakpoints? "))))
14028 {
14029 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
14030 if (user_breakpoint_p (b))
14031 delete_breakpoint (b);
14032 }
14033 }
14034 else
14035 map_breakpoint_numbers (arg, do_map_delete_breakpoint, NULL);
14036 }
14037
14038 /* Return true if all locations of B bound to PSPACE are pending. If
14039 PSPACE is NULL, all locations of all program spaces are
14040 considered. */
14041
14042 static int
14043 all_locations_are_pending (struct breakpoint *b, struct program_space *pspace)
14044 {
14045 struct bp_location *loc;
14046
14047 for (loc = b->loc; loc != NULL; loc = loc->next)
14048 if ((pspace == NULL
14049 || loc->pspace == pspace)
14050 && !loc->shlib_disabled
14051 && !loc->pspace->executing_startup)
14052 return 0;
14053 return 1;
14054 }
14055
14056 /* Subroutine of update_breakpoint_locations to simplify it.
14057 Return non-zero if multiple fns in list LOC have the same name.
14058 Null names are ignored. */
14059
14060 static int
14061 ambiguous_names_p (struct bp_location *loc)
14062 {
14063 struct bp_location *l;
14064 htab_t htab = htab_create_alloc (13, htab_hash_string,
14065 (int (*) (const void *,
14066 const void *)) streq,
14067 NULL, xcalloc, xfree);
14068
14069 for (l = loc; l != NULL; l = l->next)
14070 {
14071 const char **slot;
14072 const char *name = l->function_name;
14073
14074 /* Allow for some names to be NULL, ignore them. */
14075 if (name == NULL)
14076 continue;
14077
14078 slot = (const char **) htab_find_slot (htab, (const void *) name,
14079 INSERT);
14080 /* NOTE: We can assume slot != NULL here because xcalloc never
14081 returns NULL. */
14082 if (*slot != NULL)
14083 {
14084 htab_delete (htab);
14085 return 1;
14086 }
14087 *slot = name;
14088 }
14089
14090 htab_delete (htab);
14091 return 0;
14092 }
14093
14094 /* When symbols change, it probably means the sources changed as well,
14095 and it might mean the static tracepoint markers are no longer at
14096 the same address or line numbers they used to be at last we
14097 checked. Losing your static tracepoints whenever you rebuild is
14098 undesirable. This function tries to resync/rematch gdb static
14099 tracepoints with the markers on the target, for static tracepoints
14100 that have not been set by marker id. Static tracepoint that have
14101 been set by marker id are reset by marker id in breakpoint_re_set.
14102 The heuristic is:
14103
14104 1) For a tracepoint set at a specific address, look for a marker at
14105 the old PC. If one is found there, assume to be the same marker.
14106 If the name / string id of the marker found is different from the
14107 previous known name, assume that means the user renamed the marker
14108 in the sources, and output a warning.
14109
14110 2) For a tracepoint set at a given line number, look for a marker
14111 at the new address of the old line number. If one is found there,
14112 assume to be the same marker. If the name / string id of the
14113 marker found is different from the previous known name, assume that
14114 means the user renamed the marker in the sources, and output a
14115 warning.
14116
14117 3) If a marker is no longer found at the same address or line, it
14118 may mean the marker no longer exists. But it may also just mean
14119 the code changed a bit. Maybe the user added a few lines of code
14120 that made the marker move up or down (in line number terms). Ask
14121 the target for info about the marker with the string id as we knew
14122 it. If found, update line number and address in the matching
14123 static tracepoint. This will get confused if there's more than one
14124 marker with the same ID (possible in UST, although unadvised
14125 precisely because it confuses tools). */
14126
14127 static struct symtab_and_line
14128 update_static_tracepoint (struct breakpoint *b, struct symtab_and_line sal)
14129 {
14130 struct tracepoint *tp = (struct tracepoint *) b;
14131 struct static_tracepoint_marker marker;
14132 CORE_ADDR pc;
14133
14134 pc = sal.pc;
14135 if (sal.line)
14136 find_line_pc (sal.symtab, sal.line, &pc);
14137
14138 if (target_static_tracepoint_marker_at (pc, &marker))
14139 {
14140 if (strcmp (tp->static_trace_marker_id, marker.str_id) != 0)
14141 warning (_("static tracepoint %d changed probed marker from %s to %s"),
14142 b->number,
14143 tp->static_trace_marker_id, marker.str_id);
14144
14145 xfree (tp->static_trace_marker_id);
14146 tp->static_trace_marker_id = xstrdup (marker.str_id);
14147 release_static_tracepoint_marker (&marker);
14148
14149 return sal;
14150 }
14151
14152 /* Old marker wasn't found on target at lineno. Try looking it up
14153 by string ID. */
14154 if (!sal.explicit_pc
14155 && sal.line != 0
14156 && sal.symtab != NULL
14157 && tp->static_trace_marker_id != NULL)
14158 {
14159 VEC(static_tracepoint_marker_p) *markers;
14160
14161 markers
14162 = target_static_tracepoint_markers_by_strid (tp->static_trace_marker_id);
14163
14164 if (!VEC_empty(static_tracepoint_marker_p, markers))
14165 {
14166 struct symtab_and_line sal2;
14167 struct symbol *sym;
14168 struct static_tracepoint_marker *tpmarker;
14169 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
14170 struct explicit_location explicit_loc;
14171
14172 tpmarker = VEC_index (static_tracepoint_marker_p, markers, 0);
14173
14174 xfree (tp->static_trace_marker_id);
14175 tp->static_trace_marker_id = xstrdup (tpmarker->str_id);
14176
14177 warning (_("marker for static tracepoint %d (%s) not "
14178 "found at previous line number"),
14179 b->number, tp->static_trace_marker_id);
14180
14181 init_sal (&sal2);
14182
14183 sal2.pc = tpmarker->address;
14184
14185 sal2 = find_pc_line (tpmarker->address, 0);
14186 sym = find_pc_sect_function (tpmarker->address, NULL);
14187 ui_out_text (uiout, "Now in ");
14188 if (sym)
14189 {
14190 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "func",
14191 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (sym));
14192 ui_out_text (uiout, " at ");
14193 }
14194 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "file",
14195 symtab_to_filename_for_display (sal2.symtab));
14196 ui_out_text (uiout, ":");
14197
14198 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
14199 {
14200 const char *fullname = symtab_to_fullname (sal2.symtab);
14201
14202 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "fullname", fullname);
14203 }
14204
14205 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "line", sal2.line);
14206 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
14207
14208 b->loc->line_number = sal2.line;
14209 b->loc->symtab = sym != NULL ? sal2.symtab : NULL;
14210
14211 delete_event_location (b->location);
14212 initialize_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
14213 explicit_loc.source_filename
14214 = ASTRDUP (symtab_to_filename_for_display (sal2.symtab));
14215 explicit_loc.line_offset.offset = b->loc->line_number;
14216 explicit_loc.line_offset.sign = LINE_OFFSET_NONE;
14217 b->location = new_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
14218
14219 /* Might be nice to check if function changed, and warn if
14220 so. */
14221
14222 release_static_tracepoint_marker (tpmarker);
14223 }
14224 }
14225 return sal;
14226 }
14227
14228 /* Returns 1 iff locations A and B are sufficiently same that
14229 we don't need to report breakpoint as changed. */
14230
14231 static int
14232 locations_are_equal (struct bp_location *a, struct bp_location *b)
14233 {
14234 while (a && b)
14235 {
14236 if (a->address != b->address)
14237 return 0;
14238
14239 if (a->shlib_disabled != b->shlib_disabled)
14240 return 0;
14241
14242 if (a->enabled != b->enabled)
14243 return 0;
14244
14245 a = a->next;
14246 b = b->next;
14247 }
14248
14249 if ((a == NULL) != (b == NULL))
14250 return 0;
14251
14252 return 1;
14253 }
14254
14255 /* Split all locations of B that are bound to PSPACE out of B's
14256 location list to a separate list and return that list's head. If
14257 PSPACE is NULL, hoist out all locations of B. */
14258
14259 static struct bp_location *
14260 hoist_existing_locations (struct breakpoint *b, struct program_space *pspace)
14261 {
14262 struct bp_location head;
14263 struct bp_location *i = b->loc;
14264 struct bp_location **i_link = &b->loc;
14265 struct bp_location *hoisted = &head;
14266
14267 if (pspace == NULL)
14268 {
14269 i = b->loc;
14270 b->loc = NULL;
14271 return i;
14272 }
14273
14274 head.next = NULL;
14275
14276 while (i != NULL)
14277 {
14278 if (i->pspace == pspace)
14279 {
14280 *i_link = i->next;
14281 i->next = NULL;
14282 hoisted->next = i;
14283 hoisted = i;
14284 }
14285 else
14286 i_link = &i->next;
14287 i = *i_link;
14288 }
14289
14290 return head.next;
14291 }
14292
14293 /* Create new breakpoint locations for B (a hardware or software
14294 breakpoint) based on SALS and SALS_END. If SALS_END.NELTS is not
14295 zero, then B is a ranged breakpoint. Only recreates locations for
14296 FILTER_PSPACE. Locations of other program spaces are left
14297 untouched. */
14298
14299 void
14300 update_breakpoint_locations (struct breakpoint *b,
14301 struct program_space *filter_pspace,
14302 struct symtabs_and_lines sals,
14303 struct symtabs_and_lines sals_end)
14304 {
14305 int i;
14306 struct bp_location *existing_locations;
14307
14308 if (sals_end.nelts != 0 && (sals.nelts != 1 || sals_end.nelts != 1))
14309 {
14310 /* Ranged breakpoints have only one start location and one end
14311 location. */
14312 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
14313 printf_unfiltered (_("Could not reset ranged breakpoint %d: "
14314 "multiple locations found\n"),
14315 b->number);
14316 return;
14317 }
14318
14319 /* If there's no new locations, and all existing locations are
14320 pending, don't do anything. This optimizes the common case where
14321 all locations are in the same shared library, that was unloaded.
14322 We'd like to retain the location, so that when the library is
14323 loaded again, we don't loose the enabled/disabled status of the
14324 individual locations. */
14325 if (all_locations_are_pending (b, filter_pspace) && sals.nelts == 0)
14326 return;
14327
14328 existing_locations = hoist_existing_locations (b, filter_pspace);
14329
14330 for (i = 0; i < sals.nelts; ++i)
14331 {
14332 struct bp_location *new_loc;
14333
14334 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (sals.sals[i].pspace);
14335
14336 new_loc = add_location_to_breakpoint (b, &(sals.sals[i]));
14337
14338 /* Reparse conditions, they might contain references to the
14339 old symtab. */
14340 if (b->cond_string != NULL)
14341 {
14342 const char *s;
14343
14344 s = b->cond_string;
14345 TRY
14346 {
14347 new_loc->cond = parse_exp_1 (&s, sals.sals[i].pc,
14348 block_for_pc (sals.sals[i].pc),
14349 0);
14350 }
14351 CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
14352 {
14353 warning (_("failed to reevaluate condition "
14354 "for breakpoint %d: %s"),
14355 b->number, e.message);
14356 new_loc->enabled = 0;
14357 }
14358 END_CATCH
14359 }
14360
14361 if (sals_end.nelts)
14362 {
14363 CORE_ADDR end = find_breakpoint_range_end (sals_end.sals[0]);
14364
14365 new_loc->length = end - sals.sals[0].pc + 1;
14366 }
14367 }
14368
14369 /* If possible, carry over 'disable' status from existing
14370 breakpoints. */
14371 {
14372 struct bp_location *e = existing_locations;
14373 /* If there are multiple breakpoints with the same function name,
14374 e.g. for inline functions, comparing function names won't work.
14375 Instead compare pc addresses; this is just a heuristic as things
14376 may have moved, but in practice it gives the correct answer
14377 often enough until a better solution is found. */
14378 int have_ambiguous_names = ambiguous_names_p (b->loc);
14379
14380 for (; e; e = e->next)
14381 {
14382 if (!e->enabled && e->function_name)
14383 {
14384 struct bp_location *l = b->loc;
14385 if (have_ambiguous_names)
14386 {
14387 for (; l; l = l->next)
14388 if (breakpoint_locations_match (e, l))
14389 {
14390 l->enabled = 0;
14391 break;
14392 }
14393 }
14394 else
14395 {
14396 for (; l; l = l->next)
14397 if (l->function_name
14398 && strcmp (e->function_name, l->function_name) == 0)
14399 {
14400 l->enabled = 0;
14401 break;
14402 }
14403 }
14404 }
14405 }
14406 }
14407
14408 if (!locations_are_equal (existing_locations, b->loc))
14409 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b);
14410 }
14411
14412 /* Find the SaL locations corresponding to the given LOCATION.
14413 On return, FOUND will be 1 if any SaL was found, zero otherwise. */
14414
14415 static struct symtabs_and_lines
14416 location_to_sals (struct breakpoint *b, struct event_location *location,
14417 struct program_space *search_pspace, int *found)
14418 {
14419 struct symtabs_and_lines sals = {0};
14420 struct gdb_exception exception = exception_none;
14421
14422 gdb_assert (b->ops != NULL);
14423
14424 TRY
14425 {
14426 b->ops->decode_location (b, location, search_pspace, &sals);
14427 }
14428 CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
14429 {
14430 int not_found_and_ok = 0;
14431
14432 exception = e;
14433
14434 /* For pending breakpoints, it's expected that parsing will
14435 fail until the right shared library is loaded. User has
14436 already told to create pending breakpoints and don't need
14437 extra messages. If breakpoint is in bp_shlib_disabled
14438 state, then user already saw the message about that
14439 breakpoint being disabled, and don't want to see more
14440 errors. */
14441 if (e.error == NOT_FOUND_ERROR
14442 && (b->condition_not_parsed
14443 || (b->loc != NULL
14444 && search_pspace != NULL
14445 && b->loc->pspace != search_pspace)
14446 || (b->loc && b->loc->shlib_disabled)
14447 || (b->loc && b->loc->pspace->executing_startup)
14448 || b->enable_state == bp_disabled))
14449 not_found_and_ok = 1;
14450
14451 if (!not_found_and_ok)
14452 {
14453 /* We surely don't want to warn about the same breakpoint
14454 10 times. One solution, implemented here, is disable
14455 the breakpoint on error. Another solution would be to
14456 have separate 'warning emitted' flag. Since this
14457 happens only when a binary has changed, I don't know
14458 which approach is better. */
14459 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
14460 throw_exception (e);
14461 }
14462 }
14463 END_CATCH
14464
14465 if (exception.reason == 0 || exception.error != NOT_FOUND_ERROR)
14466 {
14467 int i;
14468
14469 for (i = 0; i < sals.nelts; ++i)
14470 resolve_sal_pc (&sals.sals[i]);
14471 if (b->condition_not_parsed && b->extra_string != NULL)
14472 {
14473 char *cond_string, *extra_string;
14474 int thread, task;
14475
14476 find_condition_and_thread (b->extra_string, sals.sals[0].pc,
14477 &cond_string, &thread, &task,
14478 &extra_string);
14479 gdb_assert (b->cond_string == NULL);
14480 if (cond_string)
14481 b->cond_string = cond_string;
14482 b->thread = thread;
14483 b->task = task;
14484 if (extra_string)
14485 {
14486 xfree (b->extra_string);
14487 b->extra_string = extra_string;
14488 }
14489 b->condition_not_parsed = 0;
14490 }
14491
14492 if (b->type == bp_static_tracepoint && !strace_marker_p (b))
14493 sals.sals[0] = update_static_tracepoint (b, sals.sals[0]);
14494
14495 *found = 1;
14496 }
14497 else
14498 *found = 0;
14499
14500 return sals;
14501 }
14502
14503 /* The default re_set method, for typical hardware or software
14504 breakpoints. Reevaluate the breakpoint and recreate its
14505 locations. */
14506
14507 static void
14508 breakpoint_re_set_default (struct breakpoint *b)
14509 {
14510 int found;
14511 struct symtabs_and_lines sals, sals_end;
14512 struct symtabs_and_lines expanded = {0};
14513 struct symtabs_and_lines expanded_end = {0};
14514 struct program_space *filter_pspace = current_program_space;
14515
14516 sals = location_to_sals (b, b->location, filter_pspace, &found);
14517 if (found)
14518 {
14519 make_cleanup (xfree, sals.sals);
14520 expanded = sals;
14521 }
14522
14523 if (b->location_range_end != NULL)
14524 {
14525 sals_end = location_to_sals (b, b->location_range_end,
14526 filter_pspace, &found);
14527 if (found)
14528 {
14529 make_cleanup (xfree, sals_end.sals);
14530 expanded_end = sals_end;
14531 }
14532 }
14533
14534 update_breakpoint_locations (b, filter_pspace, expanded, expanded_end);
14535 }
14536
14537 /* Default method for creating SALs from an address string. It basically
14538 calls parse_breakpoint_sals. Return 1 for success, zero for failure. */
14539
14540 static void
14541 create_sals_from_location_default (const struct event_location *location,
14542 struct linespec_result *canonical,
14543 enum bptype type_wanted)
14544 {
14545 parse_breakpoint_sals (location, canonical);
14546 }
14547
14548 /* Call create_breakpoints_sal for the given arguments. This is the default
14549 function for the `create_breakpoints_sal' method of
14550 breakpoint_ops. */
14551
14552 static void
14553 create_breakpoints_sal_default (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
14554 struct linespec_result *canonical,
14555 char *cond_string,
14556 char *extra_string,
14557 enum bptype type_wanted,
14558 enum bpdisp disposition,
14559 int thread,
14560 int task, int ignore_count,
14561 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
14562 int from_tty, int enabled,
14563 int internal, unsigned flags)
14564 {
14565 create_breakpoints_sal (gdbarch, canonical, cond_string,
14566 extra_string,
14567 type_wanted, disposition,
14568 thread, task, ignore_count, ops, from_tty,
14569 enabled, internal, flags);
14570 }
14571
14572 /* Decode the line represented by S by calling decode_line_full. This is the
14573 default function for the `decode_location' method of breakpoint_ops. */
14574
14575 static void
14576 decode_location_default (struct breakpoint *b,
14577 const struct event_location *location,
14578 struct program_space *search_pspace,
14579 struct symtabs_and_lines *sals)
14580 {
14581 struct linespec_result canonical;
14582
14583 init_linespec_result (&canonical);
14584 decode_line_full (location, DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE, search_pspace,
14585 (struct symtab *) NULL, 0,
14586 &canonical, multiple_symbols_all,
14587 b->filter);
14588
14589 /* We should get 0 or 1 resulting SALs. */
14590 gdb_assert (VEC_length (linespec_sals, canonical.sals) < 2);
14591
14592 if (VEC_length (linespec_sals, canonical.sals) > 0)
14593 {
14594 struct linespec_sals *lsal;
14595
14596 lsal = VEC_index (linespec_sals, canonical.sals, 0);
14597 *sals = lsal->sals;
14598 /* Arrange it so the destructor does not free the
14599 contents. */
14600 lsal->sals.sals = NULL;
14601 }
14602
14603 destroy_linespec_result (&canonical);
14604 }
14605
14606 /* Prepare the global context for a re-set of breakpoint B. */
14607
14608 static struct cleanup *
14609 prepare_re_set_context (struct breakpoint *b)
14610 {
14611 input_radix = b->input_radix;
14612 set_language (b->language);
14613
14614 return make_cleanup (null_cleanup, NULL);
14615 }
14616
14617 /* Reset a breakpoint given it's struct breakpoint * BINT.
14618 The value we return ends up being the return value from catch_errors.
14619 Unused in this case. */
14620
14621 static int
14622 breakpoint_re_set_one (void *bint)
14623 {
14624 /* Get past catch_errs. */
14625 struct breakpoint *b = (struct breakpoint *) bint;
14626 struct cleanup *cleanups;
14627
14628 cleanups = prepare_re_set_context (b);
14629 b->ops->re_set (b);
14630 do_cleanups (cleanups);
14631 return 0;
14632 }
14633
14634 /* Re-set breakpoint locations for the current program space.
14635 Locations bound to other program spaces are left untouched. */
14636
14637 void
14638 breakpoint_re_set (void)
14639 {
14640 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
14641 enum language save_language;
14642 int save_input_radix;
14643 struct cleanup *old_chain;
14644
14645 save_language = current_language->la_language;
14646 save_input_radix = input_radix;
14647 old_chain = save_current_space_and_thread ();
14648
14649 /* Note: we must not try to insert locations until after all
14650 breakpoints have been re-set. Otherwise, e.g., when re-setting
14651 breakpoint 1, we'd insert the locations of breakpoint 2, which
14652 hadn't been re-set yet, and thus may have stale locations. */
14653
14654 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
14655 {
14656 /* Format possible error msg. */
14657 char *message = xstrprintf ("Error in re-setting breakpoint %d: ",
14658 b->number);
14659 struct cleanup *cleanups = make_cleanup (xfree, message);
14660 catch_errors (breakpoint_re_set_one, b, message, RETURN_MASK_ALL);
14661 do_cleanups (cleanups);
14662 }
14663 set_language (save_language);
14664 input_radix = save_input_radix;
14665
14666 jit_breakpoint_re_set ();
14667
14668 do_cleanups (old_chain);
14669
14670 create_overlay_event_breakpoint ();
14671 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ();
14672 create_std_terminate_master_breakpoint ();
14673 create_exception_master_breakpoint ();
14674
14675 /* Now we can insert. */
14676 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
14677 }
14678 \f
14679 /* Reset the thread number of this breakpoint:
14680
14681 - If the breakpoint is for all threads, leave it as-is.
14682 - Else, reset it to the current thread for inferior_ptid. */
14683 void
14684 breakpoint_re_set_thread (struct breakpoint *b)
14685 {
14686 if (b->thread != -1)
14687 {
14688 if (in_thread_list (inferior_ptid))
14689 b->thread = ptid_to_global_thread_id (inferior_ptid);
14690
14691 /* We're being called after following a fork. The new fork is
14692 selected as current, and unless this was a vfork will have a
14693 different program space from the original thread. Reset that
14694 as well. */
14695 b->loc->pspace = current_program_space;
14696 }
14697 }
14698
14699 /* Set ignore-count of breakpoint number BPTNUM to COUNT.
14700 If from_tty is nonzero, it prints a message to that effect,
14701 which ends with a period (no newline). */
14702
14703 void
14704 set_ignore_count (int bptnum, int count, int from_tty)
14705 {
14706 struct breakpoint *b;
14707
14708 if (count < 0)
14709 count = 0;
14710
14711 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
14712 if (b->number == bptnum)
14713 {
14714 if (is_tracepoint (b))
14715 {
14716 if (from_tty && count != 0)
14717 printf_filtered (_("Ignore count ignored for tracepoint %d."),
14718 bptnum);
14719 return;
14720 }
14721
14722 b->ignore_count = count;
14723 if (from_tty)
14724 {
14725 if (count == 0)
14726 printf_filtered (_("Will stop next time "
14727 "breakpoint %d is reached."),
14728 bptnum);
14729 else if (count == 1)
14730 printf_filtered (_("Will ignore next crossing of breakpoint %d."),
14731 bptnum);
14732 else
14733 printf_filtered (_("Will ignore next %d "
14734 "crossings of breakpoint %d."),
14735 count, bptnum);
14736 }
14737 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b);
14738 return;
14739 }
14740
14741 error (_("No breakpoint number %d."), bptnum);
14742 }
14743
14744 /* Command to set ignore-count of breakpoint N to COUNT. */
14745
14746 static void
14747 ignore_command (char *args, int from_tty)
14748 {
14749 char *p = args;
14750 int num;
14751
14752 if (p == 0)
14753 error_no_arg (_("a breakpoint number"));
14754
14755 num = get_number (&p);
14756 if (num == 0)
14757 error (_("bad breakpoint number: '%s'"), args);
14758 if (*p == 0)
14759 error (_("Second argument (specified ignore-count) is missing."));
14760
14761 set_ignore_count (num,
14762 longest_to_int (value_as_long (parse_and_eval (p))),
14763 from_tty);
14764 if (from_tty)
14765 printf_filtered ("\n");
14766 }
14767 \f
14768 /* Call FUNCTION on each of the breakpoints
14769 whose numbers are given in ARGS. */
14770
14771 static void
14772 map_breakpoint_numbers (char *args, void (*function) (struct breakpoint *,
14773 void *),
14774 void *data)
14775 {
14776 int num;
14777 struct breakpoint *b, *tmp;
14778
14779 if (args == 0 || *args == '\0')
14780 error_no_arg (_("one or more breakpoint numbers"));
14781
14782 number_or_range_parser parser (args);
14783
14784 while (!parser.finished ())
14785 {
14786 const char *p = parser.cur_tok ();
14787 bool match = false;
14788
14789 num = parser.get_number ();
14790 if (num == 0)
14791 {
14792 warning (_("bad breakpoint number at or near '%s'"), p);
14793 }
14794 else
14795 {
14796 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, tmp)
14797 if (b->number == num)
14798 {
14799 match = true;
14800 function (b, data);
14801 break;
14802 }
14803 if (!match)
14804 printf_unfiltered (_("No breakpoint number %d.\n"), num);
14805 }
14806 }
14807 }
14808
14809 static struct bp_location *
14810 find_location_by_number (char *number)
14811 {
14812 char *dot = strchr (number, '.');
14813 char *p1;
14814 int bp_num;
14815 int loc_num;
14816 struct breakpoint *b;
14817 struct bp_location *loc;
14818
14819 *dot = '\0';
14820
14821 p1 = number;
14822 bp_num = get_number (&p1);
14823 if (bp_num == 0)
14824 error (_("Bad breakpoint number '%s'"), number);
14825
14826 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
14827 if (b->number == bp_num)
14828 {
14829 break;
14830 }
14831
14832 if (!b || b->number != bp_num)
14833 error (_("Bad breakpoint number '%s'"), number);
14834
14835 p1 = dot+1;
14836 loc_num = get_number (&p1);
14837 if (loc_num == 0)
14838 error (_("Bad breakpoint location number '%s'"), number);
14839
14840 --loc_num;
14841 loc = b->loc;
14842 for (;loc_num && loc; --loc_num, loc = loc->next)
14843 ;
14844 if (!loc)
14845 error (_("Bad breakpoint location number '%s'"), dot+1);
14846
14847 return loc;
14848 }
14849
14850
14851 /* Set ignore-count of breakpoint number BPTNUM to COUNT.
14852 If from_tty is nonzero, it prints a message to that effect,
14853 which ends with a period (no newline). */
14854
14855 void
14856 disable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
14857 {
14858 /* Never disable a watchpoint scope breakpoint; we want to
14859 hit them when we leave scope so we can delete both the
14860 watchpoint and its scope breakpoint at that time. */
14861 if (bpt->type == bp_watchpoint_scope)
14862 return;
14863
14864 bpt->enable_state = bp_disabled;
14865
14866 /* Mark breakpoint locations modified. */
14867 mark_breakpoint_modified (bpt);
14868
14869 if (target_supports_enable_disable_tracepoint ()
14870 && current_trace_status ()->running && is_tracepoint (bpt))
14871 {
14872 struct bp_location *location;
14873
14874 for (location = bpt->loc; location; location = location->next)
14875 target_disable_tracepoint (location);
14876 }
14877
14878 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
14879
14880 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (bpt);
14881 }
14882
14883 /* A callback for iterate_over_related_breakpoints. */
14884
14885 static void
14886 do_disable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b, void *ignore)
14887 {
14888 disable_breakpoint (b);
14889 }
14890
14891 /* A callback for map_breakpoint_numbers that calls
14892 disable_breakpoint. */
14893
14894 static void
14895 do_map_disable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b, void *ignore)
14896 {
14897 iterate_over_related_breakpoints (b, do_disable_breakpoint, NULL);
14898 }
14899
14900 static void
14901 disable_command (char *args, int from_tty)
14902 {
14903 if (args == 0)
14904 {
14905 struct breakpoint *bpt;
14906
14907 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
14908 if (user_breakpoint_p (bpt))
14909 disable_breakpoint (bpt);
14910 }
14911 else
14912 {
14913 char *num = extract_arg (&args);
14914
14915 while (num)
14916 {
14917 if (strchr (num, '.'))
14918 {
14919 struct bp_location *loc = find_location_by_number (num);
14920
14921 if (loc)
14922 {
14923 if (loc->enabled)
14924 {
14925 loc->enabled = 0;
14926 mark_breakpoint_location_modified (loc);
14927 }
14928 if (target_supports_enable_disable_tracepoint ()
14929 && current_trace_status ()->running && loc->owner
14930 && is_tracepoint (loc->owner))
14931 target_disable_tracepoint (loc);
14932 }
14933 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
14934 }
14935 else
14936 map_breakpoint_numbers (num, do_map_disable_breakpoint, NULL);
14937 num = extract_arg (&args);
14938 }
14939 }
14940 }
14941
14942 static void
14943 enable_breakpoint_disp (struct breakpoint *bpt, enum bpdisp disposition,
14944 int count)
14945 {
14946 int target_resources_ok;
14947
14948 if (bpt->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
14949 {
14950 int i;
14951 i = hw_breakpoint_used_count ();
14952 target_resources_ok =
14953 target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (bp_hardware_breakpoint,
14954 i + 1, 0);
14955 if (target_resources_ok == 0)
14956 error (_("No hardware breakpoint support in the target."));
14957 else if (target_resources_ok < 0)
14958 error (_("Hardware breakpoints used exceeds limit."));
14959 }
14960
14961 if (is_watchpoint (bpt))
14962 {
14963 /* Initialize it just to avoid a GCC false warning. */
14964 enum enable_state orig_enable_state = bp_disabled;
14965
14966 TRY
14967 {
14968 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bpt;
14969
14970 orig_enable_state = bpt->enable_state;
14971 bpt->enable_state = bp_enabled;
14972 update_watchpoint (w, 1 /* reparse */);
14973 }
14974 CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ALL)
14975 {
14976 bpt->enable_state = orig_enable_state;
14977 exception_fprintf (gdb_stderr, e, _("Cannot enable watchpoint %d: "),
14978 bpt->number);
14979 return;
14980 }
14981 END_CATCH
14982 }
14983
14984 bpt->enable_state = bp_enabled;
14985
14986 /* Mark breakpoint locations modified. */
14987 mark_breakpoint_modified (bpt);
14988
14989 if (target_supports_enable_disable_tracepoint ()
14990 && current_trace_status ()->running && is_tracepoint (bpt))
14991 {
14992 struct bp_location *location;
14993
14994 for (location = bpt->loc; location; location = location->next)
14995 target_enable_tracepoint (location);
14996 }
14997
14998 bpt->disposition = disposition;
14999 bpt->enable_count = count;
15000 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
15001
15002 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (bpt);
15003 }
15004
15005
15006 void
15007 enable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
15008 {
15009 enable_breakpoint_disp (bpt, bpt->disposition, 0);
15010 }
15011
15012 static void
15013 do_enable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt, void *arg)
15014 {
15015 enable_breakpoint (bpt);
15016 }
15017
15018 /* A callback for map_breakpoint_numbers that calls
15019 enable_breakpoint. */
15020
15021 static void
15022 do_map_enable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b, void *ignore)
15023 {
15024 iterate_over_related_breakpoints (b, do_enable_breakpoint, NULL);
15025 }
15026
15027 /* The enable command enables the specified breakpoints (or all defined
15028 breakpoints) so they once again become (or continue to be) effective
15029 in stopping the inferior. */
15030
15031 static void
15032 enable_command (char *args, int from_tty)
15033 {
15034 if (args == 0)
15035 {
15036 struct breakpoint *bpt;
15037
15038 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
15039 if (user_breakpoint_p (bpt))
15040 enable_breakpoint (bpt);
15041 }
15042 else
15043 {
15044 char *num = extract_arg (&args);
15045
15046 while (num)
15047 {
15048 if (strchr (num, '.'))
15049 {
15050 struct bp_location *loc = find_location_by_number (num);
15051
15052 if (loc)
15053 {
15054 if (!loc->enabled)
15055 {
15056 loc->enabled = 1;
15057 mark_breakpoint_location_modified (loc);
15058 }
15059 if (target_supports_enable_disable_tracepoint ()
15060 && current_trace_status ()->running && loc->owner
15061 && is_tracepoint (loc->owner))
15062 target_enable_tracepoint (loc);
15063 }
15064 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
15065 }
15066 else
15067 map_breakpoint_numbers (num, do_map_enable_breakpoint, NULL);
15068 num = extract_arg (&args);
15069 }
15070 }
15071 }
15072
15073 /* This struct packages up disposition data for application to multiple
15074 breakpoints. */
15075
15076 struct disp_data
15077 {
15078 enum bpdisp disp;
15079 int count;
15080 };
15081
15082 static void
15083 do_enable_breakpoint_disp (struct breakpoint *bpt, void *arg)
15084 {
15085 struct disp_data disp_data = *(struct disp_data *) arg;
15086
15087 enable_breakpoint_disp (bpt, disp_data.disp, disp_data.count);
15088 }
15089
15090 static void
15091 do_map_enable_once_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt, void *ignore)
15092 {
15093 struct disp_data disp = { disp_disable, 1 };
15094
15095 iterate_over_related_breakpoints (bpt, do_enable_breakpoint_disp, &disp);
15096 }
15097
15098 static void
15099 enable_once_command (char *args, int from_tty)
15100 {
15101 map_breakpoint_numbers (args, do_map_enable_once_breakpoint, NULL);
15102 }
15103
15104 static void
15105 do_map_enable_count_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt, void *countptr)
15106 {
15107 struct disp_data disp = { disp_disable, *(int *) countptr };
15108
15109 iterate_over_related_breakpoints (bpt, do_enable_breakpoint_disp, &disp);
15110 }
15111
15112 static void
15113 enable_count_command (char *args, int from_tty)
15114 {
15115 int count;
15116
15117 if (args == NULL)
15118 error_no_arg (_("hit count"));
15119
15120 count = get_number (&args);
15121
15122 map_breakpoint_numbers (args, do_map_enable_count_breakpoint, &count);
15123 }
15124
15125 static void
15126 do_map_enable_delete_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt, void *ignore)
15127 {
15128 struct disp_data disp = { disp_del, 1 };
15129
15130 iterate_over_related_breakpoints (bpt, do_enable_breakpoint_disp, &disp);
15131 }
15132
15133 static void
15134 enable_delete_command (char *args, int from_tty)
15135 {
15136 map_breakpoint_numbers (args, do_map_enable_delete_breakpoint, NULL);
15137 }
15138 \f
15139 static void
15140 set_breakpoint_cmd (char *args, int from_tty)
15141 {
15142 }
15143
15144 static void
15145 show_breakpoint_cmd (char *args, int from_tty)
15146 {
15147 }
15148
15149 /* Invalidate last known value of any hardware watchpoint if
15150 the memory which that value represents has been written to by
15151 GDB itself. */
15152
15153 static void
15154 invalidate_bp_value_on_memory_change (struct inferior *inferior,
15155 CORE_ADDR addr, ssize_t len,
15156 const bfd_byte *data)
15157 {
15158 struct breakpoint *bp;
15159
15160 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bp)
15161 if (bp->enable_state == bp_enabled
15162 && bp->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
15163 {
15164 struct watchpoint *wp = (struct watchpoint *) bp;
15165
15166 if (wp->val_valid && wp->val)
15167 {
15168 struct bp_location *loc;
15169
15170 for (loc = bp->loc; loc != NULL; loc = loc->next)
15171 if (loc->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint
15172 && loc->address + loc->length > addr
15173 && addr + len > loc->address)
15174 {
15175 value_free (wp->val);
15176 wp->val = NULL;
15177 wp->val_valid = 0;
15178 }
15179 }
15180 }
15181 }
15182
15183 /* Create and insert a breakpoint for software single step. */
15184
15185 void
15186 insert_single_step_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
15187 struct address_space *aspace,
15188 CORE_ADDR next_pc)
15189 {
15190 struct thread_info *tp = inferior_thread ();
15191 struct symtab_and_line sal;
15192 CORE_ADDR pc = next_pc;
15193
15194 if (tp->control.single_step_breakpoints == NULL)
15195 {
15196 tp->control.single_step_breakpoints
15197 = new_single_step_breakpoint (tp->global_num, gdbarch);
15198 }
15199
15200 sal = find_pc_line (pc, 0);
15201 sal.pc = pc;
15202 sal.section = find_pc_overlay (pc);
15203 sal.explicit_pc = 1;
15204 add_location_to_breakpoint (tp->control.single_step_breakpoints, &sal);
15205
15206 update_global_location_list (UGLL_INSERT);
15207 }
15208
15209 /* See breakpoint.h. */
15210
15211 int
15212 breakpoint_has_location_inserted_here (struct breakpoint *bp,
15213 struct address_space *aspace,
15214 CORE_ADDR pc)
15215 {
15216 struct bp_location *loc;
15217
15218 for (loc = bp->loc; loc != NULL; loc = loc->next)
15219 if (loc->inserted
15220 && breakpoint_location_address_match (loc, aspace, pc))
15221 return 1;
15222
15223 return 0;
15224 }
15225
15226 /* Check whether a software single-step breakpoint is inserted at
15227 PC. */
15228
15229 int
15230 single_step_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (struct address_space *aspace,
15231 CORE_ADDR pc)
15232 {
15233 struct breakpoint *bpt;
15234
15235 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
15236 {
15237 if (bpt->type == bp_single_step
15238 && breakpoint_has_location_inserted_here (bpt, aspace, pc))
15239 return 1;
15240 }
15241 return 0;
15242 }
15243
15244 /* Tracepoint-specific operations. */
15245
15246 /* Set tracepoint count to NUM. */
15247 static void
15248 set_tracepoint_count (int num)
15249 {
15250 tracepoint_count = num;
15251 set_internalvar_integer (lookup_internalvar ("tpnum"), num);
15252 }
15253
15254 static void
15255 trace_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
15256 {
15257 struct breakpoint_ops *ops;
15258 struct event_location *location;
15259 struct cleanup *back_to;
15260
15261 location = string_to_event_location (&arg, current_language);
15262 back_to = make_cleanup_delete_event_location (location);
15263 if (location != NULL
15264 && event_location_type (location) == PROBE_LOCATION)
15265 ops = &tracepoint_probe_breakpoint_ops;
15266 else
15267 ops = &tracepoint_breakpoint_ops;
15268
15269 create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
15270 location,
15271 NULL, 0, arg, 1 /* parse arg */,
15272 0 /* tempflag */,
15273 bp_tracepoint /* type_wanted */,
15274 0 /* Ignore count */,
15275 pending_break_support,
15276 ops,
15277 from_tty,
15278 1 /* enabled */,
15279 0 /* internal */, 0);
15280 do_cleanups (back_to);
15281 }
15282
15283 static void
15284 ftrace_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
15285 {
15286 struct event_location *location;
15287 struct cleanup *back_to;
15288
15289 location = string_to_event_location (&arg, current_language);
15290 back_to = make_cleanup_delete_event_location (location);
15291 create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
15292 location,
15293 NULL, 0, arg, 1 /* parse arg */,
15294 0 /* tempflag */,
15295 bp_fast_tracepoint /* type_wanted */,
15296 0 /* Ignore count */,
15297 pending_break_support,
15298 &tracepoint_breakpoint_ops,
15299 from_tty,
15300 1 /* enabled */,
15301 0 /* internal */, 0);
15302 do_cleanups (back_to);
15303 }
15304
15305 /* strace command implementation. Creates a static tracepoint. */
15306
15307 static void
15308 strace_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
15309 {
15310 struct breakpoint_ops *ops;
15311 struct event_location *location;
15312 struct cleanup *back_to;
15313
15314 /* Decide if we are dealing with a static tracepoint marker (`-m'),
15315 or with a normal static tracepoint. */
15316 if (arg && startswith (arg, "-m") && isspace (arg[2]))
15317 {
15318 ops = &strace_marker_breakpoint_ops;
15319 location = new_linespec_location (&arg);
15320 }
15321 else
15322 {
15323 ops = &tracepoint_breakpoint_ops;
15324 location = string_to_event_location (&arg, current_language);
15325 }
15326
15327 back_to = make_cleanup_delete_event_location (location);
15328 create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
15329 location,
15330 NULL, 0, arg, 1 /* parse arg */,
15331 0 /* tempflag */,
15332 bp_static_tracepoint /* type_wanted */,
15333 0 /* Ignore count */,
15334 pending_break_support,
15335 ops,
15336 from_tty,
15337 1 /* enabled */,
15338 0 /* internal */, 0);
15339 do_cleanups (back_to);
15340 }
15341
15342 /* Set up a fake reader function that gets command lines from a linked
15343 list that was acquired during tracepoint uploading. */
15344
15345 static struct uploaded_tp *this_utp;
15346 static int next_cmd;
15347
15348 static char *
15349 read_uploaded_action (void)
15350 {
15351 char *rslt;
15352
15353 VEC_iterate (char_ptr, this_utp->cmd_strings, next_cmd, rslt);
15354
15355 next_cmd++;
15356
15357 return rslt;
15358 }
15359
15360 /* Given information about a tracepoint as recorded on a target (which
15361 can be either a live system or a trace file), attempt to create an
15362 equivalent GDB tracepoint. This is not a reliable process, since
15363 the target does not necessarily have all the information used when
15364 the tracepoint was originally defined. */
15365
15366 struct tracepoint *
15367 create_tracepoint_from_upload (struct uploaded_tp *utp)
15368 {
15369 char *addr_str, small_buf[100];
15370 struct tracepoint *tp;
15371 struct event_location *location;
15372 struct cleanup *cleanup;
15373
15374 if (utp->at_string)
15375 addr_str = utp->at_string;
15376 else
15377 {
15378 /* In the absence of a source location, fall back to raw
15379 address. Since there is no way to confirm that the address
15380 means the same thing as when the trace was started, warn the
15381 user. */
15382 warning (_("Uploaded tracepoint %d has no "
15383 "source location, using raw address"),
15384 utp->number);
15385 xsnprintf (small_buf, sizeof (small_buf), "*%s", hex_string (utp->addr));
15386 addr_str = small_buf;
15387 }
15388
15389 /* There's not much we can do with a sequence of bytecodes. */
15390 if (utp->cond && !utp->cond_string)
15391 warning (_("Uploaded tracepoint %d condition "
15392 "has no source form, ignoring it"),
15393 utp->number);
15394
15395 location = string_to_event_location (&addr_str, current_language);
15396 cleanup = make_cleanup_delete_event_location (location);
15397 if (!create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
15398 location,
15399 utp->cond_string, -1, addr_str,
15400 0 /* parse cond/thread */,
15401 0 /* tempflag */,
15402 utp->type /* type_wanted */,
15403 0 /* Ignore count */,
15404 pending_break_support,
15405 &tracepoint_breakpoint_ops,
15406 0 /* from_tty */,
15407 utp->enabled /* enabled */,
15408 0 /* internal */,
15409 CREATE_BREAKPOINT_FLAGS_INSERTED))
15410 {
15411 do_cleanups (cleanup);
15412 return NULL;
15413 }
15414
15415 do_cleanups (cleanup);
15416
15417 /* Get the tracepoint we just created. */
15418 tp = get_tracepoint (tracepoint_count);
15419 gdb_assert (tp != NULL);
15420
15421 if (utp->pass > 0)
15422 {
15423 xsnprintf (small_buf, sizeof (small_buf), "%d %d", utp->pass,
15424 tp->base.number);
15425
15426 trace_pass_command (small_buf, 0);
15427 }
15428
15429 /* If we have uploaded versions of the original commands, set up a
15430 special-purpose "reader" function and call the usual command line
15431 reader, then pass the result to the breakpoint command-setting
15432 function. */
15433 if (!VEC_empty (char_ptr, utp->cmd_strings))
15434 {
15435 struct command_line *cmd_list;
15436
15437 this_utp = utp;
15438 next_cmd = 0;
15439
15440 cmd_list = read_command_lines_1 (read_uploaded_action, 1, NULL, NULL);
15441
15442 breakpoint_set_commands (&tp->base, cmd_list);
15443 }
15444 else if (!VEC_empty (char_ptr, utp->actions)
15445 || !VEC_empty (char_ptr, utp->step_actions))
15446 warning (_("Uploaded tracepoint %d actions "
15447 "have no source form, ignoring them"),
15448 utp->number);
15449
15450 /* Copy any status information that might be available. */
15451 tp->base.hit_count = utp->hit_count;
15452 tp->traceframe_usage = utp->traceframe_usage;
15453
15454 return tp;
15455 }
15456
15457 /* Print information on tracepoint number TPNUM_EXP, or all if
15458 omitted. */
15459
15460 static void
15461 tracepoints_info (char *args, int from_tty)
15462 {
15463 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
15464 int num_printed;
15465
15466 num_printed = breakpoint_1 (args, 0, is_tracepoint);
15467
15468 if (num_printed == 0)
15469 {
15470 if (args == NULL || *args == '\0')
15471 ui_out_message (uiout, 0, "No tracepoints.\n");
15472 else
15473 ui_out_message (uiout, 0, "No tracepoint matching '%s'.\n", args);
15474 }
15475
15476 default_collect_info ();
15477 }
15478
15479 /* The 'enable trace' command enables tracepoints.
15480 Not supported by all targets. */
15481 static void
15482 enable_trace_command (char *args, int from_tty)
15483 {
15484 enable_command (args, from_tty);
15485 }
15486
15487 /* The 'disable trace' command disables tracepoints.
15488 Not supported by all targets. */
15489 static void
15490 disable_trace_command (char *args, int from_tty)
15491 {
15492 disable_command (args, from_tty);
15493 }
15494
15495 /* Remove a tracepoint (or all if no argument). */
15496 static void
15497 delete_trace_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
15498 {
15499 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
15500
15501 dont_repeat ();
15502
15503 if (arg == 0)
15504 {
15505 int breaks_to_delete = 0;
15506
15507 /* Delete all breakpoints if no argument.
15508 Do not delete internal or call-dummy breakpoints, these
15509 have to be deleted with an explicit breakpoint number
15510 argument. */
15511 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (b)
15512 if (is_tracepoint (b) && user_breakpoint_p (b))
15513 {
15514 breaks_to_delete = 1;
15515 break;
15516 }
15517
15518 /* Ask user only if there are some breakpoints to delete. */
15519 if (!from_tty
15520 || (breaks_to_delete && query (_("Delete all tracepoints? "))))
15521 {
15522 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
15523 if (is_tracepoint (b) && user_breakpoint_p (b))
15524 delete_breakpoint (b);
15525 }
15526 }
15527 else
15528 map_breakpoint_numbers (arg, do_map_delete_breakpoint, NULL);
15529 }
15530
15531 /* Helper function for trace_pass_command. */
15532
15533 static void
15534 trace_pass_set_count (struct tracepoint *tp, int count, int from_tty)
15535 {
15536 tp->pass_count = count;
15537 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (&tp->base);
15538 if (from_tty)
15539 printf_filtered (_("Setting tracepoint %d's passcount to %d\n"),
15540 tp->base.number, count);
15541 }
15542
15543 /* Set passcount for tracepoint.
15544
15545 First command argument is passcount, second is tracepoint number.
15546 If tracepoint number omitted, apply to most recently defined.
15547 Also accepts special argument "all". */
15548
15549 static void
15550 trace_pass_command (char *args, int from_tty)
15551 {
15552 struct tracepoint *t1;
15553 unsigned int count;
15554
15555 if (args == 0 || *args == 0)
15556 error (_("passcount command requires an "
15557 "argument (count + optional TP num)"));
15558
15559 count = strtoul (args, &args, 10); /* Count comes first, then TP num. */
15560
15561 args = skip_spaces (args);
15562 if (*args && strncasecmp (args, "all", 3) == 0)
15563 {
15564 struct breakpoint *b;
15565
15566 args += 3; /* Skip special argument "all". */
15567 if (*args)
15568 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
15569
15570 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (b)
15571 {
15572 t1 = (struct tracepoint *) b;
15573 trace_pass_set_count (t1, count, from_tty);
15574 }
15575 }
15576 else if (*args == '\0')
15577 {
15578 t1 = get_tracepoint_by_number (&args, NULL);
15579 if (t1)
15580 trace_pass_set_count (t1, count, from_tty);
15581 }
15582 else
15583 {
15584 number_or_range_parser parser (args);
15585 while (!parser.finished ())
15586 {
15587 t1 = get_tracepoint_by_number (&args, &parser);
15588 if (t1)
15589 trace_pass_set_count (t1, count, from_tty);
15590 }
15591 }
15592 }
15593
15594 struct tracepoint *
15595 get_tracepoint (int num)
15596 {
15597 struct breakpoint *t;
15598
15599 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (t)
15600 if (t->number == num)
15601 return (struct tracepoint *) t;
15602
15603 return NULL;
15604 }
15605
15606 /* Find the tracepoint with the given target-side number (which may be
15607 different from the tracepoint number after disconnecting and
15608 reconnecting). */
15609
15610 struct tracepoint *
15611 get_tracepoint_by_number_on_target (int num)
15612 {
15613 struct breakpoint *b;
15614
15615 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (b)
15616 {
15617 struct tracepoint *t = (struct tracepoint *) b;
15618
15619 if (t->number_on_target == num)
15620 return t;
15621 }
15622
15623 return NULL;
15624 }
15625
15626 /* Utility: parse a tracepoint number and look it up in the list.
15627 If STATE is not NULL, use, get_number_or_range_state and ignore ARG.
15628 If the argument is missing, the most recent tracepoint
15629 (tracepoint_count) is returned. */
15630
15631 struct tracepoint *
15632 get_tracepoint_by_number (char **arg,
15633 number_or_range_parser *parser)
15634 {
15635 struct breakpoint *t;
15636 int tpnum;
15637 char *instring = arg == NULL ? NULL : *arg;
15638
15639 if (parser != NULL)
15640 {
15641 gdb_assert (!parser->finished ());
15642 tpnum = parser->get_number ();
15643 }
15644 else if (arg == NULL || *arg == NULL || ! **arg)
15645 tpnum = tracepoint_count;
15646 else
15647 tpnum = get_number (arg);
15648
15649 if (tpnum <= 0)
15650 {
15651 if (instring && *instring)
15652 printf_filtered (_("bad tracepoint number at or near '%s'\n"),
15653 instring);
15654 else
15655 printf_filtered (_("No previous tracepoint\n"));
15656 return NULL;
15657 }
15658
15659 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (t)
15660 if (t->number == tpnum)
15661 {
15662 return (struct tracepoint *) t;
15663 }
15664
15665 printf_unfiltered ("No tracepoint number %d.\n", tpnum);
15666 return NULL;
15667 }
15668
15669 void
15670 print_recreate_thread (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
15671 {
15672 if (b->thread != -1)
15673 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " thread %d", b->thread);
15674
15675 if (b->task != 0)
15676 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " task %d", b->task);
15677
15678 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "\n");
15679 }
15680
15681 /* Save information on user settable breakpoints (watchpoints, etc) to
15682 a new script file named FILENAME. If FILTER is non-NULL, call it
15683 on each breakpoint and only include the ones for which it returns
15684 non-zero. */
15685
15686 static void
15687 save_breakpoints (char *filename, int from_tty,
15688 int (*filter) (const struct breakpoint *))
15689 {
15690 struct breakpoint *tp;
15691 int any = 0;
15692 struct cleanup *cleanup;
15693 struct ui_file *fp;
15694 int extra_trace_bits = 0;
15695
15696 if (filename == 0 || *filename == 0)
15697 error (_("Argument required (file name in which to save)"));
15698
15699 /* See if we have anything to save. */
15700 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (tp)
15701 {
15702 /* Skip internal and momentary breakpoints. */
15703 if (!user_breakpoint_p (tp))
15704 continue;
15705
15706 /* If we have a filter, only save the breakpoints it accepts. */
15707 if (filter && !filter (tp))
15708 continue;
15709
15710 any = 1;
15711
15712 if (is_tracepoint (tp))
15713 {
15714 extra_trace_bits = 1;
15715
15716 /* We can stop searching. */
15717 break;
15718 }
15719 }
15720
15721 if (!any)
15722 {
15723 warning (_("Nothing to save."));
15724 return;
15725 }
15726
15727 filename = tilde_expand (filename);
15728 cleanup = make_cleanup (xfree, filename);
15729 fp = gdb_fopen (filename, "w");
15730 if (!fp)
15731 error (_("Unable to open file '%s' for saving (%s)"),
15732 filename, safe_strerror (errno));
15733 make_cleanup_ui_file_delete (fp);
15734
15735 if (extra_trace_bits)
15736 save_trace_state_variables (fp);
15737
15738 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (tp)
15739 {
15740 /* Skip internal and momentary breakpoints. */
15741 if (!user_breakpoint_p (tp))
15742 continue;
15743
15744 /* If we have a filter, only save the breakpoints it accepts. */
15745 if (filter && !filter (tp))
15746 continue;
15747
15748 tp->ops->print_recreate (tp, fp);
15749
15750 /* Note, we can't rely on tp->number for anything, as we can't
15751 assume the recreated breakpoint numbers will match. Use $bpnum
15752 instead. */
15753
15754 if (tp->cond_string)
15755 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " condition $bpnum %s\n", tp->cond_string);
15756
15757 if (tp->ignore_count)
15758 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " ignore $bpnum %d\n", tp->ignore_count);
15759
15760 if (tp->type != bp_dprintf && tp->commands)
15761 {
15762 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " commands\n");
15763
15764 ui_out_redirect (current_uiout, fp);
15765 TRY
15766 {
15767 print_command_lines (current_uiout, tp->commands->commands, 2);
15768 }
15769 CATCH (ex, RETURN_MASK_ALL)
15770 {
15771 ui_out_redirect (current_uiout, NULL);
15772 throw_exception (ex);
15773 }
15774 END_CATCH
15775
15776 ui_out_redirect (current_uiout, NULL);
15777 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " end\n");
15778 }
15779
15780 if (tp->enable_state == bp_disabled)
15781 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "disable $bpnum\n");
15782
15783 /* If this is a multi-location breakpoint, check if the locations
15784 should be individually disabled. Watchpoint locations are
15785 special, and not user visible. */
15786 if (!is_watchpoint (tp) && tp->loc && tp->loc->next)
15787 {
15788 struct bp_location *loc;
15789 int n = 1;
15790
15791 for (loc = tp->loc; loc != NULL; loc = loc->next, n++)
15792 if (!loc->enabled)
15793 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "disable $bpnum.%d\n", n);
15794 }
15795 }
15796
15797 if (extra_trace_bits && *default_collect)
15798 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "set default-collect %s\n", default_collect);
15799
15800 if (from_tty)
15801 printf_filtered (_("Saved to file '%s'.\n"), filename);
15802 do_cleanups (cleanup);
15803 }
15804
15805 /* The `save breakpoints' command. */
15806
15807 static void
15808 save_breakpoints_command (char *args, int from_tty)
15809 {
15810 save_breakpoints (args, from_tty, NULL);
15811 }
15812
15813 /* The `save tracepoints' command. */
15814
15815 static void
15816 save_tracepoints_command (char *args, int from_tty)
15817 {
15818 save_breakpoints (args, from_tty, is_tracepoint);
15819 }
15820
15821 /* Create a vector of all tracepoints. */
15822
15823 VEC(breakpoint_p) *
15824 all_tracepoints (void)
15825 {
15826 VEC(breakpoint_p) *tp_vec = 0;
15827 struct breakpoint *tp;
15828
15829 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (tp)
15830 {
15831 VEC_safe_push (breakpoint_p, tp_vec, tp);
15832 }
15833
15834 return tp_vec;
15835 }
15836
15837 \f
15838 /* This help string is used to consolidate all the help string for specifying
15839 locations used by several commands. */
15840
15841 #define LOCATION_HELP_STRING \
15842 "Linespecs are colon-separated lists of location parameters, such as\n\
15843 source filename, function name, label name, and line number.\n\
15844 Example: To specify the start of a label named \"the_top\" in the\n\
15845 function \"fact\" in the file \"factorial.c\", use\n\
15846 \"factorial.c:fact:the_top\".\n\
15847 \n\
15848 Address locations begin with \"*\" and specify an exact address in the\n\
15849 program. Example: To specify the fourth byte past the start function\n\
15850 \"main\", use \"*main + 4\".\n\
15851 \n\
15852 Explicit locations are similar to linespecs but use an option/argument\n\
15853 syntax to specify location parameters.\n\
15854 Example: To specify the start of the label named \"the_top\" in the\n\
15855 function \"fact\" in the file \"factorial.c\", use \"-source factorial.c\n\
15856 -function fact -label the_top\".\n"
15857
15858 /* This help string is used for the break, hbreak, tbreak and thbreak
15859 commands. It is defined as a macro to prevent duplication.
15860 COMMAND should be a string constant containing the name of the
15861 command. */
15862
15863 #define BREAK_ARGS_HELP(command) \
15864 command" [PROBE_MODIFIER] [LOCATION] [thread THREADNUM] [if CONDITION]\n\
15865 PROBE_MODIFIER shall be present if the command is to be placed in a\n\
15866 probe point. Accepted values are `-probe' (for a generic, automatically\n\
15867 guessed probe type), `-probe-stap' (for a SystemTap probe) or \n\
15868 `-probe-dtrace' (for a DTrace probe).\n\
15869 LOCATION may be a linespec, address, or explicit location as described\n\
15870 below.\n\
15871 \n\
15872 With no LOCATION, uses current execution address of the selected\n\
15873 stack frame. This is useful for breaking on return to a stack frame.\n\
15874 \n\
15875 THREADNUM is the number from \"info threads\".\n\
15876 CONDITION is a boolean expression.\n\
15877 \n" LOCATION_HELP_STRING "\n\
15878 Multiple breakpoints at one place are permitted, and useful if their\n\
15879 conditions are different.\n\
15880 \n\
15881 Do \"help breakpoints\" for info on other commands dealing with breakpoints."
15882
15883 /* List of subcommands for "catch". */
15884 static struct cmd_list_element *catch_cmdlist;
15885
15886 /* List of subcommands for "tcatch". */
15887 static struct cmd_list_element *tcatch_cmdlist;
15888
15889 void
15890 add_catch_command (char *name, char *docstring,
15891 cmd_sfunc_ftype *sfunc,
15892 completer_ftype *completer,
15893 void *user_data_catch,
15894 void *user_data_tcatch)
15895 {
15896 struct cmd_list_element *command;
15897
15898 command = add_cmd (name, class_breakpoint, NULL, docstring,
15899 &catch_cmdlist);
15900 set_cmd_sfunc (command, sfunc);
15901 set_cmd_context (command, user_data_catch);
15902 set_cmd_completer (command, completer);
15903
15904 command = add_cmd (name, class_breakpoint, NULL, docstring,
15905 &tcatch_cmdlist);
15906 set_cmd_sfunc (command, sfunc);
15907 set_cmd_context (command, user_data_tcatch);
15908 set_cmd_completer (command, completer);
15909 }
15910
15911 static void
15912 save_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
15913 {
15914 printf_unfiltered (_("\"save\" must be followed by "
15915 "the name of a save subcommand.\n"));
15916 help_list (save_cmdlist, "save ", all_commands, gdb_stdout);
15917 }
15918
15919 struct breakpoint *
15920 iterate_over_breakpoints (int (*callback) (struct breakpoint *, void *),
15921 void *data)
15922 {
15923 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
15924
15925 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
15926 {
15927 if ((*callback) (b, data))
15928 return b;
15929 }
15930
15931 return NULL;
15932 }
15933
15934 /* Zero if any of the breakpoint's locations could be a location where
15935 functions have been inlined, nonzero otherwise. */
15936
15937 static int
15938 is_non_inline_function (struct breakpoint *b)
15939 {
15940 /* The shared library event breakpoint is set on the address of a
15941 non-inline function. */
15942 if (b->type == bp_shlib_event)
15943 return 1;
15944
15945 return 0;
15946 }
15947
15948 /* Nonzero if the specified PC cannot be a location where functions
15949 have been inlined. */
15950
15951 int
15952 pc_at_non_inline_function (struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc,
15953 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
15954 {
15955 struct breakpoint *b;
15956 struct bp_location *bl;
15957
15958 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
15959 {
15960 if (!is_non_inline_function (b))
15961 continue;
15962
15963 for (bl = b->loc; bl != NULL; bl = bl->next)
15964 {
15965 if (!bl->shlib_disabled
15966 && bpstat_check_location (bl, aspace, pc, ws))
15967 return 1;
15968 }
15969 }
15970
15971 return 0;
15972 }
15973
15974 /* Remove any references to OBJFILE which is going to be freed. */
15975
15976 void
15977 breakpoint_free_objfile (struct objfile *objfile)
15978 {
15979 struct bp_location **locp, *loc;
15980
15981 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, locp)
15982 if (loc->symtab != NULL && SYMTAB_OBJFILE (loc->symtab) == objfile)
15983 loc->symtab = NULL;
15984 }
15985
15986 void
15987 initialize_breakpoint_ops (void)
15988 {
15989 static int initialized = 0;
15990
15991 struct breakpoint_ops *ops;
15992
15993 if (initialized)
15994 return;
15995 initialized = 1;
15996
15997 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be inherit by all kinds of
15998 breakpoints (real breakpoints, i.e., user "break" breakpoints,
15999 internal and momentary breakpoints, etc.). */
16000 ops = &bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops;
16001 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
16002 ops->re_set = bkpt_re_set;
16003 ops->insert_location = bkpt_insert_location;
16004 ops->remove_location = bkpt_remove_location;
16005 ops->breakpoint_hit = bkpt_breakpoint_hit;
16006 ops->create_sals_from_location = bkpt_create_sals_from_location;
16007 ops->create_breakpoints_sal = bkpt_create_breakpoints_sal;
16008 ops->decode_location = bkpt_decode_location;
16009
16010 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in regular breakpoints. */
16011 ops = &bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
16012 *ops = bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops;
16013 ops->re_set = bkpt_re_set;
16014 ops->resources_needed = bkpt_resources_needed;
16015 ops->print_it = bkpt_print_it;
16016 ops->print_mention = bkpt_print_mention;
16017 ops->print_recreate = bkpt_print_recreate;
16018
16019 /* Ranged breakpoints. */
16020 ops = &ranged_breakpoint_ops;
16021 *ops = bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
16022 ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_ranged_breakpoint;
16023 ops->resources_needed = resources_needed_ranged_breakpoint;
16024 ops->print_it = print_it_ranged_breakpoint;
16025 ops->print_one = print_one_ranged_breakpoint;
16026 ops->print_one_detail = print_one_detail_ranged_breakpoint;
16027 ops->print_mention = print_mention_ranged_breakpoint;
16028 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_ranged_breakpoint;
16029
16030 /* Internal breakpoints. */
16031 ops = &internal_breakpoint_ops;
16032 *ops = bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops;
16033 ops->re_set = internal_bkpt_re_set;
16034 ops->check_status = internal_bkpt_check_status;
16035 ops->print_it = internal_bkpt_print_it;
16036 ops->print_mention = internal_bkpt_print_mention;
16037
16038 /* Momentary breakpoints. */
16039 ops = &momentary_breakpoint_ops;
16040 *ops = bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops;
16041 ops->re_set = momentary_bkpt_re_set;
16042 ops->check_status = momentary_bkpt_check_status;
16043 ops->print_it = momentary_bkpt_print_it;
16044 ops->print_mention = momentary_bkpt_print_mention;
16045
16046 /* Momentary breakpoints for bp_longjmp and bp_exception. */
16047 ops = &longjmp_breakpoint_ops;
16048 *ops = momentary_breakpoint_ops;
16049 ops->dtor = longjmp_bkpt_dtor;
16050
16051 /* Probe breakpoints. */
16052 ops = &bkpt_probe_breakpoint_ops;
16053 *ops = bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
16054 ops->insert_location = bkpt_probe_insert_location;
16055 ops->remove_location = bkpt_probe_remove_location;
16056 ops->create_sals_from_location = bkpt_probe_create_sals_from_location;
16057 ops->decode_location = bkpt_probe_decode_location;
16058
16059 /* Watchpoints. */
16060 ops = &watchpoint_breakpoint_ops;
16061 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
16062 ops->dtor = dtor_watchpoint;
16063 ops->re_set = re_set_watchpoint;
16064 ops->insert_location = insert_watchpoint;
16065 ops->remove_location = remove_watchpoint;
16066 ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_watchpoint;
16067 ops->check_status = check_status_watchpoint;
16068 ops->resources_needed = resources_needed_watchpoint;
16069 ops->works_in_software_mode = works_in_software_mode_watchpoint;
16070 ops->print_it = print_it_watchpoint;
16071 ops->print_mention = print_mention_watchpoint;
16072 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_watchpoint;
16073 ops->explains_signal = explains_signal_watchpoint;
16074
16075 /* Masked watchpoints. */
16076 ops = &masked_watchpoint_breakpoint_ops;
16077 *ops = watchpoint_breakpoint_ops;
16078 ops->insert_location = insert_masked_watchpoint;
16079 ops->remove_location = remove_masked_watchpoint;
16080 ops->resources_needed = resources_needed_masked_watchpoint;
16081 ops->works_in_software_mode = works_in_software_mode_masked_watchpoint;
16082 ops->print_it = print_it_masked_watchpoint;
16083 ops->print_one_detail = print_one_detail_masked_watchpoint;
16084 ops->print_mention = print_mention_masked_watchpoint;
16085 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_masked_watchpoint;
16086
16087 /* Tracepoints. */
16088 ops = &tracepoint_breakpoint_ops;
16089 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
16090 ops->re_set = tracepoint_re_set;
16091 ops->breakpoint_hit = tracepoint_breakpoint_hit;
16092 ops->print_one_detail = tracepoint_print_one_detail;
16093 ops->print_mention = tracepoint_print_mention;
16094 ops->print_recreate = tracepoint_print_recreate;
16095 ops->create_sals_from_location = tracepoint_create_sals_from_location;
16096 ops->create_breakpoints_sal = tracepoint_create_breakpoints_sal;
16097 ops->decode_location = tracepoint_decode_location;
16098
16099 /* Probe tracepoints. */
16100 ops = &tracepoint_probe_breakpoint_ops;
16101 *ops = tracepoint_breakpoint_ops;
16102 ops->create_sals_from_location = tracepoint_probe_create_sals_from_location;
16103 ops->decode_location = tracepoint_probe_decode_location;
16104
16105 /* Static tracepoints with marker (`-m'). */
16106 ops = &strace_marker_breakpoint_ops;
16107 *ops = tracepoint_breakpoint_ops;
16108 ops->create_sals_from_location = strace_marker_create_sals_from_location;
16109 ops->create_breakpoints_sal = strace_marker_create_breakpoints_sal;
16110 ops->decode_location = strace_marker_decode_location;
16111
16112 /* Fork catchpoints. */
16113 ops = &catch_fork_breakpoint_ops;
16114 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
16115 ops->insert_location = insert_catch_fork;
16116 ops->remove_location = remove_catch_fork;
16117 ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_catch_fork;
16118 ops->print_it = print_it_catch_fork;
16119 ops->print_one = print_one_catch_fork;
16120 ops->print_mention = print_mention_catch_fork;
16121 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_catch_fork;
16122
16123 /* Vfork catchpoints. */
16124 ops = &catch_vfork_breakpoint_ops;
16125 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
16126 ops->insert_location = insert_catch_vfork;
16127 ops->remove_location = remove_catch_vfork;
16128 ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_catch_vfork;
16129 ops->print_it = print_it_catch_vfork;
16130 ops->print_one = print_one_catch_vfork;
16131 ops->print_mention = print_mention_catch_vfork;
16132 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_catch_vfork;
16133
16134 /* Exec catchpoints. */
16135 ops = &catch_exec_breakpoint_ops;
16136 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
16137 ops->dtor = dtor_catch_exec;
16138 ops->insert_location = insert_catch_exec;
16139 ops->remove_location = remove_catch_exec;
16140 ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_catch_exec;
16141 ops->print_it = print_it_catch_exec;
16142 ops->print_one = print_one_catch_exec;
16143 ops->print_mention = print_mention_catch_exec;
16144 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_catch_exec;
16145
16146 /* Solib-related catchpoints. */
16147 ops = &catch_solib_breakpoint_ops;
16148 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
16149 ops->dtor = dtor_catch_solib;
16150 ops->insert_location = insert_catch_solib;
16151 ops->remove_location = remove_catch_solib;
16152 ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_catch_solib;
16153 ops->check_status = check_status_catch_solib;
16154 ops->print_it = print_it_catch_solib;
16155 ops->print_one = print_one_catch_solib;
16156 ops->print_mention = print_mention_catch_solib;
16157 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_catch_solib;
16158
16159 ops = &dprintf_breakpoint_ops;
16160 *ops = bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops;
16161 ops->re_set = dprintf_re_set;
16162 ops->resources_needed = bkpt_resources_needed;
16163 ops->print_it = bkpt_print_it;
16164 ops->print_mention = bkpt_print_mention;
16165 ops->print_recreate = dprintf_print_recreate;
16166 ops->after_condition_true = dprintf_after_condition_true;
16167 ops->breakpoint_hit = dprintf_breakpoint_hit;
16168 }
16169
16170 /* Chain containing all defined "enable breakpoint" subcommands. */
16171
16172 static struct cmd_list_element *enablebreaklist = NULL;
16173
16174 void
16175 _initialize_breakpoint (void)
16176 {
16177 struct cmd_list_element *c;
16178
16179 initialize_breakpoint_ops ();
16180
16181 observer_attach_solib_unloaded (disable_breakpoints_in_unloaded_shlib);
16182 observer_attach_free_objfile (disable_breakpoints_in_freed_objfile);
16183 observer_attach_memory_changed (invalidate_bp_value_on_memory_change);
16184
16185 breakpoint_objfile_key
16186 = register_objfile_data_with_cleanup (NULL, free_breakpoint_probes);
16187
16188 breakpoint_chain = 0;
16189 /* Don't bother to call set_breakpoint_count. $bpnum isn't useful
16190 before a breakpoint is set. */
16191 breakpoint_count = 0;
16192
16193 tracepoint_count = 0;
16194
16195 add_com ("ignore", class_breakpoint, ignore_command, _("\
16196 Set ignore-count of breakpoint number N to COUNT.\n\
16197 Usage is `ignore N COUNT'."));
16198
16199 add_com ("commands", class_breakpoint, commands_command, _("\
16200 Set commands to be executed when a breakpoint is hit.\n\
16201 Give breakpoint number as argument after \"commands\".\n\
16202 With no argument, the targeted breakpoint is the last one set.\n\
16203 The commands themselves follow starting on the next line.\n\
16204 Type a line containing \"end\" to indicate the end of them.\n\
16205 Give \"silent\" as the first line to make the breakpoint silent;\n\
16206 then no output is printed when it is hit, except what the commands print."));
16207
16208 c = add_com ("condition", class_breakpoint, condition_command, _("\
16209 Specify breakpoint number N to break only if COND is true.\n\
16210 Usage is `condition N COND', where N is an integer and COND is an\n\
16211 expression to be evaluated whenever breakpoint N is reached."));
16212 set_cmd_completer (c, condition_completer);
16213
16214 c = add_com ("tbreak", class_breakpoint, tbreak_command, _("\
16215 Set a temporary breakpoint.\n\
16216 Like \"break\" except the breakpoint is only temporary,\n\
16217 so it will be deleted when hit. Equivalent to \"break\" followed\n\
16218 by using \"enable delete\" on the breakpoint number.\n\
16219 \n"
16220 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("tbreak")));
16221 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
16222
16223 c = add_com ("hbreak", class_breakpoint, hbreak_command, _("\
16224 Set a hardware assisted breakpoint.\n\
16225 Like \"break\" except the breakpoint requires hardware support,\n\
16226 some target hardware may not have this support.\n\
16227 \n"
16228 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("hbreak")));
16229 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
16230
16231 c = add_com ("thbreak", class_breakpoint, thbreak_command, _("\
16232 Set a temporary hardware assisted breakpoint.\n\
16233 Like \"hbreak\" except the breakpoint is only temporary,\n\
16234 so it will be deleted when hit.\n\
16235 \n"
16236 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("thbreak")));
16237 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
16238
16239 add_prefix_cmd ("enable", class_breakpoint, enable_command, _("\
16240 Enable some breakpoints.\n\
16241 Give breakpoint numbers (separated by spaces) as arguments.\n\
16242 With no subcommand, breakpoints are enabled until you command otherwise.\n\
16243 This is used to cancel the effect of the \"disable\" command.\n\
16244 With a subcommand you can enable temporarily."),
16245 &enablelist, "enable ", 1, &cmdlist);
16246
16247 add_com_alias ("en", "enable", class_breakpoint, 1);
16248
16249 add_prefix_cmd ("breakpoints", class_breakpoint, enable_command, _("\
16250 Enable some breakpoints.\n\
16251 Give breakpoint numbers (separated by spaces) as arguments.\n\
16252 This is used to cancel the effect of the \"disable\" command.\n\
16253 May be abbreviated to simply \"enable\".\n"),
16254 &enablebreaklist, "enable breakpoints ", 1, &enablelist);
16255
16256 add_cmd ("once", no_class, enable_once_command, _("\
16257 Enable breakpoints for one hit. Give breakpoint numbers.\n\
16258 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it becomes disabled."),
16259 &enablebreaklist);
16260
16261 add_cmd ("delete", no_class, enable_delete_command, _("\
16262 Enable breakpoints and delete when hit. Give breakpoint numbers.\n\
16263 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it is deleted."),
16264 &enablebreaklist);
16265
16266 add_cmd ("count", no_class, enable_count_command, _("\
16267 Enable breakpoints for COUNT hits. Give count and then breakpoint numbers.\n\
16268 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion,\n\
16269 the count is decremented; when it reaches zero, the breakpoint is disabled."),
16270 &enablebreaklist);
16271
16272 add_cmd ("delete", no_class, enable_delete_command, _("\
16273 Enable breakpoints and delete when hit. Give breakpoint numbers.\n\
16274 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it is deleted."),
16275 &enablelist);
16276
16277 add_cmd ("once", no_class, enable_once_command, _("\
16278 Enable breakpoints for one hit. Give breakpoint numbers.\n\
16279 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it becomes disabled."),
16280 &enablelist);
16281
16282 add_cmd ("count", no_class, enable_count_command, _("\
16283 Enable breakpoints for COUNT hits. Give count and then breakpoint numbers.\n\
16284 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion,\n\
16285 the count is decremented; when it reaches zero, the breakpoint is disabled."),
16286 &enablelist);
16287
16288 add_prefix_cmd ("disable", class_breakpoint, disable_command, _("\
16289 Disable some breakpoints.\n\
16290 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
16291 To disable all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
16292 A disabled breakpoint is not forgotten, but has no effect until re-enabled."),
16293 &disablelist, "disable ", 1, &cmdlist);
16294 add_com_alias ("dis", "disable", class_breakpoint, 1);
16295 add_com_alias ("disa", "disable", class_breakpoint, 1);
16296
16297 add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_alias, disable_command, _("\
16298 Disable some breakpoints.\n\
16299 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
16300 To disable all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
16301 A disabled breakpoint is not forgotten, but has no effect until re-enabled.\n\
16302 This command may be abbreviated \"disable\"."),
16303 &disablelist);
16304
16305 add_prefix_cmd ("delete", class_breakpoint, delete_command, _("\
16306 Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions.\n\
16307 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
16308 To delete all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
16309 \n\
16310 Also a prefix command for deletion of other GDB objects.\n\
16311 The \"unset\" command is also an alias for \"delete\"."),
16312 &deletelist, "delete ", 1, &cmdlist);
16313 add_com_alias ("d", "delete", class_breakpoint, 1);
16314 add_com_alias ("del", "delete", class_breakpoint, 1);
16315
16316 add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_alias, delete_command, _("\
16317 Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions.\n\
16318 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
16319 To delete all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
16320 This command may be abbreviated \"delete\"."),
16321 &deletelist);
16322
16323 add_com ("clear", class_breakpoint, clear_command, _("\
16324 Clear breakpoint at specified location.\n\
16325 Argument may be a linespec, explicit, or address location as described below.\n\
16326 \n\
16327 With no argument, clears all breakpoints in the line that the selected frame\n\
16328 is executing in.\n"
16329 "\n" LOCATION_HELP_STRING "\n\
16330 See also the \"delete\" command which clears breakpoints by number."));
16331 add_com_alias ("cl", "clear", class_breakpoint, 1);
16332
16333 c = add_com ("break", class_breakpoint, break_command, _("\
16334 Set breakpoint at specified location.\n"
16335 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("break")));
16336 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
16337
16338 add_com_alias ("b", "break", class_run, 1);
16339 add_com_alias ("br", "break", class_run, 1);
16340 add_com_alias ("bre", "break", class_run, 1);
16341 add_com_alias ("brea", "break", class_run, 1);
16342
16343 if (dbx_commands)
16344 {
16345 add_abbrev_prefix_cmd ("stop", class_breakpoint, stop_command, _("\
16346 Break in function/address or break at a line in the current file."),
16347 &stoplist, "stop ", 1, &cmdlist);
16348 add_cmd ("in", class_breakpoint, stopin_command,
16349 _("Break in function or address."), &stoplist);
16350 add_cmd ("at", class_breakpoint, stopat_command,
16351 _("Break at a line in the current file."), &stoplist);
16352 add_com ("status", class_info, breakpoints_info, _("\
16353 Status of user-settable breakpoints, or breakpoint number NUMBER.\n\
16354 The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\
16355 \tbreakpoint - normal breakpoint\n\
16356 \twatchpoint - watchpoint\n\
16357 The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\
16358 the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit. \"dis\" means that the\n\
16359 breakpoint will be disabled. The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\
16360 address and file/line number respectively.\n\
16361 \n\
16362 Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\
16363 are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\
16364 is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\
16365 Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\
16366 breakpoint set."));
16367 }
16368
16369 add_info ("breakpoints", breakpoints_info, _("\
16370 Status of specified breakpoints (all user-settable breakpoints if no argument).\n\
16371 The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\
16372 \tbreakpoint - normal breakpoint\n\
16373 \twatchpoint - watchpoint\n\
16374 The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\
16375 the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit. \"dis\" means that the\n\
16376 breakpoint will be disabled. The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\
16377 address and file/line number respectively.\n\
16378 \n\
16379 Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\
16380 are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\
16381 is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\
16382 Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\
16383 breakpoint set."));
16384
16385 add_info_alias ("b", "breakpoints", 1);
16386
16387 add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_maintenance, maintenance_info_breakpoints, _("\
16388 Status of all breakpoints, or breakpoint number NUMBER.\n\
16389 The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\
16390 \tbreakpoint - normal breakpoint\n\
16391 \twatchpoint - watchpoint\n\
16392 \tlongjmp - internal breakpoint used to step through longjmp()\n\
16393 \tlongjmp resume - internal breakpoint at the target of longjmp()\n\
16394 \tuntil - internal breakpoint used by the \"until\" command\n\
16395 \tfinish - internal breakpoint used by the \"finish\" command\n\
16396 The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\
16397 the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit. \"dis\" means that the\n\
16398 breakpoint will be disabled. The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\
16399 address and file/line number respectively.\n\
16400 \n\
16401 Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\
16402 are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\
16403 is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\
16404 Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\
16405 breakpoint set."),
16406 &maintenanceinfolist);
16407
16408 add_prefix_cmd ("catch", class_breakpoint, catch_command, _("\
16409 Set catchpoints to catch events."),
16410 &catch_cmdlist, "catch ",
16411 0/*allow-unknown*/, &cmdlist);
16412
16413 add_prefix_cmd ("tcatch", class_breakpoint, tcatch_command, _("\
16414 Set temporary catchpoints to catch events."),
16415 &tcatch_cmdlist, "tcatch ",
16416 0/*allow-unknown*/, &cmdlist);
16417
16418 add_catch_command ("fork", _("Catch calls to fork."),
16419 catch_fork_command_1,
16420 NULL,
16421 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_fork_permanent,
16422 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_fork_temporary);
16423 add_catch_command ("vfork", _("Catch calls to vfork."),
16424 catch_fork_command_1,
16425 NULL,
16426 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_vfork_permanent,
16427 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_vfork_temporary);
16428 add_catch_command ("exec", _("Catch calls to exec."),
16429 catch_exec_command_1,
16430 NULL,
16431 CATCH_PERMANENT,
16432 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
16433 add_catch_command ("load", _("Catch loads of shared libraries.\n\
16434 Usage: catch load [REGEX]\n\
16435 If REGEX is given, only stop for libraries matching the regular expression."),
16436 catch_load_command_1,
16437 NULL,
16438 CATCH_PERMANENT,
16439 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
16440 add_catch_command ("unload", _("Catch unloads of shared libraries.\n\
16441 Usage: catch unload [REGEX]\n\
16442 If REGEX is given, only stop for libraries matching the regular expression."),
16443 catch_unload_command_1,
16444 NULL,
16445 CATCH_PERMANENT,
16446 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
16447
16448 c = add_com ("watch", class_breakpoint, watch_command, _("\
16449 Set a watchpoint for an expression.\n\
16450 Usage: watch [-l|-location] EXPRESSION\n\
16451 A watchpoint stops execution of your program whenever the value of\n\
16452 an expression changes.\n\
16453 If -l or -location is given, this evaluates EXPRESSION and watches\n\
16454 the memory to which it refers."));
16455 set_cmd_completer (c, expression_completer);
16456
16457 c = add_com ("rwatch", class_breakpoint, rwatch_command, _("\
16458 Set a read watchpoint for an expression.\n\
16459 Usage: rwatch [-l|-location] EXPRESSION\n\
16460 A watchpoint stops execution of your program whenever the value of\n\
16461 an expression is read.\n\
16462 If -l or -location is given, this evaluates EXPRESSION and watches\n\
16463 the memory to which it refers."));
16464 set_cmd_completer (c, expression_completer);
16465
16466 c = add_com ("awatch", class_breakpoint, awatch_command, _("\
16467 Set a watchpoint for an expression.\n\
16468 Usage: awatch [-l|-location] EXPRESSION\n\
16469 A watchpoint stops execution of your program whenever the value of\n\
16470 an expression is either read or written.\n\
16471 If -l or -location is given, this evaluates EXPRESSION and watches\n\
16472 the memory to which it refers."));
16473 set_cmd_completer (c, expression_completer);
16474
16475 add_info ("watchpoints", watchpoints_info, _("\
16476 Status of specified watchpoints (all watchpoints if no argument)."));
16477
16478 /* XXX: cagney/2005-02-23: This should be a boolean, and should
16479 respond to changes - contrary to the description. */
16480 add_setshow_zinteger_cmd ("can-use-hw-watchpoints", class_support,
16481 &can_use_hw_watchpoints, _("\
16482 Set debugger's willingness to use watchpoint hardware."), _("\
16483 Show debugger's willingness to use watchpoint hardware."), _("\
16484 If zero, gdb will not use hardware for new watchpoints, even if\n\
16485 such is available. (However, any hardware watchpoints that were\n\
16486 created before setting this to nonzero, will continue to use watchpoint\n\
16487 hardware.)"),
16488 NULL,
16489 show_can_use_hw_watchpoints,
16490 &setlist, &showlist);
16491
16492 can_use_hw_watchpoints = 1;
16493
16494 /* Tracepoint manipulation commands. */
16495
16496 c = add_com ("trace", class_breakpoint, trace_command, _("\
16497 Set a tracepoint at specified location.\n\
16498 \n"
16499 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("trace") "\n\
16500 Do \"help tracepoints\" for info on other tracepoint commands."));
16501 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
16502
16503 add_com_alias ("tp", "trace", class_alias, 0);
16504 add_com_alias ("tr", "trace", class_alias, 1);
16505 add_com_alias ("tra", "trace", class_alias, 1);
16506 add_com_alias ("trac", "trace", class_alias, 1);
16507
16508 c = add_com ("ftrace", class_breakpoint, ftrace_command, _("\
16509 Set a fast tracepoint at specified location.\n\
16510 \n"
16511 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("ftrace") "\n\
16512 Do \"help tracepoints\" for info on other tracepoint commands."));
16513 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
16514
16515 c = add_com ("strace", class_breakpoint, strace_command, _("\
16516 Set a static tracepoint at location or marker.\n\
16517 \n\
16518 strace [LOCATION] [if CONDITION]\n\
16519 LOCATION may be a linespec, explicit, or address location (described below) \n\
16520 or -m MARKER_ID.\n\n\
16521 If a marker id is specified, probe the marker with that name. With\n\
16522 no LOCATION, uses current execution address of the selected stack frame.\n\
16523 Static tracepoints accept an extra collect action -- ``collect $_sdata''.\n\
16524 This collects arbitrary user data passed in the probe point call to the\n\
16525 tracing library. You can inspect it when analyzing the trace buffer,\n\
16526 by printing the $_sdata variable like any other convenience variable.\n\
16527 \n\
16528 CONDITION is a boolean expression.\n\
16529 \n" LOCATION_HELP_STRING "\n\
16530 Multiple tracepoints at one place are permitted, and useful if their\n\
16531 conditions are different.\n\
16532 \n\
16533 Do \"help breakpoints\" for info on other commands dealing with breakpoints.\n\
16534 Do \"help tracepoints\" for info on other tracepoint commands."));
16535 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
16536
16537 add_info ("tracepoints", tracepoints_info, _("\
16538 Status of specified tracepoints (all tracepoints if no argument).\n\
16539 Convenience variable \"$tpnum\" contains the number of the\n\
16540 last tracepoint set."));
16541
16542 add_info_alias ("tp", "tracepoints", 1);
16543
16544 add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, delete_trace_command, _("\
16545 Delete specified tracepoints.\n\
16546 Arguments are tracepoint numbers, separated by spaces.\n\
16547 No argument means delete all tracepoints."),
16548 &deletelist);
16549 add_alias_cmd ("tr", "tracepoints", class_trace, 1, &deletelist);
16550
16551 c = add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, disable_trace_command, _("\
16552 Disable specified tracepoints.\n\
16553 Arguments are tracepoint numbers, separated by spaces.\n\
16554 No argument means disable all tracepoints."),
16555 &disablelist);
16556 deprecate_cmd (c, "disable");
16557
16558 c = add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, enable_trace_command, _("\
16559 Enable specified tracepoints.\n\
16560 Arguments are tracepoint numbers, separated by spaces.\n\
16561 No argument means enable all tracepoints."),
16562 &enablelist);
16563 deprecate_cmd (c, "enable");
16564
16565 add_com ("passcount", class_trace, trace_pass_command, _("\
16566 Set the passcount for a tracepoint.\n\
16567 The trace will end when the tracepoint has been passed 'count' times.\n\
16568 Usage: passcount COUNT TPNUM, where TPNUM may also be \"all\";\n\
16569 if TPNUM is omitted, passcount refers to the last tracepoint defined."));
16570
16571 add_prefix_cmd ("save", class_breakpoint, save_command,
16572 _("Save breakpoint definitions as a script."),
16573 &save_cmdlist, "save ",
16574 0/*allow-unknown*/, &cmdlist);
16575
16576 c = add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_breakpoint, save_breakpoints_command, _("\
16577 Save current breakpoint definitions as a script.\n\
16578 This includes all types of breakpoints (breakpoints, watchpoints,\n\
16579 catchpoints, tracepoints). Use the 'source' command in another debug\n\
16580 session to restore them."),
16581 &save_cmdlist);
16582 set_cmd_completer (c, filename_completer);
16583
16584 c = add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, save_tracepoints_command, _("\
16585 Save current tracepoint definitions as a script.\n\
16586 Use the 'source' command in another debug session to restore them."),
16587 &save_cmdlist);
16588 set_cmd_completer (c, filename_completer);
16589
16590 c = add_com_alias ("save-tracepoints", "save tracepoints", class_trace, 0);
16591 deprecate_cmd (c, "save tracepoints");
16592
16593 add_prefix_cmd ("breakpoint", class_maintenance, set_breakpoint_cmd, _("\
16594 Breakpoint specific settings\n\
16595 Configure various breakpoint-specific variables such as\n\
16596 pending breakpoint behavior"),
16597 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist, "set breakpoint ",
16598 0/*allow-unknown*/, &setlist);
16599 add_prefix_cmd ("breakpoint", class_maintenance, show_breakpoint_cmd, _("\
16600 Breakpoint specific settings\n\
16601 Configure various breakpoint-specific variables such as\n\
16602 pending breakpoint behavior"),
16603 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist, "show breakpoint ",
16604 0/*allow-unknown*/, &showlist);
16605
16606 add_setshow_auto_boolean_cmd ("pending", no_class,
16607 &pending_break_support, _("\
16608 Set debugger's behavior regarding pending breakpoints."), _("\
16609 Show debugger's behavior regarding pending breakpoints."), _("\
16610 If on, an unrecognized breakpoint location will cause gdb to create a\n\
16611 pending breakpoint. If off, an unrecognized breakpoint location results in\n\
16612 an error. If auto, an unrecognized breakpoint location results in a\n\
16613 user-query to see if a pending breakpoint should be created."),
16614 NULL,
16615 show_pending_break_support,
16616 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist,
16617 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist);
16618
16619 pending_break_support = AUTO_BOOLEAN_AUTO;
16620
16621 add_setshow_boolean_cmd ("auto-hw", no_class,
16622 &automatic_hardware_breakpoints, _("\
16623 Set automatic usage of hardware breakpoints."), _("\
16624 Show automatic usage of hardware breakpoints."), _("\
16625 If set, the debugger will automatically use hardware breakpoints for\n\
16626 breakpoints set with \"break\" but falling in read-only memory. If not set,\n\
16627 a warning will be emitted for such breakpoints."),
16628 NULL,
16629 show_automatic_hardware_breakpoints,
16630 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist,
16631 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist);
16632
16633 add_setshow_boolean_cmd ("always-inserted", class_support,
16634 &always_inserted_mode, _("\
16635 Set mode for inserting breakpoints."), _("\
16636 Show mode for inserting breakpoints."), _("\
16637 When this mode is on, breakpoints are inserted immediately as soon as\n\
16638 they're created, kept inserted even when execution stops, and removed\n\
16639 only when the user deletes them. When this mode is off (the default),\n\
16640 breakpoints are inserted only when execution continues, and removed\n\
16641 when execution stops."),
16642 NULL,
16643 &show_always_inserted_mode,
16644 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist,
16645 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist);
16646
16647 add_setshow_enum_cmd ("condition-evaluation", class_breakpoint,
16648 condition_evaluation_enums,
16649 &condition_evaluation_mode_1, _("\
16650 Set mode of breakpoint condition evaluation."), _("\
16651 Show mode of breakpoint condition evaluation."), _("\
16652 When this is set to \"host\", breakpoint conditions will be\n\
16653 evaluated on the host's side by GDB. When it is set to \"target\",\n\
16654 breakpoint conditions will be downloaded to the target (if the target\n\
16655 supports such feature) and conditions will be evaluated on the target's side.\n\
16656 If this is set to \"auto\" (default), this will be automatically set to\n\
16657 \"target\" if it supports condition evaluation, otherwise it will\n\
16658 be set to \"gdb\""),
16659 &set_condition_evaluation_mode,
16660 &show_condition_evaluation_mode,
16661 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist,
16662 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist);
16663
16664 add_com ("break-range", class_breakpoint, break_range_command, _("\
16665 Set a breakpoint for an address range.\n\
16666 break-range START-LOCATION, END-LOCATION\n\
16667 where START-LOCATION and END-LOCATION can be one of the following:\n\
16668 LINENUM, for that line in the current file,\n\
16669 FILE:LINENUM, for that line in that file,\n\
16670 +OFFSET, for that number of lines after the current line\n\
16671 or the start of the range\n\
16672 FUNCTION, for the first line in that function,\n\
16673 FILE:FUNCTION, to distinguish among like-named static functions.\n\
16674 *ADDRESS, for the instruction at that address.\n\
16675 \n\
16676 The breakpoint will stop execution of the inferior whenever it executes\n\
16677 an instruction at any address within the [START-LOCATION, END-LOCATION]\n\
16678 range (including START-LOCATION and END-LOCATION)."));
16679
16680 c = add_com ("dprintf", class_breakpoint, dprintf_command, _("\
16681 Set a dynamic printf at specified location.\n\
16682 dprintf location,format string,arg1,arg2,...\n\
16683 location may be a linespec, explicit, or address location.\n"
16684 "\n" LOCATION_HELP_STRING));
16685 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
16686
16687 add_setshow_enum_cmd ("dprintf-style", class_support,
16688 dprintf_style_enums, &dprintf_style, _("\
16689 Set the style of usage for dynamic printf."), _("\
16690 Show the style of usage for dynamic printf."), _("\
16691 This setting chooses how GDB will do a dynamic printf.\n\
16692 If the value is \"gdb\", then the printing is done by GDB to its own\n\
16693 console, as with the \"printf\" command.\n\
16694 If the value is \"call\", the print is done by calling a function in your\n\
16695 program; by default printf(), but you can choose a different function or\n\
16696 output stream by setting dprintf-function and dprintf-channel."),
16697 update_dprintf_commands, NULL,
16698 &setlist, &showlist);
16699
16700 dprintf_function = xstrdup ("printf");
16701 add_setshow_string_cmd ("dprintf-function", class_support,
16702 &dprintf_function, _("\
16703 Set the function to use for dynamic printf"), _("\
16704 Show the function to use for dynamic printf"), NULL,
16705 update_dprintf_commands, NULL,
16706 &setlist, &showlist);
16707
16708 dprintf_channel = xstrdup ("");
16709 add_setshow_string_cmd ("dprintf-channel", class_support,
16710 &dprintf_channel, _("\
16711 Set the channel to use for dynamic printf"), _("\
16712 Show the channel to use for dynamic printf"), NULL,
16713 update_dprintf_commands, NULL,
16714 &setlist, &showlist);
16715
16716 add_setshow_boolean_cmd ("disconnected-dprintf", no_class,
16717 &disconnected_dprintf, _("\
16718 Set whether dprintf continues after GDB disconnects."), _("\
16719 Show whether dprintf continues after GDB disconnects."), _("\
16720 Use this to let dprintf commands continue to hit and produce output\n\
16721 even if GDB disconnects or detaches from the target."),
16722 NULL,
16723 NULL,
16724 &setlist, &showlist);
16725
16726 add_com ("agent-printf", class_vars, agent_printf_command, _("\
16727 agent-printf \"printf format string\", arg1, arg2, arg3, ..., argn\n\
16728 (target agent only) This is useful for formatted output in user-defined commands."));
16729
16730 automatic_hardware_breakpoints = 1;
16731
16732 observer_attach_about_to_proceed (breakpoint_about_to_proceed);
16733 observer_attach_thread_exit (remove_threaded_breakpoints);
16734 }
This page took 0.353909 seconds and 5 git commands to generate.